View original document

The full text on this page is automatically extracted from the file linked above and may contain errors and inconsistencies.

BUDGET

BUDGET OF THE UNITED STATES GOVERNMENT

Fiscal Year 1998

THE BUDGET DOCUMENTS
Budget of the United States Government, Fiscal Year 1998
contains the Budget Message of the President and information on
the President’s 1998 budget proposals. In addition, the Budget includes a descriptive discussion of Federal programs organized by function, i.e., by the primary purpose of the activity.
Analytical Perspectives, Budget of the United States Government, Fiscal Year 1998 contains analyses that are designed to highlight specified subject areas or provide other significant presentations
of budget data that place the budget in perspective.
The Analytical Perspectives volume includes economic and accounting analyses; information on Federal receipts and collections; analyses
of Federal spending; detailed information on Federal borrowing and
debt; the Budget Enforcement Act preview report; current services
estimates; and other technical presentations. It also includes information on the budget system and concepts and a listing of the Federal
programs by agency and account.
Historical Tables, Budget of the United States Government,
Fiscal Year 1998 provides data on budget receipts, outlays, surpluses or deficits, Federal debt, and Federal employment covering
an extended time period—in most cases beginning in fiscal year 1940
or earlier and ending in fiscal year 2002. These are much longer
time periods than those covered by similar tables in other budget
documents. As much as possible, the data in this volume and all
other historical data in the budget documents have been made consistent with the concepts and presentation used in the 1998 Budget,
so the data series are comparable over time.
Budget of the United States Government, Fiscal Year 1998—
Appendix contains detailed information on the various appropriations and funds that constitute the budget and is designed primarily
for the use of the Appropriations Committee. The Appendix contains
more detailed financial information on individual programs and appropriation accounts than any of the other budget documents. It

includes for each agency: the proposed text of appropriations language, budget schedules for each account, new legislative proposals,
explanations of the work to be performed and the funds needed,
and proposed general provisions applicable to the appropriations of
entire agencies or group of agencies. Supplemental and rescission
proposals for the current year are presented separately. Information
is also provided on certain activities whose outlays are not part
of the budget totals.
A Citizen’s Guide to the Federal Budget, Budget of the United States Government, Fiscal Year 1998 is an Office of Management and Budget (OMB) publication that provides general information about the budget and the budget process for the general public.
Budget System and Concepts, Fiscal Year 1998 contains an
explanation of the system and concepts used to formulate the President’s budget proposals.
AUTOMATED SOURCES OF BUDGET INFORMATION
The information contained in these documents is available in
electronic format from the following sources:
CD-ROM. The CD-ROM contains all of the budget documents and
software to support reading, printing, and searching the documents.
The CD-ROM also has many of the tables in the budget in
spreadsheet format.
Internet. All budget documents, including documents that are
released at a future date, will be available for downloading in several
formats from the Internet. To access documents through the World
Wide Web, use the following address:
http://www.access.gpo.gov/su_docs/budget/index.html
For more information on access to the budget documents, call tollfree (888) 293–6498.

GENERAL NOTES
1.
2.

All years referred to are fiscal years, unless otherwise noted.
Detail in this document may not add to the totals due to rounding.

U.S. GOVERNMENT PRINTING OFFICE
WASHINGTON

1997

For sale by the Superintendent of Documents, U.S. Government Printing Office, Washington, D.C. 20402

1

TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page

I.

The Budget Message of the President .............................................................

1

II.

Building a Bridge to the 21st Century ............................................................

11

III.

Putting the Building Blocks in Place ..............................................................

21

IV.

Improving Performance in a Balanced Budget World ................................

35

V.

Creating Opportunity, Demanding Responsibility, and Strengthening
Community

VI.

1.

Strengthening Health Care ..................................................................

49

2.

Investing in Education and Training ..................................................

57

3.

Protecting the Environment .................................................................

67

4.

Promoting Research ..............................................................................

77

5.

Enforcing the Law .................................................................................

85

6.

Restoring the American Community ...................................................

95

7.

Implementing Welfare Reform .............................................................

105

8.

Promoting Tax Fairness .......................................................................

111

9.

Supporting America’s Global Leadership ............................................

117

10.

Supporting the World’s Strongest Military Force ..............................

123

Investing in the Common Good: The Major Functions of the Federal
Government
11.

Overview ................................................................................................

131

12.

National Defense ...................................................................................

137

13.

International Affairs .............................................................................

141

14.

General Science, Space, and Technology .............................................

145

15.

Energy ....................................................................................................

149

16.

Natural Resources and Environment ..................................................

153

17.

Agriculture .............................................................................................

159

18.

Commerce and Housing Credit ............................................................

163

19.

Transportation .......................................................................................

169

20.

Community and Regional Development ..............................................

173

21.

Education, Training, Employment, and Social Services ....................

177

22.

Health ....................................................................................................

181

23.

Medicare ................................................................................................

185

24.

Income Security .....................................................................................

189
i

ii

TABLE OF CONTENTS—Continued
Page

VII.

25.

Social Security .......................................................................................

193

26.

Veterans Benefits and Services ...........................................................

199

27.

Administration of Justice .....................................................................

203

28.

General Government .............................................................................

207

29.

Net Interest ...........................................................................................

211

30.

Undistributed Offsetting Receipts .......................................................

215

31.

Detailed Functional Tables ..................................................................

217

Summary Tables
Budget Aggregates .........................................................................................

303

1998 Budget Proposals ..................................................................................

309

Summaries by Agency ...................................................................................

323

Other Summary Tables .................................................................................

329

VIII.

List of Charts and Tables ....................................................................................

333

IX.

OMB Contributors to the 1998 Budget ............................................................

343

I.

THE BUDGET MESSAGE
OF THE PRESIDENT

1

2

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

THE FEDERAL GOVERNMENT DOLLAR
FISCAL YEAR 1998 ESTIMATES

WHERE IT COMES FROM...
CORPORATE
INCOME
TAXES
11 %

SOCIAL
INSURANCE
RECEIPTS
33 %

OTHER
4%
BORROWING
7%

EXCISE
TAXES
4%

INDIVIDUAL
INCOME
TAXES
41 %

WHERE IT GOES...

DIRECT BENEFIT
PAYMENTS FOR
INDIVIDUALS
50 %

OTHER
FEDERAL
OPERATIONS
5%

GRANTS TO
STATES
& LOCALITIES
15 %

Table I–1.

NET
INTEREST
15 %

NATIONAL
DEFENSE
15 %

RECEIPTS, OUTLAYS, AND SURPLUS OR DEFICIT
(In billions of dollars)
Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Receipts ........................................
Outlays .........................................

1,453
1,560

1,505
1,631

1,567
1,687

1,643
1,761

1,727
1,814

1,808
1,844

1,897
1,880

Surplus/Deficit (–):
Unified ......................................
On-budget .................................
Off-budget .................................

–107
–174
67

–126
–199
74

–121
–197
76

–117
–205
87

–87
–183
96

–36
–139
103

17
–93
110

THE BUDGET MESSAGE OF THE PRESIDENT
To the Congress of the United States:
The 1998 Budget, which I am transmitting
to you with this message, builds upon our
successful economic program of the last four
years by balancing the budget while investing
in the future.
My budget reaches balance in 2002 the
right way—cutting unnecessary and lowerpriority spending while protecting our values.
It strengthens Medicare and Medicaid, improves last year’s welfare reform law, and
provides tax relief to help Americans raise
their children, send them to college, and
save for the future. It invests in education
and training, the environment, science and
technology, and law enforcement to raise
living standards and the quality of life for
average Americans.
Over the last four years, my Administration
and Congress have already done much of
the hard work of reaching balance in 2002.
We have reversed the trend of higher deficits
that we inherited, and we have gone almost
two-thirds of the way to reaching balance.
Now, I want to work with Congress to
achieve the final increment of deficit cutting
and bring the budget into balance for the
first time since 1969.
Building a Bridge to the 21st Century
For four years, my Administration has
worked to prepare America for the future,
to create a Government and a set of policies
that will help give Americans the tools they
need to compete in an increasingly competitive, global economy.
We have worked to create opportunity for
all Americans, to demand responsibility from
all Americans, and to strengthen the American
community. We have worked to bring the
Nation together because, as Americans have
shown time and again over the years, together
we can overcome whatever hurdles stand
before us.
Working with Congress and the American
people, we have put America on the right

path. Today, the United States is safer,
stronger, and more prosperous. Our budget
deficit is much smaller, our Government
much leaner, and our policies much wiser.
The economic plan that we put in place
in 1993 has exceeded all expectations. Already,
it has helped to reduce the deficit by 63
percent—from the record $290 billion of 1992
to just $107 billion in 1996—and it has
spurred a record of strong growth, low interest
rates, low inflation, millions of new jobs,
and record exports for four years.
While cutting the deficit, we also have
cut the Federal work force by over 250,000
positions, bringing it to its smallest size
in 30 years and, as a share of the civilian
work force, its smallest since the 1930s.
We have eliminated Federal regulations that
we don’t need and improved the ones we
do. And we have done all this while improving
the service that Federal agencies are providing
to the American people.
We have cut wisely. We have, in fact,
cut enough in unnecessary and lower-priority
spending to find the resources to invest
in the future. That’s why we were able
to cut taxes for 15 million working families,
to make college more affordable for 10 million
students, to put tens of thousands of young
people to work through national service, to
invest more in basic and biomedical research,
and to help reduce crime by putting more
police on the street.
My plan to reach balance in 2002 provides
the resources to continue these important
investments. We must not only provide tax
relief for average Americans, but also increase
access to education and training; expand
health insurance to the unemployed and
children who lack it; better protect the environment; enhance our investments in biomedical and other research; beef up our
law enforcement efforts; and provide the
needed funds for a thriving global policy
and a strong defense.
3

4
Putting the Building Blocks in Place
When my Administration took office in
1993, we inherited an economy that had
barely grown over the previous four years
while creating few jobs. The budget deficit
had hit record levels, and experts in and
out of Government expected it to go higher.
Savings and investment were down, interest
rates were up, and incomes remained stagnant, making it harder for families to pay
their bills.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

budget into balance for the first time since
1969 while continuing to invest in the American people. My budget does that.
Improving Performance in a Balanced
Budget World
Led by the Vice President’s National Performance Review, we are truly creating a
Government that ‘‘works better and costs
less.’’

We put in place a comprehensive set of
policies that are bearing fruit. By cutting
the deficit from $290 billion to $107 billion
last year, my economic program (and the
strong economy it helped create) has brought
the deficit to its lowest level since 1981.
As a share of Gross Domestic Product (GDP),
we have our smallest deficit since 1974
and the smallest of any major industrialized
nation.

We have cut the Federal work force by
over 250,000 positions, eliminated over 200
programs and projects, closed nearly 2,000
obsolete field offices, cut red tape, and eliminated thousands of pages of regulations while
dramatically simplifying thousands more. We
also are providing better service for Americans—at the Social Security Administration,
the Department of Veterans Affairs, and
other agencies.

Other parts of my economic policy also
are helping to create jobs and raise living
standards. With regard to trade, for instance,
my Administration not only completed the
Uruguay Round of the General Agreement
on Tariffs and Trade and the North American
Free Trade Agreement, but also more than
200 separate trade agreements, helping to
raise exports to record levels. By opening
overseas markets to American goods—by encouraging free and fair trade—we are creating
high-wage jobs at home.

Our efforts to balance the budget will
continue to put a premium on spending
wisely. I am determined that we will provide
the highest-quality service to Americans for
the lowest price. And I will demand that
agencies continue to search for better and
better ways to achieve results for the American people.

Taken together, our budget and trade policies have helped to create over 11 million
new jobs in the last four years. After two
decades of troubling stagnation, incomes have
begun to rise again while inequality shrinks.
Also, partly due to a strong economy (and
partly to our policies), poverty, welfare, and
crime are down all across America.
With strong growth, low interest rates,
low inflation, millions more jobs, record exports, more savings and investment, and
higher incomes, the Nation is enjoying what
such experts as Alan Greenspan, the chairman
of the Federal Reserve, have described as
the healthiest economy in a generation.
Now, our challenge is to complete the
job that we began in 1993—to bring the

As we move ahead, we plan to follow
a series of strategies that build upon our
successes to date. We will, for instance,
restructure agencies to make them more
flexible and decentralized. We will work to
ensure that Federal employees and their
managers work together to achieve common
goals. We will expand competition to ensure
that agencies perform their functions as efficiently as possible.
Government cannot solve all of our problems, but it surely must help us solve
many of them. We need an effective Government to serve as a partner with States,
localities, business and labor, communities,
schools, and families. Only when we can
show the American people that Government
can, in fact, work better for them can we
restore their confidence in it. And I am
determined to do just that.

THE BUDGET MESSAGE OF THE PRESIDENT

Creating Opportunity, Demanding
Responsibility, and Strengthening
Community
I worked with the last Congress to ensure
that as many as 25 million Americans no
longer have to fear that they will lose
their access to health insurance if they lose
their jobs or change jobs; that people no
longer will be denied coverage because they
have preexisting medical conditions; that insurance companies will sell coverage to small
employer groups and to individuals who lose
group coverage; and that self-employed people
will find it easier and cheaper to get health
insurance. Now, I want to strengthen both
Medicare and Medicaid to ensure that they
continue to serve the tens of millions of
Americans who rely on them, to expand
health care coverage to help the growing
numbers of American children and families
who lack insurance, and to promote public
health. My budget invests more in biomedical
research, in programs to combat infectious
diseases, in the Ryan White AIDS program
that provides potentially life-extending drug
therapies to many people with AIDS, and
in community health centers and Indian
Health Service facilities that serve critically
underserved populations.
We have to ensure that every American
has the skills and education needed to win
in the new economy, and we can do that
only if every American is ready for a lifetime
of continuous learning. My budget expands
Head Start, increases our investments in
Federal elementary and secondary education
programs, launches a new effort to jumpstart needed school renovation and construction, and provides funds for America Reads
to ensure that all children can read well
and independently by the end of third grade.
To expand higher education and training
to all Americans, I propose HOPE scholarship
tax credits of up to $1,500 for two years,
tax deductions of up to $10,000, the largest
increase in Pell Grant scholarships in two
decades, lower student loan fees and interest
rates, and the G.I. Bill for America’s Workers
so they can choose where to get the best
job training available.
We do not have to choose between a
stronger economy and a cleaner environment.

5
Over the last four years, we have produced
both. Now, we want to go further. In this
budget, I am proposing the funds to speed
up toxic waste clean-ups, to redevelop abandoned and contaminated sites known as
‘‘brownfields,’’ to improve the facilities at
our national parks, to advance our salmon
recovery efforts, to invest in energy efficiency
and renewable energy, to further our environmental efforts overseas, and to expand our
work with States, localities, private groups,
and others to restore such sensitive ecosystems
as the South Florida Everglades and California’s Bay-Delta area between San Francisco
and Sacramento.
We must maintain our leadership in research, the results of which have so greatly
improved our health and well-being. Federal
research, in concert with the private sector,
creates new knowledge, trains our workers,
generates new jobs and industries, solves
many of our health care challenges, strengthens our ability to address environmental
issues, enables us to teach our children
better, and ensures that we can maintain
a strong, capable national defense. I am
proposing to increase our investments in
basic research in health sciences at the
National Institutes of Health, in basic research
and education at the National Science Foundation, in research at other agencies that depend
on science and technology, and in cooperative
ventures with industry, such as through the
successful Advanced Technology Program and
Manufacturing Extension Partnerships.
I want to build on our efforts to fight
crime, curb the scourge of illegal drugs,
and secure the Nation’s borders. Crime is
falling all across America. And, under the
Brady Bill that I fought so hard to achieve,
we have prevented over 100,000 felons, fugitives, and stalkers from obtaining guns. Now,
I want to make further progress and, in
particular, target juvenile crime and violence.
My budget continues our progress toward
putting 100,000 more police on the street.
It renews our efforts to fight drug abuse,
particularly by focusing on youth prevention
programs to reverse the recent trends of
softening attitudes toward drugs and more
drug use by young Americans. It also strengthens our efforts to control illegal immigration
by stopping those who want to enter illegally,

6
quickly removing those who slipped by, and
making it harder for illegal immigrants to
get jobs.
Because some American communities have
grown disconnected from the opportunity and
prosperity that most of us enjoy, I want
to help communities attract private investment
to spur their revitalization. Because permanent solutions must come from the community
level, my budget proposes to create opportunities and offer incentives for individuals and
businesses to participate directly in addressing
local problems. I want to expand my national
service program so that more Americans
can volunteer and earn money for college.
I want to expand Empowerment Zones and
Enterprise Communities, making more and
more communities eligible for the tax incentives and other support that can spur a
return of business and jobs. I also want
to expand the Community Development Financial Institutions Fund to enhance credit and
other services to distressed areas. In addition,
the Nation’s capital, which suffers from a
unique set of challenges, would benefit greatly
from the groundbreaking proposal that I
have previously outlined.
I am pleased that, today, 2.1 million fewer
Americans are on welfare than the day
I took office, both because of a strong economy
and because I have helped States to test
innovative ways to move people from welfare
to work and protect children. I am also
pleased that I could sign last year’s welfare
reform legislation, because I believe it will
promote my basic goals of work, family,
and responsibility. I have directed my Administration to work closely with States so that
we can make welfare reform succeed. Last
year’s law, however, also included excessive
budget cuts, mainly affecting nutrition programs, legal immigrants, and children, that
had nothing to do with welfare reform. In
signing the bill, I said that I would seek
legislation to address those problems. My
budget does that.
Over the last four years, we have provided
tax relief to millions of working Americans
and to small businesses. But I want to
go further by helping middle-income Americans raise their children, send them to college,
and save for the future. For those Americans,

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

my tax plan offers a $500 per child tax
credit for all children under 13, a $1,500a-year tax credit to help families send their
children to college for two years, a $10,000
tax deduction for tuition and fees for higher
education and training, and expanded Individual Retirement Accounts to encourage saving
and enable families to cope with unforeseen
problems. I am also proposing to ensure
that homeowners do not have to pay capital
gains taxes on 99 percent of all home sales.
My tax plan would promote the hiring of
long-term welfare recipients in order to help
move people from welfare to work, restore
the tax credit that encourages business research and development, and expand tax
credits for Empowerment Zones and Enterprise Communities. And it would help finance
my tax relief by eliminating unwarranted
tax loopholes and preferences.
On the international front, we must continue
to project our leadership abroad while we
advance our national goals. With the Cold
War over, we have a great opportunity to
expand democracy overseas, but we will have
a much better chance to succeed if we
fulfill our international commitments. In this
budget, I am proposing that we pay our
arrears to the United Nations and other
international organizations, so that our leadership is not undermined at this crucial time.
But I will also insist that these institutions
control their budgets and enact the reforms
that our Government and others have called
for. In addition, we must continue our support
for Russia and the New Independent States
of the Soviet Union as they make the difficult
transition to free markets and democracy,
and we must be prepared to do whatever
we can to advance the difficult, but vital,
peace process in the Middle East. A strong,
coherent foreign policy also will help us
further our progress in opening markets
abroad, and my budget proposes strong, continued support for the Federal efforts that
help to expand exports.
Finally, our goals both at home and abroad
must rest on the firm foundation of a strong
national defense. It is a strong defense that
safeguards our interests, prevents conflict,
and secures the peace. We must ensure
that our armed forces are highly ready and
armed with the best equipment that tech-

7

THE BUDGET MESSAGE OF THE PRESIDENT

nology can provide. They must be prepared
and trained for the new threats to our
security—from the proliferation of weapons
of mass destruction, to ethnic and regional
conflicts, to terrorism and drug trafficking
that directly threaten our free and open
society. My budget continues to sustain and
modernize the world’s strongest and most
ready military force, a force capable of prevailing in two nearly simultaneous regional conflicts. It fully funds our commitment to
maintain the highest levels of training and
readiness, and to equip our uniformed men
and women with the most advanced technologies in the world. We must never fall
short when it comes to defense.
Conclusion

we have helped to spur four years of strong
economic growth, providing vast new opportunities for millions of Americans. Jobs, incomes,
savings, investment, exports, and homeownership are all up. Crime, poverty, teen pregnancy, and inequality are all down. Clearly,
we are moving in the right direction.
But our work is not done. For too long,
the Federal Government has spent much
more than it received, creating deficits that
cast doubt on both our economic future
and our ability to govern. In the last four
years, we have made huge progress, cutting
the deficit by nearly two-thirds. I urge Congress to help me finish the job and balance
the budget by 2002—giving the American
people the balanced budget they deserve.

Our policies are working. By dramatically
cutting the deficit and investing in the future,
WILLIAM J. CLINTON

February 6, 1997

II.

BUILDING A BRIDGE TO THE
21ST CENTURY

9

II.

BUILDING A BRIDGE TO THE 21ST
CENTURY

I would like to be remembered as the President who prepared America for . . . the 21st Century
where we had opportunity available to all Americans who were responsible enough to exercise it;
where we lived with the diversity of this country and the diversity of the world on terms of respect
and honor, giving everyone a chance to live up to the fullest of his or her own ability in building
a stronger sense of community, instead of becoming more divided, as so many countries are; and
where we continue to be the indispensable Nation in the world for peace and freedom and prosperity.
President Clinton
December 13, 1996

Nearly a century ago, America struggled
through what was, up to then, its most
profound change—from an economy rooted
in the farm to one powered by the machine.
As our economy changed, so did the lives
and habits of our people. Once mostly isolated
in small areas or small communities, Americans moved to towns and cities, transforming
how they lived, how they worked, and how
they related to one another.
With such change came new challenges.
Theodore Roosevelt and then Woodrow Wilson—two former governors, the first a Republican and the second a Democrat—provided
the responses for what eventually became
known as the Progressive Era. What this
burst of Federal activity represented was
a new way of thinking—of using Government
to address the wrongs, and shape the future,
of a growing Nation.
Today, the Nation faces an upheaval that
is just as great, as its economy moves
from one rooted in machines to one in
which information spreads from person to
person, city to city, nation to nation, at
lightning speed. Like the upheaval of 100
years earlier, this one, too, is transforming
the lives of our people, changing the way
we live, the way we work, and the way
we relate to one another.
But what worked in the Progressive Era
was inadequate for the demands prompted
by the Great Depression. What worked in

the 1930s gave way to a new approach
prompted by the Cold War. So, what worked
then must, in turn, give way to a new
approach for the times that we now face.
The Nation stands at one of those truly
unique moments in its history—a moment
that demands new thinking. The traditional
debates between liberals and conservatives
seem not to hold the answers for the challenges before us. We should not move left
or right; rather, we must move forward.
As the President has said, ‘‘the era of
big Government is over.’’ And we are, in
fact, cutting the size and scope of Government
as we move toward a balanced budget. But,
as the President also has said, the issue
is not solely bigger versus smaller. It is
also how to make Government better. For
if Americans do not want a Government
that tries to solve every problem, they just
as surely do not want one that retreats
from its proper role.
Generally speaking, governments do certain
things well. They ‘‘promote the general welfare’’ by safeguarding the public, financing
education, building roads and bridges, distributing benefit checks, and so on. The Federal
Government, in particular, defends the Nation
against attack, engages in international diplomacy, ensures retirement income, provides
health coverage for the elderly, the poor,
and people with disabilities, expands access
to education and housing, protects the environ11

12

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

ment, encourages business investment, and
more.
But the Federal Government does not—
indeed, cannot—do it all. Today, Federal
spending totals less than 25 percent of the
Nation’s income, as measured by the Gross
Domestic Product (GDP). To promote the
goals that Americans share, the Federal Government must work with State and local
governments, business and labor, non-profits,
communities, schools, and families.

I believe that the Federal Government should give people the tools and
try to establish the conditions in which
they can make the most of their own
lives. That, to me, is the key.
President Clinton
October 6, 1996

Nor, in this budget, should we think about
Government solely in terms of what it spends.
The Government provides services and benefits
in all sorts of ways. Not only does it distribute
cash and provide services, but it also allocates
tax incentives to achieve certain goals, such
as expanded home ownership and more research and development. At the same time,
it pursues social goals through responsible
regulation, such as protecting children by
reducing their access to cigarettes. (For a
discussion of the full range of Federal activities, see Section VI, ‘‘Investing in the Common
Good: The Major Functions of the Federal
Government.’’)
For four years, this Administration has
been creating a Government for the 21st
Century. It is leaner, but not meaner. It
spends money more wisely. It is no longer
wrapped in the red tape and bureaucracy
of yesterday. And it provides better service
to its ‘‘customers,’’ be they Social Security
recipients or victims of natural disasters.
Shrinking the Size of Government
Nowhere is our success more dramatic
than on the fiscal front. The budget deficit—
for too long a kind of public metaphor
for waste and mismanagement—had hit a
record $290 billion in 1992, the year before
President Clinton took office. The national

debt, meanwhile, had quadrupled, to $4 trillion, in the 12 years before the President
took office. By all accounts, the deficit was
on a path ever higher, about to heap more
debt on our children and grandchildren and
to force the Government to use more of
its taxpayer dollars not for anything useful
but, rather, to pay interest on the debt.
Then in 1993, the President worked with
Congress to enact his economic program of
lower deficits and, at the same time, more
public investment. Largely due to the plan,
and to the strong economic performance that
it has helped to spur, the deficit fell by
a whopping 63 percent, to just $107 billion
in 1996—its lowest level since 1981 and,
as a share of GDP, its lowest since 1974.
The plan slowed the growth of entitlements,
raised taxes almost entirely on the wealthiest
1.2 percent of Americans, and extended the
annual limits, or ‘‘caps,’’ on discretionary
spending for five years. While helping to
dramatically reduce the deficit, the plan also
cut taxes for 15 million working families,
made 90 percent of small businesses eligible
for tax relief, and invested in the future.
(For a full discussion of the Administration’s
fiscal policy, see Section III, ‘‘Putting the
Building Blocks in Place.’’)
By limiting total discretionary spending,
the caps put a premium on spending wisely—
on eliminating wasteful and lower-priority
programs while emphasizing investments in
the Nation’s future. Thus, the Administration
has worked with Congress to invest in education and training, and in research, in
order to enhance productivity and, in turn,
promote higher living standards; to protect
the environment and fight crime in order
to improve the quality of life for all Americans;
and to secure the resources for a global
policy that has brought peace to certain
troublespots and has expanded markets for
U.S. goods.
Facing the challenge of global competition,
American businesses are forcing themselves
to do more with less. The Federal Government
is doing the same. Led by Vice President
Gore’s National Performance Review, the Administration has worked hard to ‘‘create a
Government that works better and costs
less.’’

II.

13

BUILDING A BRIDGE TO THE 21ST CENTURY

As business downsizes, so does the Federal
Government. Four years after the President
and Vice President assumed office, and largely
due to their efforts, the Federal work force
stands at 1.9 million civilian employees 1—
its smallest size in 30 years and, as a
share of civilian employment, its smallest
since 1931. The Administration has cut the
work force by over 250,000 full-time equivalents (FTE),2 and it will continue shrinking
as the President and Congress finish the
job of balancing the budget.
The shrinking work force focuses the spotlight on those Federal workers who remain
on the job. It is they who must work
more effectively if the Federal Government
is to work better. From our efforts to reinvent
Government, which these workers have led,
the Administration knows that the vast majority of them want to do a good job. The
President and Vice President will continue
to view them as partners in a great quest
to give the American people the best Government that they can create.
To the average American, however, the
size of Government involves more than the
size of its budget or of its work force.
It involves the regulations (or rules) with
which millions of businesses and individuals
must comply. It also involves the responses
they receive when they call the Government
for help.
Regulations are not inherently good or
bad; potentially, they can be either. Good
rules bring us safer cars and workplaces,
cleaner air and water, and fairer business
practices. But bad rules—those that are too
costly, too intrusive, and too inflexible—can
impede businesses and other institutions from
doing their jobs.
The President has sought to develop a
more sensible regulatory program, one that
reduces the burden of existing and new
rules while improving their effectiveness. Specifically, the Administration has nearly
reached its goal of eliminating 16,000 pages
of regulations and dramatically simplifying
31,000 others. In addition, agencies are effectively implementing the President’s Executive
1 Not included in this figure are 1.5 million uniformed men and
women and 0.9 million employees of the Postal Service
2 As of September 1996.

Order 12866 of 1993—using better data and
analysis to make their decisions, considering
the costs and benefits of alternative ways
to reach their goals, and opening the decisionmaking process to those affected by the
rules.
What do Americans find when they call
their Government? Compared to four years
ago, they are likely to find a friendlier,
more responsive voice on the other end.
Agencies are making real progress in improving service to their customers, the American
people. They are finding new, innovative
ways to deliver service, and they are reaching
out to learn more about what their customers
want.
If anything, the challenges will only grow
for departments and agencies. They face
a future of severely constrained resources.
As a result, the Administration has developed
a set of strategies (or tools) by which agencies
will try to make even more progress in
this environment. (For a full discussion of
these seven tools, see Section IV, ‘‘Improving
Performance in a Balanced Budget World.’’)
Achieving Our Goals
But can smaller really be better? Can
we really do more with less? As the Administration has proved across a broad spectrum
of areas, the answer is a resounding ‘‘Yes!’’
The right kind of Government, making the
right kind of decisions, can have a demonstrably better effect on the lives of millions
of Americans.
Opportunity for all, responsibility from all,
and a stronger American community—those
have been the underpinnings for what the
Administration has sought to achieve. In
pursuing these goals, Administration policies
have helped to produce a strong economy
with better jobs, higher incomes, more pension
and health security, greater educational opportunity, safer streets, and a cleaner environment.
By cutting the deficit, for instance, the
President’s 1993 economic plan helped cut
interest rates, spurring strong growth with
steady prices. The result: over 11 million
new jobs (most of them high-wage); the
lowest inflation of any Administration in

14
over 30 years; the highest rate of homeownership in 15 years; rising incomes; falling
inequality; and record numbers of exports
and new small businesses.
With the 1993 plan limiting spending, the
President has worked with Congress to spend
the available resources most wisely, helping
to produce real results in education, the
environment, research, and law enforcement.
• His direct lending program has helped
make college more affordable for 10 million students.
• His national service program has enabled
70,000 Americans to earn money for college while building houses, helping children to read, patrolling the streets, and
performing other vital community work.
• His investments in research are helping
to build new, high-powered supercomputers, and to develop drugs that could extend the life expectancy of those with HIV
and AIDS.
• His community policing program has already put 64,000 more police (out of
100,000 under the program) on the streets
of America’s communities, helping to reduce serious and violent crime for five
straight years.
The President worked with Congress to:
• Raise the minimum wage, giving 10 million Americans a pay raise;
• Enact the Family and Medical Leave Act,
enabling 67 million workers to take up to
12 weeks of unpaid leave from work to
care for a newborn or a sick family member;
• Adopt the Kassebaum-Kennedy bill, ensuring that as many as 25 million American
workers would not lose their health insurance when they change jobs;
• Reform the Federal pension insurance system, protecting the pensions of over 40
million Americans;
• Take a vital first step ‘‘to end welfare as
we know it’’ by requiring able-bodied recipients to work;
• Adopt the Brady bill, imposing a five-day
waiting period on gun purchases that has

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

already prevented over 100,000 felons, fugitives, and stalkers from buying handguns;
• Ban the import and manufacture of 19
deadly assault weapons, keeping them
from would-be killers; and
• Overhaul the immigration system, cracking down on illegal immigration without
punishing legal immigrants.
The Administration also has acted on its
own to improve the lives of average Americans.
It has:
• Approved waivers (before last year’s welfare reform law) to let 43 States find innovative ways to move recipients off welfare
and into the economic mainstream. (Due
to those efforts and a strong economy, 2.1
million fewer Americans are on welfare
than when President Clinton took office.);
• Approved waivers to let 15 States pursue
major State-wide health reform initiatives
under Medicaid;
• Protected the border by deporting a record
206,000 illegal and criminal aliens from
1993 to 1996; and
• Completed the General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade and the North American
Free Trade Agreement, as well as over 200
other trade agreements, helping to spur
exports to record levels and, in turn, create high-wage jobs at home.
Our trade agreements, and the benefits
they produce, point to a growing reality—
we live in an increasingly inter-connected
world, one in which our prosperity at home
depends on our leadership abroad. Over the
last four years, the Administration has reduced tensions in the world’s troublespots
through the deft use of diplomacy and, when
necessary, the deployment of troops. Democracy in Haiti, peace in Bosnia, more dialogue
in the Middle East—they are all due to
American leadership.
Yet, despite his impressive four-year record
of accomplishment both at home and abroad,
the President understands that his work
is not done. Most importantly, we must
finish the job of balancing the budget. For
only when we balance the budget can we

II.

BUILDING A BRIDGE TO THE 21ST CENTURY

hope to assure a healthy economic future
for all Americans. And only then can we
hope to restore the public’s confidence in
Government.
The Task Ahead: Balancing the Budget
This budget fulfills the President’s commitment to reach balance in 2002. In fact,
under the Administration’s economic and technical assumptions, it would generate a $17
billion surplus that year.
The budget builds on the balanced budget
proposals that the President outlined in his
negotiations with the bipartisan congressional
leadership over the last two years. The
negotiations brought the two sides close to
an agreement, and the President is determined
to finish the job this year. He views this
budget proposal as the next step in the
march to reach balance.
Specifically, the President continues to seek
cuts in unnecessary and lower-priority spending in both discretionary and mandatory
programs, and to eliminate unwarranted tax
loopholes and preferences. His $388 billion
in total savings would do more than bring
the budget into balance by 2002. They also
would provide enough savings to finance
a modest tax cut to help middle-income
Americans raise their children, send them
to college, and save for the future; and
to correct the harsh provisions that Congress
attached to last year’s welfare reform legislation.
Among its major elements, the budget:
• saves $137 billion in discretionary spending, cutting unnecessary and lower-priority programs while investing in education
and training, the environment, science and
technology, law enforcement, and other
priorities that would raise living standards
and the quality of life for average Americans (see Chapters 2–6);
• saves $100 billion in Medicare ($138 billion over six years), ensuring the solvency
of the Part A trust fund until 2007 while
maintaining the essential quality of Medicare services for the elderly and people
with disabilities (see Chapter 1);

15
• saves $22 billion in Medicaid, building
upon the substantial savings that Federal
and State experimentation in this jointlyrun program is already generating, and
continuing the guarantee of essential
health and long-term care coverage for the
most vulnerable Americans (see Chapter
1);
• saves $76 billion by ending corporate subsidies and other tax loopholes, extending
expired tax provisions, and improving tax
compliance (see Chapter 8);
• saves $36 billion by continuing the Administration’s successful policy of auctioning
segments of the broadcast spectrum (for
other proposals on mandatory programs,
see below);
• provides $18 billion to correct the harsh
provisions that Congress attached to last
year’s welfare reform law, protecting those
in need and helping recipients to find selfsupporting work (see Chapter 7); and
• cuts taxes by $98 billion, providing tax relief to tens of millions of middle-income
Americans and small businesses (see
Chapter 8).
With regard to other mandatory programs,
the budget proposes to more fully fund the
costs of Federal civilian employee retirement;
extend previously-enacted savings in veterans’
benefits; cut subsidies to financial institutions
that make and hold student loans while
reducing the costs to borrowers; impose fees
to recover the costs of services that the
Federal Government provides to private businesses; and privatize or sell, rather than
give away, valuable public resources.
All budget plans—the President’s, Congress’,
and others—rest on a set of assumptions
about how the economy will perform over
the next five years, and about technical
matters such as how fast Medicare spending
will grow. Those assumptions, in turn, help
shape projections about the future direction
of the deficit and, thus, the size of the
challenge ahead in balancing the budget.
Since the President took office, the Administration has worked hard to develop a set
of conservative assumptions each year and,
in fact, our economic assumptions generally

16

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

have proved too conservative. The economy
has performed better than most analysts
expected in the past four years, providing
strong growth, low interest rates, and stable
prices. The Government has received more
tax revenues, and spent less on certain
social programs—and, as a result, the deficit
has fallen far more than projected.
The Administration’s assumptions also
proved more accurate than the even-more
conservative assumptions of the Congressional
Budget Office (CBO)—although both sets of
assumptions were quite reasonable. The Administration is confident that its own assumptions will continue to prove the more accurate.
Nevertheless, the budget includes a mechanism to ensure that the President’s plan
reaches balance in 2002 under OMB or
CBO assumptions. If OMB’s assumptions
prove correct, as we expect, then the mechanism would not take effect. If, however,
CBO proves correct—and the President and
Congress cannot agree on how to close the
gap through expedited procedures—then most
of the President’s tax cuts would sunset,
and discretionary budget authority and identified entitlement programs would face an
across-the-board limit.
With this mechanism in place, the American
people can rest assured that we will reach
balance in 2002—no matter which set of
assumptions are used in the budget process.
The Task Ahead: Investing in the Future
Balancing the budget is not an end in
itself. Rather, it helps fulfill the President’s
central economic goal—to raise the standard

of living for average Americans, both now
and in the future.
So, too, do the spending priorities of this
budget. Details matter. How the Government
spends money—for whom, for what purpose—
is just as important as whether it does.
Within tight constraints, the budget continues the President’s policy of the last four
years in shifting Federal resources to education and training, science and technology,
and other investments to enable Americans
to get the skills to acquire good jobs, and
to give businesses the tools to become more
competitive, in the new economy. The budget
also continues to shift resources to the environment and law enforcement, raising the quality
of life for average Americans.
For education and training, the budget
proposes to fulfill the President’s commitment
to put one million disadvantaged children
in the Head Start program by 2002; to
create safe learning environments for more
children; to help more school systems extend
high academic standards, better teaching,
and better learning to all students; to enable
more Americans to serve their communities
and earn money for college; to bring technology
into more classrooms; to expand college workstudy to one million students by the year
2000; to create a $1,000 merit scholarship
for the top five percent of graduates in
every high school; to let more parents, teachers, and communities create public schools
to meet their own children’s needs; to make
it easier for parents and students to borrow
and repay college loans; to create the largest
increase in Pell Grant scholarships in 20

Comparisons between this budget and the President’s earlier balanced budget plans can be
misleading.
Over the last two years, the President’s goal has not changed. He has consistently sought to
reach balance by 2002. But with each passing year, the time frame has, by definition, shrunk.
Thus, the seven-year plan that he first proposed was followed by a six-year plan, followed by a
five-year plan in this budget.
Is the task of reaching balance easier now? Yes and no. On one hand, the continued strength
of the economy, slower spending in key programs (such as Medicare and Medicaid), and savings
enacted last year have lowered the projected deficits through 2002, reducing the amount of savings needed to reach balance. On the other hand, the shorter time frame makes it harder to
phase in savings in entitlement programs, thus making the entitlement cuts deeper than they
otherwise would have to be.

II.

17

BUILDING A BRIDGE TO THE 21ST CENTURY

years; and, finally, to provide Skill Grants
to adults for job training.
On other priorities, the budget proposes
to maintain environmental enforcement; protect national parks and other sensitive resources; and provide tax incentives to encourage companies to clean up ‘‘brownfields’’—
abandoned, contaminated industrial properties
in distressed areas. The budget would put
17,000 more police on the street, bringing
the total to 81,000 and moving closer to
the President’s goal of 100,000 by the year
2000; and it would provide more funds to
combat juvenile crime and step up the fight
against drugs, largely by focusing on treatment
and prevention aimed at youth. It would
increase the number of Border Patrol agents
and workplace investigations to prevent illegal
immigration and deter the hiring of illegal
immigrants.
The budget invests in research, including
biomedical research at the National Institutes
of Health, in programs to combat infectious
diseases at the Centers for Disease Control,
in the Ryan White AIDS program that provides potentially life-extending drug therapies
to many people with AIDS, and in community
health centers and Indian Health Service
facilities. The budget funds full participation
in the Special Supplemental Nutrition Program for Women, Infants, and Children (WIC),
which would be 7.5 million people by the
end of 1998.
Finally, the budget proposes to add $1
billion to the Community Development Financial Institutions Fund over five years to
create jobs and foster development in lowincome urban and rural communities. For
the same purpose, the budget proposes to
expand the number of Empowerment Zones
and Enterprise Communities, providing tax
relief and other assistance for distressed
urban and rural areas.
Over the last year, the President also
has proposed a series of initiatives to more
quickly, and more effectively, meet his goal
of higher living standards and a better quality
of life for all Americans.
• Along with his earlier tax deduction proposal of up to $10,000 for college tuition
and job training, the President proposes

a new $1,500-a-year HOPE scholarship tax
credit to make two years of college universal. The budget also proposes to increase
Pell Grants for lower-income families who
lack the tax liability to benefit from the
tax cuts.
• The President proposes the America Reads
Challenge to help ensure that all children
can read by the third grade, and a fiveyear, $5 billion school construction fund
to help States and communities address
the serious problem of dilapidated school
buildings.
• Building on his earlier proposal to help
the unemployed keep their health care
coverage for six months, the President now
proposes to help expand health care coverage to uninsured children.
• Having taken the first step to reform welfare, the President now proposes to enhance the Work Opportunity Tax Credit
to encourage employers to hire long-term
welfare recipients.
• The President proposes to reshape the
Federal Government’s relationship with
the District of Columbia by assuming responsibility for certain pension, justice,
and other functions. In exchange, the Government no longer would make an annual
discretionary payment to the city, and it
also would expect the city to be more accountable for how it uses its resources.
A Look Ahead
A balanced budget; a leaner, more effective
Government; investments to help secure a
brighter future—these are the priorities that
pervade this budget, and that are outlined
in the pages that follow. They are the
priorities that will, in the President’s words
that began this section, ‘‘prepare America
for . . . the 21st Century.’’
But to fully appreciate the President’s agenda for the future, it helps to know what
the Administration has already accomplished.
The President’s economic policies, including
a dramatic cut in the deficit, have helped
to revive an economy that was suffering
from over a decade of debt and other burdens.
It is to that record—four years of significant
accomplishment—that we now turn.

III.

PUTTING THE BUILDING
BLOCKS IN PLACE

19

III.

PUTTING THE BUILDING BLOCKS IN
PLACE

To reclaim our future, we must strive to close both the budget deficit and the investment gap.
Governor Bill Clinton
Senator Al Gore
Putting People First
1992

With regard to Congress, if I could do one thing, I would pass a balanced budget that would
open the doors of college to all Americans and continue the incremental progress we’ve made in
health care reform.
President Clinton
November 10, 1996

President Clinton has pursued a disciplined
but fair budget policy, working with Congress
to make the tough choices that have dramatically cut the deficit while protecting the
values that Americans share. He has cut
wasteful and lower-priority spending while
protecting safety net programs and investing
in the future.
The results are clear: The deficit has
fallen by a whopping 63 percent—from $290
billion in 1992, the year before the President
took office, to $107 billion last year. Now,
with this budget, the President proposes
to build on that progress by balancing the
budget for the first time since 1969.
Why must we finish the job?
What the Administration Inherited
Large budget deficits damage the economy,
hurting taxpayers and discouraging businesses. The sharply higher deficits that began
in 1981 have been a serious drag on the
Nation’s economic performance ever since.
The Debt and What It Means for the
Average Citizen: The budget deficit is the annual amount that the Government spends in
excess of what it receives in revenues. The
Federal debt, by contrast, is the total of the

accumulated deficits that have not been offset
by surpluses over the years.
At first blush, deficits may appear painless;
they allow the Nation’s leaders to avoid
the hard choices needed to bring spending
in line with revenues. But the Government
must finance the debt that it accumulates,
and the cost of doing so prevents the Nation
from meeting future spending needs or cutting
taxes.
The Government finances the deficit mainly
by borrowing from the public, including foreign
investors. The large deficits of the 1980s
and early 1990s quadrupled the Federal debt.
At the end of 1980, Federal debt held by
the public was $710 billion. By the end
of 1992, it had grown by $2.289 trillion—
to $2.999 trillion.1 Because the deficit has
fallen under this Administration, the debt
has risen more slowly, and, in fact, the
ratio of the debt to our Gross Domestic
Product (GDP) has declined. But until we
balance the budget, the debt will keep growing.
In a sense, today’s deficits are the legacy
of the much larger deficits of the years
from 1981 to 1992. The budget would be
1 This measure excludes the debt held in Federal trust funds. It
counts only the debt held directly by private investors and the Federal Reserve System.

21

22
balanced today if not for the interest that
we pay on the deficits accumulated in those
12 years.
The Federal Government paid $241 billion
in interest last year—$241 billion that it
could have spent in far more productive
ways. If the Government were not paying
interest at all, it could have used those
funds to have a balanced budget and still
have $134 billion left over—which equals
half of the military budget, or about 40
percent of Social Security payments, or about
20 percent of income taxes.
How Deficits Have Damaged the Economy: The economy did not perform as well
from 1980–1992 as before, partly due to the
rise in Federal debt that marked the period.
As this experience shows, persistent deficits
reduce saving, raise interest rates, stifle investment, and cut the growth of productivity,
output, and incomes.
During recessions, when private consumption and investment declines, Government
borrowing to finance unemployment and other
benefits and to make up for reduced income
taxes maintains demand and helps to turn
the economy around. But if deficits become
‘‘structural’’—that is, they persist even in
good times—they can cause harm. That’s
what happened in the 1980s.
A structural deficit—especially when sustained for a long time, as in the 1980s—
depletes the Nation’s pool of saving. Saving
provides the resources to build the new
factories and machinery that generate tomorrow’s incomes. National saving has two components:
• private saving (by individuals and businesses—the net result of millions of savings decisions); and
• public saving (by Federal, State, and local
governments, which save when they run
surpluses and dis-save when they run deficits). 2
If the Government taps the savings pool
to finance its deficit, that borrowed saving
is not available to make productive private
2 Recently, the Commerce Department’s Bureau of Economic
Analysis modified the national income accounts to measure more
accurately how government at all levels contributes to saving.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

investments. With its massive deficits in
the 1980s, the Government drained much
of the pool. Worse, as Federal deficits were
rising, private saving was falling, exacerbating
the overall saving problem.
In each year of the 1960s, net national
saving 3 totaled at least 10 percent of GDP
(see Chart III–1). Since then, net saving
has fallen substantially. After averaging about
eight percent of GDP in the 1970s, the
net national saving rate fell to five percent
of GDP in the 1980s, and hit a low point
of just 2.4 percent of GDP in 1992.
With less saving, interest rates remained
high in the 1980s, choking off demand for
private investment. Why? Because lower saving shrinks the pool of available funds. The
Federal Government taps the pool first by
selling its bills, notes, and bonds at auction,
leaving private borrowers to compete for
what’s left. With so many would-be borrowers,
and so little left to borrow, the competition
forces interest rates higher.
Real interest rates—that is, the portion
of the rate that exceeds inflation—were markedly higher in the 1980s than in the prior
three decades. In real terms, short-term rates
had actually been negative for much of the
1970s, but they averaged almost four percent
in the 1980s; long-term real interest rates
were as much as much as two to three
percentage points higher than in the prior
three decades (see Chart III–2).
Under this Administration, saving has rebounded, mainly due to lower deficits. In
the first three quarters of calendar 1996,
net national saving averaged 5.4 percent
of GDP. In fact, over 90 percent of the
improvement in the net saving rate in the
last four years is attributable to lower deficits.
Higher real interest rates in the early
1980s attracted foreign capital into the United
States, driving up the dollar in foreign exchange markets. The foreign capital helped
offset some of the fall in domestic saving
and helped to cushion U.S. investment. But
it came at a price. The higher dollar pushed
up the U.S. trade deficit significantly, causing
competitive problems for American manufac3 That is, gross saving minus depreciation of the Nation’s capital
stock.

III.

23

PUTTING THE BUILDING BLOCKS IN PLACE

Chart III-1. SAVING RATES
PERCENT OF GDP
14

12

NET NATIONAL SAVINGS
10

8

NET PRIVATE SAVINGS
6

4

2

0
1960

1965

1970

1975

1980

1985

1990

1995

Chart III-2. REAL INTEREST RATES
PERCENT
10

REAL 10-YEAR TREASURY NOTE RATE

5

0

-5
REAL 91-DAY TREASURY BILL RATE

-10
1960

1964

1968

1972

1976

1980

1984

1988

1992

1996

24

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

turers and industrial workers. The Nation
entered the 1980s as the world’s largest
creditor; it left as the largest debtor.
Thus, big deficits unsettle potential investors—they raise interest rates, increase the
risk of ballooning future Government credit
demands and higher inflation, and create
uncertainty in the currency markets. In response, business decision makers and other
investors will likely buy safer, shorter-term
securities rather than risk their money in
long-term commitments for new factories, machines, and other productive investments. As
a result, investment declines, and the economy
is poorer for the foreseeable future.
And, in fact, despite the increase in borrowing from abroad, net investment 4 fell in
the 1980s. The share of net private domestic
investment (including residential and nonresidential spending) fell from over seven percent
to five percent of GDP (see Chart III–3).

By 1992, the ratio of net investment to
GDP had dropped to just 2.5 percent.
With the rise in net saving since then,
net investment has rebounded. Equipment
investment, which includes computer purchases, has risen especially rapidly—with the
increases averaging 11 percent a year in
inflation-adjusted terms.
The economy grew much slower in the
1980s than in prior decades, partly due
to the fall in saving and investment. From
the business cycle peak in 1960 to the
peak in 1980, real economic growth averaged
3.7 percent a year—compared to 2.6 percent
during the business cycle of the 1980s. By
reducing national saving, the 1980s-era deficits
held down capital formation enough to cut
real potential GDP at the end of the decade
by an estimated 2.5 to 3.5 percent. If incomes
had been three percent higher in 1996, the
average person would have had $600 more
in disposable income to spend.

4 That is, gross investment minus depreciation of the Nation’s
capital stock.

Chart III-3. NET PRIVATE DOMESTIC INVESTMENT
PERCENT OF GDP
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1960

1963

1966

1969

1972

1975

1978

1981

1984

1987

1990

1993

1996

III.

PUTTING THE BUILDING BLOCKS IN PLACE

Growth has improved in the past four
years, compared to 1988–1992. In fact, privatesector GDP has grown since 1992 faster
than in either of the two previous Administrations. Because the government component
of GDP is shrinking now, whereas it rose
rapidly in the 1980s, the overall numbers
do not fully reflect this strength.
Still, several factors continue to hold the
economy back. First, the stagnant saving
and low investment of the 1980s and early
1990s are still having an effect. Only years
of higher investment will offset the capital
that was not put in place over the preceding
12 years. Second, the labor force is growing
more slowly. And third, the recent slow
growth of the major European economies
and Japan has constrained the exports of
even the newly revitalized and competitive
U.S. economy.
What the Administration Has
Accomplished
When the President took office, the deficit
was high and rising. It had reached almost
five percent of GDP in 1992, and projections
suggested that it would not fall below four
percent of GDP even during the anticipated
economic recovery over the following four
years. Then, according to the projections,
the deficit would rise again, and continue
rising without limit in the future.
The President took action.
The Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act
of 1993 (OBRA 1993): Upon taking office, the
President proposed a five-year deficit reduction
program that was largely enacted later that
year as OBRA 1993.
The law was designed to cut projected
deficits from 1994 to 1998 by a total of
$505 billion, cutting spending and raising
revenues about equally. Of the spending cuts,
about $100 billion came in entitlement programs, mostly in health care programs (although expanded health coverage offset some
of the savings); other cuts came in discretionary spending and interest costs. All income
tax rate increases fell on the top 1.2 percent
of families. At the same time, the plan
cut taxes for 15 million working families
by expanding the Earned Income Tax Credit.

25
But, largely because the economy has performed better than expected, the Administration now projects that the plan will cut
the 1994–98 deficits by $924 billion (see
Chart III–4). Specifically, the plan helped
cut interest rates and spur growth, thereby
generating more Federal revenues and less
spending on unemployment compensation and
other social benefits. Lower interest rates
also helped to cut Federal costs for deposit
insurance and for servicing the debt. Meanwhile, the Administration’s push for health
care reform helped to slow the rise in health
care inflation, thus helping to slow the growth
in Medicare and Medicaid.
While cutting the deficit, the President’s
plan also shifted resources toward Administration priorities in education and training,
the environment, science and technology, and
law enforcement. These investments were
intended to raise living standards and the
quality of life, both now and in the future.
Budget Cuts Since OBRA 1993: The President has continued to cut the budget the right
way—eliminating wasteful and lower-priority
spending while preserving key investments.
The President and Congress have scrapped
over 200 programs and projects entirely, while
cutting hundreds more. Spurred by the Vice
President’s National Performance Review, departments and agencies also have cut their
workforces, streamlined programs, reduced paperwork, and overhauled their procurement
systems.
The Economic Benefits: The President’s
success in cutting the deficit is paying huge
dividends.
Falling deficits enabled the Federal Reserve
to hold short-term interest rates low in
1993. In addition, the markets also reacted
favorably, cutting long-term rates. Just as
rising deficits increase investor uncertainty
about credit demands, inflation, and currency
fluctuations, the prospect of continually falling
deficits into the future eases uncertainty,
prompting investors to risk their money on
the new factories and equipment that enhance
productivity and, thus, make the economy
grow.
Short-term rates stayed low through the
President’s first year in office. As for long-

26

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart III-4. BUDGET DEFICITS
PERCENT OF GDP
9
8
7
PRE-OBRA BASELINE
6
5
4
3
ACTUAL DEFICIT PATH
2
1
0
1980

1982

1984

1986

1988

1990

1992

term rates, the yield on 10-year Treasury
notes fell below six percent in 1993—the
first time since 1972 that the rate was
this low. Lower long-term rates helped to
stimulate investment in housing and business
equipment, spurring the recovery.
Interest rates later rose somewhat as the
economy expanded, but they remained at
very low levels for a rapidly growing economy
with such low unemployment. In fact, the
last time the economy had unemployment
as low as today, the rate on the 10-year
Treasury bond was about two percentage
points higher.
Future interest rates likely will depend
on the success of efforts to balance the
budget over the next five years. A bipartisan
agreement this year would greatly foster
chances of further cuts in both short- and
long-term rates.
What have we learned? That, contrary
to some views, deficit cutting can go hand-

1994

1996

1998

2000

2002

2004

in-hand with economic growth—if the deficit
cutting allows the Federal Reserve to maintain
low interest rates, and if it’s credible in
the financial markets. In the months between
the announcement and enactment of the
President’s 1993 economic plan, economic activity picked up. As shown in the monthly
employment reports, job gains accelerated,
and over the next four years, the economy
created over 11 million new jobs—about 93
percent of them in the private sector (see
Chart III–5).
The job gains occurred without an increase
in inflation, which has been remarkably stable
for several years. Although the Consumer
Price Index (CPI) rose a bit more last year,
the increase was due to faster increases
in volatile food and energy prices, which
experts do not expect to see again this
year. If anything, the underlying rate of
inflation has fallen (see Chart III–6).

III.

27

PUTTING THE BUILDING BLOCKS IN PLACE

Chart III-5. JOB CREATION
MILLIONS OF JOBS

5

3.8

4

2.8

3

2.6
2.2

2
2
1.1
1
0.3
0

-0.8

-1

-2
1989

1990

1991

1992

1993

1994

1995

1996

Chart III-6. UNDERLYING RATES OF INFLATION
CPI: ALL ITEMS LESS FOOD AND ENERGY
12-MONTH PERCENT CHANGE

6
5.31
5
4.44

4.39

4
3.38
3.14
3

2.96
2.65

2.63

2

1

0
1989

1990

1991

1992

1993

1994

1995

1996

28

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Family Incomes, Poverty, and Inequality:
More jobs, low inflation, and steady growth
can foster a widely shared rise in living standards, as witnessed by the last two years. After
many years of, at best, modest gains in median
family income, 1995 witnessed one of the largest real gains in two decades—1.8 percent.
Moreover, people in all kinds of households
gained. Poverty fell for the second straight
year (see Chart III–7), and groups at the bottom of the income distribution actually enjoyed
larger percentage gains than those at the top.

payments and a slowdown in employers’ health
insurance costs.

The stronger investment climate also sent
stocks much higher. The Dow-Jones Industrial
Average has risen an average of 18 percent
a year from December 1992 to December
1996—more than half again as fast as in
the prior 12 years. Corporate profits, the
underpinning for the value of stocks, also
have soared. Just as important, the profit
gains have not come at the expense of
wages, which have risen in this period,
but are mainly due to falling corporate interest

What Remains To Be Done

To be sure, the strong economy is not
due to the President’s budget policy alone.
But just as surely, his policies have contributed to a stronger financial climate, enabled
the Federal Reserve to maintain low interest
rates, released extra saving for private investment, and showed skeptics that the Nation’s
leaders could cut the deficit. These successes
have played their part in revitalizing the
economy in the last four years.

The best way to preserve and strengthen
the current economic expansion is to cut
the deficit further. This budget reaches balance in 2002—a goal widely shared by Congress and the public. The President is committed to achieving it, and his previous success
in cutting the deficit puts it well within
reach.
But the goal of reaching balance is not
without controversy. Some observers would

Chart III-7. POVERTY RATES
PERCENT

16
15.1
14.8

15

14.5
14.2
13.8

14

13

13.5
12.8

12

11

0
1989

1990

1991

1992

1993

1994

1995

III.

29

PUTTING THE BUILDING BLOCKS IN PLACE

balance the budget every year—no matter
what the circumstances; they even would
enshrine the goal in the Constitution by
passing an amendment to that effect. Others
argue that further deficit cutting is unnecessary, if not economically harmful. Both of
these visions are misguided.
A Balanced Budget Requirement: A requirement to reach balance every year is potentially harmful. Virtually all taxes, and
many spending programs, respond automatically to changing economic conditions. That is,
when the economy is weak and incomes fall,
income tax revenues fall as well; unemployment compensation and other benefits also
cushion the effect of the downturn on
consumer buying power. Without these ‘‘automatic stabilizers,’’ economic downturns would
be much worse.
Consider what could happen under a balanced budget amendment. A weak economy
would mean fewer tax revenues and more
spending on unemployment and other programs. As a result, a balanced budget requirement could force a tax increase or spending
cuts—or both—in the middle of a recession.
Those steps would make a weak economy
even weaker.
Nor are any ‘‘escape hatches’’ from the
budget-balancing requirement—for times of
economic distress—guaranteed to work. One
reason is that economists are notoriously
slow to recognize economic downturns. Consequently, by the time they saw the slowdown
and Congress acted to ease the balancedbudget requirement, the economic damage
would be done. The better practice is to
aim for balance, but to adjust budget policy
according to circumstances.
A Reversal of Course: Allowing the deficit
to begin rising again would be economically
damaging. Admittedly, as some analysts argue,
continued economic growth and low interest
rates could keep Federal debt growing more
slowly than the economy as a whole, and that
would help to keep Federal interest costs
under control. The problem is, the Nation faces
some important challenges in the not-so-distant future for which we should begin to prepare. A balanced budget would be a good first
step.

Today, the Nation is benefitting from its
demography. Its largest population group—
the ‘‘baby-boom’’ generation, born between
1946 and 1964—is entering its highest-earning
years. They pay much more to the Government
than they receive in direct benefits. But
the situation will begin to change in about
12 years.
At that point, the oldest baby-boomers
will become eligible for early retirement under
Social Security. Because the next generation
of taxpayers is smaller in size, they will
contribute relatively less to the Government
in revenues, making it harder to support
the baby-boomers in their retirement. The
President has already called for a bipartisan
process to address that problem. But if we
don’t balance the budget beforehand, the
challenge of supporting the baby boomers
will only grow larger.
A balanced budget by 2002 will add a
margin of safety into the budget to absorb
the coming demographic burden—and any
unforeseen problems before then. As illustrated in Chart III–8, if Congress enacts
the President’s budget and continues his
proposed limits on Medicaid while controlling
discretionary spending beyond 2002, the Government should be able to avoid an explosion
of debt when the baby-boomers retire. (See
Chapter 2 of Analytical Perspectives for a
full discussion of the methodology underlying
these projections.)
The Administration’s Economic
Assumptions
This budget, like the Administration’s previous budgets, is based on prudent assumptions about economic growth, interest rates,
inflation, and unemployment for the foreseeable future. As with the previous budgets,
the assumptions are close to the consensus
among private forecasters. While the Administration believes that, with sound policies,
our economy can do even better, we also
believe that we should use prudent, mainstream economic assumptions for budget planning.
The Congressional Budget Office (CBO) also
prepares economic assumptions with which
to evaluate budget proposals. In the past
four years, CBO’s assumptions generally have

30

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart III-8. LONG-RUN DEFICIT PROJECTIONS
PERCENT OF GDP
40

30

20

CURRENT OUTLOOK
WITHOUT A
BALANCED BUDGET

PRE-OBRA BASELINE

10
PRESIDENTIAL POLICY
0

-10
1980

1986

1992

1998

2004

2010

been quite close to this Administration’s,
although small differences can generate large
gaps in budget projections over five to seven
years.
In recent years, the economy generally
has performed somewhat better than either
the Administration or CBO had projected,
showing faster growth and lower unemployment and inflation.
The Administration’s assumptions include
the following:
• Growth: Real growth will dip slightly
below the trend for the next two years,
averaging two percent on a fourth quarter
over fourth quarter basis. Later, real GDP
growth will average 2.3 percent per year—
the Administration’s estimate of its potential growth rate.
• Interest rates: If Congress enacts the
President’s budget plan, interest rates will
fall as the budget approaches balance. The
yield on 10-year Treasury notes, 6.3 percent at the end of 1996 and higher earlier

2016

2022

2028

2034

2040

2046

2050

in the year, will decline to 5.1 percent and
then stabilize; on a discount-basis, the 90day Treasury bill rate will drop to four
percent, from around 5.1 percent. The
long-term real rate will be about 2.5 percent, and the short-term real rate about
1.5 percent. These real interest rates are
consistent with U.S. experience during
past periods of steady growth and low inflation.
• Inflation: Inflation will remain fairly stable. The CPI will rise an average of 2.7
percent a year from 1997 through 2002,
down slightly from the 3.3 percent increase in 1996 (which was aggravated by
special factors). The price index for GDP
(measured on a chain-weighted basis) will
rise at a 2.6 percent annual rate—somewhat faster than in 1996. The gap between
these two measures of inflation, which has
been large in the past, will narrow due
to recent and forthcoming changes to the
methodology underlying both indexes—including improved measures of health care

III.

31

PUTTING THE BUILDING BLOCKS IN PLACE

inflation (due later this year) and an update of the CPI market basket (effective
in 1998).
• Unemployment: Civilian unemployment
will be 5.5 percent by the start of 1998,
very near the current rate, and the average level will remain there.
The Administration does not forecast the
economy’s cyclical pattern beyond the next
few quarters; within that horizon, it sees

Table III–1.

no sign of an impending downturn. If the
economy continues to grow for the entire
forecasting period, the current expansion
would become the longest in this century.
In some years, growth may exceed 2.3
percent; in others, it may fall a bit short.
But, the Administration’s assumptions should
be, on average, close to correct for this
period, and should provide a sound basis
for reaching balance by 2002.

ECONOMIC ASSUMPTIONS 1

(Calendar years; dollar amounts in billions)
Actual
1995

Gross Domestic Product (GDP):
Levels, dollar amounts in billions:
Current dollars .......................................
Real, chained (1992) dollars ...................
Chained price index (1992 = 100), annual average ........................................
Percent change, fourth quarter over
fourth quarter:
Current dollars .......................................
Real, chained (1992) dollars ...................
Chained price index (1992 = 100) ...........
Percent change, year over year:
Current dollars .......................................
Real, chained (1992) dollars ...................
Chained price index (1992 = 100) ...........
Incomes, billions of current dollars:
Corporate profits before tax ...................
Wages and salaries .................................
Other taxable income 2 ...........................
Consumer Price Index (all urban): 3
Level (1982–84 = 100), annual average
Percent change, fourth quarter over
fourth quarter ......................................
Percent change, year over year .............

Projections
1996

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

7,254
6,743

7,577
6,901

7,943
7,056

8,313
7,197

8,717
7,355

9,153
7,525

9,610 10,087
7,699 7,877

107.6

109.9

112.7

115.7

118.7

121.8

125.0

128.2

3.8
1.3
2.5

5.0
2.8
2.3

4.6
2.0
2.5

4.7
2.0
2.6

5.0
2.3
2.6

5.0
2.3
2.6

5.0
2.3
2.6

5.0
2.3
2.6

4.6
2.0
2.5

4.5
2.3
2.2

4.8
2.2
2.5

4.7
2.0
2.6

4.9
2.2
2.6

5.0
2.3
2.6

5.0
2.3
2.6

5.0
2.3
2.6

599
3,431
1,532

652
3,628
1,612

676
3,808
1,684

714
3,982
1,748

757
4,168
1,809

796
4,374
1,882

816
4,590
1,967

849
4,810
2,068

152.5

156.9

161.2

165.5

170.0

174.6

179.3

184.1

2.7
2.8

3.1
2.9

2.6
2.7

2.7
2.7

2.7
2.7

2.7
2.7

2.7
2.7

2.7
2.7

Unemployment rate, civilian, percent:
Fourth quarter level ...............................
Annual average .......................................
Federal pay raises, January, percent:
Military ....................................................
Civilian 4 ..................................................

5.5
5.6

5.3
5.4

5.4
5.3

5.6
5.5

5.5
5.5

5.5
5.5

5.5
5.5

5.5
5.5

2.6
2.6

2.6
2.4

3.0
3.0

2.8
2.8

3.0
NA

3.0
NA

3.0
NA

3.0
NA

Interest rates, percent:
91-day Treasury bills 5 ...........................
10-year Treasury notes ..........................

5.5
6.6

5.0
6.5

5.0
6.1

4.7
5.9

4.4
5.5

4.2
5.3

4.0
5.1

4.0
5.1

NA=Not Available.
1 Based on information available as of mid-November 1996.
2 Rent, interest, dividend and proprietor’s components of personal income.
3 CPI for all urban consumers. Two versions of the CPI are now published. The index shown here is that currently used,
as required by law, in calculating automatic adjustments to individual income tax brackets. Projections reflect scheduled
changes in methodology.
4 Overall average increase, including locality pay adjustments. Percentages to be proposed for years after 1998 have not
yet been determined.
5 Average rate (bank discount basis) on new issues within period.

IV. IMPROVING PERFORMANCE
IN A BALANCED BUDGET WORLD

33

IV.

IMPROVING PERFORMANCE IN A
BALANCED BUDGET WORLD

We still have work to do, for while the era of big Government is over, the era of big challenges
is not. Achieving educational excellence, finishing welfare reform and our campaign for safe
streets, helping families to succeed at home and at work, balancing the budget, keeping America
strong and prosperous, reforming campaign finance and modernizing Government operations so
that, together, we can meet the challenges and seize the opportunities of this remarkable time.
President Clinton
December 11, 1996

The President’s challenge is an awesome
one—literally, how to do more with less,
and how to do it better.
But it is the challenge that we face,
shaped by the fiscal and political realities
of our times. The President has worked
hard to reduce the deficit, and he wants
to work with Congress to finish the job
and balance the budget by 2002—a goal
that is widely shared in Congress and across
the Nation. Consequently, departments and
agencies no longer can count on more funding
each year. For the foreseeable future, their
resources will be constrained, perhaps severely
so.
And yet, the Federal Government has a
legitimate role to play in fulfilling the President’s goals. Over the last four years, the
President has used Federal resources and
the power of his office to begin achieving
educational excellence, expanding opportunity,
cleaning up the environment, investing in
promising research, ending welfare as we
know it, protecting health care and pensions,
making the tax system fairer, and keeping
America strong. The public wants further
progress on these and other issues and,
with limited resources, the Federal Government must be able to respond effectively.
Led by Vice President Gore’s National Performance Review, the Administration promised
to create a Government that ‘‘works better
and costs less.’’ And we have made a good
start. We are saving money, cutting the

work force, eliminating needless regulations
and improving the ones we need, streamlining
bureaucracies, cutting red tape, and finding
numerous ways to better serve Government’s
‘‘customers’’—the American people.
Costs Less
The Administration has:
• Saved over $100 billion, largely through
a series of management reforms.
• Cut the Federal work force by over
250,000 employees,1 creating the smallest
work force in 30 years and, as a share
of total civilian employment, the smallest
since 1931. Thirteen of the 14 Cabinet Departments have cut their permanent work
forces between 1993 and 1996; the Justice
Department is growing because of the Administration’s expanded war on crime and
drugs.
• Eliminated over 200 programs and
projects—major programs like the Bureau
of Mines, and smaller special-interest or
narrowly-focused activities like wool and
mohair subsidies and the Tea-Tasters
Board.
• Closed nearly 2,000 obsolete field offices.
• Negotiated better deals for Government
purchases. The Government now pays
$3.62 for a three-pound commercial overnight delivery, compared to the $27 retail
rate, and as little as two-cents-a-minute
1 As

of September 1996.

35

36

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

for long-distance calls, compared to the 16cents-a-minute retail rate.
Works Better
Departments and agencies are:
• Eliminating 16,000 pages of regulations
and dramatically simplifying 31,000.2
• Improving customer service. Spurred by
the President’s challenge to be the ‘‘best
in the business,’’ over 200 agencies have
committed to meet over 3,000 customer
service standards. The Social Security Administration was rated first in a 1995
independent survey of selected public and
private 1–800 services. Agencies including
the Postal Service, Veterans Affairs Department (VA), and the Bureau of Engraving and Printing have surveyed over a million customers in the past year to learn
how they can improve services.

convert Federal listings by agency to listings according to services, such as Food
Stamps or AIDS information. Over 18 million Americans will get such listings this
year.
• Launching pilot projects to shift regulatory
enforcement approaches from adversarial
relationships to partnerships. In the
Maine 200 partnership program, in which
both companies and workers look for hazards, workman’s compensation claims
have dropped 40 percent.
• Cutting ‘‘red tape’’ and paperwork. The
President and Congress strengthened the
Paperwork Reduction Act, establishing
goals for agencies to cut by 25 percent,
by 1998, the hours that the public spends
filling out Government forms and paperwork.
A Toolkit of Strategies and Techniques

• Using emerging technologies, particularly
the Internet and its World Wide Web, to
make Government information readily accessible and easier to find. The White
House
expanded
its
home
page
(www.whitehouse.gov) to provide access to
commonly requested services. For example, citizens can get passport applications,
their earnings records from the Social Security Administration, or student loan applications. The Commerce Department’s
‘‘FedWorld’’ system connects users to hundreds of agency resources and information—from Federal job opportunities, to
automobile emission system repair instructions, to information on starting a small
business. Users downloaded over 250,000
tax forms and instruction booklets from
the IRS’ home page during the 1996 tax
season.

The Administration is proud of its accomplishments, but our work is not done. As
we move forward, the challenge will only
get harder. Spurred by the Vice President,
the Administration has identified many ways
for agencies to improve their performance
and cut costs. Some of these tools focus
on eliminating obsolete processes; others focus
on improving the ones we have. Because
agencies and programs operate in such different ways, not all of these tools, techniques,
and strategies apply to each agency and
department. But every agency and program
can benefit from a number of them.

• Creating ‘‘one-stop shops,’’ such as the new
U.S. General Stores, which give the public
walk-in access to services across a wide
range of agencies while cutting agency
overhead costs. Similarly, the National
Performance Review and the General
Services Administration are working with
phone companies across the country to

A smaller Government is not an end in
itself. We want to change the way it operates.
In place of highly-centralized, inflexible organizations that focused on inputs, the Administration is creating more flexible, decentralized
management structures within agencies to
focus on results. Agencies are streamlining
their work forces, collapsing redundant layers,
increasing spans of control, and creating
leaner headquarters. Many are closing small,
inefficient field offices while strengthening

2 As of December 31, 1996, agencies had eliminated, or proposed
for elimination, 87 percent of the 16,000; they had improved, or
proposed for improvement, 78 percent of the 31,000.

Based on what we have learned over the
past four years, we plan to employ the
following seven tools, as shown in Table
IV–1.
1. Restructure Agencies

IV.

37

IMPROVING PERFORMANCE IN A BALANCED BUDGET WORLD

Table IV–1.

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.

STRATEGIES TO IMPROVE PERFORMANCE
AND REDUCE COSTS

Restructure Agencies
Improve Effectiveness of the Federal Workplace
Reform Federal Purchasing Practices
Expand Competition to Improve Services and Reduce Costs
Follow the Best Private Sector Practices in Using Information Technology
Improve Credit Program Performance
Improve Business Management Practices

the services they provide to customers through
increased electronic communications and systems. And some agencies are fundamentally
changing the way they work with State
and local governments and with the private
sector by creating partnerships to focus on
joint goals and the progress toward meeting
them.
• Create more efficient, performance-based
organizations (PBOs): PBOs, which the
President has labeled a priority for his second term, are discrete units of a department that commit to clear management
objectives, measurable goals, customer
service standards, and specific targets for
improved performance (see Table IV–2).
Once designated, they would have greater
personnel and procurement flexibilities
and a competitively-hired CEO, who would
sign an annual performance agreement
with the Secretary and have a share of
his or her pay depend on the organiza-

Table IV–2.

tion’s performance. The British, who have
extensive experience with this concept,
have found that such agencies have improved performance and cut administrative costs.
• Consolidate intergovernmental funding
streams into Performance Partnerships:
Performance Partnership grants with larger, more flexible funding pools can replace
small categorical grants, improving financial incentives, rewarding results, eliminating overlapping authorities, and cutting Federal overhead, micro-management,
and paperwork. States or Tribes can now
combine up to 15 separate Environmental
Protection Agency funding streams across
water, air, hazardous waste, and similar
programs to improve environmental outcomes. Agriculture Department (USDA)
State Directors can combine funding for
18 programs into three funding streams

PROPOSED PERFORMANCE-BASED ORGANIZATIONS

Department or Agency

Function

Commerce ..................................................

Technical information dissemination (National Technical Information Service)
Intellectual property rights (Patent and Trademark
Office)
Seafood inspection
Defense Commissary Agency
Mortgage insurance services (GNMA)
Mortgage insurance services (FHA)
St. Lawrence Seaway Development Corporation
United States Mint
Retirement benefit services

Commerce ..................................................
Commerce ..................................................
Defense ......................................................
Housing and Urban Development ...........
Housing and Urban Development ...........
Transportation ..........................................
Treasury ....................................................
Office of Personnel Management ............

38

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

for rural housing, utilities and business
or cooperative services.
• Accelerate implementation of existing
streamlining plans: The President and
Congress are ahead of schedule on plans
to cut 272,900 Federal positions, or 12 percent of the work force, by the end of this
decade (see Chart IV–1). As Chart IV–2
shows, agencies are working hard to implement their streamlining plans—designed to cut overhead, eliminate vertical
layers and redundant structures, particularly in headquarters operations, and increase spans of control.
• Eliminate excess field offices: Several agencies, including the Departments of Agriculture, Transportation, and the Treasury,
and the Small Business Administration,
have developed proposals to streamline
their field office structures, while improving operations and customer service. Over
890,000 Federal employees work in almost

30,000 separate field offices that vary
greatly in size. Although the average field
office houses 30 employees, over 11,000
offices house five or fewer.
2. Improve Effectiveness of the Federal
Workplace
What was true in 1993 remains true today.
The main agents for change are Federal
employees themselves. With a quarter of
a million fewer of them than in 1993, we
are asking those who remain to do more
with less. They are working harder and
smarter each and every day, and our efforts
to reinvent Government would be nowhere
near as successful were it not for their
enthusiastic leadership and support. We must,
however, continue to downsize and restructure,
if only because of the limited resources that
a balanced budget will offer. As with the
previous personnel cuts, the Administration
plans to closely manage and target further
downsizing. Agencies need to avoid workplace

Chart IV-1. EXECUTIVE BRANCH CIVILIAN EMPLOYMENT, 1965 - 1996
(Excluding Postal Service)
EMPLOYEES IN MILLIONS
2.4

2.3

2.2

2.1

2

1.9

0
1.8
1965

1970

Note: Data is end-of-year count.

1975

1980

1985

1990

1995

IV.

39

IMPROVING PERFORMANCE IN A BALANCED BUDGET WORLD

Chart IV-2. CIVILIAN FTE CHANGES
ON A PERCENT BASIS, 1993 - 1996
CABINET DEPARTMENTS AND SELECTED INDEPENDENT AGENCIES
PERCENT

-45

FTE LEVELS
(in thousands)

-40
-35
Cabinet
Depts.
All Other
Agencies
Exec.
Branch
Total

-30
-25
-20

1993

1996

Reduction

Percent
Reduction

1,880

1,651

-229

-12.2

241

-34

-12.5

1,892

-263

-12.2

275
2,155

-15
-10
-5
0
SSA

Justice

EPA

Veterans Affairs

Energy

Education

Corps of Engineers

Treasury

Commerce

HHS

Transportation

State

Exec. Branch Average

Smithsonian

Labor

Agriculture

Interior

All Other Agencies

TVA

HUD

NASA

Defense--Military

USIA

GSA

OPM

5

Notes: The Executive Branch total excludes Postal Service. The 1993 base, which is the starting point for calculating the 272,900 FTE reduction
required by the Federal Workforce Restructuring Act, is 2.2 million.

disruptions and employee disputes and, when
they occur, resolve them quickly and fairly.
Employees and managers need to plan and
work together for common goals. In addition,
the President proposes a 2.8 percent pay
raise for both civilian employees and the
military. 3
• Increase the number and effectiveness of
labor-management
partnerships:
The
Administration plans to add to the more
than 850 labor-management partnerships
already in place to improve relations between agencies and the unions representing their employees. With these partnerships, the two sides work together toward
a common goal—providing the highestquality service at the lowest cost. The two
sides cooperate to solve problems, implement changes, and jointly resolve worksite
issues. Good partnerships breed good organizations, with an energized work force
3 Once again, the Administration will consult employee organizations and others before recommending how to allocate the civilian
pay raise between locality pay and a national schedule adjustment.

focused on doing its job better and more
efficiently.
• Use buyouts to adjust the size and skill
mix of the work force: A well-planned,
well-executed buyout program can minimize the need for involuntary layoffs by
increasing attrition in targeted occupations, organizations, or locations. In response to changed conditions, missions,
and resources, private and public organizations have used buyouts to make needed
adjustments in the composition of the
work force. Generally, they are less costly
than formal reductions-in-force and are always less disruptive to workers—to those
who elect to leave and those who remain.
• Replace formal grievance procedures with
Alternative Dispute Resolution (ADR): The
early, voluntary use of ADR can quickly
resolve workplace disputes, eliminating
the costs, delays, and adverse effects on
workplace morale of formal administrative
procedures or litigation. ADR encompasses
various techniques to resolve disputes and

40

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

reach negotiated settlements and, at the
Federal level, ADR has resolved a wide
range of workplace disputes, including employee grievances and allegations of discrimination. For example, a Postal Service
alternative mediation pilot program in
Florida resolved 77 percent of cases using
ADR, and generally reached settlements
within two weeks of the offer of mediation
services. ADR’s expanded use can produce
quicker, better settlements and significant
savings.
3. Reform Federal Purchasing Practices
Prior to this Administration, efforts to
make Government work better and cost less
were often hindered by the Government’s
unique acquisition system. It was heavily
rule-driven, leaving little leeway for Federal
managers and employees to exercise good
business judgment and common sense and
providing too much incentive for wasteful
and costly litigation. With leadership from
the National Performance Review, the Administration issued an early call for fundamental
reform and—with strong bipartisan support
that helped produce the 1994 Federal Acquisition and Streamlining Act—is transforming
the system into one that operates much
more like private sector acquisition. The Administration seeks a Government acquisition
system that performs like those of our most
successful companies and, to achieve it, is
pursuing important reforms.
• Use performance-based service contracting
(PBSC): The Government spends over
$100 billion a year for contracted services.
PBSC is a valuable tool that can not just
save money, but also better enable agencies to achieve their missions. PBSC emphasizes what the Government wants from
a contractor in measurable, mission-related, results-oriented terms, rather than
prescribing how to do the work. PBSC also
cuts costs by moving the Government
away from cost reimbursement contracts,
which are open-ended, to fixed price contracts. An ongoing Government-wide pilot
project already has generated savings of
15 to 20 percent, and the agencies in-

volved have expressed more satisfaction
with contractor performance.
• Use past performance in selecting contractors: Agencies have realized, as have successful companies, that they need not settle for mediocrity when they can get better
overall value from stronger performers. By
paying more attention to a contractor’s
past performance, agencies are beginning
to do business only with firms that provide
quality performance in exchange for taxpayers dollars. For example, a Navy installation in Seattle reports that its use
of past performance has improved on-time
delivery from 20 to over 70 percent and
significantly reduced defects in the past
18 months.
• Apply successful commercial buying strategies: Recent legal and regulatory reforms
are letting agencies more easily and effectively use commercial purchasing practices. Many agencies, for instance, are
leveraging the Government’s buying power
as a large customer of commercial products, often by consolidating their orders.
VA entered into a single national contract
for one of its pharmaceuticals, cutting its
costs from about $2.5 million a year to
just $550,000. By consolidating its requirements for lab testing services in the
Southeast region, the Army cut its bill in
half. The Defense Logistics Agency is
using another approach—a ‘‘prime vendor’’
strategy in which customers order and receive products directly from distributors—
reducing the value of its pharmaceutical
inventories by nearly $85 million.
• Streamline the buying process: The Administration is revising the rules for source
selection, letting contracting officials more
easily get the best deals while still allowing all interested firms to participate.
These changes will save the Government
the cost of fruitless negotiations with
offerors who are not leading contenders,
and allow firms to focus resources on situations in which they likely will be the
most competitive.

IV.

IMPROVING PERFORMANCE IN A BALANCED BUDGET WORLD

4. Expand Competition to Improve Services
and Reduce Costs
Competition spurs efficiency. Agencies that
provide administrative and other commercial
or industrial products or services to ‘‘captive
customers’’—be they other agencies, or individuals or businesses—lack the stimulus of competition to sharpen their performance and
control their costs. The Administration’s effort
to expand competition encourages agencies
to compete with one another, and with the
private sector, to provide common administrative support services. More competition will
bring new technologies, capital, management
techniques, and opportunity to Federal employees and their customers.
• Accelerate and expand the use of competition: Agencies are using competition to
purchase support services from their own
employees, from ‘‘franchise funds’’ in other
agencies, and from the private sector.
Competition allows agencies to focus on
their core mission requirements while giving them access to the best service providers, both public and private, and it encourages employees to organize themselves to
cut costs and meet performance standards.
The Social Security Administration, for example, recently chose to purchase payroll
services from the Interior Department at
lower annual operating costs. Through
competition, the Defense Department
(DOD) is cutting costs without cutting
service. Indeed, experience here and
abroad has shown that a greater use of
competition can cut costs by as much as
30 percent.
• Spin off or privatize functions: Agencies
are spinning off or otherwise converting
to the private sector a range of assets and
activities that the Government no longer
needs to own or perform, including the
Alaska Power Administration, the Interior
Department’s helium processing, the
Naval Petroleum Reserve known as Elk
Hills, and, eventually, the U.S. Enrichment Corporation. Similarly, VA relied on
‘‘just in time’’ deliveries in buying medical
supplies, eliminating its internal warehousing system and saving about $100
million a year. In a new, innovative approach, the Office of Personnel Manage-

41

ment converted its background investigation staff to an Employee Stock Ownership
corporation, saving money, protecting jobs,
and letting those former Government employees expand services into State, local,
and private markets.
5. Follow the Best Private Sector Practices
in Using Information Technology
Well-managed information technology should
improve the Government’s productivity while
cutting its costs. Table IV–3 at the end
of this chapter lists some of the most important investments in information technology
for which the President is proposing funding.
To ensure the maximum return on investment,
agencies can now copy the successful practices
of private firms, due to their new authority
under the 1996 Clinger-Cohen Act. These
practices—reengineering, buying and managing smart, integrating information—ensure
that the technology provides workable solutions to real problems at a reasonable cost.
• Re-engineer before automating: Agencies
can redesign how they do business to ensure that automation cuts costs, improves
effectiveness, and uses commercial, off-theshelf technology as much as possible. The
Census Bureau, for example, moved its information to the World Wide Web to let
researchers draw from the vast stores of
Census data. The Weather Service restructured the duties of its forecasters, using
advanced workstations to increase their
productivity, and the accuracy and timeliness of weather forecasts. The warning
time for tornados has risen significantly,
giving communities more time to take appropriate precautions, such as moving children off playgrounds.
• Acquire systems in phases: By acquiring
information technology systems in pieces,
rather than all at once, agencies can reap
immediate benefits while increasing the
chance of having an integrated, working
system at the end. A General Accounting
Office (GAO) study found that buying systems in phases was one of the most important strategies followed by companies that
have most successfully acquired new information technology systems.

42
• Buy off-the-shelf: Agencies can reduce their
risks of problems by avoiding custom-designed components. The broad range of information technology equipment, software,
and services now commercially available
provides new opportunities to use commercial, off-the-shelf technology, rather than
designing and building more-costly custom
systems from the ground up. Through contracts with the General Services Administration (GSA), agencies can get standard
commercial software packages for financial
systems.
• Consolidate and out source: The Government can close over half of its larger computer centers and eliminate duplicative
communications links. The National Aeronautics and Space Administration cut its
data center processing costs by 30 percent
in its first year of consolidation, and expects to save another 35 to 40 percent next
year. GSA will close 11 data centers,
outsourcing all of its data center requirements to the private sector.
• Monitor progress with performance-based
management systems: Agencies are establishing performance-based monitoring systems, enabling managers to track whether
major system acquisitions are meeting expectations for costs, schedules, and capabilities. The Federal Aviation Administration’s Air Traffic Modernization System is
using performance measures that are
linked to design and procurement decisions.
• Integrate information: By integrating their
information, agencies can stop duplicating
each others’ efforts while making their
critical information more accurate. Many
agencies collect information that other
agencies use. Over 40 agencies, for example, collect and use trade data for analysis
and for processing imports and exports.
Those agencies are integrating information
about shippers, bills of lading, types of
cargo, exports, imports, and duties into a
cohesive, coordinated system. The new system will eliminate duplicative import
forms, speed cargo clearance, and improve
our trade statistics. Similarly, eight agencies administering programs that deliver
cash benefits to individuals are working

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

together to better coordinate program information across major Federal benefit
programs, in order to prevent overpayments and avoid the costs of trying to recoup them after the fact.
6. Improve Credit Program Performance
To fulfill its stewardship responsibilities
to taxpayers, the Government must manage
its cash and loan assets as wisely as possible.
Specifically, it must design and administer
its loan programs prudently, and provide
incentives to ensure that it can collect its
‘‘receivables’’ (that is, the amounts owed)
in a timely fashion. At the end of 1995,
contingent liabilities (that is, outstanding
guaranteed loans) totaled $737 billion, and
non-tax receivables totaled $245 billion, of
which $50 billion was delinquent. The 1996
Debt Collection Improvement Act gives agencies a range of new tools to improve credit
program performance.
• Lower costs with improved loan servicing:
The Debt Collection Improvement Act lets
agencies withhold Federal payments to
those who are delinquent on loans from
the Federal Government, refer delinquent
accounts to a private collection agency or
a private attorney, or sell the ‘‘account receivable’’ to the private sector. Agencies
also can keep up to five percent of any
increase in their collections in 1997, compared to their average annual collections
in 1993–96, but they must use the funds
they keep to improve their credit management and debt collection.
• Obtain higher recoveries on delinquencies
with enhanced payment offset: Also under
the Act, the Treasury Department has
begun to implement its new authority to
intercept any Federal payment to a delinquent individual or entity to offset the
delinquent amount. Through agency referrals of such debt to the Treasury Department, the Government expects to recover
over $300 million in the next three years,
which it will credit to agency accounts.
• Consolidate Government-wide debt collection: The Act enables Treasury to designate agencies as Federal Debt Collection
Centers to compete for delinquent account
referrals and, in turn, be paid from recov-

IV.

IMPROVING PERFORMANCE IN A BALANCED BUDGET WORLD

eries. By October 1997, Treasury will designate up to five agencies to provide
comprehensive account maintenance and
special collection services. For agencies
with decentralized account servicing operations or few loans, the centers will offer
a low-cost alternative to in-house servicing.
• Coordinate and expedite asset sales: The
Act encourages agencies to sell loan assets
when the Federal Government will benefit
financially. In 1996, the Department of
Housing and Urban Development received
over $300 million more by selling collateralized loans than it would have—had it
continued to hold these delinquent loans
in its portfolio. VA sells over $1 billion
in collateralized loan assets each year. The
Small Business Administration will undertake loan sales in 1998.
7. Improve Business Management
Practices
The Administration is trying to transform
a Federal Government with vestiges of early
20th Century thinking into one suited for
the next century, and seeking to provide
financial accountability for Government spending. An efficient, effective Government needs
sound financial management, reliable information, and, where appropriate, fees from those
who benefit from Government’s business-like
activities. The Administration is taking a
coordinated approach to electronic process
initiatives in order to re-engineer financial
services; aggressively implement electronic
purchasing, payment, and funds transfer; and
improve the quality and timeliness of financial
reporting.
• Collect fees from the beneficiaries of Government’s business-like activities: The Federal Government provides services to businesses and others in the private sector.
The budget would impose or raise fees on
these recipients because, where possible,
those who benefit from the Government’s
business-like activities should finance the
services—not the general taxpayer. Specifically, the budget proposes Federal
Aviation Administration fees to fund the
air traffic control system; Food and Drug
Administration fees to finance the testing

43

and approval of new drugs; and Food Safety and Inspection Service fees to fund the
costs of meat and poultry inspection in
production plants.
• Re-engineer travel policies and procedures:
The Federal Government spends over $7
billion a year for travel (almost $5 billion
in the Defense Department). GAO found
that DOD spends an additional 30 percent
of its direct travel costs to manage its
travel system, while the private sector
spends about six percent. DOD has begun
implementing the recommendations of a
two-year study to streamline its travel
management procedures. GSA also has
begun implementing the recommendations
of a similar study of civilian agency travel
management policies and practices. Both
efforts likely will dramatically cut travel
administrative costs throughout the Government.
• Use electronic means to improve purchasing and capture financial data for easier
accounting: Purchase cards and electronic
data interchange let buyers buy items
cheaply and conveniently, while they capture the needed financial data from the
buyers. USDA estimates that a paper purchase costs $77 to process, while the same
purchase by card costs $33; USDA hopes
to cut the card cost to $17 per transaction.
At the same time, information technology
makes it easier for buyers to learn about
items for sale. The ‘‘GSA Advantage’’
World Wide Web site lets Government employees browse through thousands of product listings and order with the Government’s ‘‘IMPAC’’ credit card, and agencies
can order high-end computer equipment
and software through the Web page of
NASA’s ‘‘Scientific and Engineering
Workstation Procurement’’ contract. The
Administration wants to adopt ‘‘smart
card’’ technology so that, ultimately, every
employee will be able to use one card for
a wide range of purposes, including travel,
small purchases, and building access.
• Phase-in electronic funds transfer: The
Debt Collection Improvement Act supports
agencies’ efforts to modernize their payment processes by requiring the Federal
Government, by 1999, to make payments

44

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

to individuals and businesses by electronic
funds transfer, thereby eliminating the
costs and inconvenience of lost and stolen
paper checks.
• Accelerate implementation of Electronic
Benefits Transfer (EBT): EBT replaces
multiple Federal and State paper-based
benefit delivery systems with a single card
system, cutting overhead costs by streamlining processes and replacing multiple
government delivery systems with the private banking infrastructure. EBT also
brings dignity, security, and access to benefit recipients. Over half of the States will
issue EBT cards in 1997. The Administration’s EBT Task Force has estimated that
Nation-wide implementation of EBT will
save $195 million a year by 1999.
• Assure integrity of data (with audited financial statements): Government managers need management and reporting
systems that produce reliable information.
The basic set of Federal accounting standards is now complete, and agencies are
improving the accuracy and reliability of
their financial information. Sixty percent
of entities that prepared audited financial
statements for 1995 received unqualified
opinions. Agencies are also making those
statements more timely by completing and
releasing them earlier.
Public Confidence in Government
The tools discussed above are designed
to do more than let agencies function better
for their own sake. Ultimately, they are
designed to help agencies provide better,
more effective services to the American people.
Already, agencies are assessing what their
programs actually accomplish and what we
must do to improve their performance. The

Government Performance and Results Act
(GPRA)—the landmark legislation that enjoyed
broad bipartisan support in Congress before
the President signed it in 1993—makes agencies more accountable for, and focused on,
what their programs achieve. The law provides
the Administration, working with Congress,
an unprecedented opportunity to give the
American people a comprehensive picture of
what they are getting for their taxes.
GPRA requires all agencies to send strategic
plans to Congress by September 30, 1997
and make them available to the public.
Each agency will define its mission, and
set out its long-term goals for fulfilling it.
Complementing the strategic plans, agencies
also will create annual performance plans,
establishing performance targets for the year
ahead. Agencies will send the first of these
performance plans, for 1999, to Congress
and make them available publicly in February
1998. Finally, at year-end, GPRA requires
agencies to compare actual performance
against target levels in the performance plan,
and to feature the comparisons in annual
reports on performance to the President and
Congress. Agencies will complete the first
of those reports, for 1999, by March 2000.
For the challenges ahead, agencies now
have many of the tools they need from
not only GPRA but, as illustrated above,
from the Federal Acquisition and Streamlining
Act, the Debt Collection Improvement Act,
the Clinger-Cohen Act, and the Paperwork
Reduction Act. Others, however, will require
legislation. Working together, the Administration and Congress can build on the groundwork they have laid. Working together, we
can help agencies improve the Federal Government’s performance in a balanced budget
world.

IV.

45

IMPROVING PERFORMANCE IN A BALANCED BUDGET WORLD

Table IV–3. PROGRAM PERFORMANCE BENEFITS FROM MAJOR
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY INVESTMENTS
(Budget authority, in millions of dollars)
1996
1997
1998
Actual Estimate Proposed

Program/Project

Program Performance Benefits

Agriculture: Field Service Center
Initiative.

132

91

Commerce:
Advanced
Weather
Interactive Processing System.

58

100

117 Improves the timeliness and accuracy of forecasts. Lowers
the costs of generating forecasts through reduced staffing requirements.

Commerce: Census 2000 ...................

6

20

67 Reduces errors, the number of temporary employees needed, and publication costs.

Defense: Defense Messaging System

121

167

203 Provides timely, reliable, standardized, and secure communications worldwide and in the field.

Loan

85

135

172 Provides efficient and accurate servicing and record keeping for direct student loans.

Education: National Student Loan
Data System.

23

28

32 Identifies institutions with high default rates for corrective action or elimination from student loan programs.
Prevents students with previously defaulted student
loans from receiving additional aid.

Education: PELL Grant Systems .....

6

11

11 Distributes grant funds to institutions and supports sound
financial management.

Student

24

23

20 Makes payments and maintains records for transactions
between the Education Department, guaranty agencies,
and banks, as well as improving debt collection of student loans.

Education: Student Aid Application
System.

50

50

52 Assists institutions and students by providing a standardized way to determine financial aid eligibility.

Energy: Telecommunications Integrator Services contract.

—

2

4 Lowers operating and maintenance costs and improves
sharing of information by promoting interoperability of
telecommunications systems.

Health and Human Services: Medicare Transaction System.

20

75

89 Simplifies and streamlines claims processing, eligibility,
and managed care information systems while improving
service to Medicare customers.

Health and Human Services: National Directory of New Hires.

—

—

30 Will help locate non-custodial parents who flee their home
state to avoid making child support payments.

Housing and Urban Development:
Information Technology Investments.

40

43

66 Provides better internal controls and oversight of Federal
grants, verification of the eligibility of recipients, timely
and accurate payment of funds, and oversight and servicing of FHA mortgages.

Interior: Automated Land Management Records System.

51

42

33 Improves the quality of, and access to, land, resources,
and title information for public land managers and the
public.

Interior: American
System.

Trust

—

13

17 Ensures that trust income is collected, invested, and distributed accurately.

Justice:
Integrated
Automated
Fingerprinting Identification System.

84

84

84 Allows the FBI to process routine identification requests
in 24 hours and urgent requests in two hours.

Justice: National Criminal Information Center 2000.

62

39

— Provides the criminal justice community Nation-wide with
immediate access to documented information on criminals and criminal activity.

Labor: ERISA
System.

Acceptance

—

6

3 Increases the speed, accuracy, and integrity of information
that three agencies use to safeguard private pensions.

State: Diplomatic and Consular Systems Modernization.

100

144

191 Improve delivery and management of information required by diplomatic and consular officers overseas to
support the Nation’s foreign policy goals and ensure
U.S. border security. (Includes user fees and budget authority.)

Education: Direct Student
Servicing System.

Education: Guaranteed
Loan Data System.

Indian

Filing

101 Allows ‘‘one-stop service’’ for farmers and producers.

46

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table IV–3. PROGRAM PERFORMANCE BENEFITS FROM MAJOR
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY INVESTMENTS—Continued
(Budget authority, in millions of dollars)
1996
1997
1998
Actual Estimate Proposed

Program/Project

Program Performance Benefits

Transportation: FAA Air Traffic
Control System Modernization.

1,368

1,233

1,306 Maintains and improves capability to promote the safe,
orderly, and expeditious flow of air traffic

Treasury: Information Technology
Investments.

—

—

500 Provides advanced funding for reengineering and redesign
of tax administration systems and operations.

Treasury: Treasury Communications
System.

46

115

118 Provides secure data transmission and information services worldwide for Treasury bureaus. (Funded through
Treasury’s working capital fund, not annual appropriations.)

Treasury: Automated
Environment.

Commercial

15

15

15 Supports business process redesign, systems architecture,
development, and implementation for systems to replace
Customs’ Automated Commercial System.

Veterans Administration: Benefits
Payment System transition.

6

6

7 Ensures that benefits are delivered timely and establishes
a modern information technology infrastructure.

Veterans Administration: VA Clinical Workstation Information System.

430

450

456 Allows clinicians at VA hospitals and clinics easy access to
complete medical records.

Environmental Protection Agency:
Toxic Release Inventory System.

7

7

8 Helps to improve the environment by maintaining data
related to the release of certain toxic chemical uses. The
data is available to EPA staff, State and local governments, educational institutions, industry, environmental
and public interest groups, and the general public.

National Aeronautics and Space Administration: Earth Observing
System Data Information System.

247

255

245 Archives, manages, and distributes earth science data
from NASA missions and provides spacecraft control
and science data processing for the earth-observing
mission systems.

Social
Security
Administration
(SSA): Automation Investment
Fund.

167

235

200 Funds national implementation of a new computing network of intelligent workstations for SSA and the State
Disability Determination Services and related technological enhancements, including electronic sharing of
information.

Administration:

10

21

31 Beginning in 1998, will offer the Federal Government lowcost, state-of-the-art, integrated voice, data, video, and
long-distance telecommunications. (Cost numbers are
not budget authority, but agency contributions to the
Information Technology Fund for expenses associated
with the FTS 2000 Program.)

Nuclear Regulatory Commission:
Agency Document Access and
Management System.

1

2

2 Implements workprocess improvement review and increases staff efficiency through improved information
access and elimination of redundant data entry. Reduces maintenance costs by replacing aging legacy hardware and minimizing custom software.

Office of Personnel Management:
Retirement System Modernization.

—

—

— Improves product accuracy, customer service, and staff
efficiency by reengineering current paper-laden Federal
employee retirement processes.

Interagency: Simplified Tax
Wage Reporting System.

and

—

—

— Reduces employers’ tax and wage reporting burden.

Trade

—

—

6 Reduces burden on exports and imports, speeds up shipments, and improves the quality of trade statistics.

Data Center Consolidation ...............

—

—

–56 Saves money by requiring all Federal agencies to consolidate or co-locate their data processing centers to fewer
larger, more efficient, and cost effective locations, either
within the Government or with a private sector provider.

General Services
Post-FTS 2000.

Interagency: International
Data System.

Note: This report is required by the Information Technology Management Reform Act of 1996, 40 USC 1412(c)).

V. CREATING OPPORTUNITY,
DEMANDING RESPONSIBILITY,
AND STRENGTHENING
COMMUNITY

47

1.

STRENGTHENING HEALTH CARE

We can, and we must, work together to reform Medicare and Medicaid so they continue to meet
the promise to our parents and our children and continue to expand health care step by step to
children in working families who don’t have it. We can do that and balance the budget, and take
advantage of the fact that new models are clearly making it possible to lower the rate of medical
inflation in a way that advances the quality of health care as well as the quality of our long-term
objectives in balancing the budget and investing in the future of America. I know it can be done,
and I am determined to get it done.
President Clinton
December 11, 1996

Americans have good reason to be optimistic
about the Nation’s health care as we approach
the new millennium.
Medicare ensures that older Americans receive high quality health care and can look
forward to a longer life expectancy. Medicaid
provides vital health services to low-income
pregnant women and children, people with
disabilities, and elderly Americans. Together,
Medicare and Medicaid serve over 71 million
Americans. Meanwhile, the Federal Government is investing more in biomedical research
and technology, furthering our knowledge
about the prevention and treatment of diseases
and providing new insights into the genetic
basis of diseases such as breast cancer as
well as threats from food-borne illnesses newly
emerging infectious diseases.
And just in the past year, we have witnessed
the rapid development of new prescription
drugs to help people with AIDS and other
debilitating diseases. These new developments
hold the potential for a vastly increased
life expectancy for these Americans.
Our private health system, already the
world’s most dynamic, is undergoing a dramatic transformation—much of it positive.
The best private sector innovations have
helped make our delivery system more efficient, and have improved quality by increasing
consumer choice, stressing accountability, and
focusing on medical outcomes.
In his first term, the President and Congress
took important steps to improve our Nation’s

health care system. One of the most significant
was last year’s passage of the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of
1996 (HIPAA), also known as the KassebaumKennedy bill. Now, as many as 25 million
Americans have health benefit portability they
did not have before; no longer will people
who have been sick have to fear that they
will lose their access to health insurance
if they lose their job or change jobs. Nor
can they be denied coverage because they
have a preexisting medical condition. Moreover, the law requires insurance companies
to sell coverage to small employer groups
and to individuals who lose group coverage
without regard to their health status. It
also made it easier and cheaper for selfemployed people to get health insurance,
simplified health care paperwork, strengthened Medicare’s fraud and abuse efforts,
and helped make long-term care insurance
more affordable.
Other significant health care initiatives
enacted in the last four years include laws
requiring health plans to allow new mothers
and their babies to remain in the hospital
at least 48 hours following most deliveries,
and prohibiting health plans from establishing
separate lifetime and annual limits for mental
health coverage.
With this budget, the President takes the
next critical steps toward a better health
care future:

49

50
• Preserving Medicare and Medicaid, while
reforming and strengthening both programs in important ways.
• Helping the growing numbers of American
children and families who lack health insurance coverage.
• Strengthening the health care infrastructure by investing more in biomedical research, in programs to combat infectious
diseases, in the Ryan White AIDS program that provides life-extending drug
therapies to many people with AIDS, and
in programs such as community health
centers and Indian Health Service facilities that serve critically underserved populations.
Preserving Medicare
The budget preserves and improves Medicare, extending the life of the Part A Hospital
Insurance Trust Fund into 2007. Like the
President’s previous two budgets, it gives
beneficiaries more choices among private
health plans, makes Medicare more efficient
and responsive to beneficiary needs, slows
the growth rate of provider payments, and
maintains the Part B Supplementary Medical
Insurance premium at 25 percent of program
costs. The plan saves $100 billion over five
years (and $138 billion over six years), according to the Health Care Financing Administration’s Office of the Actuary.
The President also wants to work with
Congress on a bipartisan basis to address
the longer-term problem of financing Medicare
to support the health care needs of the
‘‘baby boom’’ generation.
Provider Payment Reforms and Program
Savings
• Hospitals: The budget reduces the annual
inflation increase, or ‘‘update,’’ for hospitals; reduces payments for hospital capital; reforms payments for graduate medical education; and begins to reform the
payment methodology for outpatient departments while protecting beneficiaries
from increasing charges for those services.
• Managed Care: Along with the Administration’s previous proposals to reduce the
current geographic variation in payments,

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

the budget proposes a new managed care
payment methodology in light of substantial evidence that Medicare pays too much
for managed care plans and, in fact, loses
money for every beneficiary who opts for
managed care. The budget would reduce
Medicare reimbursement to managed care
plans from its current rate of 95 percent
of fee-for-service rates to 90 percent. To
enable the industry to prepare for this
change, the Administration would not implement it until the year 2000. The Administration views this reform as a first
step and will continue to work with the
industry to create a better reimbursement
mechanism for Medicare managed care
plans.
• Physicians: The budget reforms physician
payments by paying a single update for
all physician services—based on a single
‘‘conversion factor,’’ or base payment
amount, and replacing the current three
conversion factors, effective January 1,
1998. The budget replaces current ‘‘volume
performance standards’’ with a sustainable
growth rate.
• Home Health Agencies/Skilled Nursing
Facilities: The budget implements payment reforms, leading to separate prospective payment systems for home health care
and skilled nursing facilities. Prospective
payments would begin to bring the current
double-digit rise in spending on these services under control. The budget also proposes to reform the home health benefit
by paying for services following a hospital
stay from the Part A Trust Fund and paying for other services from Medicare’s Part
B Trust Fund. Beneficiaries would not be
affected by the change. In addition, the
change will not count towards the budget’s
proposed $100 billion in Medicare savings
through 2002, but will help to extend the
solvency of the Part A Trust Fund.
• Other Providers: The budget makes payments for durable medical equipment and
laboratory services more consistent with
private market rates and reduces payment
updates to ambulatory surgical centers.
The budget also proposes to address Medicare’s overpayment for prescription drugs
that are provided in a physician’s office

1.

51

STRENGTHENING HEALTH CARE

by making payments more competitive
with what private purchasers pay.
• Beneficiaries: The budget continues, but
does not increase, the requirement that
beneficiaries pay 25 percent of Part B
costs through the monthly Part B premium. The budget imposes no new cost
increases on beneficiaries. The budget also
would maintain current law to prevent
‘‘balance billing,’’ ensuring that doctors in
the new managed care plan options may
not charge above Medicare’s approved
amount and leave the elderly vulnerable
to higher costs.
• Private Plan Choices: The budget increases
the numbers of plans—including Preferred
Provider Organizations and Provider
Sponsored Networks—available to seniors
and people with disabilities. These new options will meet strong quality standards
and include consumer protections. The
plans would be required to compete on cost
and quality, not on the health status of
enrollees.
Beneficiary Improvements
The budget proposes reforms to improve
and increase services to beneficiaries, to protect them from the burden of additional
costs, and to offer them a wider choice
of private plans.
• Preventive Health Care: The budget covers
new preventive health benefits including:
colorectal screening; diabetes management; preventive injections like pneumonia, influenza, and hepatitis B; and annual mammograms without coppayments.
• Alzheimer’s Respite Benefit: The budget establishes a new respite benefit for the families of Medicare beneficiaries with Alzheimer’s disease. Medicare beneficiaries
would be eligible to receive non-medical
care, giving family members a much-needed break from the constant demands of
caring for them.
• Outpatient Department Payments: Payments to hospitals for outpatient services
are one of Medicare’s fastest growing components. Due to flaws in the current reimbursement methodology, hospital outpatient departments get a reimbursement

higher than their actual costs. In effect,
beneficiaries pay about a 50-percent copayment for hospital outpatient services, as
opposed to the 20-percent copayment made
for other Part B services. Medicare’s payments are not always reduced to account
fully for these high copayments. The budget corrects these flaws by establishing a
prospective payment system for outpatient
services and ensuring that, by 2007, beneficiaries pay the same 20-percent copayment as they do for other Part B services.
• Medigap Protections: The budget adds protections, such as new open enrollment requirements and prohibitions against the
use of pre-existing condition exclusions, to
help Medicare beneficiaries who wish to
opt for managed care but fear they will
be ‘‘locked in’’ and unable to access their
old Medigap protections if they switch
back to a fee-for-service plan.
• The Working Disabled: The budget proposes a Medicare demonstration project to
encourage Social Security Disability Insurance (SSDI) beneficiaries to return to
work. Under the four-year, Nation-wide
demonstration project, SSDI beneficiaries
who return to work beginning in 1998
would receive Part A coverage through
2001 without paying the premiums.
Additional High-Priority Initiatives
The budget contains other reforms to improve the Medicare program as well as adjustments to Medicare payments to ensure that
rural beneficiaries have access to health care
services.
• Rural Health Care: The budget would expand access to, and improve the quality
of, health care in rural areas. It would
extend the Rural Referral Center program;
allow direct Medicare reimbursement for
nurse practitioners, clinical nurse specialists, and physician assistants; improve the
Sole Community Hospital program; expand the Rural Primary Care Hospital
program; and provide grants to promote
telemedicine and rural health outreach.
The proposed changes in managed care
payment methodology also would promote
access to managed care plans in rural
areas.

52
• Fraud and Abuse: The budget proposes
strong fraud and abuse provisions, including measures to eliminate fraud in home
health care—such as by ensuring that
home health agencies are reimbursed
based on the location of the service, not
the billing office, and by enabling the Secretary of Health and Human Services to
deny payments for excessive home health
use. The budget also would repeal several
provisions in last year’s HIPAA law that
weakened anti-fraud enforcement. Together, these initiatives would save about
$9 billion.
Strengthening Medicaid
The budget would reform Medicaid to give
States much more flexibility to manage their
programs, while preserving the guarantee
of high-quality health care and long-term
services for the most vulnerable Americans—
millions of children, pregnant women, people
with disabilities, and older Americans. The
budget would ensure that as we control
the costs of Medicaid, we do not compromise
what is right with the program.
The growth in Medicaid spending has slowed
significantly over the past two years. The
budget, however, ensures that our success
in bringing Medicaid spending under control
will not be lost in future years, when the
actuaries project that Medicaid spending will
again begin to rise. The budget would save
$22 billion from a combination of policies
to impose a per capita limit on spending
and reduce Disproportionate Share Hospital
(DSH) payments and retarget them to hospitals that serve large numbers of Medicaid
and low-income patients. The budget also
makes a number of improvements to the
Medicaid program, including changes to last
year’s welfare reform law, costing $13 billion
over the same period.
Program Savings
• Per Capita Cap: Even though the growth
in Medicaid spending has fallen in recent
years, aggregate Medicaid spending still
will grow at an average annual rate of
7.2 percent from 1997 to 2002. To ensure
that Medicaid’s explosive growth of the
1980s and early 1990s does not resume,
the budget would set a per capita cap on

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Medicaid spending, based on spending per
beneficiary in a base year, increased by
an annual growth limit. The cap protects
States facing population growth or economic downturns because it ensures that
dollars follow people, allowing Medicaid
spending to respond to changes in caseload
and the economy.
• Disproportionate Share Hospital Payments:
Medicaid DSH spending doubled each year
from 1988 to 1993. Although this rapid
growth has slowed, due to 1993 legislation
that modified the program, the DSH program is still large, and the payments could
be targeted better. The budget proposes
reforms to reach this goal without undermining the important role these funds
play for providers who serve a disproportionate number of low-income and Medicaid beneficiaries.
Provisions to Increase State Flexibility
The budget continues the President’s strong
commitment to giving States the flexibility
to design their own Medicaid program. The
budget would ensure accountability for highquality health care while enabling States
to develop programs that meet the special
needs of their populations.
• Coverage for Children: The budget would
let States provide continuous coverage for
one year after eligibility is determined,
guaranteeing more stable coverage for
children and more continuity of health
care services. In addition, it will reduce
the administrative burden on Medicaid officials, health care providers, and families
required to refile paperwork to determine
their children’s eligibility.
• Coverage Without Waivers: The budget
would let States, without a waiver, expand
coverage to any person whose income is
under 150 percent of the poverty line,
within their per-capita spending limits.
• Managed Care: The budget would allow
States to enroll people in managed care
without Federal waivers.
• Home- and Community-based Care: The
budget would allow States to serve people
needing long-term care in home- and com-

1.

53

STRENGTHENING HEALTH CARE

munity-based
waivers.

settings

without

Federal

• Boren Amendment: The budget would repeal the ‘‘Boren amendment’’ for hospitals
and nursing homes, giving States more
flexibility to negotiate provider payment
rates.
• The Working Disabled: The budget would
let States establish an income-related premium buy-in program under Medicaid for
people with disabilities who work. It would
let eligible Supplemental Security Income
beneficiaries who earn more than certain
amounts purchase Medicaid coverage by
paying a premium that States would set
on an income-related sliding scale.
Maintaining and Expanding Coverage for
Working Families
The President’s budget plan would help
an estimated 3.2 million families, including
700,000 children, keep their health care coverage for to six months up until their breadwinners find new jobs. The budget also
would help provide health coverage for millions
of children who do not now have it. Finally,
the budget proposes to help States to create
voluntary health insurance purchasing cooperatives.
Health Insurance for the Families of
Workers Who are In-Between Jobs
While unemployment remains low and job
creation remains high, the fast-moving economy creates rapid job turnover and job elimination. An estimated one in four workers
will make an unemployment claim at least
once in four years.
With health care coverage in this country
usually linked to employment, many workers
lose their health care coverage during these
brief periods of unemployment. Nearly half
of workers with one or more job interruptions
experienced at least a month without health
insurance between 1992 and 1995. Nearly
half of children who lose their health insurance do so because of a change in their
parent’s employment status. A family experiencing a catastrophic illness during this transition loses the benefit of years’ worth of
premiums. Worse, for families with an ill
child or a worker with a chronic condition,

the loss of health insurance while their
breadwinner is between jobs can make it
financially impossible for them to regain
coverage.
The budget proposes a national demonstration program to help States finance up to
six months of coverage for the unemployed
and their families. The program would be
available to recipients, based on need, who
had employer-based coverage in their prior
jobs. Eligible individuals and their families
would have access to a policy generally
equivalent to the Blue Cross/Blue Shield
Standard Option plan available through the
Federal Employees Health Benefits program.
The plan gives States flexibility to administer
their own programs (e.g., through Medicaid,
COBRA, or an independent program). It would
cost $1.7 billion in 1998, $9.8 billion from
1998 to 2002.
Health Coverage for Children
The budget proposes several measures to
expand health care coverage to more children.
Combined with the proposal to help the
families of unemployed workers (discussed
above), and the ongoing phase-in of Medicaid
coverage for a million older children, these
additional proposals could add coverage for
as many as five million children. The President is pleased with the widespread congressional interest in expanding health care coverage for children, and he looks forward
to working with both Democrats and Republicans to develop and implement proposals
to reach that goal.
• State Grants to Develop Innovative Programs: The budget provides $750 million
a year in grants to States ($3.8 billion
from 1998 to 2002) to build on recent State
successes in working with insurers, providers, employers, schools, and others to develop innovative ways to provide coverage
to children. This proposal would cover an
estimated one million children.
• Continuous Medicaid Coverage to Children: The budget provides funds to let
States extend one year of continuous Medicaid coverage to children, potentially helping one million children who would otherwise have lost coverage to keep it. The
proposal would reduce administrative bur-

54

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

dens on States, families, and health care
plans who now must determine eligibility
at least every six months.
• Medicaid Outreach: About three million
children are now eligible for Medicaid, but
not enrolled. The Administration will ask
the Nation’s Governors to work with us
to find ways to reach and sign up such
children.
• School Health Centers and Consolidated
Health Centers (CHCs): The budget provides more funds for CHCs to expand and
enhance services to working families and
their children through school-based health
clinics.
Voluntary Purchasing Cooperatives
Employees in small businesses and their
families are far likelier to be uninsured
than other Americans. Small businesses have
more difficulty providing health care coverage
for their workers because they have higher
per capita costs due to increased risk and
extraordinarily high administrative costs.
The budget would make it easier for small
businesses to provide health care coverage
for their employees, by helping them to
band together to reduce their risks, lower
their administrative costs, and improve their
purchasing power with insurance companies.
The budget proposes to empower small businesses to access and purchase more affordable
health insurance through voluntary health
purchasing cooperatives—providing $25 million a year in grants that States can use
for technical assistance, and setting up voluntary purchasing cooperatives and allowing
them to access Federal Employees Health
Benefit Plans.
Promoting Public Health
The budget invests in preventive steps
that show the greatest promise of ameliorating
pain and suffering while controlling future
costs. In particular, the budget focuses on
preventing teen smoking; substance abuse;
teen pregnancy; the spread of AIDS and
HIV infections; food-borne diseases; the spread
of infectious diseases; and infant mortality.
The budget also invests in health care services
for low-income and other vulnerable popu-

lations, such as American Indians and Alaska
Natives.
Expanding Biomedical and Behavioral
Research
The budget continues the Administration’s
longstanding commitment to biomedical and
behavioral research, which advances the
health and well-being of all Americans. For
the National Institutes of Health (NIH), it
proposes $13.1 billion for biomedical research
that would lay the foundation for future
innovations that improve health and prevent
disease. The budget includes funding for
high-priority research areas such as HIV/
AIDS (including efforts to develop an AIDS
vaccine), breast cancer, spinal cord injury,
high performance computing, prevention and
genetic medicine.
The Office of AIDS Research will continue
to coordinate all of NIH’s AIDS research.
The budget also includes the second year
of funding for a new NIH Clinical Research
Center, which would give NIH a state-ofthe-art research facility in which researchers
would bring the latest discoveries directly
to patients’ bedsides. NIH’s top priority continues to be financing investigator-initiated research project grants.
Providing Direct Services and Preventive
Care to Special Populations
While basic biomedical research lays the
foundation for medical advances, direct health
services and prevention activities reduce the
cost of medical care, and directly benefit
Americans by preventing disease outbreaks
and promoting the population’s health. The
budget proposes funding increases for the
following health service and prevention activities:
• Preventing and Treating AIDS through
Ryan White HIV/AIDS Treatment Grants/
HIV Prevention: The budget proposes just
over $1 billion for activities authorized by
the Ryan White CARE Act, $40 million
more than in 1997, to help our most hardhit cities, States, and local clinics provide
medical and support services to individuals with HIV/AIDS. Under this Administration, funding for Ryan White grants has
risen by 158 percent. The proposed level

1.

STRENGTHENING HEALTH CARE

would fund grants to cities and States to
help finance medical and support services
for individuals infected with the HIV
virus; to community-based clinics to provide HIV early intervention services; to pediatric AIDS and HIV dental activities;
and to HIV education and training programs for health care providers. The budget also includes $167 million dedicated to
State AIDS drug assistance programs
funded under Title II of the Ryan White
Care act, to improve access to protease inhibitors and other life-extending AIDS
medications. The budget also proposes
$637 million for the Centers for Disease
Control’s (CDC) HIV prevention activities,
$20 million more than in 1997. The increased funding will help prevent HIV
among drug users, who face the greatest
risk of HIV infection.
• Reducing Tobacco Use Among Young People: Tobacco is linked to over 400,000
deaths a year from cancer, respiratory
illness, heart disease, and other health
problems. Each year, another million
young people become regular smokers, and
over 300,000 of them will die earlier as
a result. Consequently, in August 1996,
the Administration approved an FDA regulation that aims to cut tobacco use among
young people by half over seven years; the
budget includes $34 million to implement
the regulation. The budget also provides
$36 million for the CDC and $50 million
for NIH for State grants and technical
support for tobacco control and cancer prevention activities.
• Enhancing Food Safety: Too many Americans get sick from preventable food-borne
diseases. The Nation faces new challenges
in this area as we enter the 21st Century.
New pathogens are emerging and familiar
pathogens have grown resistant to treatment. We consume record levels of imported foods, some of which moves across
the globe overnight. The budget proposes
$42 million for a new interagency food
safety initiative to establish a national
early warning system for food-borne illnesses Nation-wide, and to improve Federal-State coordination when food-borne
disease outbreaks occur. The budget also
proposes to continue implementing a new

55
food safety system in the meat, poultry,
and seafood industries.
• Promoting Full Participation in Women,
Infants, and Children (WIC): WIC reaches
over seven million women, infants, and
children a year, providing nutrition assistance, nutrition education and counseling,
and health and immunization referrals.
WIC provides prenatal care to those who
would not otherwise get it, while reducing
the incidence of premature birth and infant death. As a result, Medicaid saves
significant sums that it would otherwise
spend in the first 60 days after childbirth.
Because of funding increases in the last
four years, WIC participation has grown
by over 25 percent. The budget proposes
$4.1 billion to serve 7.5 million people by
the end of 1998, fulfilling the President’s
goal of full participation in WIC.
• Promoting Childhood Immunizations: The
budget proposes $794 million for the
Childhood Immunization Initiative, including the Vaccines for Children program and
CDC’s discretionary immunization program. The Nation is ahead of schedule to
meet the Administration’s goal of raising
immunization rates to 90 percent for twoyear old children for each basic childhood
vaccine. The incidence of vaccine-preventable diseases among children, such as
diphtheria, tetanus, measles, and polio,
are at all-time lows. The budget also includes $47 million to eradicate polio—preventable
through
immunizations—
throughout the world.
• Improving Substance Abuse Treatment and
Prevention: The budget proposes to increase support for the Substance Abuse
and Mental Health Services Administration’s substance abuse treatment and prevention activities by $33 million, to $1.7
billion, enabling hundreds of thousands of
pregnant women, high-risk youth, and
other under-served Americans to get drug
treatment and prevention services. The
budget proposes a coordinated approach to
combating substance abuse among youth
with a comprehensive prevention initiative, focusing on State-level data documenting trends in drug use. The Administration again calls on Congress to enact

56

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Performance Partnerships, which would
give States more flexibility to better target
Federal resources to priorities.
• Enhancing Abstinence Education and
Family Planning: For each of the next five
years, the budget includes $50 million in
mandatory funding for States to conduct
abstinence education projects to help reduce out-of-wedlock pregnancies. The
budget also includes a $5 million increase,
to $203 million, to support voluntary family planning services.
• Preventing and Containing Infectious Diseases: The budget includes $103 million,
$15 million more than in 1997, for CDC’s
cooperative efforts with States to address
infectious disease. It would support training and applied research, and the States’
disease surveillance capability. All Americans face threats from infectious disease
problems, such as drug resistant bacteria,
and from emerging viruses, such as the
hantavirus. CDC works with State health
departments to monitor and prevent such
problems and to contain outbreaks.

• Promoting Better Health Care for Native
Americans through Indian Health Service
(IHS): The budget proposes $2.4 billion for
the IHS, $70 million over 1997. IHS clinical services are often the only source of
medical care on remote reservation lands,
and this increase maintains our commitment to American Indians and Alaska Natives.
• Caring for Veteran’s Health Needs through
Veterans Medical Care: Continuing its
longstanding commitment to veterans
programs, the Administration proposes
$17.5 billion for the Department of Veterans Affairs’ (VA) health system, $0.5 billion more than in 1997. The budget would
enable the VA health system to retain,
and spend for itself, all first- and thirdparty medical collections. In the past,
these collections have gone to the Treasury; in 1998, they would support health
services for veterans. The budget would
enable the VA to implement eligibility reform legislation that the President signed
in October 1996, and pursue ambitious
plans to restructure the health system to
better deliver care.

2.

INVESTING IN EDUCATION AND
TRAINING

I want to build a bridge to the 21st Century in which we expand opportunity through education, where computers are as much a part of the classroom as blackboards, where highlytrained teachers demand peak performance from our students, where every eight-year-old can
point to a book and say, I can read it myself.
President Clinton
August 29, 1996

Today’s most successful workers are those
with skills and a firm educational footing
who continue to learn throughout their careers
in order to compete successfully in this
fast-changing economy.

throughout their working lives can get those
opportunities; and that States and communities that receive Federal funds can use
them more flexibly, with fewer regulations
and less paperwork.

In recent years, education and wages have
become increasingly intertwined. Generally,
those with the best skills and education
have made steady progress, enjoying higher
living standards. Those without the requisite
skills and education have fallen behind. Tomorrow’s workers face an even greater challenge. As the very nature of work changes
with technological innovation, employers will
demand even more highly-skilled and flexible
workers. The best-paying jobs increasingly
will go only to those with education and
training beyond high school.

Federal resources help States improve the
quality of education and training for the
disadvantaged and for people with disabilities;
support State- and locally-designed elementary
and secondary school reform; and help lowand middle-income families gain financial
access to postsecondary education and skill
training through loans and grants. To help
States raise student achievement, the President has worked hard to make schools safer,
improve teacher quality, move technology into
the classroom as quickly as possible, raise
academic standards, and better prepare students for college and the new workplace.

For the most part, our Nation places responsibility for education and training on State
and local governments, families and individuals, and the private sector. Nevertheless,
the Federal Government plays a crucial, if
limited, role in providing education for a
lifetime—from pre-school to adult career training.
The President’s goals are to help families,
communities and States ensure that every
child is prepared to make the best use
of education; that the education system enables every child to learn to his or her
potential; that those who need resources
to pay for postsecondary education and training can get them; that those who need
a second chance at training and education
or a chance to improve or learn new skills

The budget reaffirms the President’s commitment to America’s children by increasing
the investment in Head Start and in Federal
elementary and secondary education programs—focusing on innovation and technology—and launching a new effort to jumpstart needed school renovation and construction. In addition, the President has begun
a national, volunteer-based challenge called
America Reads, to ensure that all children
can read well and independently by the
end of third grade.
To ensure that all Americans have access
to the high-skill training needed for today’s
workplace, the President proposes to make
two years of postsecondary education universally available, through HOPE scholarship
57

58

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

tax credits of up to $1,500 for two years.
And to encourage lifelong learning, the budget
proposes: tax deductions of up to $10,000
for tuition and fees for college, graduate
school, or job training; a $300 increase in
the maximum Pell Grant college scholarship
(to $3,000), marking the largest increase
in two decades and providing grants for
at least 348,000 more students; lower student
loan fees and interest rates for parents
and students; the G.I. Bill for America’s
Workers so they can choose where to get
the best job training available; and new
resources to help move welfare recipients
from welfare to work (see Table 2–1 and
Chart 2–1).

than the time parents spend reading to, and
with, them. Research shows that the first
three years of a child’s life are crucial to his
or her development. An early exposure to
books, even for infants, is important to prepare
children for pre-reading activities as toddlers.
Reading to them for 20 minutes a day can
make a big difference in their readiness for
school. To give parents help and information
in teaching their children, the Administration
proposes a Parents as First Teachers Challenge Grant Fund of $300 million over five
years, building on the current Even Start Family Literacy program to support effective, proven efforts that help parents help their children
become successful readers.

America Reads

Head Start

Many of our children are falling short
of meeting standard educational levels—a
failure that they often have trouble overcoming
later. In 1994, for instance, two-fifths of
fourth-graders failed to reach the ‘‘basic’’
reading level on the National Assessment
of Educational Progress and only 30 percent
attained the ‘‘proficient’’ level. In response,
the President has launched the America Reads
Challenge, a multi-part effort to help States
and communities ensure that all children
are reading well and independently by the
end of the third grade. Business and academic
leaders already have pledged their support,
and the budget proposes the Federal funding
component. The Administration will measure
the success of this effort on a national
basis through the biennial administration
of the National Assessment of Educational
Progress fourth grade reading assessment.

A healthy, caring family environment is
the best preparation for school. For over
30 years, Head Start has helped low-income
families create this environment by taking
a comprehensive approach to child development—improving children’s learning skills,
health, nutrition, and social competency. Head
Start involves parents in their children’s
learning, and links children and their families
to a wide array of services in their communities. Over the last four years, the President
has secured a 43-percent increase in funds
for Head Start, enabling the program to
serve 800,000 children in 1997.

America’s Reading Corps: One-on-one tutoring is one key to better reading. America’s
Reading Corps will provide individualized
after-school and summer help for over three
million children in grades K-3 who want and
need it. A five-year, $2.45 billion investment,
through the Education Department and the
Corporation for National and Community Service, would help communities mobilize 30,000
reading specialists and volunteer coordinators
to recruit and train over a million tutors, including 100,000 college work-study students.
Parents as First Teachers: Nothing is
more important to children’s reading skills

The budget proposes $4.3 billion for Head
Start, $324 million more than in 1997, to
enable 86,000 more children to participate
than in 1996 and raising program quality
(see Chart 2–2). With this funding, the Administration would be well on its way toward
meeting the President’s commitment of a
million children in Head Start by 2002.
In addition, the Early Start component
of Head Start extends comprehensive early
development services to infants aged 0 to
3 in a way that supports families, builds
parenting skills, and extends a safe, nurturing,
and stimulating environment to very young
children.
Elementary and Secondary Education
The Administration has energized State
and local efforts to raise student achievement
by boosting funds for various programs that

2.

59

INVESTING IN EDUCATION AND TRAINING

Table 2–1. THE BUDGET INCREASES RESOURCES FOR MAJOR EDUCATION AND
TRAINING PROGRAMS BY $15 BILLION, OR 56 PERCENT OVER 1993
(Dollar amounts in millions)

1993
Actual

MANDATORY OUTLAYS/TAX EXPENDITURES:
HOPE scholarships tax credit/deduction ........................................
America Reads (Education Department) ........................................
School construction ..........................................................................
Work Opportunity Tax Credit .........................................................
Welfare-to-Work Jobs Challenge .....................................................

...............
100
............... .................
............... .................
...............
120
............... .................

Total, mandatory outlays and tax expenditures ............... ...............
DISCRETIONARY BUDGET AUTHORITY:
Head Start ......................................................................................
Elementary and secondary education:
America Reads (Corp. for National and Community Service)
Goals 2000 .....................................................................................
Education technology ...................................................................
Title I Education for Disadvantaged ...........................................
Eisenhower Teacher Training .....................................................
Special education ..........................................................................
Safe and drug free schools ...........................................................
Charter schools .............................................................................
After-school learning centers .......................................................
Postsecondary student aid:
Pell Grants ....................................................................................
College Work Study ......................................................................
Other campus-based aid ...............................................................
Presidential Honors Scholarships ...............................................
Training and employment:
Vocational education ....................................................................
Adult education .............................................................................
School-To-Work (Education and Labor Departments) ...............
Summer Jobs for Youth ...............................................................
Job Corps .......................................................................................
Youth Opportunity Areas .............................................................
JTPA adult/dislocated worker training .......................................
Employment service and One-Stops ............................................

1997
Estimate

2,776

1998
Proposed

Percent
Change:
1993 to
1998

4,100
31
1,250
160
600

NA
NA
NA
NA
NA

220

6,141

NA

3,981

4,305

+55%

............... .................
...............
491
23
305
6,709
7,698
289
310
2,966
4,036
582
540
...............
51
............... .................

200
NA
620
NA
545 +2,270%
8,077
+20%
360
+25%
4,210
+42%
620
+7%
100
NA
50
NA

6,458
5,919
616
830
845
811
............... .................

7,635
857
771
132

+18%
+39%
–9%
NA

1,176
1,131
304
354
...............
400
849
871
966
1,154
............... .................
1,666
2,181
975
974

1,172
394
400
871
1,246
250
2,415
993

–*%
+30%
NA
+3%
+29%
NA
+45%
+2%

Total, budget authority ........................................................

27,200

32,037

36,223

+33%

Total, mandatory outlays, tax expenditures, and
budget authority .............................................................

27,200

32,257

42,364

+56%

STUDENT LOAN VOLUME (loan amount):
Direct loans ....................................................................................... ...............
Guaranteed loans .............................................................................
16,029
Consolidation loans ..........................................................................
1,527

9,938
16,965
6,803

12,037
16,774
7,729

NA
+5%
+406%

33,706

36,540

+108%

Total, loan volume ........................................................................

17,556

NA = Not applicable.
* Less than 0.5 percent.

States and localities then combine with their
own funds to help all students achieve at
high levels in a safe, modern learning environment. The budget builds on this momentum
by proposing additional funds for all major
programs, and for the new America Reads

initiative (discussed earlier in this chapter)
and the new school construction initiative
(discussed later).
The Administration’s goal for elementary
and secondary education is to help States
and communities raise the quality of education

60

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 2-1. INVESTMENT IN EDUCATION DEPARTMENT PROGRAMS,
HOPE SCHOLARSHIPS AND TAX DEDUCTIONS
WILL INCREASE 56 PERCENT BETWEEN 1996 AND 2002
DOLLARS IN BILLIONS
50

45

NEW MANDATORY AND TAX INITIATIVES

40

35
CURRENT MANDATORY OUTLAYS
30

25

DISCRETIONARY OUTLAYS

20
1996

1997

1998

for all children. Administration initiatives
launched in 1994 are designed to establish
a framework for comprehensive reform and
to help States finance their role in it. The
goals include: high State standards for all
children; new curriculum and teaching methods to help all children achieve those standards; teacher and administrator training to
support the standards; assessments of each
child’s progress; and a safe, technologically
up-to-date learning environment. The budget
proposes to increase funds for programs that
support these goals, and proposes more flexibility to enhance the success of State and
community efforts.
School Construction: The General Accounting Office found that a third of all schools
across the country, with 14 million students,
have one or more buildings needing extensive
repair. School districts also face the cost of
upgrading schools to accommodate computers
and modern technology, and of constructing
new classrooms and schools to meet expected
record enrollment levels over the next decade.

1999

2000

2001

2002

The President proposes to leverage new construction or renovation projects through a $5
billion fund for school districts with substantial need. The fund would support interest subsidies or similar assistance to cut borrowing
costs for States and localities in order to reach
higher levels of infrastructure investment.
Goals 2000: Enacted in 1994, this Administration initiative helps participating States establish high standards for all children and
plan and implement steps to raise educational
achievement. It builds on the National Education Goals, first articulated by the Nation’s
governors (led by then-Governor Clinton) and
President Bush in 1989, which provide clear
national targets but encourage States to develop their own means to achieve them. All
States have now chosen to receive Goals 2000
funding.
The program is working. In Maryland,
40 percent of all students met challenging
State academic standards in 1995, a 25
percent gain over 1993. Over the next two
years, the Education Department seeks to

2.

61

INVESTING IN EDUCATION AND TRAINING

Chart 2-2. 36 THOUSAND NEW HEAD START OPPORTUNITIES FOR
CHILDREN IN 1998 OVER 1997; ONE MILLION BY 2002
SLOTS IN THOUSANDS
1050
1000
950
900
850
800
750
700
650
600

1993

1994

1995

1996

1997

ensure that at least half of all school districts
are implementing reforms based on Statedeveloped standards, and that the number
of students meeting or exceeding their State’s
standards continues to rise. Goals 2000 also
supports individual school reforms. The budget
would finance aid for 4,000 more schools
than in 1997—for a total of 16,000 schools.
The budget provides $620 million for Goals
2000, 26 percent more than in 1997. It
includes $15 million for parental information
and resource centers in 42 States to help
parents become more involved in their children’s education and gain skills in child
rearing through parent-to-parent training, hotlines, and other activities. Each center also
provides information and training to parents
of pre-school aged children, either through
the Home Instruction Program for Preschool
Youngsters or the Parents as Teachers program.
Charter Schools: One way to improve the
quality of public schools is to introduce variety
and competition into the system. Charter

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

schools are public schools that parents, teachers, and communities create—and that States
free from most rules and regulations and, instead, hold accountable for raising student
achievement. Begun as a grassroots movement
in 1991, and supported by Federal start-up
funds since 1995, charter schools now number
over 400, and some are now showing results
in higher student test scores and lower dropout rates. For example, in the Vaughn Next
Century Learning Center, a Los Angeles public
charter school, median scores on a 4th-grade
standardized reading test rose from the 19th
to 37th percentile in one year. The budget proposes $100 million for public charter schools,
nearly double the 1997 level, in order to fund
start-up costs for as many as 1,100 schools
and to make further progress towards the
President’s goal of 3,000 schools by 2001.
Title I—Education for the Disadvantaged: Title I provides funds to raise the educational achievement of disadvantaged children. In 1994, the President proposed, and
Congress adopted, changes to focus Title I re-

62

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

sources more on low-income children, to set
the same high standards for those children as
for all others, to hold schools accountable for
progress toward achieving those standards,
and to give States and schools great flexibility
in using Title I funds. The budget includes
$8.1 billion for Title I, five percent more than
in 1997.

violence programs in our schools. It helps students resolve conflicts before they escalate into
tragedy, teaches them the dangers of drug use,
and helps schools increase security. The budget proposes to spend $620 million for the program, 12 percent over the 1997 level, and to
encourage States to adopt models of proven
excellence.

Education Technology: Education technology can expand learning opportunities for
all students, helping to raise student achievement, but many districts lack the resources
to integrate technology fully into their school
curricula. In February 1996, the President
challenged the public and private sectors to
work together to ensure that all children are
technologically literate by the dawn of the 21st
Century, with the communication, math,
science, and critical thinking skills essential
to succeed in the Information Age. The budget
proposes substantial increases in two technology programs, for a total 1998 investment
of $500 million.

Special Education: States have made real
progress in giving children with disabilities a
‘‘free appropriate public education,’’ as the Individuals with Disabilities Education Act
(IDEA) calls for. The Administration will propose amendments that will help improve educational results for children with disabilities
by promoting accountability for performance
and focusing resources on teaching and learning. The budget provides $4.2 billion for special education, four percent more than in 1997.

First, the President has committed $2 billion
over five years for the Technology Literacy
Challenge Fund. For 1998, the budget proposes
$425 million, more than doubling the $200
million that Congress provided in 1997. Second, the budget proposes $75 million, 32
percent more than in 1997, for the Technology
Innovation Challenge Grant program, which
gives matching Federal funds to school-centered, public-private partnerships to develop
and implement innovative applications of technology in the curriculum.
Teacher Training: The Eisenhower Professional Development program helps States invest in training teachers and other educators
so that they can help all children reach the
State’s challenging academic standards. The
President proposed, and Congress enacted,
major improvements in 1994 to ensure that
the training is of high enough quality and sufficient duration to pay off in the classroom.
The budget increases funding to $360 million,
16 percent more than in 1997.
Safe and Drug-Free Schools and Communities: Students can reach their full potential only in safe, disciplined learning environments. The Safe and Drug-Free Schools and
Communities program helps 97 percent of
school districts implement anti-drug and anti-

Bilingual and Immigrant Education:
The Bilingual Education program helps schools
improve the quality of instructional services
for limited English proficient (LEP) students,
teaching them English and preparing them to
meet the same challenging academic standards
as all other students. The Immigrant Education program helps States with large concentrations of immigrant students who have
recently arrived, helping to offset their financial impact on school systems. The budget proposes $199 million for Bilingual Education and
$150 million for Immigrant Education, 27 percent and 50 percent more than in 1997, respectively.
Postsecondary Education and Training
Education beyond high school is increasingly
a prerequisite for success in the rapidly
changing job market. The rising rate of
college attendance over the last half-century
was fueled by State efforts to expand the
public college system, and Federal efforts
to help families pay for college. The postWorld War II GI Bill was a watershed
event in Federal investment in higher education, greatly increasing benefits for returning servicemen. Since then, through the Higher Education Act of 1965 and subsequent
amendments, the Federal Government has
vastly expanded grant and work-study aid
to all low- and middle-income students, and
made it possible for every American to borrow

2.

63

INVESTING IN EDUCATION AND TRAINING

enough money to attend college. The President
wants to ensure that financial barriers to
higher education continue to fall for all
Americans. The budget provides substantial
new support to low- and middle-income families through a new tax credit and tax deduction for education costs (see Chart 2–3).

would put over $36 billion back in the hands
of Americans for education and training between 1997 and 2002.
Pell Grants: The President proposes to
raise the maximum Pell Grant award by $300,
to $3,000, marking the largest increase in two
decades. The Administration’s changes also
would bring at least 348,000 more students
into the program, reaching a total of over four
million low- and middle-income undergraduates. Such help is particularly important to
raise participation and graduation rates of lowincome students. With Pell Grants, they are
as likely to stay in school and earn a degree
as middle-income students without grants.

HOPE Scholarships: More than ever, today’s employers look for job applicants with
more than a high school diploma. HOPE scholarships would make the 13th and 14th years
of education the norm for students by offering,
to most working families, up to a $1,500 per
student tuition tax credit for postsecondary
education or training. Students would have to
maintain at least a B average to receive the
credit in the second year.

Student Loans: An estimated 5.5 million
individuals will borrow $37 billion through the
Federal student loan programs in 1998. Families at any income level can receive loans, but
students who show greater financial need receive greater interest subsidies. The loans finance study toward undergraduate or graduate degrees, or short-term vocational training
programs. The annual maximum loan amount

Tuition Deduction: To encourage Americans to pursue higher education and to promote lifelong learning, the budget proposes to
give families a tax deduction for postsecondary
tuition and fees of up to $5,000 in 1997 and
1998, and $10,000 starting in 1999. Together,
the tuition deduction and HOPE scholarship

Chart 2-3. THE FEDERAL GOVERNMENT WILL PROVIDE NEARLY
$60 BILLION IN STUDENT AID IN 2002, MORE THAN DOUBLE
THE 1993 LEVEL
DOLLARS IN BILLIONS
60

50

HOPE

40

AR

ETION

30

DISCR

ITY

THOR

T AU

DGE
Y BU

H

LARS

SCHO

RES

DITU

XPEN

XE
IP TA

20
STUDENT LOAN VOLUME
10

0
1993

1994

1995

1996

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

64

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

varies from $2,625 for a first-year student financially dependent on his or her parents, to
$18,500 for a graduate or professional program
student. Under this Administration, the rate
of student loan defaults within the first two
years after borrowers leave college has reached
an all-time low.
Before 1993, students and parents paid
fees of up to eight percent of their loan
proceeds. The Student Loan Reform Act of
1993, which the President initiated, cut the
fees to four percent and has already saved
families nearly $2 billion. The 1993 reforms
also created the simpler, less costly, and
more accountable Federal Direct Loan Program (FDLP), and gave borrowers a way
to afford payments on their student loans
based on their actual post-college income—
which the existing guaranteed loan program
could not do.
The budget proposes to cut the loan fees
again—by half for needy students, and by
a quarter for other students and parents.
The budget also would continue to allow
schools to choose to participate in either
the FDLP or the guaranteed loan program—
the Federal Family Education Loan Program
(FFELP). In addition, it would reform FFELP
to improve Federal management and give
lenders and intermediaries financial incentives
to prevent defaults. It also would ensure
that all borrowers receive a variety of repayment options.
Presidential Honors Scholarships: The
President proposes an achievement-based
scholarship program, rewarding the best and
the brightest of high school students. It would
grant $1,000 honors awards to the top five

percent of graduating students in every secondary school in the Nation, making clear the
Government’s commitment to excellence. The
budget requests $132 million for this program.
College Work-Study: Work-study gives students additional aid through subsidized jobs,
including an increasing number of community
service positions. The budget proposes $857
million for Work-study, three percent more
than in 1997, and continues the President’s
commitment to raise the number of Workstudy recipients to a million by the year 2000,
including 100,000 reading tutors to support
America Reads.
G.I. Bill for America’s Workers
For the past two years, the President
has sought to dramatically overhaul the complex, inefficient structure of Federal job training programs through his proposed G.I. Bill
for America’s Workers. It would consolidate
multiple programs into a single, integrated
work force development system and provide
Skill Grants (i.e., vouchers) to adults who
need training so that they, not bureaucracies,
choose where to get it. It also would streamline
program administration, while improving accountability by freeing States and localities
to focus on results, not process.
Although Congress did not enact these
essential reforms, the Administration has
pressed ahead to reform the job training
system under current law. The Administration
is making grants to establish One-Stop Career
Center systems and School-to-Work systems;
developing America’s Labor Market Information System; expanding America’s Job Bank
to help match workers to jobs across the

The President’s Principles for Work Force Policy Reform:
1. Give resources for training directly to adults so they can make informed choices, without
bureaucratic interference.
2. Consolidate and streamline Federal programs for adults, organize them within the OneStop Career Center delivery system, and ensure that the private sector is a full partner.
3. Ensure strong accountability to taxpayers by establishing high standards for program
quality and giving States and localities responsibility for results.
4. Organize Federal programs for youth within the School-to-Work Opportunities Act systems being established in States and local communities.
5. Increase funding for work force development each year, commensurate with the needs of
workers and the economy.

2.

INVESTING IN EDUCATION AND TRAINING

country; and implementing new authority to
waive certain Federal legal and regulatory
requirements in order to help States and
local communities make changes to the job
training system.
Comprehensive reform still requires legislation. The President will again seek legislation
that reflects the principles of his G.I. Bill.
Because enactment would not occur before
the fiscal 1998 appropriations process begins
in Congress, the budget presents funding
proposals under the current program structure.
Youth Programs
The President is deeply committed to helping States and communities help young people
make a successful transition to the world
of work and family responsibility. As discussed
earlier in this chapter, the budget includes
major new proposals to eliminate financial
barriers to postsecondary education and training for all youth. In addition, the budget
continues to support the goal by helping
States develop and implement their schoolto-work systems. And it proposes additional
resources to aid disadvantaged youth who
have left school, or are on the verge of
doing so, and have entered the labor force.
School-to-Work: This initiative, which the
Education and Labor Departments fund and
administer jointly, gives States and communities competitive grants to build comprehensive systems to help young people move from
high school to careers or postsecondary training and education. School-to-Work supports reforms to the education system and its links
to employers, so that young people can better
prepare for high-skill, high-wage careers; receive top-quality academic and occupational
training; and pursue more postsecondary education or training. Businesses get the trained
workers they need to stay globally competitive.
By 1996, 37 States and 133 local partnerships
had already received grants to implement
School-to-Work systems. The budget proposes
$400 million, maintaining the 1997 level, in
accord with the strategy of phasing in Schoolto-Work in all States by early in the next
decade.
After-School Program: Young people need
access to after-school activities that keep them

65
off the streets and out of trouble. The Presidential initiative will provide $50 million to
keep public schools open during non-school
hours, giving students access to after-school
tutoring and other educational and recreational activities in a crime-free environment
within their own communities.
Youth Opportunity Areas Program: Recognizing the special problems of out-of-school
youth, especially those in inner-city neighborhoods where jobless rates can exceed 50 percent, the budget proposes $250 million for new
competitive grants to selected high-poverty
urban and rural areas with major youth unemployment problems. The Labor Department
would award funds to high-poverty areas, including designated Empowerment Zones or Enterprise Communities, based on the quality of
the local applications—that is, those that show
the best chance of substantially increasing employment among youth. These ‘‘seed’’ funds
would leverage State, local, and private resources to sustain public-private efforts to
train and employ youth in private sector jobs.
(For more information on Empowerment Zones
and Enterprise Communities, see Chapter 6.)
Summer Youth Employment and Training Program: The summer jobs program
gives many urban and rural disadvantaged
students their first work experiences, and localities may include an academic component
that re-enforces the skills they have learned
during the school year. The budget provides
$871 million to finance 530,000 job opportunities for the summer of 1998, assuming that
localities spend this flexible funding entirely
on summer jobs.
Disadvantaged Youth Year-Round Program: The year-round program helps low-income youth who have dropped out of school,
are at risk of dropping out, or are in families
on public assistance. The Administration will
expand upon ongoing efforts to refocus this
program to stress local programs of proven effectiveness. Local service delivery areas that
receive these funds under the Job Training
Partnership Act can shift resources between
the summer and year-round programs, as local
needs dictate. The budget proposes $130 million for the year-round program.

66
Job Corps: The Job Corps provides intensive, work-related vocational skills training,
academic and social education, and support
services to severely disadvantaged young people in a structured residential setting. The
budget proposes $1.2 billion to fund opportunities for 70,000 young people.
Adult Programs
Most adults change jobs and get new
skills by themselves or through their employers. But, many others—particularly welfare
recipients and those permanently laid off
from jobs—need help to get the services
and information they need to successfully
manage their careers. The budget proposes
sizable new support for grants to States
and localities to finance a training and employment system that adequately serves these
adults, and helps build the job skills of
American workers and job seekers into the
21st Century. These activities are the core
of the adult portion of the G.I. Bill for
America’s Workers.
Dislocated Workers and Low-Income
Adult Training: The budget proposes $2.4
billion for Job Training Partnership Act programs that provide training, job search assistance, and related services to laid-off workers
and economically disadvantaged adults, a $233
million increase over 1997. The dislocated
worker program provides readjustment services, job search assistance, training, and other
services to help dislocated workers find new
jobs as quickly as possible. The program for
disadvantaged adults helps welfare recipients
and other low-income adults, giving them the
skills and support to become employed. States
and localities likely will continue to use a sizable portion of these resources to supplement
training for welfare recipients under the new

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Transitional Assistance to Needy Families
block grant. (For more information on this new
block grant, and on the related Welfare-toWork Challenge Fund and tax credit, see
Chapter 7.)
Adult Education: The Adult Education program helps educationally disadvantaged adults
develop basic skills (including literacy), achieve
certification of high school equivalency, and
learn English. In 1993–94, the program served
over 3.75 million adult learners—over 1.4 million enrollments in adult basic education programs, about 1.1 million in adult secondary
education programs, and over 1.2 million in
English-as-a-second-language programs. The
budget proposes $394 million, nine percent
more than in 1997 (and over 50 percent more
than in 1996), to meet the demand for literacy
training that the new welfare and immigration
laws have stimulated.
One-Stop Employment Service: The budget proposes $843 million for grants to the Employment Service—the Nation’s public labor
exchange—and $150 million to continue building One-Stop Career Center systems to
streamline re-employment and career development service delivery. To date, 24 States have
received grants to implement One-Stop systems and nine more States will receive grants
in July 1997. The budget would permit OneStops to expand to all States in 1998. While
the One-Stop grants provide seed money for
systems-building and increased automation,
Employment Service grants provide the core
operating funds for the new system. They help
States to match employers and job seekers,
and to provide counseling and re-employment
assistance to unemployment insurance claimants and others who need more help finding
jobs.

3.

PROTECTING THE ENVIRONMENT

None of our children should have to live near a toxic waste dump or eat food poisoned by pesticides. Our grandchildren should not have to live in a world stripped of its natural beauty. We
can and we must protect the environment while advancing the prosperity of the American people
and people throughout the world.
President Clinton
April 22, 1996

The President believes that the Nation
does not have to choose between a strong
economy and a clean environment. In fact,
while the President’s policies have contributed
greatly to four years of strong economic
growth with low inflation, they also have
produced a cleaner, healthier environment.
The Administration has helped ensure that
the air is cleaner for tens of millions of
people. It has protected Yellowstone, one
of our national treasures and our first national
park, from the ravages of nearby mining.
It also has cleaned up more toxic waste
sites in its first three years than the previous
two administrations did in 12 years. Meanwhile, American industry has continued reducing toxic emissions, which have fallen 43
percent in the last decade.
While Americans want a Government that
helps protect the environment and our natural
resources, they do not want to burden business
unduly, choke innovation, or waste taxpayer
dollars. The Administration has reinvented
the regulatory process, cutting excessive regulation and targeting investments in programs
that will have the biggest impact on improving
the environment, protecting public health,
providing more opportunities for outdoor recreation, and enhancing natural resources. The
President’s strategy for environmental protection is reflected in not just the creative
approaches the Administration is pursuing,
but in the priorities that the budget proposes
to fund.

New Approaches for Environmental
Success
Working with Congress on a bipartisan
basis whenever possible, the Administration
has pioneered ways to protect the environment
that are cleaner, cheaper, and smarter, while
preserving natural resources for current and
future generations.
Reinventing Drinking Water Legislation:
In August 1996, the President signed the Safe
Drinking Water Act Amendments, fulfilling
the goals he outlined in 1993—to reinvent the
Nation’s safe drinking water legislation to better protect public health, and to authorize the
creation of new Drinking Water State Revolving Funds (SRFs) to help hundreds of communities protect their citizens from harmful contaminants.
In several respects, the new law is a
model for regulatory reform. It gives the
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) more
flexibility to act on contaminants of greatest
risk, and to analyze costs and benefits while
maintaining public health as the paramount
concern. It institutes a cost-effective, community-based approach for ensuring safe drinking
water. Further, it affirms the right of all
Americans to know the quality of their drinking water and the potential threats to its
safety, and it authorizes resources to address
Federal mandates under the law.
Reforming Food Quality Protection: Also
in August, based on his proposal of 1993, the
President signed legislation to revolutionize

67

68
the way our food supply is protected from
harmful pesticides. The law overhauls the system that kept harmful pesticides on the market too long and safer alternatives off the market, and it will ensure that families have the
safest possible food on the dinner table. Specifically, the law replaces conflicting and outdated pesticide residue standards with a single, health-based standard for all food. It provides incentives for swift approval of safe, new
pesticide alternatives for farmers. And, it includes provisions to better protect children
from pesticide risks.
‘‘Greening’’ America’s Farm Programs:
The 1996 Farm Bill, which the President
signed in April 1996, was the most conservation-oriented farm legislation ever enacted. It
created five new mandatory conservation programs, including the Environmental Quality
Incentives Program (EQIP) that consolidates
four cost-sharing conservation programs into
one and focuses cost-sharing and technical assistance on locally-identified conservation priority areas, and to areas where agricultural
and natural resource management improvements will help meet water quality goals. The
law provides $200 million in 1998 ($1.3 billion
from 1996 to 2002) for EQIP, dedicating half
of the funds to conservation associated with
smaller livestock operations. It also authorizes
the Wildlife Habitat Incentives Program to
help landowners improve wildlife habitat on
private lands.
Enhancing the National Park System:
Although the budget provides higher funding
for parks, available resources can barely keep
up with the system’s new responsibilities and
with ongoing needs to maintain an aging infrastructure. Consequently, the National Park
Service is using creative new approaches to
manage the parks, enabling it to protect our
natural and cultural treasures with limited resources.
The 1996 Omnibus Parks and Public Lands
Management Act includes several examples
of these creative approaches. It will, for
instance, establish the Tallgrass Prairie National Preserve in Kansas as a partnership
with a private group that owns most of
the land—at far less cost than establishing
a traditional park. Also, at the Presidio
in San Francisco, a government corporation

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

will be able to lease and manage hundreds
of unused buildings in a manner consistent
with park purposes, but which reduces the
burden on taxpayers. In addition, the budget
supports other partnership arrangements by
including funds, matched by non-Federal
sources, to implement newly authorized nonFederal heritage areas and to restore historic
structures at historically black colleges and
universities.
Creating a New National Monument:
The budget provides funds for start-up activities at the Grand Staircase-Escalante National
Monument, which the President created by
proclamation in September 1996, in the pristine canyonlands of south-central Utah. The
National Monument encompasses 1.7 million
acres of public lands and will preserve for future generations hundreds of millions of years
of geologic and cultural history. Over the next
three years, the Bureau of Land Management
will consult with State, local, and Tribal governments; the private sector; the public; and
other Federal agencies in preparing a land use
management plan for the Monument.
Reinventing Regulation: In March 1995,
the President announced a comprehensive program to improve the regulatory system and
move toward a better environmental management system for the 21st Century. One prominent element is Project XL (for Excellence and
Leadership), which fulfills the President’s challenge to EPA and industry to make it easier
for businesses to better protect the environment. This national pilot program enables a
limited number of regulated entities to adopt
alternative strategies to current regulations, as
long as they produce superior environmental
results.
For example, Intel’s new computer chip
manufacturing plant in Chandler, Arizona—
which recently signed a Project XL agreement
with EPA—will adopt a five-year Environmental Management Plan that outlines specific
steps to meet tough standards of superior
environmental performance. The agreement
will eliminate the red tape of the normal
permit modification process, enabling Intel
to quickly change its manufacturing operations
and, in turn, better compete in its fastpaced industry.

3.

PROTECTING THE ENVIRONMENT

Establishing Performance Partnerships:
In April 1996, Congress enacted the President’s proposal for EPA Performance Partnership Grants, allowing States or Tribes to combine several categorical grants—each of which
addresses only air, water, hazardous waste, or
similar programs—into a multimedia environmental grant. Twenty States used this approach in 1996, and 24 States have expressed
interest for 1997. As more States recognize the
benefits, we expect most, if not all, to participate. The grants build on the National Environmental Performance Partnership System,
which EPA established with the States in 1995
to give them more leeway to achieve environmental results and emphasize less-intensive
EPA oversight for States that show strong performance. Six States participated in 1996 and
28 more have expressed interest for 1997.
Restoring the Everglades: The budget supports the continued Federal, State, local, and
Tribal efforts to implement the restoration
project for the South Florida ecosystem, which
the Administration began in 1993 and which
Congress authorized in the 1996 Water Resources Development Act. During 1999, the
Army Corps of Engineers will complete the
Central and Southern Florida Comprehensive
Review Study, providing long-term direction
for restoration efforts.
Along with improved water management,
the budget recognizes the need for more
science and for land acquisition to restore
the Everglades’ hydrologic functions. The Administration is re-proposing a four-year, $100
million-a-year Everglades Restoration Fund
to provide a steady source of funding, mainly
for land acquisition. It is also re-proposing
a one-cent per pound assessment on Floridaproduced sugar to help finance the Fund.
The budget proposes $331 million, 163 percent
more than Congress approved in 1997.
Making the Endangered Species Act
Work: The Endangered Species Act (ESA)
gives Federal, State, and local governments,
and the private sector the flexibility to protect
endangered species and conserve habitat,
while allowing for development, by establishing Habitat Conservation Plans (HCPs). From
1983 to 1992, such parties created only 14
HCPs. But the Administration recognized that,
to reduce conflict between the needs of con-

69
servation and development, it should more
fully utilize HCPs. As a result, from 1993 to
1997, the number of HCPs issued or under
development soared to 300—covering 8.4 million acres in the Pacific Northwest alone.
Creating Sustainable Fisheries: Last October, the President signed the Sustainable
Fisheries Act, reinventing the way the Nation
addresses the problems facing its commercial
and recreational fisheries. The Act brings the
Nation closer to achieving the vast long-term
benefits of sustainable fisheries with new
measures to prevent overfishing and to ensure
that already depressed stocks are rebuilt to
levels that produce maximum sustainable
yields. The Act also establishes a new national
standard to minimize the unintentional catch
of non-target fish, and highlights the long-term
importance of habitat to fish stocks by requiring fishery management plans to identify essential fish habitat.
Protecting the Northwest Forests: The
President’s Forest Plan—a balanced, sciencebased blueprint—is protecting natural resources and providing new economic opportunities in the Pacific Northwest. It represents the
first region-wide application of ecosystem management on the part of Federal, State, and
local agencies; Tribes; non-governmental organizations; and individuals. The Administration
is offering sustainable volumes of timber sales,
restoring thousands of acres of key habitat and
watersheds, providing training and short-term
jobs to displaced timber workers, spurring
small business through grants and job training, and strengthening local economies. The
Federal Government plans to spend $369 million in the region in 1997 through the coordinated efforts of 12 Federal agencies, and the
budget proposes to increase this level of support to $408 million in 1998.
The recent expiration of the July 1995
timber ‘‘rider’’ to a 1995 spending bill restores
public participation in the salvage timber
program. As the timber program again faces
the full range of environmental laws, the
Administration will address the concerns that
its 1996 Interagency Salvage Review Report
identified. The budget modifies the use of
the Forest Service Salvage Sale Fund, establishes a new Forest Ecosystem Management
Fund, and provides more funding for wildlife

70
and fish management (especially sensitive
species), watershed improvements, and monitoring.
Saving Yellowstone Park: To protect Yellowstone, the Federal Government last August
agreed to exchange Federal land or other assets for Crown Butte, Inc.’s interest in the
New World Mine. The development of the gold
mine posed a severe environmental threat to
Yellowstone’s unique landscape and wildlife resources. The agreement protected Crown
Butte’s property rights while preserving one
of the crown jewels of the National Park System. Following the exchange with the Federal
Government, Crown Butte will dedicate $22
million to clean up contamination at the site
from earlier mining activities. The Administration is working to identify appropriate assets
to execute the agreement, and to appraise
their value in order to ensure a fair exchange.
Protecting Headwaters Forest: The Federal Government and California agreed in September 1996 to negotiate an exchange of land
and other assets with a private company, enabling them to jointly acquire 7,500 acres, including the Headwaters Grove in northern
California—the largest privately-owned grove
of old-growth redwoods—to protect it from timber harvesting. The negotiations involve complex issues, including asset appraisals and the
development of Habitat Conservation Plans for
endangered species. The Administration believes that all parties are working in good faith
to negotiate a fair and equitable exchange, and
is fully committed to taking all necessary steps
to reach a successful conclusion.
Providing a Fair Return for Taxpayers:
The Administration proposes a five-percent
royalty fee on the ‘‘net smelter return’’ from
producing hardrock minerals on Federal lands.
The royalties would go into a new reclamation
fund to finance the restoration of abandoned
mine sites on Federal lands. The budget also
proposes to eliminate the percentage depletion
tax allowance for non-fuel mineral rights acquired from the Federal Government for only
nominal cost under the 1872 Mining Act. In
addition, the budget would continue the moratorium on patenting hardrock mineral rights
on Federal lands.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Environmental and Natural Resource
Investments
The budget proposes to boost funding
high-priority environmental and natural
sources programs to levels that would
17 percent over those in place when
President took office (see Table 3–1).

for
rebe
the

Kalamazoo Initiative: The President announced a new national commitment last August to protect communities from toxic pollution by the year 2000, and the budget provides
almost $800 million in 1998 to help carry it
out. The key components are:
• Accelerating Superfund Cleanups: The
budget proposes $2.1 billion for Superfund,
including a $650 million increase over
1997 to begin meeting the President’s
pledge to nearly double the pace of
Superfund cleanups (see Chart 3–1). The
Administration proposes to clean up another 500 sites in the next four years,
meaning that about two-thirds of the Nation’s worst toxic waste dumps would be
cleaned up by the year 2000. To ensure
available funding, the budget proposes to
extend the Superfund taxes that have expired. The budget also funds the ‘‘orphan
share’’ cleanup costs, which are attributable to insolvent parties.
• Expanding Brownfields Redevelopment
Initiative: The budget proposes a major expansion of the President’s brownfields initiative, which promotes local cleanup and
redevelopment, by providing a $75 million
increase. First, the budget proposes that
EPA receive a $50 million increase, to
nearly $88 million, to expand grants to
communities for site assessment and redevelopment planning, and to support revolving loan funds to finance brownfield
cleanup efforts of contaminated and abandoned urban properties at the local level.
Second, the budget proposes $25 million
in Department of Housing and Urban Development funding to leverage State, local,
and private funds to redevelop the
cleaned-up sites and create jobs. Also, the
President again proposes a targeted tax
incentive to spur the cleanup of brownfield
sites.

3.

71

PROTECTING THE ENVIRONMENT

Table 3–1.

ENVIRONMENTAL/NATURAL RESOURCE INVESTMENTS AND OTHER HIGHPRIORITY PROGRAMS
(Discretionary budget authority unless otherwise noted; dollar amounts in millions)

1993
Actual

Environmental Protection Agency (EPA):
Operating Program ................................................................................................
State Revolving Funds (SRFs):
Clean Water1 .....................................................................................................
Drinking Water 1 ................................................................................................
Superfund ...............................................................................................................
Other ......................................................................................................................

1997
Estimate

1998
Proposed

Percent
Change:
1993 to
1997

Percent
Change:
1997 to
1998

2,767

3,109

3,402

+12%

+9%

1,928
—
1,589
639

625
1,275
1,394
396

1,075
725
2,094
349

–68%
NA
–12%
–38%

+72%
–43%
+50%
–12%

Subtotal, EPA .................................................................................................
Department of the Interior (DOI):
National Park Service Operating Program .........................................................
Bureau of Land Management Operating Program .............................................
Fish and Wildlife Service Operating Program ....................................................

6,923

6,799

7,645

–2%

+12%

984
638
531

1,155
673
524

1,220
688
562

+17%
+5%
–1%

+6%
+2%
+7%

Subtotal, DOI (Select programs) ......................................................................
Department of Agriculture (USDA):
Forest Service Operating Program ......................................................................
Investment Non-Operating Program (NW Forest Plan, infrastructure, other)
Rural Water and Wastewater 2 ............................................................................
Wetlands ................................................................................................................
Environmental Quality Incentives Program (Mandatory) .................................
Wetlands Reserve Program (Mandatory) ............................................................
Conservation Reserve Program (Mandatory) ......................................................

2,153

2,352

2,470

+9%

+5%

1,319
276
508
115
—
—
1,579

1,275
241
565
212
200
128
1,862

1,342
211
555
213
200
176
1,943

–3%
–13%
+11%
+84%
NA
NA
+18%

+5%
–12%
–2%
+*%
+*%
+38%
+4%

Subtotal, USDA (Select programs) ...................................................................
Land Acquisition: LWCF (DOI/USDA) and Everglades Restoration
Fund (DOI) ...........................................................................................................
Other Everglades Restoration (DOI, Corps, USDA, DOC, EPA) ................
Department of Energy (DOE):
Energy Conservation and Efficiency ....................................................................
Solar and Renewable Energy R&D ......................................................................
Federal Facilities Cleanup (Environmental Management) ................................

3,797

4,483

4,640

+18%

+4%

286
70

149
114

301
196

–48%
+63%

+102%
+72%

592
257
6,396

550
270
6,027

688
330
7,246

–7%
+5%
–6%

+25%
+22%
+20%

Subtotal, DOE (Select programs) .....................................................................
Department of Defense (DOD):
Cleanup ..................................................................................................................
Environmental Compliance/Pollution Prevention/Conservation ........................
Environmental Technology ...................................................................................

7,245

6,847

8,264

–5%

+21%

1,604
2,227
393

2,043
2,411
182

2,114
2,486
171

+27%
+8%
–54%

+3%
+3%
–6%

Subtotal, DOD (Select programs) .....................................................................
Department of Commerce (DOC)/National Oceanic and Atmospheric
Administration (NOAA):
Fisheries and Protected Species ...........................................................................
Ocean and Coastal Management .........................................................................
Ocean and Atmospheric Research ........................................................................

4,224

4,636

4,771

+10%

+3%

232
121
138

297
128
222

313
154
223

+28%
+6%
+61%

+5%
+20%
+*%

Subtotal, DOC/NOAA (Select programs) .........................................................
California Bay-Delta Ecosystem Rest. (DOI, DOC, EPA, Corps, USDA)
Pacific Northwest Forest Plan (USDA, DOI, EPA, DOC, DOL) ..................
Army Corps of Engineers Regulatory Program (wetlands) ........................
Partnership for a New Generation of Vehicles (DOE, DOC, NSF, EPA,
DOT) ......................................................................................................................
U.S. Global Change Research (NASA, DOE, NSF, DOC, others) ................
Climate Change Action Plan (EPA, DOE, USDA) ..........................................
GLOBE—Global Environmental Education (DOC, NASA, EPA, NSF) .....
Montreal Protocol (State/EPA) ...........................................................................
Global Environment Facility (Treasury) .........................................................
Multilateral and Bilateral Assistance (Funds Appropriated to the
President/AID) ....................................................................................................
Border Environmental Activities (State/Treasury) ......................................

491
20
—
86

647
70
369
101

690
213
408
112

+32%
+250%
NA
+17%

+7%
+204%
+11%
+11%

—
1,464
—
—
25
—

263
1,810
183
13
40
35

281
1,878
277
15
49
100

NA
+24%
NA
NA
+60%
NA

+7%
+4%
+51%
+15%
+23%
+186%

272
30

264
83

314
88

–3%
+177%

+19%
+6%

25,295

26,334

29,485

+4%

+12%

Total 3 .................................................................................................................
1 Reflects

a one time transfer of clean water funds to drinking water in 1997.
funding for Rural Community Advancement Program grants to States; 1998 funding would be nine percent higher otherwise.
adjusted to eliminate double counts and mandatory spending.
NA = Not applicable.
*Less than 0.5 percent.

2 Excludes
3 Total

72

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 3-1. MAJOR PROGRESS IN SUPERFUND CLEANUPS
CUMULATIVE COMPLETIONS
900
900

250
800

705
700

115
555

600

475

500

540

410
400

346
278

300
200

650
590

217
149

100
0
THROUGH 1992 1993

1994

1995

CUMULATIVE COMPLETIONS
(WITHOUT KALAMAZOO INITIATIVE)

• Improving Americans’ Right to Know
About Toxics: The budget proposes $49
million to expand the information that
people can get about toxic threats to their
families—without imposing more reporting
requirements on anyone. It would make
the information available for the 75 largest metropolitan areas in the country
through a comprehensive monitoring system, with computer links to schools, libraries, and home computers.
EPA Operating Program: The budget proposes $3.4 billion, a nine-percent increase over
1997, for EPA’s operating program, which includes most of EPA’s research, regulatory,
partnership grants (with States and Tribes),
and enforcement programs. The program represents the backbone of the Nation’s efforts
to protect public health through standard setting, enforcement, and other means, ensuring
that our water is pure, our air clean, and our
food safe.

1996

1997

1998

1999

2000

CUMULATIVE COMPLETIONS
(WITH KALAMAZOO INITIATIVE)

Within the operating program, the budget
proposes important increases to carry out
recently-enacted legislation to protect drinking
water and food quality. It proposes significant
investments to assess the health risks to
children, identify new ways to apply advanced
technology to environmental needs, and provide urban areas with tools to develop community-based solutions to environmental issues.
It also maintains a strong environmental
enforcement program to ensure that polluters
find an environmental cop on the beat, and
fully funds EPA’s part of the Climate Change
Action Plan.
Water Quality Infrastructure: The budget
proposes $725 million in capitalization grants
for the new Drinking Water State Revolving
Funds (SRFs), which make low-interest loans
to municipalities to help them meet the requirements of the new Safe Drinking Water
Act Amendments. These funds will help ensure
that Americans have a safe, clean drinking

3.

PROTECTING THE ENVIRONMENT

73

water supply—our first line of defense in protecting public health.

the fully authorized amount under the 1996
law for 1999 and 2000.

EPA also proposes $1.1 billion in capitalization grants to Clean Water SRFs to help
municipalities comply with the Clean Water
Act, thus helping to reduce beach closures
and keeping our waterways safe and clean.
In addition, the budget proposes targeted
wastewater funds for areas facing unique
circumstances—$100 million for Boston Harbor, $150 million for Mexican border projects,
and $15 million for Alaskan Native villages.
The Administration will request a final $100
million of special Federal assistance for Boston
Harbor for 1999—provided EPA finds that
the project still requires the funds.

Wetlands Reserve Program (WRP): The
WRP is a voluntary USDA program in which
willing sellers receive the fair market value
to permanently retire wetland acres from farm
production. Under the 1996 Farm Bill, WRP
will use permanent easements on one-third of
the acres enrolled, 30-year easements on another third, and cost-sharing agreements on
the remaining third. In this last category,
landowners will agree to restore wetlands on
cropland without an easement, receiving only
cost-sharing assistance. For 1998, the budget
proposes to enroll 212,000 acres, an increase
of 82,000 acres over 1997, bringing cumulative
WRP enrollment to over 655,000 acres by the
end of 1998. Retiring cropland through the
WRP will directly benefit the recovery of
threatened or endangered species, almost 35
percent of which depend on wetlands (see
Chart 3–2).

Department of Agriculture (USDA)
Water 2000: The budget proposes to continue
funding the USDA’s Water 2000 initiative—
to bring safe drinking water to 2.5 million
rural Americans with some of the Nation’s
most serious problems of water availability, dependability, and quality—within its $1.3 billion for rural water and wastewater loans and
grants. In addition, the budget proposes to
fund, through the Rural Community Advancement Program (RCAP), rural development
grants that States can use to meet their particular rural development needs. With proposed RCAP funding eight percent above the
1997 levels, the Administration expects to fund
227 new water treatment systems in 1998.
California Bay-Delta Ecosystem Restoration: In December 1994, Federal and California officials signed the historic Bay-Delta Accord, calling for a comprehensive series of
steps to restore and protect the San Francisco
Bay and the Sacramento-San Joaquin Delta
ecosystem while strengthening the State’s
long-term economic health. With Administration support, Congress then adopted the California Bay-Delta Environmental Enhancement
and Water Security Act in 1996 to authorize
more Federal spending for restoration activities in the ecosystem. Later that year, California voters approved a $995 million bond issue
to cover State cost-sharing for past and future
Bay-Delta restoration and other water-related
activities. The budget proposes $213 million
for Bay-Delta ecosystem restoration activities,
a 204-percent increase over 1997. As it did
for 1998, the Administration plans to request

Conservation Reserve Program (CRP):
The CRP pays producers to temporarily retire
from production environmentally sensitive
lands. Producers sign 10-year CRP contracts
and agree to convert their enrolled acres to
approved conservation uses, receiving rental
payments in return. After the contracts expire,
producers can return lands back to production.
The 1996 Farm Bill enables USDA to maintain
a 36-million-acre CRP, or roughly the current
CRP level. Contracts on about 21 million acres
will expire in 1997 and USDA will hold a signup to begin to replace them in early spring
1997. Through new program rules, the Administration will seek to enroll land with the highest environmental benefits and release from
the CRP less erodible land that is better suited
for production. CRP’s benefits have been significant—after falling by 35 to 50 percent in
the 1970s and 1980s, wild-duck populations
bounced back with a 12-percent increase in
the mid-1990s.
National Parks: The budget proposes over
$1.2 billion for park operations and maintenance, six percent more than in 1997. This
level would maintain current services at existing parks and support commitments for new
parks and responsibilities under the 1996 Omnibus Parks and Public Lands Management
Act. Budgeted funds alone, however, cannot

74

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 3-2. USDA WETLANDS CONSERVATION
ACRES IN THOUSANDS
1100
975

1000
900
800
655

700

CUMULATIVE
WETLANDS

600
500
400

313

300
212

200
129
100

154
94

130
80

42

80

80

80
0

0

0
1992

1993

1994

1995

1996

1997

ANNUAL WRP ACRES

meet the growing demand for recreational and
visitor services, as illustrated in Chart 3–3.
Consequently, the Administration is using
its temporary demonstration fee authority
to finance facility and resource management
improvements. Not only do user fees raise
funds for repairs and improvements that
enhance the visitor experience, they give
parks an incentive to please their customers
by improving their facilities and operations.
The Administration will seek permanent fee
authority and legislation to reform park concessions—to increase competition between
companies that want to conduct business
in the parks, and to give parks an added
incentive to negotiate higher returns from
concessioners by allowing the National Park
Service to keep all new receipts.
Salmon Recovery: Salmon runs throughout
the Pacific Northwest are a major part of the
region’s ecosystem and economy. Salmon runs
that originate in the Columbia/Snake River

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

2003

ANNUAL EMERGENCY WRP ACRES

have declined so much that the Commerce Department’s National Marine Fisheries Service
lists three runs as endangered. The Administration has supported a regional bipartisan effort to help restore the runs, including a stable, multi-year contribution from the Bonneville Power Administration’s (BPA) customers
because BPA’s hydro-power operation has
helped to foster the decline. The Administration is carrying out an agreement with congressional and regional interests under which
BPA customers would pay, on average, up to
$435 million a year for salmon recovery.
The budget also provides funds to fully
implement the 1992 Elwha River Ecosystem
and Fisheries Restoration Act. The Elwha
River, a major waterway within Olympic
National Park in Washington State, holds
tremendous potential for restoring abundant
salmon runs. The budget provides $25 million
in funding for 1998—enough to complete
acquisition of the river’s two dams and perform
planning and design activities associated with

3.

75

PROTECTING THE ENVIRONMENT

Chart 3-3. RECREATIONAL VISITS TO SELECT FEDERAL LANDS
MILLIONS
800
709
700
606
600

500

512

522

1980

1985

436
401

400

300

200

100

0
1970

1975

1990

1995

Note: Includes National Park Service, Fish & Wildlife Service, Bureau of Land Management, and Forest Service.

their removal—and seeks future-year funding
at levels that would complete dam removal
and river restoration.
Multilateral and Bilateral Environmental Assistance: The budget proposes $314
million, 19 percent more than in 1997, for bilateral and multilateral environment assistance. Bilateral assistance includes Agency for
International Development activities to address climate change, biodiversity, and sustainable agriculture in developing countries.
Multilateral assistance funds U.S. voluntary
contributions to the U.N. environment system
and other international organizations to address various international environmental activities.
Global Environment Facility (GEF): U.S.
participation in the GEF is a cornerstone of
U.S. foreign policy on the environment. The
GEF has become the world’s leading institution for protecting the global environment and
avoiding economic disruption from climate

change, massive extinction of valuable species,
and dramatic collapse of the oceans’ fish population. The $100 million budget proposal would
meet the 1998 portion of the U.S. pledge to
the GEF’s four-year (1995–1998) funding program, and doing so is vital to maintaining U.S.
leadership of the program.
Energy Efficiency and Renewable Energy: The budget proposes $688 million for energy conservation and efficiency programs, and
$330 million for solar and renewable energy
programs, increases of 25 percent and 22 percent, respectively. These Energy Department
(DOE) programs reduce greenhouse gases and
other pollutants by increasing energy efficiency
and expanding the use of non-fossil-based energy sources. The energy conservation programs include both near-term efforts to demonstrate and promote the best available technologies, and longer-term efforts to develop
breakthrough technologies and products. A
prominent example of the latter is the Partnership for a New Generation of Vehicles, a joint

76
government-industry effort to develop cars
with triple the fuel economy of today’s models.
The solar and renewable energy research and
development activities include substantial support for reducing the costs of photovoltaics,
wind energy, and biofuels.
Federal Facilities Cleanup and Compliance: The Federal Government continues to
face an enormous challenge in cleaning up
Federal facilities contaminated with radioactive or hazardous waste. DOE faces the most
complex and costly problems from over 40
years of research, production, and testing of
nuclear weapons. The Defense Department’s
(DOD) problems include hazardous wastes
similar to those found at industrial and commercial sites.
The budget proposes over $7.2 billion for
DOE’s Environmental Management program,
20 percent more than in 1997, including
over $1 billion to implement a privatization
strategy to cut costs and speed cleanup
and waste disposal. In 1998, DOE will acceler-

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

ate the Formerly Used Sites Remedial Actions
Program (FUSRAP), which is cleaning up
private properties contaminated during the
weapons production process in order to allow
their speedier return to productive use. By
the end of 1998, DOE will complete cleanup at 28 of 46 FUSRAP sites and 44
of 86 other DOE sites and facilities.
DOD, which operates one of the Nation’s
most diverse and successful environmental
programs, is focusing its cleanup efforts on
reducing relative risk at its active and closing
installations. It is conducting studies or cleanups at 15,240 sites on 770 military installations and 2,641 formerly-used properties.
Moreover, it has determined that 10,970
other sites require no further action. DOD
also is making real progress in its compliance/
pollution prevention, conservation, and environmental technology programs. The budget
proposes over $4.7 billion for all DOD environmental activities, three percent more than
in 1997.

4.

PROMOTING RESEARCH

. . . We must harness the remarkable forces of science and technology that are remaking our
world. . . . We can make this age of science and technology a true age of possibility for all the
American people, but we must invest in it and do it wisely if we expect to get a return.
President Clinton
December 11, 1996

Technological innovation has accounted for
at least half of the Nation’s productivity
growth in the last 50 years. We enjoy the
fruits of this innovation every day in the
many technologies that we have come to
depend on for our way of life—including
lasers, computers, x-rays, teflon, weather and
communication satellites, jet aircraft, microwave ovens, solar-electric cells, human insulin,
and a plethora of pharmaceutical products.
These advances have generated millions of
high-skilled, high-wage jobs and significantly
improved the quality of life for Americans.
Because our investments in science and
technology (S&T) have paid such rich dividends, U.S. leadership in S&T is a cornerstone
of the President’s vision for America. Thus,
the budget continues these vital S&T investments—investments that contribute significantly to many of the Administration’s broader
goals, including creating new knowledge, training our workers, creating new jobs and industries, solving our many health challenges,
enhancing our ability to address environmental issues, improving our ability to teach
our children, and maintaining a strong, capable national defense.
Specifically, the budget adds funds for
basic research in health sciences at the
National Institutes of Health (NIH), for basic
research and education at the National Science
Foundation (NSF), for research at other agencies that depend on S&T for their missions,
and for cooperative projects with industry
and universities.
As the President has said, we need to
balance the budget in a way that boosts
economic growth and encourages public and

private investment in innovative S&T. The
budget continues the record of S&T investment
that has helped to keep the economy strong
over the last four years.
The Federal Role in S&T
The post-Cold War era is one of intense
global economic competition. The United
States also faces new national security challenges, including the proliferation of nuclear
and biological weapons, regional conflicts,
threats from environmental degradation, and
emerging infectious diseases.
Thus, the Federal Government has an indispensable role to play in investing in S&T—
a role critical to the country’s economy,
national security, environment, health, and
other social needs. This is especially true
when the risk is too great for individual
companies to make the needed investment,
or when the public benefit is large but
private return is small. Our Nation also
must support a balanced mix of S&T investments (i.e., basic research, applied research,
and technology development), because the
steps involved in scientific discovery and
technological innovation are so profoundly
interwoven.
The Administration has initiated or expanded public-private partnerships to spur
innovations with broad economic impact. These
partnerships have traditionally served our
Nation well, not only in building transportation infrastructure (e.g., highways, airways,
harbors, and railroads), but in nurturing
new types of technological infrastructure (e.g.,
the Internet, global positioning satellites, and
environmental monitoring systems). They also
77

78

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

enable the private sector to translate new
knowledge into novel technologies that benefit
its bottom line as well as society at large.
Science and Technology Highlights
As noted above, S&T investments contribute
significantly to the Administration’s economic,

Table 4–1.

health, environment, national security, and
education goals. This chapter describes the
contributions in greater detail. Overall research and development investment totals
are displayed in Table 4–1, while selected
S&T highlights are displayed in Table 4–2.

RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT INVESTMENTS
(Budget authority, dollar amounts in millions)
1993
Actual

1997
Estimate

1998
Proposed

Dollar
Change:
1997 to
1998

Percent
Change:
1997 to
1998

By Agency:
Defense .....................................................................................................
Health and Human Services ..................................................................
National Aeronautics and Space Administration .................................
Energy 1 ....................................................................................................
National Science Foundation .................................................................
Agriculture ...............................................................................................
Commerce ................................................................................................
Interior .....................................................................................................
Transportation .........................................................................................
Environmental Protection Agency .........................................................
Other ........................................................................................................

38,898
10,472
8,873
6,896
2,012
1,467
793
649
613
511
1,308

37,461
12,933
9,314
6,186
2,458
1,545
1,050
581
639
504
1,150

36,780
13,478
9,603
7,312
2,553
1,485
1,115
605
754
555
1,229

–681
+545
+289
+1,126
+95
–60
+65
+24
+115
+51
+79

–2%
+4%
+3%
+18%
+4%
–4%
+6%
+4%
+18%
+10%
+7%

Total ........................................................................................................

72,492

73,821

75,469

+1,648

+2%

By R&D Theme:
Basic Research .........................................................................................
Applied Research .....................................................................................
Development ............................................................................................
Equipment 2 .............................................................................................
Facilities 1,2 ...............................................................................................

13,362
13,608
42,795
NA
2,727

14,885
14,529
42,153
937
1,317

15,303
15,159
41,636
960
2,411

+418
+630
–517
+23
+1,094

+3%
+4%
–1%
+2%
+83%

Total ........................................................................................................

72,492

73,821

75,469

+1,648

+2%

By Civilian Theme:
Basic Research .........................................................................................
Applied Research .....................................................................................
Development ............................................................................................
Equipment 2 .............................................................................................
Facilities 2 ................................................................................................

11,951
9,130
7,269
NA
1,979

13,747
10,469
7,860
492
984

14,112
11,125
8,117
506
1,128

+365
+656
+257
+14
+144

+3%
+6%
+3%
+3%
+15%

Subtotal ....................................................................................................
By Defense Theme:
Basic Research .........................................................................................
Applied Research .....................................................................................
Development ............................................................................................
Equipment 2 .............................................................................................
Facilities 1,2 ..............................................................................................

30,329

33,552

34,988

+1,436

+4%

1,411
4,478
35,526
NA
748

1,138
4,060
34,293
445
333

1,191
4,034
33,519
454
1,283

+53
–26
–774
+9
+950

+5%
–1%
–2%
+2%
+285%

Subtotal ....................................................................................................
By R&D Share:
Defense .....................................................................................................
Civilian .....................................................................................................

42,163

40,269

40,481

+212

+1%

42,163
30,329

40,269
33,552

40,481
34,988

+212
+1,436

+1%
+4%

Total ........................................................................................................
Civilian (percent) ........................................................................................
R&D Support to Universities ...............................................................
Merit (Peer) Reviewed R&D Programs .............................................

72,492
42
11,674
NA

73,821
45
12,979
22,220

75,469
46
13,268
22,717

+1,648
NA
+289
+497

+2%
NA
+2%
+2%

NA = Not applicable.
1 1998 estimates reflect an extra $1 billion for Department of Energy (DOE) facilities acquisition (primarily in defense) as part of DOE’s
move to fully funding acquisitions up front.
2 Equipment and Facilities were not collected separately in 1993.

4.

79

PROMOTING RESEARCH

Table 4–2.

SELECTED SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY HIGHLIGHTS
(Budget authority, dollar amounts in millions)
1993
Actual

1997
Estimate

1998
Proposed

Dollar
Change:
1997 to
1998

Percent
Change:
1997 to
1998

National Science Foundation ...............................................................
National Institutes of Health ...............................................................
Environmental Protection Agency:
Particulate matter in ambient air research ..........................................
Science to achieve results .......................................................................
National Aeronautics and Space Administration:.
International Space Station ...................................................................
Mission to Planet Earth ..........................................................................
Space science ...........................................................................................
X-33 reusable launch vehicle technology program ...............................
Aeronautics initiative ..............................................................................
Department of Energy:
Science-based stockpile stewardship .....................................................
Civilian basic science programs .............................................................
Large Hadron Collider project ...............................................................
Department of Commerce:
Advanced Technology Program ..............................................................
Manufacturing Extension Partnerships ................................................
National Information Infrastructure .....................................................
Department of Defense: Dual Use Application Program ....................
Department of Agriculture: National Research Initiative
Department of Transportation: Intelligent Transportation Infrastructure ...................................................................................................
National Science and Technology Council initiatives:
High performance computing and communications: 1
Defense .................................................................................................
Health and Human Services ...............................................................
National Aeronautics and Space Administration ..............................
Energy ..................................................................................................
National Science Foundation ..............................................................
Commerce .............................................................................................
Transportation .....................................................................................
Education .............................................................................................
Veterans ...............................................................................................
Environmental Protection Agency ......................................................

2,734
10,326

3,270
12,741

3,367
13,078

+97
+337

+3%
+3%

NA
NA

19
95

26
115

+7
+20

+37%
+21%

2,262
1,062
1,756
NA
129

2,149
1,362
1,971
245
417

2,121
1,417
2,044
330
456

–28
+55
+73
+85
+39

–1%
+4%
+4%
+35%
+9%

NA
2,583
NA

1,439
2,035
15

1,444
2,067
35

+5
+32
+20

+*%
+1%
+133%

68
18
NA
NA
98

225
95
22
181
94

275
129
36
225
130

+50
+34
+14
+44
+36

+22%
+36%
+64%
+24%
+38%

143

235

250

+15

+6%

298
47
82
100
233
12
NA
NA
NA
NA

334
90
114
117
278
32
20
12
22
6

357
97
128
152
294
35
25
12
22
6

+23
+7
+14
+35
+16
+3
+5
+*
+*
+*

+7%
+8%
+12%
+30%
+6%
+9%
+25%
+*%
+*%
+*%

Subtotal ....................................................................................................
U.S. global change research program: 2
Health and Human Services ...............................................................
National Aeronautics and Space Administration ..............................
Energy ..................................................................................................
National Science Foundation ..............................................................
Agriculture ...........................................................................................
Commerce .............................................................................................
Interior .................................................................................................
Environmental Protection Agency ......................................................
Smithsonian .........................................................................................
Tennessee Valley Authority ................................................................

772

1,025

1,128

+103

+10%

1
1,062
118
124
55
66
38
NA
NA
NA

4
1,362
112
164
57
60
29
14
7
1

4
1,417
110
166
61
62
29
21
7
1

+*
+55
–2
+2
+4
+2
+*
+7
+*
+*

+*%
+4%
–2%
+1%
+7%
+3%
+*%
+50%
+*%
+*%

Subtotal ....................................................................................................
Partnership for a new generation of vehicles ...........................................
Construction and building ..........................................................................
Educational technology ...............................................................................
Emerging infectious diseases research .....................................................

1,464
NA
NA
NA
NA

1,810
263
176
499
260

1,878
281
203
524
280

+68
+8
+27
+25
+20

+4%
+7%
+15%
+5%
+8%

NA = Not collected in this year.
* Less than $500 thousand or 0.5 percent.
1 Listing by agency required by law; estimates include $100 million in 1998 for the Next Generation Internet.
2 Listing by agency required by law.

80
Increasing Total Support for Science
and Technology: This budget marks the fifth
straight year that the President has proposed
increases in research and development
(R&D)—at $75.5 billion, $1.6 billion or two
percent more than in 1997.1 Continuing previous efforts, the budget also provides an increasing share for civilian R&D investments,
with those investments at 46 percent of the
total.
Boosting Funding for Basic Research
and Applied Research: The budget proposes
$15.3 billion for basic research and $15.2 billion for applied research—increases of $418
million and $630 million over 1997, respectively. These investments, which include increases of three percent each for NIH and
NSF, reflect the Administration’s commitment
to create new knowledge that will pay economic dividends down the road and address
many of the health challenges that face the
nation, such as breast cancer.
Strengthening
University-Based
Research: University-based research (a mixture
of basic, applied, development R&D, equipment, and facilities) is key to America’s future;
simultaneously, it provides new knowledge and
new technology, and it trains the next generation of scientists and engineers. The budget
proposes $13.3 billion for university-based research, an increase of $289 million over 1997.
It also proposes $22.7 billion for merit-reviewed research (two percent more than in
1997), comprising 18 percent of the R&D budget. Increases in merit-reviewed research ensure that the Nation receives the highest quality return on these investments.
Investing in Innovation to Create New
Jobs and Industries: Many of the new jobs
created under this Administration have been
high-tech, high-wage jobs in industries like
biotechnology and computing—jobs that didn’t
exist a decade or two ago. The budget maintains a strong investment in technology to foster these high-priority civilian S&T industries
and jobs. Funding continues or expands for
high-performance computing research; for the
Advanced Technology Program, which works
with industry to develop high-risk, high-payoff
technologies; for Manufacturing Extension
1 Research and Development (R&D) is a widely-accepted measure
of investment in S&T.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Partnerships to help small businesses battle
foreign competition by adopting modern technologies and production techniques; and for
other programs.
Investing in Environmental Research:
S&T investments are critical for enhancing environmental quality and assuring a sustainable future. While the Nation is making
progress on many pollution fronts, emerging
global environmental problems pose new risks.
The budget maintains vital research to provide
safe food, clean air, and pure water. It supports programs to increase energy efficiency
and the development of renewable energy
sources that cut demand for foreign oil and
reduce greenhouse emissions, and partnerships
with industry to develop cars that use less
fuel. The budget invests in programs that preserve biological diversity and help us understand and prepare for changing climate conditions and natural disasters. These investments
also provide a sound scientific basis for rational rule-making on, and cost-effective implementation of, environmental regulations. (For
information on energy efficiency and renewable
energy R&D programs, see Chapter 3.)
Investing in a 21st-Century Education:
Information technology has revolutionized
America’s businesses, but it has not been widely adopted in America’s classrooms. We must
use this new technology to help children prepare for the challenges of the 21st Century.
Building on the experience of earlier Federal
investment in educational technology, the
budget includes a second installment for the
President’s new five-year, $2 billion Technology Literacy Challenge Fund to encourage
States and communities, working with private
sector partners, to develop and implement
plans for fully integrating educational technology into their school curricula. (For more
information, see Chapter 2.)
Enhancing Programs to Keep Our Nation Secure: While the budget continues investments in defense research that ensure our
strong, future military capabilities, it also fosters key programs to keep nuclear weapons
out of the hands of terrorists, to comply with
the Comprehensive Test Ban Treaty by using
science-based techniques to ensure the safety
and reliability of our nuclear weapons stockpiles, and to bolster strong international S&T

4.

81

PROMOTING RESEARCH

cooperation to improve global stability. The
budget also supports the Dual Use Applications Program (DUAP), which puts the technical know-how and economies of scale from
commercial industry at the service of national
defense.
Agency Highlights
National Science Foundation: NSF, recognized world-wide for its high standards of
quality and efficiency, funds proposals based
on a rigorous, competitive process of merit review. Reflecting the high quality of NSFbacked science, NSF supported five of the six
1996 U.S. Nobel prize winners early in their
careers. Alone among Federal agencies, NSF
has the broad mission of promoting science
and engineering research and education across
all fields and disciplines. It supports nearly
half of the non-medical basic research conducted at academic institutions, and provides
30 percent of Federal support for mathematics
and science education. Because most NSF
awards go to colleges and universities, they
generate knowledge and train the next generation of scientists and engineers. The budget
proposes $3.4 billion for NSF, three percent
more than in 1997.
National Institutes of Health: The budget
continues the President’s commitment to biomedical research, which promotes the health
and well-being of all Americans. NIH support
for biomedical research grew by $2.4 billion,
or by 23 percent, between 1993 and 1997. For
1998, the budget proposes $13.1 billion for
NIH, a three-percent increase over 1997. NIH’s
highest priority continues to be funding investigator-initiated,
peer-reviewed
research
project grants. The budget proposal would enable NIH to increase HIV/AIDS-related research, research into breast cancer and other
health concerns of women, minority health initiatives, high performance computing, prevention research, spinal cord injury, and developmental and reproductive biology.
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA):
Particulate Matter (PM) in Ambient Air Research: The budget proposes $26.4 million for
PM research, a 37-percent increase over 1997.
To reduce the great uncertainty about PM’s
health effects, EPA will continue its efforts to
identify the mechanisms by which particles af-

fect human health. It will launch research into
three areas: (1) evaluating the relationship between health effects and PM exposures; (2) determining the amount and size of particles inhaled and retained in the lungs; and (3) investigating biological mechanisms by which PM
concentrations in outdoor air may induce
health effects and, in doing so, evaluating potential links between PM exposures and health
effects.
Science to Achieve Results (STAR) Program:
The budget proposes $115 million (21 percent
more than in 1997) for EPA’s STAR program,
which awards grants and fellowships on the
basis of rigorous peer review. The program
funds research proposals from scientists outside the Federal Government that focus on the
most pressing environmental concerns. EPA
funds the proposals independently or in cooperation with NSF and other Federal agencies.
National Aeronautics and Space
Administration (NASA):
NASA has been on the forefront of Administration efforts to reshape the Federal Government—to make it work better, cost less,
and better service its customers, the American
people. The budget proposes balanced and
sustainable funding for NASA over the next
five years, permitting NASA not only to
continue improving its operations but also
to support important strategic research efforts,
including the efforts highlighted below:
Space Science: The space science program
has achieved impressive successes this past
year—meteoric evidence of possible life on ancient Mars, the possible detection of water on
the Moon and a moon of Jupiter, and the identification of possible planets around other
stars. To build on these successes and implement the President’s directives in his recentlyreleased space policy, the Administration proposes $2 billion for space science, a four-percent increase over 1997. The additional funding will enhance NASA’s Origins program,
which seeks to understand the creation of the
universe, stars, solar system, and life, and determine if life once existed or still exists beyond Earth.

82
International Space Station: The Administration continues to support the development
of the International Space Station—a U.S.-led
collaborative effort with the European Space
Agency, Canada, Japan, and Russia—that will
provide an unique laboratory to explore innovative research on materials and biological
processes, on promising new technologies, and
on how people can live and work in a lowgravity environment. The budget proposes $9
billion in advanced, multi-year appropriations
to complete the $17.4 billion Space Station development and assembly, helping to ensure
that the program is completed, as promised,
within budget and on schedule.
Mission to Planet Earth (MTPE): MTPE is
NASA’s effort to observe, understand, and predict natural and human-induced changes to
the environment. The budget proposes $1.4 billion for MTPE, four percent more than in
1997. MTPE programs include the Earth Observing System satellites, the Landsat satellite, and a broad range of scientific research
and data analysis activities.
X-33 Reusable Launch Vehicle (RLV) Technology: The budget proposes $719 million in
advanced multi-year appropriations to complete development of the RLV X-33 test vehicle, that should dramatically cut the cost of
getting into space by demonstrating the use
of new materials, reusable components, and
new operations management approaches.
Aeronautics Initiative: The budget proposes
$456 million for NASA’s aeronautics initiatives, a nine-percent increase over 1997. These
initiatives are partnerships with industry and
include advanced subsonic technology and high
speed research that may revolutionize the next
generation of commercial aircraft.
Department of Energy (DOE):
Stockpile Stewardship: The President’s commitment to a Comprehensive Test Ban Treaty
(CTBT) is closely linked to the Administration’s plan to maintain the safety and reliability of the nuclear weapons stockpile through
scientific experiments and computer modeling
(i.e., no explosive testing of nuclear weapons).
The budget proposes $1.4 billion for Stockpile
Stewardship activities in 1998, plus $1.3 billion for related construction projects. Among
these projects, $900 million would go to build

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

the National Ignition Facility at the Lawrence
Livermore National Laboratory. The President,
who plans to submit the CTBT for Senate ratification in 1997, also is committed to funding
a comprehensive R&D program over the next
decade to improve treaty monitoring capabilities and operations.
Civilian Basic Science Programs: The Administration has designated High Energy and
Nuclear Physics, Basic Energy Sciences, and
Biological and Environmental Research as
high-priority areas of DOE basic science in
1998. These programs, which have a large university-based component, contribute to both
our national basic research enterprise and to
DOE’s core activities. In addition, these programs build and operate large user facilities
that serve over 15,000 university, government,
and industry scientists. The budget proposes
$2.1 billion in 1998 for these activities.
Large Hadron Collider Project: When it
comes on-line in 2005, the Large Hadron
Collider (LHC) at the European high-energy
physics laboratory CERN, in Switzerland, will
be by far the world’s most powerful accelerator. Its scientific goals are to search for the
origin of mass, to explore in detail the structure and interactions of the top quark (the
heaviest of the known subatomic particles),
and to probe high-energy conditions beyond
the Standard Model—the remarkably successful physics theory that describes all the forces
of nature, except gravity. Hundreds of U.S.
high energy physicists plan to participate in
the LHC project. The Administration proposes
$394 million in advanced, multi-year appropriations over eight years for DOE, which it
designated as the lead Federal agency for U.S.
participation. U.S. funding for the LHC would
support U.S. scientists and technicians, and
support the purchase of U.S. goods and services necessary for our contribution to constructing the accelerator and two detectors.
Department of Commerce:
Advanced Technology Program (ATP): ATP
is a rigorously competitive, industry-led, and
cost-shared R&D program that fosters technology development, promotes industrial alliances, and creates jobs. ATP pursues technologies that are critical to the competitive position of U.S. industries, but where the risk

4.

PROMOTING RESEARCH

is so high that industries will not likely invest
enough to ensure continued U.S. leadership.
The projects have led to significant technology
advances that have improved our daily lives.
With ATP funding, for example, a consortium
of several large and small companies recently
developed techniques to make better cars, thus
increasing customer satisfaction. The budget
proposes $275 million in 1998 for ATP, growing to $500 million by 2002.
The Manufacturing Extension Partnerships
(MEP): MEP gives the Nation’s 381,000 smaller manufacturers the technological information
and expertise to improve their operations. Extension centers are helping to improve the performance of small manufacturers across the
country, leading to more sales, more jobs, and
savings in labor and materials. The budget
proposes $129 million in 1998 to support 78
extension centers and over 300 field offices nationwide.
National Telecommunications and Information Administration National Information Infrastructure (NII) Grants Program: The budget
proposes $36 million for grants to help develop
the NII, which provides the infrastructure
that enables computers to connect to one
another and to information systems across
the country. These grants help fund innovative
demonstration projects to show how information technology can improve the delivery
of educational, health, and other social services.
Department of Defense Dual Use Applications Program: The budget proposes $225
million for DUAP, which will build on previous
Federal dual-use technology development programs and allow the military services to develop and use technologies, processes, and
products available to the commercial sector.
Dual-use technologies can enhance the performance and reduce the costs of military applications.
Department of Agriculture (USDA) National Research Initiative: The budget proposes a 38-percent increase, to $130 million,
for the National Research Initiative (NRI),
USDA’s major peer-reviewed competitive
grants program. The NRI supports fundamental research on key agricultural problems that
will help our Nation’s farmers retain their
technological edge, such as research in food

83
safety, plant and animal genetics, water quality, integrated pest management, and sustainable food and fiber production systems. Of particular concern is the need to expand the
science base for reducing food-borne illness due
to microbial pathogens and to the many food
and fiber production practices that contribute
to environmental degradation, such as the excessive use of pesticides, fertilizers and tillage.
As a result, the Administration proposes to
target $4 million to expand research in food
safety, $10 million to expand research in environmentally sound production practices, and
$22 million to expand research on enhancing
plants through genetics.
Department of Transportation Intelligent Transportation System (ITS) Initiative: The budget proposes $250 million for the
ITS initiative—a package of technologies designed to enhance the efficiency of our surface
transportation infrastructure. The request includes $100 million for a new Deployment Incentives program to encourage integrated implementation of ITS. The Administration also
proposes to make ITS projects eligible for surface transportation funds and, in 1997, to complete 77 operational tests of ITS standards and
technology and a demonstration of the technical feasibility of the Automated Highway
System.
National Science and Technology Council
Interagency Initiatives
Next Generation Internet (NGI) Program: The budget proposes $100 million for
each of the next three years to support the
NGI, which seeks to develop a research network that can reach speeds 100 to 1,000 times
faster than today’s Internet and greatly improve the quality of service. The NGI proposal
is a part of an overall request for $1.1 billion,
10 percent more than in 1997, for research
and development in computers and communications technologies under the rubric of the
Administration’s High Performance Computing
and Communications initiative.
U.S. Global Change Research Program
(USGCRP): The budget continues strong Administration support for the USGCRP, proposing $1.9 million for 1998. Program priorities
include research on seasonal to interannual climate variability, climate change over decades

84
to centuries, and on changes in atmospheric
chemistry and ecosystems. The program also
will continue to increase its focus on understanding the consequences of change, particularly at regional levels.
Emerging Infectious Diseases: The budget
proposes $280 million, eight percent over 1997,
for research on the development of new tools
to detect and control emerging infectious diseases and on the biology and pathology of infectious agents. Focus areas include: surveillance; screening and quarantine; diagnostics,
treatment, and prevention measures; training;
antibiotic
resistance;
zoonotic
infectious
agents; and health effects of climate change.
Partnership for a New Generation of Vehicles: The budget proposes $281 million, a
seven-percent increase over 1997, for research
to: (1) develop advanced manufacturing techniques that make it easier to get new auto-

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

mobiles and auto components into the marketplace quickly; (2) use new technologies for
near-term improvements in auto efficiency,
safety, and emissions; and (3) lead to production prototypes of vehicles that are three times
more fuel efficient than today’s cars, with no
sacrifice in comfort, performance, or price.
Construction and Building: The budget
proposes $203 million, a 15-percent increase
over 1997, for research to develop better construction technologies to improve the competitive performance of U.S. industry, raise the
life cycle performance of buildings, and protect
public safety and the environment.
Educational Technology: The budget proposes $524 million, a five-percent increase over
1997, for research and development on education and training to improve learning in
schools, workplaces, and homes.

5.

ENFORCING THE LAW

At the beginning of my Administration, we set out to change the country’s approach to crime by
putting more officers on our streets through community policing, and taking guns out of the
hands of criminals. We are making a difference. Today, our neighborhoods are safer, and we are
restoring the American people’s confidence that crime can be reduced.
President Clinton
January 5, 1997

The budget extends the Administration’s
commitment to cut crime, curb the scourge
of illegal drugs, and secure the Nation’s
borders.
With overall crime dropping, the budget
proposes to make further progress while
targeting a remaining area of concern—juvenile crime and violence. In addition, the
budget continues the President’s progress toward putting 100,000 more police on the
street, while increasing State grants for prison
construction and for preventing violence
against women. While crime remains mainly
a State and local responsibility, the success
of the Brady bill in preventing over 100,000
felons, fugitives, and stalkers from obtaining
guns shows the Federal Government also
has an important role to play.
The budget renews the Administration’s
efforts to fight drug abuse, particularly by
focusing on youth prevention programs to
reverse the recent trends of softening attitudes
towards drugs and increased drug use by
youth. It also continues efforts to stress
treatment and prevention, domestic law enforcement, international programs, and interdiction. It would increase funds for the innovative Drug Courts initiative, for drug testing,
for the Safe and Drug-Free Schools and
Communities Program, for targeted interdiction efforts along the Nation’s Southern border, and for disrupting the drug industry
and its leadership overseas. The budget proposes to increase spending for these purposes
by over $800 million in 1998, and by more
than $6 billion between 1997 and 2002.

Finally, the budget strengthens the Administration’s aggressive efforts to control illegal
immigration by targeting resources to stop
those who want to enter the United States
illegally, detain and quickly remove those
who slipped by, and make it harder for
illegal immigrants to get jobs. It proposes
to strengthen border enforcement in the South
and West, to continue Port Courts to expedite
removals, and to expand efforts to verify
the employment eligibility of newly hired
non-citizens.
Fighting Crime
The Administration’s efforts to work with
communities and local police forces are paying
off. Serious and violent crime dropped for
the fifth year in a row in 1996, marking
the longest period of decline in 25 years.
But, while overall crime rates are dropping,
young people are increasingly the perpetrators
and victims of some of society’s most violent
crimes. As a result, the Administration’s
crime-fighting agenda includes a major focus
on reducing juvenile crime and violence. Its
programs recognize that youth violence has
to be addressed in the home, on the street,
and in the community.
The budget proposes $24.9 billion to control
crime, an increase of $1.1 billion over 1997,
as illustrated on Chart 5–1. Of the total,
the Violent Crime Reduction Trust Fund
(VCRTF) provides $5.5 billion toward programs authorized in the 1994 Crime Act,
an increase of $817 million over 1997, as
shown on Table 5–1. Federal spending, however, accounts for only 17 percent of all
85

86

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 5-1. ANTI-CRIME BUDGET HISTORY
DOLLARS IN BILLIONS
30

23.8

25

21.1
18.8

20

15.2
15

4.7

24.9
5.5

4.1

2.4
16.4

17.0

1995

1996

19.1

19.4

1997

1998

10

5

0
1993

VIOLENT CRIME REDUCTION TRUST FUND

law enforcement resources. Thus, the Administration proposes to continue empowering
States and communities, which play the
central role in controlling crime, particularly
violent crime.
Community Policing: The cornerstone of
the President’s program to fight crime, particularly violent crime in our communities, is his
plan to place 100,000 more police officers on
the streets by 2000. Putting the idea of community policing into action, the program seeks
to cut crime, violence, and disorder by applying
proven, effective programs and strategies. By
the end of 1997, the Community Oriented Policing Services (COPS) initiative will have
funded about 64,000 additional police officers.
For 1998, the budget proposes $1.4 billion to
put nearly 17,000 more officers on the street
in local communities.
In addition to funding new police officers,
COPS enables local law enforcement agencies
to buy sophisticated crime equipment and

GENERAL APPROPRIATIONS

hire support personnel. These purchases, in
turn, allow communities to deploy more officers. To enhance State and local law enforcement recruitment, retention, and education,
the budget proposes $20 million each for
the Police Corps and for police scholarships,
increasing the number of police officers with
advanced education and training.
Juveniles: The budget proposes a $50 million increase to support more local community
prevention programs such as mentoring, truancy prevention, and gang intervention. To
prevent young people from becoming involved
in the juvenile justice system, the budget expands programs that provide supervised afternoon and evening activities for youth. These
programs include $63 million for community
schools, supervision, and youth services
grants—an increase of $50 million over 1997.
Gangs: The President has worked hard to
get guns off the streets and out of the hands
of children, to crack down on violent teen

5.

87

ENFORCING THE LAW

Table 5–1.

VIOLENT CRIME REDUCTION TRUST FUND SPENDING
BY FUNCTION
(Budget authority, dollar amounts in millions)
1996
Actual

Dollar
1997
1998
Change:
Estimate Proposed 1996 to
1998

Percent
Change:
1996 to
1998

Prevention:
Violence Against Women ........................................
Drug Courts .............................................................
Prison Drug Treatment ...........................................
Other Prevention Programs ....................................

228
18
27
4

259
30
30
34

381
75
63
57

+153
+67%
+57
+317%
+36
+133%
+53 +1,483%

Subtotal, Prevention ............................................

277

353

576

+299

+108%

State and Local Assistance:
Community Policing ................................................
Incarceration of Violent Offenders .........................
Incarceration of Undocumented Criminal Aliens
Other State and Local Assistance ..........................

1,400
618
300
690

1,420
670
330
790

1,545
710
350
707

+145
+93
+50
+17

+10%
+15%
+17%
+2%

Subtotal, State and Local Assistance .................

3,008

3,210

3,312

+304

+10%

Federal Law Enforcement Assistance:
Department of Justice .............................................
Department of the Treasury ...................................
Judiciary ...................................................................

702
69
30

1,002
89
30

1,444
118
50

+742
+49
+20

+106%
+70%
+67%

801

1,121

1,612

+811

+101%

4,085

4,683

5,500 +1,415

+35%

Subtotal, Federal Law Enforcement Assistance
Total, Violent Crime Reduction Trust Fund .....

Note: The Violent Crime Reduction Trust Fund received appropriations for the first time in 1995.

gangs, and to teach children that drugs are
wrong, illegal, and dangerous. As gangs become an increasingly powerful and deadly
force, the Administration is pursuing a coordinated national strategy to combat them. For
example, the budget proposes $100 million for
prosecutorial offices to hire more prosecutors
and take other steps, $50 million for a new
juvenile court initiative, and $75 million for
a local youth crime intervention initiative. The
budget also proposes programs specifically targeted to stem violence on the street and in
public housing, including:
• Safe Streets Task Forces: The budget proposes $93 million to continue the Safe
Streets program, which blends the efforts
of the Federal Bureau of Investigation
(FBI) and other Federal law enforcement
agencies with those of State and local po-

lice departments to
crime and violence.

investigate

street

• One Strike, You’re Out: The President believes that public housing is a privilege,
not a right, and residents who commit
crime and peddle drugs should be immediately evicted. The budget provides $290
million to support anti-drug and anticrime activities in public housing, including enforcement of the President’s One
Strike, You’re Out initiative.
Violent Offenders: The Administration
seeks to ensure that convicted violent offenders
serve at least 85 percent of their sentences
behind bars. To reach this goal, the budget
proposes $710 million in State grants to build
new prisons and jail cells under two programs—the Violent Offender Incarceration and
the Truth in Sentencing Programs. Nation-

88

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

wide, the prison population is growing by over
1,700 inmates a week, and will likely grow
faster as tougher sentencing laws and practices that these grant programs require are
implemented. The 1998 funding level finances
about 9,500 new prison beds. It includes $150
million to reimburse States for the costs of
incarcerating criminal aliens and $35 million
to improve State and local correctional facilities that hold Federal prisoners.

Counter-terrorism: While acts of domestic
terrorism have been isolated incidents, the Administration has sought more Federal resources to ensure the safety and security of
the Government and public from these violent,
illegal acts. The President sought additional
resources last year to fight terrorism, and Congress overwhelmingly agreed, providing $1.1
billion in new counter-terrorism funds. The
budget would continue these programs.

Crime Prevention: The President’s Crime
Prevention Council, which the Vice President
chairs, seeks to coordinate Federal approaches
to preventing crime. It helps communities get
information about crime prevention programs,
develops strategies for integrating programs
and simplifying grants, publishes a catalog of
prevention programs, and provides grants to
communities for youth crime prevention programs.

Methamphetamine: Methamphetamine is
quickly becoming the growth drug of the
1990s. Also known on the street as ‘‘crank,’’
‘‘ice,’’ and ‘‘speed,’’ methamphetamine is a dangerous stimulant that generates the same
addiction cycle and psychological trauma associated with crack cocaine. The Drug Enforcement Administration (DEA) trains its agents,
as well as State and local law enforcement
agencies, to seize clandestine methamphetamine laboratories. Since 1994, the DEA has
devoted almost 10 percent more work hours
to methamphetamine investigations. The budget proposes to increase funding by $11 million
to continue DEA’s anti-methamphetamine efforts.

Violence Against Women: The Administration recognizes that violence against women
is a growing problem. To combat gender-based
crime, the budget proposes $381 million—the
full authorized level and an increase of $123
million over 1997. Programs in this category
include grants to encourage mandatory arrest
policies and to encourage coordination among
law enforcement officials, prosecutors, and victims assistance organizations. Academic studies show that mandatory arrest policies often
break the cycle of violence and reduce subsequent incidents of domestic violence. The expansion of these programs will enable States
to enhance their efforts to respond to violent
crimes committed against women, and to further expand access to previously under-served
Indian and other minority populations.
State Prison Drug Testing: The budget
proposes $63 million for this program, a $33
million increase over 1997. The funding would
allow States to increase the number of residential substance abuse programs and treat about
23,000 prisoners. Experts generally agree that
drug treatment programs aimed at prisoners
are among the most cost-effective programs
available in the fight against crime. In 1997,
the President proposed and Congress agreed
to require States to test prisoners and parolees
as a condition for receiving State prison
grants.

Digital Telephony: The Communications
Assistance for Law Enforcement Act ensures
that law enforcement agencies can conduct
court-authorized wiretaps as the Nation converts from analog to digital communications
technology. With $100 million available in
1997 to help develop the technology changes
to provide this capability, the President proposes another $100 million in 1998 to continue
the effort.
Combating Drug Abuse and Drug-Related
Crime
Drug abuse and drug-related crime cost
our society an estimated $67 billion a year 1
and destroy the lives and futures of our
most precious resource—our children. Illicit
drug trafficking breeds crime, violence, and
corruption across the globe, drug use facilitates
the spread of AIDS and other deadly diseases,
and addiction erodes the user’s dignity and
productivity. The effects of drug use and
drug-related crime are felt acutely by all
1 ‘‘Substance Abuse: The Nation’s Number One Health Problem,’’
Key Indicators for Policy, Institute for Health Policy, Brandeis University (1993).

5.

89

ENFORCING THE LAW

Americans, transcending economic, geographic,
and other boundaries.
The budget proposes $16.0 billion for antidrug abuse programs, a five-percent increase
over 1997. It builds on earlier initiatives
by renewing the emphasis on drug treatment
and prevention, especially for children and
adolescents; domestic law enforcement; international programs; and interdiction. (For summary information, see Table 5–2.)
In particular, the budget proposes a coordinated, multi-agency approach to combating
all types of substance abuse among youth—
including tobacco and alcohol—with a comprehensive prevention initiative that focuses,
in particular, on State-level data documenting
trends in drug use. This comprehensive approach, consistent with the President’s National Drug Control Strategy, comes in response to national surveys showing a dramatic
rise in substance abuse among adolescents.
Community-Based Prevention: The Administration is committed to reversing the
trend of increased drug use by our youth, and
it proposes $2.2 billion for drug prevention programs, 15 percent more than in 1997. After
significant and consistent declines through the
1980s, teenage drug use is rising and antidrug attitudes have softened—due in part to
drug glamorization in the popular culture and
the recent debate concerning drug legalization.
In light of the recent ‘‘medicinal marijuana’’
initiatives adopted in California and Arizona,
the Administration believes it is more important than ever to continue sending a single
‘‘no use’’ message and to focus on keeping
America’s youth drug free.

Table 5–2.

• National Media Awareness Campaign: The
Office of National Drug Control Policy
(ONDCP) will develop a media campaign—
to include public service announcements,
targeted at youth and their parents, on
the consequences of drug use and the use
of alcohol and tobacco. ONDCP will finance the campaign from the $175 million
in discretionary funds that the budget proposes for ONDCP’s Director to combat
emerging drug abuse threats.
• The Safe and Drug Free Schools and
Communities Program: The Safe and
Drug-Free Schools and Communities program is the Federal Government’s largest
effort to inoculate children against drug
abuse and ensure that schools are safe and
disciplined learning environments. The
program supports drug and violence prevention efforts in 97 percent of all school
districts through educational activities,
teacher training, curriculum development,
peer counseling, security services, and
other activities. The budget proposes to
spend $620 million for this program, 12
percent more than in 1997, and to encourage States to adopt models of proven effectiveness.
Drug Intervention: The budget proposes
$3.3 billion to treat drug abuse, seven percent
more than in 1997. The Administration seeks
to address drug abuse where the battle is
toughest—in the streets, in jails, and in urban
and rural drug markets. A priority is treating
chronic, hard-core drug users; they consume
a disproportionate amount of illicit drugs and
impose a disproportionate share of drug-related costs on society.

DRUG CONTROL FUNDING

(Budget authority, dollar amounts in millions)
1996
Actual

1997
1998
Estimate Proposed

Dollar
Change:
1996 to
1998

Percent
Change:
1996 to
1998

Demand Reduction ...............................................
Supply Reduction .................................................

4,441
9,013

4,977
10,182

5,474
10,502

+1,034
+1,489

+23%
+17%

Total, Drug Control Funding .....................

13,454

15,159

15,977

+2,523

+19%

90

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

• Drug Courts: The budget proposes $75 million, a 150-percent increase over 1997, for
the Drug Courts initiative. These courts
offer an alternative to incarceration for
non-violent offenders who are willing to
participate in, and would benefit from, rehabilitative drug treatment. Drug Court
programs rely on sanctions, such as incarceration and increased drug-testing and
supervision, to encourage treatment.

other efforts; and providing incentives to
States and localities to adopt proven drug control methods. The number of High Intensity
Drug Trafficking Areas has risen from five in
1993 to 15 in 1997.

• Substance Abuse Treatment: The budget
proposes $1.3 billion, one percent more
than in 1997, to support State substance
abuse activities, which target resources to
local user populations. In addition, the
budget maintains support for treatment
and prevention services for everyone in
need, including pregnant women, high-risk
youth, and other under-served Americans.
(For a discussion of funding proposals for
the Substance Abuse and Mental Health
Administration, see Chapter 1.)

• Southern Tier of the United States: The
Administration is working to stem the flow
of narcotics through land and seaports
along the Nation’s Southern tier. The
budget would reinforce efforts by the Customs Service to strengthen border enforcement along the Southern tier by providing
$36 million for increased drug interdiction
efforts. The budget also increases support
for other Southwest border interdiction efforts, including $16 million for the Immigration and Naturalization Service (INS),
$46 million for the DEA’s and the FBI’s
Southwest border drug interdiction efforts,
and $47 million for Coast Guard interdiction activities.

• Arrestee Drug Testing: The budget includes
$42 million, 40 percent more than in 1997,
for the costs associated with drug-testing
Federal, State, and local arrestees. With
these funds, the Administration would establish Federal demonstration pre-trial
drug testing programs and promote new,
comprehensive drug testing programs at
the State and local levels, for both pretrial and post-conviction populations. In
addition, the Administration has begun requiring, as a condition of receiving Federal
highway funds, that every State make it
illegal for anyone under 21 to drive with
alcohol in his or her bloodstream.
Domestic Drug Law Enforcement: The
budget proposes $8.4 billion for domestic drug
law enforcement, four percent more than in
1997. The funds would enhance Federal law
enforcement efforts while targeting new resources to community-based law enforcement,
stopping the flow of illegal drugs through the
Southwest border, and training Federal, State,
and local law enforcement agencies to seize
clandestine methamphetamine laboratories.
The Federal role would continue to focus on
providing leadership and training; fostering
intergovernmental cooperation through the
High Intensity Drug Trafficking Areas program, DEA’s Southwest border initiative, and

Interdiction and International Programs: The Administration has launched a
multi-faceted international strategy, making it
harder for traffickers to smuggle illicit drugs
into the United States for sale.

• Source Nation Efforts: Internationally, the
United States is focusing on not just interdiction in source countries and transit
zones, but also on disrupting the drug
leadership and its production, marketing,
and money laundering structure. Increased U.S. efforts in Colombia helped secure the arrest of several Cali Cartel leaders. The budget proposes to increase funding for counter-narcotics programs in Peru
to $40 million, 74 percent more than in
1997, to encourage that nation to grow
crops other than drugs. The budget also
proposes to continue funding for the same
purpose in Bolivia.
Deterring Illegal Immigration
The President has put a high priority
on controlling our Nation’s borders, reversing
decades of neglect. He has launched an
aggressive strategy of deterrence and has
fought successfully for a dramatic increase
in INS resources to stop illegal entry, detain
and promptly remove those here illegally,
and end the easy access to the Nation’s
job market that illegal workers have enjoyed.

5.

91

ENFORCING THE LAW

As a Nation of immigrants, the United
States continues to welcome those who seek
legal entry and refugees who seek protection
from harm in their home countries. In 1996
alone, the Nation welcomed over a million
new naturalized U.S. citizens. As a Nation
of laws, however, we are committed to maintaining the integrity of our borders, and
deterring and removing those who are here
illegally.
Over the past five years, in coordination
with Congress, the Administration has increased funding for INS by 111 percent.
The budget continues support for efforts that
advance border control and illegal alien detention and removal, and the efficient processing
of those seeking citizenship. The budget proposes $3.6 billion for INS, 13 percent more
than in 1997 and 41 percent more than
in 1996 (see Table 5–3).
Securing the Border: Controlling the Nation’s 6,000–mile border with limited resources
is a continuing challenge for INS. The Administration’s goal is unambiguous—to ensure

Table 5–3.

that the border deters illegal immigration,
drug trafficking, and alien smuggling, while
facilitating legal immigration and commerce.
The President’s immigration initiative included
a strategy to gain control at the Southwest
border and restore the rule of law, and the
Administration backed it up with unprecedented increases in Border Patrol agents, advanced technology, and investments in infrastructure. The budget would fulfill the President’s commitment to a Border Patrol staffing
goal of 7,000 agents—an 85–percent increase
from 1993 to 1998 (see Chart 5–2).
• Border Enforcement Strategy: Over the
past four years, the Administration has
launched targeted enforcement initiatives
in Texas, California, and Arizona to control parts of the border that were historically the major corridors for illegal immigration. In the San Diego, El Paso, and
Tucson areas—sites that account for over
75 percent of illegal crossings and where
the Border Patrol has focused more resources over the past few years—violent

IMMIGRATION AND NATURALIZATION SERVICE
FUNDING BY PROGRAM
(Budget authority, dollar amounts in millions)
1993
Actual

1996
Actual

1998
Proposed

Dollar
Change:
1996 to
1998

Percent
Change:
1996 to
1998

Appropriated Funds:
Border Patrol ....................................................
Investigations and intelligence ........................
Land border inspections ...................................
Detention and deportation ...............................
Program support and construction .................

354
142
83
161
227

536
190
116
289
600

818
277
157
581
624

+282
+87
+41
+292
+24

+53%
+46%
+35%
+101%
+4%

Subtotal, Appropriated Funds .....................

967

1,731

2,457

+726

+42%

Fee collections and reimbursements:
Citizenship and benefits ..................................
Air/sea inspections and support ......................
Detention and support .....................................

308
243
12

523
320
11

648
419
117

+125
+99
+106

+24%
+31%
+964%

Subtotal, Fee Collections and Reimbursements ..........................................................

563

854

1,184

+330

+39%

Total, Immigration and Naturalization
Service .............................................................

1,530

2,585

3,641

+1,056

+41%

92

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 5-2. IMMIGRATION AND NATURALIZATION SERVICE BORDER
PATROL AND LAND BORDER INSPECTION STAFFING
STAFF IN THOUSANDS
12
11

1,885

10

1,885

9

1,644

8
7
6

1,088
5
4

785
3,965

1,099
830

1,129

1,092

909

5,878

1,493
1,443
7,359
6,859

4,881

4,226

3
2
1
0
1993

1994

LAND BORDER INSPECTORS

1995

1996

BORDER PATROL SUPPORT

and property crime rates have dropped by
a dramatic 15 to 39 percent. This targeted
use of Border Patrol agents in urban areas
has forced illegal crossers to rural, mountainous, and desert locations where the
difficult terrain gives the Border Patrol an
advantage in apprehending them.
• Border Infrastructure and Technology: The
Administration has, along the entire
Southwest border, expanded advanced
technology to support enforcement. The
technology includes the IDENT system, an
automated fingerprint identification system that allows INS, for the first time,
to readily identify criminal aliens, track
illegal crossing patterns, and collect data
on repeat crossers. With the help of the
National Guard and military personnel,
the INS also has built over 63 miles of
fencing and 1,200 miles of roads, and installed over 17 miles of lighting to control
drug trafficking, alien smuggling, and illegal immigration. And, since 1993, INS has
added over 165 infrared night scopes,

1997

1998

BORDER PATROL AGENTS

8,600 ground sensors, and 8,000 encrypted
radios to support enhanced border enforcement.
• Border Control and Detention Construction: For too long, INS has worked from
decrepit and inadequate Border Patrol stations, and has been forced to incarcerate
illegal aliens in antiquated and unsafe detention facilities. The budget supports an
INS construction program that would complete six Border Patrol projects and two
detention facility projects. Along with the
military, INS also would fund 11 fencing,
border lighting, vehicle barrier, and road
projects to secure the Southwest border.
Detaining and Removing Illegal Aliens:
Last year’s immigration reform law requires
mandatory incarceration, pending deportation,
for aliens involved in crime. The Administration is moving quickly to implement the law,
funding 1,864 more jail beds in 1998 and adding investigators and detention staff. The
budget would bring total detention bedspace
to over 13,900 beds in 1998 and fund nearly

5.

ENFORCING THE LAW

3,200 staff to support detention and deportation activities. INS removed over 68,200 aliens,
including 37,000 criminal aliens, in 1996 and
estimates that it will remove over 93,000
aliens, at least 55,000 of them criminal aliens,
in 1997.
• Port Courts: The Port Court program, initiated in 1995 in San Diego, imposes immediate consequences—including exclusion and deportation—for those who attempt to enter the United States with
fraudulent documents or small amounts of
drugs. In its first full year of operation,
over 8,000 aliens were removed through
expedited proceedings at the Port Court.
The budget provides funds to continue the
Port Court concept in San Diego and at
the Miami Airport.
• Institutional Hearing Program (IHP):
Under this program, criminal aliens have
a deportation hearing while serving time
in a Federal or State institution, paving
the way for immediate deportation upon
completion of a criminal sentence. The
program ensures that criminal aliens are
not released onto the streets. INS has expanded this program, which began in California, to States with large incarcerated
alien populations. In 1995, INS began cooperative IHPs in California, Texas, New
York, and Florida. The budget continues
funding for IHP programs in these States
and in New Jersey and Arizona.
• State and Local Alien Incarceration:
Through the State Criminal Alien Assistance Program (SCAAP), the President has
provided unprecedented help to reimburse
State and local governments for the costs
of incarcerating illegal criminal aliens. In
1996, the Federal Government provided
$495 million to reimburse 49 States and
94 localities—covering most costs associated with incarcerating aliens in non-Federal facilities. The budget extends the commitment, providing $500 million for reimbursements. The Federal Government
plans to ensure that States and localities
receiving SCAAP funds fully cooperate
with INS in its efforts to expedite criminal
alien removals.
Reducing the Job Magnet for Illegal
Entry: The U.S. economy acts as a powerful

93
‘‘job magnet,’’ drawing hundreds of thousands
of illegal aliens to this country each year. The
Administration has built a strong foundation
for an effective worksite enforcement strategy
to reduce the draw of illegal aliens.
• Employment and Data Verification: In
1995, INS launched a pilot employment
verification system with over 200 employers in Orange County, California. It allowed employers to quickly verify the employment eligibility of newly hired noncitizens. INS expanded the pilot in 1996
to over 1,000 employers and into Florida.
The budget proposes over $30 million in
additional funding to correct INS data and
expand verification efforts.
• Worksite Enforcement: In 1996, INS removed over 15,000 illegal workers from
the workplace through such enforcement
initiatives as Operation JOBS and SouthPAW (Protecting American Workers).
Worksite enforcement is the third leg of
the Administration’s enforcement strategy,
and INS is committed to showing both employers who knowingly violate the law as
well as illegal workers that we mean business and will enforce the law. INS’ efforts
have focused on industries with a history
of hiring illegal workers. In the past year
alone, INS has targeted over 900 employers and apprehended 8,700 illegal workers,
freeing up over $117 million in wages for
legal workers. Since 1993, INS has removed over 30,000 illegal workers from
their jobs.
Encouraging Naturalization and Citizenship: In 1995, in response to an unprecedented increase in citizenship applications, the
Administration launched a major naturalization initiative—Citizenship USA. The initiative, targeted in five key cities where over 75
percent of naturalization applications came in
and where a naturalization backlog was building, led to streamlined citizenship procedures
and reduced applicant processing times. In
1996, over 1.2 million naturalization applicants became U.S. citizens—the highest ever.
The average application process, which in the
past exceeded a year, is now six months.

6.

RESTORING THE AMERICAN COMMUNITY
We said in 1991 we would offer opportunity for all, demand responsibility from all, build a
stronger American community. We said that this era requires a Government that neither attempts
to solve problems for people, nor leaves them alone to fend for themselves. Instead, we envision a
Government that gives people the tools to solve their own problems and make the most of their
own lives . . . I intend to spend the next four years doing everything I can to help communities to
help themselves, to educate all Americans about what is working, and to create, in the process, a
national community of purpose.
President Clinton
December 11, 1996

Some American communities have grown
disconnected from the opportunity and prosperity of their States, their regions, their
Nation, and the global economy. The polarization of communities—isolating the poor from
the well-off, the unemployed from those who
work, and people of one race or ethnicity
from others—frays the fabric of our civic
culture and depletes the strength of our
economy.

under 20 percent in non-poverty neighborhoods.
• Over half of all adults have less than a
high school education, compared to under
20 percent in non-poverty neighborhoods.
• Over 40 percent of working age men are
not working, compared to just over 19 percent in non-poverty neighborhoods.

The problem affects all Americans; we
cannot and should not wall ourselves off
from it. If we do not address the problem
in our communities, connecting residents of
distressed neighborhoods and rural areas to
the jobs and opportunities of the regional
marketplace, the Nation cannot compete and
win in the global economy.

Poverty also remains a persistent problem
in rural America. Of the 765 rural counties
with poverty rates of at least 20 percent
in 1990, 535 had such poverty rates in
1980, 1970, and 1960. Because they often
live in remote areas, and do not live near
one another, rural residents often have a
hard time receiving critical services or connecting themselves to urban and suburban centers
of economic activity.

While poverty overall is down in America,
the concentration of urban poverty has risen
in recent decades (see Chart 6–1). From
1970 to 1990, the number of people living
in areas of concentrated poverty (where over
40 percent of the residents are poor) grew
from 3.8 million to 10.4 million.1 The share
of people living in our 100 largest cities
who were concentrated in these extremepoverty neighborhoods also rose—from five
percent in 1970 to eight percent in 1980
to 11 percent in 1990. In such neighborhoods,
social conditions are bleak.

On the other hand, the 1990s have brought
signs of progress—in alleviating poverty and
creating opportunity both across the Nation
as well as in the isolated areas in which
the obstacles are so imposing. Across the
Nation, poverty, welfare, and inequality are
all down, while incomes and homeownership
are up. In the last four years, the economy
has created over 11 million jobs and record
numbers of small businesses, bringing new
hope and opportunity to millions of Americans.

• Over 60 percent of families with children
are headed by single women, compared to
1 The

President’s Urban Policy Report, 1995.

The Administration recognizes, however, the
barriers that still stand in the way of work
and self-sufficiency for many poor Americans,
and it proposes important steps to address
them and to provide more opportunity.
95

96

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 6-1. CONCENTRATION OF POVERTY IN URBAN AREAS
REACHED A 30-YEAR HIGH IN 1990
(Population living in census tracts with more than 40 percent poverty)
PERCENT

14
12

10.8

10

8.1
8
6

5.1

4
2
0
1970

1980

1990

Source: U.S. Census data for 1970, 1980, and 1990, as compiled by John Kasarda, Urban Underclass Database Machine Readable Files,
Social Science Research Council, New York, 1992 and 1993.

In particular, communities need help to
attract the kind and amount of private investment that could spur their revitalization.
Although Federal programs can provide support, solutions must come from the community.
As a result, the budget proposes to create
opportunities and offer incentives for individuals and businesses to participate directly
in addressing local problems.
National Service
National service is rooted in the American
tradition of neighbor helping neighbor to
build communities, reward personal responsibility, and expand educational opportunity.
The Corporation for National and Community
Service, established in 1993, encourages Americans of all ages and backgrounds to engage
in community-based service, addressing the
Nation’s educational, public safety, environmental, and other needs to achieve direct
and demonstrable results. In doing so, the
Corporation
fosters
civic
responsibility,
strengthens the ties that bind us together
as a people, and provides educational oppor-

tunity for those who make a substantial
commitment to service.
The budget proposes $809 million for the
Corporation, a 31-percent increase over 1997,
with the increase targeted to the President’s
America Reads initiative—an effort through
which volunteer tutors will help children
read well and independently by the third
grade. Along with support from the Departments of Education and Health and Human
Services, the Corporation’s funding will finance
11,000 AmeriCorps tutor coordinators and
logistical support to help recruit, organize,
and manage an army of a million volunteers
who will tutor over three million children—
from kindergarten through third grade—after
school, on weekends, and during the summer.
Every Corporation program will participate
in this effort. America Reads builds on the
demonstrated success of national service in
helping to solve real problems.
AmeriCorps, the Corporation’s signature initiative that includes Volunteers in Service
to America (VISTA) and the National Civilian

6.

97

RESTORING THE AMERICAN COMMUNITY

Community Corps, has proven cost-effective.
Investment in AmeriCorps members returns
$1.60 to $3.90 for each dollar invested, according to independent evaluations. AmeriCorps
enables young Americans of all backgrounds
to serve in local communities full- or parttime, generally for at least a year. In return,
they earn a minimum living allowance set
at about the poverty level of a single individual
and, when they complete their service, they
earn an education award to help pay for
postsecondary education or repay student
loans. About 70,000 individuals will have
participated in AmeriCorps in its first three
years, and the budget supports an AmeriCorps
program of about 35,000 members.
Among other national service programs:
• Learn and Serve America grants help
school districts and communities engage
youth to serve their communities and
learn citizenship. The budget proposes to
fund opportunities for almost 900,000
school-age youth.
• The National Senior Service Corps engages senior citizens—an untapped resource with time, talent, and energy to
meet community needs. The budget funds
the Retired and Senior Volunteer Program, the Foster Grandparent Program,
and the Senior Companion Program, enabling nearly 600,000 older Americans to
serve.
Corporation programs strengthen communities in several ways. AmeriCorps, for example, is run by national, State, and local
organizations such as Habitat for Humanity,
the Christian Children’s Fund, the American
Red Cross, the National Coalition of Homeless
Veterans, the YMCA, and local United Ways
across the country. These institutions select
AmeriCorps members to work alongside the
men and women already working to solve
problems at the local level. AmeriCorps members provide a regular source of service
that most volunteers, with their own time
constraints, cannot offer. AmeriCorps members
also recruit traditional, unpaid volunteers,
then help organize and manage these volunteers as they perform direct service.
The Corporation operates in a decentralized
fashion, working with bipartisan commissions

that the Nation’s governors appoint to carry
out service programs. The commissions run
competitions to determine what programs will
participate, and States manage and oversee
them. In the Learn and Serve program,
State education agencies set priorities and
resource allocations for service learning programs. In the National Senior Service Corps,
communities define the activities that Senior
Corps members will conduct.
Most important of all, national service
participants are getting things done.
• In one Ohio project, nine AmeriCorps
members conducted home visits with 1,449
students. As a result, school attendance
increased, more students applied to college
than were originally planning to, and more
parents were involved in their children’s
education.
• In California, 12 AmeriCorps members
tutored 230 students, and drop-out rates
fell from 50 to 20 percent. Teachers also
noted improved attention and behavior
among students.
• In Olympia, Washington, three teams of
retired volunteers tutored 400 students
who were reading below grade levels and
almost all were reading at their appropriate grade level by the end of the year.
Empowerment Zones (EZs) and
Enterprise Communities (ECs)
As part of his 1993 economic program,
the President proposed, and Congress enacted,
the Empowerment Zones and Enterprise Communities program. Under it, communities develop a strategic plan to help spur economic
development and expand opportunities for
their residents, and in return they receive
Federal tax benefits, social service grants,
and more flexibility in how they use Federal
funds.
EZs and ECs are parts of urban or rural
areas with high unemployment and high
poverty rates. For EZs, the Federal Government provides tax benefits for businesses
that set up shop, and grants to community
groups for job training, day care, and other
purposes. For ECs, the Government provides
grants to community groups for the same
array of purposes. Both EZs and ECs can

98
apply for waivers from Federal regulations,
enabling them to better address their local
needs.
The 1994 competition for the first round
of EZ and EC designations generated over
500 applications and created new local partnerships for community revitalization—even
in communities that were not chosen. The
105 selected communities made well over
$8 billion in private-public commitments (aside
from the promised Federal resources). In
the six urban EZs, the private sector has
made or committed over $2 billion in new
investment, bringing greater economic opportunity to those cities. One of the six, Detroit,
has announced over 21 private developments
in its zone, with one linen and supply
manufacturer announcing a $5.5 million expansion over the next two years that will
create over 100 jobs for zone residents.
But many communities that were not designated as EZs or ECs lack the seed capital
to begin their revitalization efforts. Thus,
in last year’s budget, the President proposed
a second round of EZs/ECs to stimulate
further private investment and economic opportunity in distressed urban and rural communities and to connect residents to available
local jobs. Because Congress did not act
on the proposal, this budget again proposes
a second round of EZs/ECs.
The second round would again challenge
communities to develop their own comprehensive, strategic plans for revitalization, with
input from residents and a wide array of
community partners. The Administration
would invest in communities that develop
the most innovative plans and secure significant local commitments. The second round
would build on the President’s ‘‘brownfields’’
tax incentive, which would encourage businesses to clean up abandoned, contaminated
industrial properties in distressed communities. This round would also offer a competitive application process that would stimulate
the public-private partnerships needed for
large-scale job creation, business opportunities,
and job connections for families in distressed
communities. (For more information on the
brownfields program, see Chapter 3.)
The Administration proposes to seek 100
new designations, with communities receiving

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

a combination of tax incentives, direct grants,
and priority consideration for funds from
Federal economic development programs and
for waivers of Federal requirements from
the President’s Community Empowerment
Board, chaired by Vice President Gore.
Community Development Financial
Institutions (CDFIs)
Proposed by the President in 1993 and
created a year later, the CDFI Fund is
designed to expand the availability of credit,
investment capital, financial services, and
other development services in distressed urban
and rural communities. By stimulating the
creation and expansion of a diverse set of
CDFIs, the Fund will help develop new
private markets, create healthy local economies, promote entrepreneurship, restore neighborhoods, generate tax revenues, and empower
residents.
CDFIs provide a wide range of financial
products and services, such as mortgage financing to first-time home buyers, commercial
loans and investments to start or expand
small businesses, loans to rehabilitate rental
housing, and basic financial services. CDFIs
also include a broad range of institutions—
e.g., community development banks, community development credit unions, community
development loan funds, community development venture capital funds, and microenterprise loan funds. These institutions, not the
CDFI Fund, decide which individual projects
to finance.
The budget proposes $125 million for the
CDFI Fund, $75 million more than in 1997,
and gradual increases each year to bring
the five-year total to $1 billion by 2002.
Private sector interest in the program has
dramatically exceeded expectations. In 1996,
the CDFI Fund received requests for $300
million in assistance—about 10 times what
was available for the first round—from 270
new and existing CDFIs. Of these applicants,
the CDFI Fund selected 32 institutions, serving 46 states and the District of Columbia,
to receive $37.2 million in financial and
technical assistance. In addition, the Fund
awarded $13 million to 38 traditional banks
and thrifts for increasing their activities in

6.

RESTORING THE AMERICAN COMMUNITY

99

economically distressed communities and investing in CDFIs.

sector organizations to form a National Homeownership Strategy.

Additional resources would enable the Fund
to implement a new initiative to support
private institutions that provide secondary
markets for CDFIs, leveraging public resources
with private capital. This initiative would
increase the resources to provide incentives,
through the Bank Enterprise Award program,
for traditional banks to expand their community development lending and support local
CDFIs. The funds also would substantially
enhance the CDFIs’ capacity to take advantage
of coordinated, multi-faceted community development efforts, such as EZs and ECs.

The partners are reducing the barriers
to homeownership by lowering mortgage closing costs and down payment requirements;
by simplifying the process of financing home
purchases and repairs; and by opening markets for women, minorities, central-city homebuyers, and others traditionally locked out
of the conventional lending markets. Coupled
with a stable economy and low interest
rates, this initiative has helped the Nation
reach an all-time high national homeownership rate. The rate is now 65.6 percent—
its highest level in nearly 16 years—and
4.4 million Americans have become homeowners in the last four years, including
record numbers of minorities.

A similar program at the Department of
Housing and Urban Development (HUD), the
Community Empowerment Banking Initiative,
also helps economically distressed neighborhoods establish financial institutions. Through
a competitive process, the cities of Washington
and Baltimore, and a six-county area in
rural Mississippi, received funding for empowerment banks in 1997. These recipients will
use $20 million as seed money and try
to leverage much larger investments from
conventional banks, foundations, non-profit
groups, investors, and residents. Area residents and businesses will have controlling
interest in the banks by purchasing affordably
priced stock.
Finally, the budget proposed $100 million
in non-refundable tax credits that the CDFI
Fund would allocate among equity investors
in community development banks and venture
capital funds. Investors could take the credit—
up to 25 percent of their investments—
in the year they invest. This initiative should
help leverage over $1 billion of private investment in distressed urban and rural communities.
Federal Relationship With Communities
The Administration has worked to give
communities the flexible tools they need to
develop affordable housing and revitalize their
economies.
Hoping to reverse a decline in the rate
of homeownership, for instance, the Administration in 1994 entered into an unprecedented
partnership with 58 key public and private

For housing programs in general, HUD
has focused on initiatives that ‘‘build from
the ground up’’—giving communities the power
and responsibility to assess their housing
and economic development needs, and to
tailor their responses accordingly. HUD has
paid particular attention to streamlining and
simplifying Federal requirements in exchange
for demanding a higher level of performance.
In addition, the Administration has worked
closely with Congress to advance the most
profound changes to public housing in over
a generation. This effort reflects HUD’s fourpart transformation agenda:
• Replace the most dilapidated, distressed
developments with smaller-scale, affordable housing and portable housing vouchers;
• Restore management excellence to housing
agencies that are systematically troubled;
• Provide incentives for tenants to become
self sufficient by rewarding work, and connecting them to educational and employment opportunities; and
• Place conditions on public housing residency through tougher occupancy and eviction rules.
The budget builds on the progress to date
by supporting efforts to demolish 54,000 of
the worst public housing units in the next
three years and, rather than operate or
modernize those units, provide portable sub-

100

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

sidies to residents and construct a limited
amount of mixed-income housing. Portable
subsidies, now held by nearly 1.5 million
households, give recipients a greater range
of housing and neighborhood choices, reducing
the isolation of poor families and the concentration of poverty (see Chart 6–2).
But, because their needs can be so different,
no single approach will help both urban
and rural communities. Nor, in fact, will
any single approach help all rural areas.
The Administration had proposed giving
States, localities, and Tribes more flexibility
in how they use the community and economic
development assistance they receive from the
Agriculture Department (USDA). In last year’s
Farm Bill, Congress adopted the proposal
as part of the new Rural Community Advancement Program (RCAP), thus combining 12
separate USDA programs into Performance
Partnerships in which the Federal Government
provides more flexibility in exchange for requiring more accountability for how the money

is spent. The budget proposes $689 million
for the RCAP, which also would give States
block grants for rural community and economic
development.
Government-to-Government Commitment
to Native Americans
The Administration continues to strengthen
the Government-to-government relationship
with Native Americans.
In the past year, the Administration proposed steps to advance and protect Tribal
interests; negotiated an historic settlement
to the century-old land dispute between Navajos and Hopis; and fought attempts to cut
Tribal funding and undermine Tribal sovereignty. For 1998, the budget proposes $6.5
billion, six percent more than in 1997, for
Government-wide programs that address basic
Tribal needs and encourage self-determination
(see Table 6–1).

Chart 6-2. HOUSING VOUCHER RECIPIENTS ARE LESS LIKELY TO LIVE IN
HIGH POVERTY NEIGHBORHOODS THAN ARE RESIDENTS OF PUBLIC
HOUSING
PERCENT

47

50

40

34
30

27
19

20

13
10

18
15
11
8

6

0
LESS THAN 10%
VOUCHERS
PUBLIC HOUSING

10-20%

20-30%
TRACT POVERTY RATE

30-40%

MORE THAN 40%

6.

101

RESTORING THE AMERICAN COMMUNITY

Table 6–1.

GOVERNMENT-WIDE NATIVE AMERICAN PROGRAM
FUNDING
(Budget authority, dollar amounts in millions)
1993
Actual

1997
Estimate

1998
Proposed

Percent
Change:
1993 to
1997

Percent
Change:
1997 to
1998

BIA .....................................................................
IHS 1 ...................................................................

1,647
2,022

1,607
2,342

1,732
2,412

–2%
+16%

+8%
+3%

Subtotal, BIA/IHS .........................................

3,669

3,949

4,144

+8%

+5%

All other .............................................................

1,833

2,138

2,309

+17%

+8%

Total ..............................................................

5,502

6,087

6,453

+11%

+6%

1 IHS program level includes both budget authority and Medicaid, Medicare, and private insurance collections.

The Interior Department’s (DOI) Bureau
of Indian Affairs (BIA) and the Health and
Human Services Department’s Indian Health
Service (IHS) comprise two-thirds of Federal
funding for Native American programs. For
the BIA, the budget proposes $1.7 billion,
eight percent more than in 1997, to help
improve the living conditions on reservations,
promote Tribal self-sufficiency, and continue
to meet the Federal trust responsibility to
Native Americans. Over 90 percent of BIA
operations funding goes for basic, high-priority
reservation-level programs such as education,
social services, law enforcement, housing improvement, and natural resource management.
The budget also would enable DOI’s Office
of Special Trustee to continue to improve
the management of Indian trust funds. In
December 1996, DOI sent a report to Congress
that outlined legislative settlement options
for resolving disputed balances in Tribal
trust accounts. For any settlement, the Administration is determined to achieve fairness
and justice with respect to these accounts.
DOI will continue consulting with Tribes
on settlement options and submit a followup report to Congress this Spring.
For the IHS—whose clinical services are
often the only source of medical care available
on remote reservation lands—the budget proposes $2.4 billion, three percent more than
in 1997. Along with higher funding, IHS
and the Health Care Financing Administration

have worked together to enhance IHS’ ability
to receive Medicare and Medicaid reimbursements, thus helping to ensure that IHS
facilities provide quality medical care. The
budget also allows Tribes to continue taking
greater responsibility for managing their own
hospitals. And the budget invests in construction to replace two antiquated IHS facilities—
Ft. Defiance on the Navajo reservation and
Keams Canyon on the Hopi reservation—
thereby helping IHS provide high-quality medical services to Native Americans.
BIA and IHS will continue to promote
Tribal self-determination through local decision-making. Tribal contracting and self-governance compacting now represent half of
the BIA operations budget, and over a third
of the IHS budget. Self-governance compact
agreements, which give Tribes greater flexibility to administer Federal programs on reservations, will likely grow in number to over
70 in BIA in 1998, a 40-percent increase
from 1997, and to over 35 in IHS.
Finally, the Administration continues to
stress the spirit of consultation and recognition
of the unique status of Native Americans.
In August 1996, Tribal leaders attended the
second annual White House meeting—marking
the anniversary of President Clinton’s historic
April 1994 meeting with over 300 Tribal
leaders. At last year’s meeting, the First
Lady and three Cabinet officials highlighted
progress on improving Government-to-govern-

102
ment relations with Tribes and assisting
the Native American community. In addition,
the Administration unveiled a number of
initiatives to improve Federal programs for
Tribes.
The District of Columbia
The Nation’s capital, which should serve
as a symbol of pride to all Americans,
has fallen on hard times. It faces not only
serious budget problems, but even serious
obstacles to providing the most basic services
to its residents.
But no simple solution will do. For as
the President said recently, the District of
Columbia suffers from the ‘‘not quite’’ syndrome—‘‘not quite a State, not quite a city,
not quite independent, not quite dependent.’’
In managing its resources and performing
public functions, the District is not like
other cities, which receive assistance from
their States. In fact, the District has broad
responsibilities for what are, elsewhere in
the Nation, separate State, county, and local
functions. And while Congress has voted
to give the city a lump sum annual payment
in recent years, it has kept the payment
basically flat while imposing strict limits
on the District’s budget and taxing powers.
Clearly, the current structure does not
work. The Administration proposes to significantly re-order the relationship between the
Federal and city governments in order to
revitalize the Nation’s capital and to improve
self-government within the District. Specifically, the Administration proposes a threepart strategy to improve the city’s financial,
managerial, and economic resources.
First, the Federal Government would directly assume certain public functions in
which it has a clear interest:
• Pensions: The Federal Government would
take over the District’s pension plans for
law enforcement officers and firefighters,
teachers, and judges, thus resuming responsibility for the unfunded pension liability that it transferred to the District
in 1979. The District would transfer to the
Federal Government (or its designee) $3.3
billion in associated pension assets, leaving the Federal Government to assume the

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

$4.3 billion unfunded liability. The District
would establish new plans for its current
and future employees.
• Criminal justice: The Federal Government
would provide full funding for the District’s Court System (which would remain
self-managed), take over the District’s
Lorton prison facility and its currently
sentenced felons, and assume responsibility for incarcerating District felons in the
future who are sentenced in accordance
with Federal standards.
• Medicaid: The Federal Government would
assume the roles normally played by the
Federal and State governments under this
Federal-State program, paying 70 percent
of Medicaid spending in the District (compared to the current 50 percent share).
In exchange, the Federal Government would
end the Federal payment to the District,
which most recently was $712 million. The
Federal Government, however, would agree
to this exchange of responsibilities only if
the District took specific steps to improve
its management and performance. The Administration, the Mayor, the City Council, and
the District of Columbia Financial Assistance
Authority would enter a Memorandum of
Understanding, setting forth the District’s
obligations to meet specific criteria.
Second, the Federal Government would establish the National Capital Infrastructure
Fund (NCIF), and would provide seed money
from the Federal Highway Trust Fund to
fund it. The NCIF would fund transportation
infrastructure projects in the District to benefit
residents and commuters alike—including the
construction of local roads, bridges, and transit
facilities.
Third, the Federal Government would create
an economic development corporation (EDC)
to provide grants and tax incentives for
economic development. The EDC would craft
a strategic economic development plan for
the District, and recommend how to use
various financial incentives that the Federal
Government would provide. It would build
local economic markets, develop strategies
to link District residents to newly-created
jobs, and help the District foster regional
economic strategies.

6.

RESTORING THE AMERICAN COMMUNITY

And fourth, Federal departments and agencies would give the District more intensive
technical assistance in education and training,
housing, transportation, health care, and procurement, in order to contribute more to
the District’s success. For instance, the Internal Revenue Service would assume responsibility to collect the District’s individual income
and payroll taxes. This fourth step would
build on the Administration’s activities

103
through the President’s inter-agency Task
Force on the District of Columbia.
The President’s plan for the District of
Columbia reflects his overall goals for the
Nation. It would increase opportunity for
District residents, demand responsibility from
the District government, and build a strong
community in the Nation’s capital that all
Americans can look to with pride.

7.

IMPLEMENTING WELFARE REFORM

. . . [W]e have an historic opportunity to make welfare what it was meant to be—a second
chance, not a way of life. And even though the bill has serious flaws that are unrelated to welfare
reform, I believe we have a duty to seize the opportunity it gives us to end welfare as we know it.
President Clinton
July 31, 1996

Not long ago, America’s welfare system
was broken. It did not serve the taxpayers
or those trapped in it. And it undermined
the values of work and family.
The President made welfare reform a key
goal of his first term—reform that would
promote the basic goals of work, family,
and responsibility. When Congress twice sent
him welfare legislation that did not meet
those goals, he was forced to veto the bills.
When, however, Congress finally produced
a bill that did meet the basic goals, the
President signed it into law on August 22,
1996 as the Personal Responsibility and Work
Opportunity Reconciliation Act.
During the many months that Congress
worked to devise a good bill, the President
acted on his own. He helped States advance
the goals of welfare reform by letting them
test innovative ways to move people from
welfare to work and to protect children.
The Administration’s actions, combined with
the falling unemployment rate that a strong
economy has generated, are having an impact.
Since the President took office, welfare caseloads have fallen by 2.1 million persons—
the biggest such drop in history (see Chart
7–1).
The Administration is determined to help
States make the most of this historic welfare
reform revolution, and to hold them accountable for results. The new law gives States
and individuals unprecedented opportunities
to build a new system that rewards work,
invests in people, and demands responsibility.
Unfortunately, the law also included overly
deep budget cuts—primarily affecting nutrition
programs, legal immigrants, and children—

that are unrelated to reforming welfare. With
this budget, the President provides $18 billion
over five years to address these problems.
In the meantime, the essential long-term
task of building the new work-based system
is underway in every State.
The new welfare law has laid the groundwork for moving those who can work to
independence by focusing on tough, but realistic, work requirements. The law repealed
Aid to Families with Dependent Children
(AFDC), a 60-year-old, joint Federal-State
program, and created the time-limited, workoriented Temporary Assistance for Needy Families (TANF) program. States must now implement the new law by tailoring a reform
plan that works for their communities. The
plans must require and reward work, impose
time limits, increase child care payments,
and demand personal responsibility. By midDecember 1996, the Federal Government already had certified 21 State plans as complete.
To better enable welfare recipients to move
off, and stay off, welfare, the new law
provides additional resources for child care
and Medicaid—the health insurance program
for low-income Americans. It ensures that
low-income people do not lose Medicaid as
a result of changes to AFDC and extends
the transitional Medicaid program that provides health insurance coverage for those
leaving welfare for work.
Finally, the law gives States vast flexibility
to design welfare programs suitable to their
own needs and circumstances, but it also
holds States accountable for making welfare
reform a success. The law requires a sustained
State financial contribution, but also recog105

106

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 7-1. WELFARE ROLLS DECLINED AS THE ECONOMY IMPROVED
AND AS STATES EXPERIMENTED WITH WELFARE INNOVATIONS
PARTICIPANTS IN MILLIONS
28

FOOD STAMPS
27

26

25

AFDC
14

13

12

0
JAN-93

DEC-93

nizes that State welfare systems need an
incentive to focus on the central goal of
moving people from welfare to work. Consequently, the law provides $800 million
in performance bonuses by the year 2002
to reward States that best achieve that
goal.
Moving From Welfare to Work
To help welfare recipients move from welfare
to work, and to help communities help them
do so, the President proposes two new initiatives:
• a performance-based Welfare-To-Work
Jobs Challenge to help States and cities
create job opportunities for the hardestto-employ welfare recipients; and
• a greatly-enhanced and targeted Work Opportunity Tax Credit (WOTC) to provide
powerful new, private-sector financial incentives to create jobs for long-term welfare recipients.

NOV-94

OCT-95

SEP-96

Welfare-to-Work Jobs Challenge: The
Jobs Challenge is designed to help States and
cities move a million of the hardest-to-employ
welfare recipients into lasting jobs by the year
2000. It provides $3 billion in mandatory funding for job placement and job creation. States
and cities can use these funds to provide subsidies and other incentives to private business.
The Federal Government also will encourage
States and cities to use voucher-like arrangements to empower individuals with the tools
and choices to help them get jobs and keep
them.
Work Opportunity Tax Credit: For States
and cities, TANF and the Jobs Challenge provide new resources to create jobs and prepare
individuals for them. For employers, the budget proposes incentives to create new job opportunities for long-term welfare recipients. The
budget would first create a much-enhanced
credit that focuses on those who most need
help—long-term welfare recipients. The new
credit would let employers claim a 50-percent
credit on the first $10,000 a year of wages,

7.

107

IMPLEMENTING WELFARE REFORM

for up to two years, for workers they hire who
were long-term welfare recipients. In addition,
the budget expands the existing WOTC tax
credit by including able-bodied childless adults
aged 18 to 50 who, under the Administration’s
Food Stamp proposal, would face a more rigorous work requirement in order to continue receiving Food Stamps. These changes to the
credit would cost $552 million from 1998 to
2002.
Additional Support: The budget also proposes additional support to help move people
from welfare to work.
• Transportation: The budget proposes to expand programs that will transport thousands of welfare recipients to jobs and
training. It provides $100 million for a
new Access to Jobs and Training initiative
in the Transportation Department. The
Administration also will propose legislation to offer grants to States and local entities for new or modified transportation
services that ensure access to work for
low-income individuals, especially current
welfare recipients.
• Housing: The budget proposes $10 million
to expand the Department of Housing and
Urban Development’s (HUD) Bridges-toWork demonstration project, which links
low-income people in central cities to job
opportunities in surrounding suburbs. In
addition, HUD will award new portable
rental assistance to localities that link
their housing assistance with their efforts
to move welfare recipients to work.
• Adult Education: The budget proposes to
increase funding by more than 50 percent
over the 1996 level for basic skill, high
school equivalency, and English classes for
disadvantaged adults—helping to meet demands for literacy training stimulated by
last year’s welfare and immigration reforms.
• Community Development: The budget also
proposes to expand the Community Development Financial Institutions Fund, thereby expanding the availability of credit, investment capital, financial services, and
other development services in distressed
urban and rural communities. (For more

information about the Fund, see Chapter
6.)
Helping To Make Work Pay
Earned Income Tax Credit (EITC): As an
important component of helping people move
from welfare to work, the Federal Government
can help ensure that those who work can support their children. The EITC, a 20-year-old
Federal program, supplements earnings to
meet this goal. In 1993, the President proposed, and Congress enacted, legislation to
substantially expand the EITC, helping 40 million Americans in 15 million lower-income
working families (see Chart 7–2). The welfare
law maintains these gains for hard-working,
low-income families.
Minimum Wage: President Clinton consistently supported an increase in the minimum
wage for all low-wage earners. Before he took
office, the last increase came in 1991. Due to
inflation, the minimum wage shrank in value
by 13 percent from 1991 to 1996. As a result,
Congress responded to the President’s request
last year by raising the minimum wage from
$4.25 to $5.15 an hour over two years—in two
steps. The first step of 50 cents went into effect in October 1996; the second step of 40
cents will occur in October 1997.
This 90-cent rise means over $1,800 a
year in higher earnings for full-time, fullyear minimum wage workers, who previously
earned less than $9,000 a year. By October
1997, nearly 10 million working Americans
will have received an immediate pay raise.
Millions of other low-wage workers making
slightly more than the new minimum also
may benefit if employers raise their paychecks
in step with the minimum wage increase—
as employers have done in the past.
Protecting the Most Vulnerable
Several provisions in last year’s Personal
Responsibility and Work Opportunity Act have
nothing to do with the goals of welfare
reform—moving people from welfare to work.
Rather, they were misguided cuts in Federal
support to vulnerable populations, including
the elderly, children, and people with disabilities. To address them, the President proposes
to better protect children, people with disabil-

108

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

CHART 7-2. 1993 EXPANSION OF THE EITC HELPS 15 MILLION
LOWER-INCOME WORKING FAMILIES
EITC AMOUNT
$4,000

OBRA 1993
$3,500

$3,000
$2,500

OBRA 1990
$2,000
$1,500

TAX REFORM, 1986

$1,000

$500
$0
0

$5,000

$10,000

1996 DOLLARS

ities, legal immigrants, and those who try
to find work but cannot.
Nutrition Safety Net: Throughout its negotiations with Congress over welfare reform, the
Administration insisted on maintaining the
nutritional safety net because it provides an
essential tool to enable lower-income families
and individuals to buy food and obtain nutritious meals for their school-age children. Due
to the Administration’s efforts, Food Stamps
remains the most extensive Federal safety net
program for low-income individuals and families.
Throughout their history, the Agriculture
Department’s Food Stamp and Child Nutrition
programs have produced significant, measurable benefits in the nutrition of children
and families. Food Stamps reach almost one
in 10 Americans every month—including over
12 million children and two million elderly.
In addition, about 26 million children receive
subsidized nutritious lunches each school day.

$15,000

$20,000

$25,000

$30,000

INCOME

Another 2.5 million children a day receive
nutritious subsidized meals in child care
settings.
As the President stated clearly last summer,
Congress cut Food Stamps too deeply. Many
of these cuts have nothing to do with moving
people from welfare to work—they affect
working families with children, the elderly,
and people with disabilities.
The deep cuts disproportionately affect those
with high housing costs, especially families
with children. With these cuts, families will
see their real benefits erode over time as
living costs rise, forcing them to choose
between paying the rent and eating. The
President proposes to ameliorate these cuts
by restoring the link between benefits for
such families and housing costs. He also
proposes to raise the vehicle asset limit
for Food Stamp program participants so that
benefits do not fall when working families
and others secure a means to get to work.

7.

IMPLEMENTING WELFARE REFORM

To achieve savings, the new law also limited
Food Stamps for able-bodied childless adults
to three months of assistance in a 36month period. This time limit does not reflect
the reality that most Food Stamp recipients
face—that finding work takes time. Nearly
60 percent of all new participants in the
Food Stamp program leave within six months.
Only 13 percent of the childless adults entering the program still receive benefits after
18 months. Once they leave, most childless
adults do not return. The President proposes
to limit Food Stamps to six months out
of 12, a policy that would encourage work
while giving those out of work the transitory
help they need to get back on their feet.
The time limit also punishes those who
want to work, but who cannot find a job
at all. The budget proposes to restore Food
Stamps for those who are looking for work
but cannot find it and for whom the State
does not provide workfare or a training
opportunity. The President proposes to make
Food Stamp work requirements real by giving
States new funding to support nearly 400,000
more work slots from 1998 to 2002, and
by adding tough new sanctions for those
who are offered jobs by the State but refuse
to accept them. In addition, the budget would
allow States, at their option, to provide
funds with which employers would supplement
the wages of childless adult recipients.
Equity in Benefits for Legal Immigrants:
By specifically cutting benefits to low-income
legal immigrants as a source of savings, the
new law affected legal immigrants—many of
them children, elderly, and people with disabilities—more adversely than any other group.
The law denies most legal immigrants access
to fundamental safety net programs unless
they become citizens—even though they are in
the United States legally and are making
every effort to become productive members of
society. Many legal immigrants may face unforeseen problems before they can naturalize.
Nevertheless, the bill punishes those who have
worked, but who no longer can through no
fault of their own. It makes short-sighted cuts
by barring cash and medical assistance to immigrant children with disabilities. Finally, it
places significant new administrative burdens
on State and local service providers.

109
The President believes that legal immigrants
should have the same opportunity, and bear
the same responsibility, as other members
of society. Thus, the budget proposes to
revise the law so that legal immigrants
who become disabled after entering our country can get the basic assistance offered by
Supplemental Security Income (SSI)—as well
as by Medicaid. The Nation should protect
legal immigrants and their families—people
admitted as permanent members of the American community—when they suffer accidents
or crippling illnesses that prevent them from
earning a living. Similarly, the Nation should
provide Medicaid to legal immigrant children
if their family is impoverished. The Administration also proposes to delay the ban on
Food Stamps for legal immigrants until the
end of September 1997 in order to give
immigrants more time to naturalize.
Finally, the budget would lengthen, from
five to seven years, the exemption to the
ban against refugees and asylees receiving
Federal benefits. The Nation admits refugees
and asylees on a humanitarian basis, and
we should be sensitive to their special needs.
Many refugees and asylees may need more
time to naturalize than the law allows.
Supplemental Security Income: The SSI
program provides critical financial support to
the needy who are elderly, are blind, or who
have disabilities. The new law was designed
to target disability benefits to needy children
with the most severe limitations by changing
the general definition of childhood disability.
The Administration and Congress agree that
most children now receiving disability benefits
deserve them. In implementing the law
through regulation, the Social Security Administration will closely monitor its impact to ensure that children with the most severe disabilities retain eligibility. In addition, the
President will propose legislation to allow disabled children now receiving Medicaid to retain their coverage if they lose their SSI eligibility due to changes in the definition of childhood disability.
The Ongoing Challenge of Improving
Welfare: The Administration is committed to
working with Congress and the States to implement welfare reform effectively. Implementation will be both challenging and exciting.

110
If the Administration discovers significant impediments to successful welfare reform, such
as inadequate funding for States during recessions, we will work with Congress to address
them.
Promoting Security and Stability for
Children
The Administration proposes a new initiative to move children more quickly from

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

foster care to safe, permanent homes—with
the goal of doubling, by the year 2002,
the number of children adopted or permanently placed. It would provide incentives
to States for increasing adoption while stressing permanent placement and the safety
of children.

8.

PROMOTING TAX FAIRNESS

We should cut taxes for the family sending a child to college, for the worker returning to college, for the family saving to buy a home or for long-term health care, and [provide] a $500 perchild credit for middle-income families raising their children . . . . That is the right way to cut
taxes—pro-family, pro-education, pro-economic growth.
President Clinton
August 29, 1996

The President proposes a tax plan that
would promote a fairer tax system and encourage activities that contribute to economic
growth—in short, a plan focused on fairness
and America’s future.
The plan calls for tax cuts that would
benefit middle-class families with children,
encourage investment in higher education,
and promote long-term saving. It would benefit
millions of homeowners by ensuring that
over 99 percent of home sales are exempt
from capital gains taxes. It would provide
incentives for employers to hire economically
disadvantaged Americans, so they would benefit from wages rather than welfare. It would
provide targeted relief to promote economic
development and environmental cleanup in
distressed areas. It would give estate tax
relief to small businesses and farmers. And
it would make the tax system more equitable
for people with disabilities who are seeking
refunds.
The proposal is also fiscally responsible.
The budget fully offsets the costs of these
tax cuts by making cuts in spending and
in unnecessary corporate subsidies and other
unwarranted tax breaks.
This chapter provides an overview of the
President’s tax plan. (See Table 8–1 for
a summary of the plan.) Chapter 3 of Analytical Perspectives provides further details.
The Middle-Class Tax Cut
The President has long considered tax cuts
for middle-income Americans and small businesses a top priority. In 1993, he worked
with Congress to cut taxes for 15 million

working families by expanding the Earned
Income Tax Credit (EITC), and to help small
business by increasing ‘‘expensing’’ 1 of investment and capital gains incentives. A year
later, he proposed his Middle Class Bill
of Rights, including child tax credits, deductions for higher education, and expanded
Individual Retirement Accounts. Then in 1996,
he signed into law a number of other tax
benefits for small businesses and their employees—including even more expensing for smallbusiness investments, greater deductibility of
health insurance premiums for the self-employed, and expanded and simplified opportunities for retirement savings. Also in 1996,
the President signed into law a $5,000 tax
credit for adoption expenses ($6,000 for adopting children with special needs) and higher
limits for tax-deductible contributions by
spouses to Individual Retirement Accounts.
This year, the budget again proposes the
President’s Middle Class Bill of Rights. It
would immediately and significantly benefit
families with young children, encourage investment in post-secondary education and training,
and promote long-term saving. This year’s
tax plan also goes further—it includes more
tax incentives and relief with regard to
education and training, work opportunities,
capital gains on home sales, and the legal
limits faced by people with disabilities who
seek tax refunds.
Tax Credit for Dependent Children: The
budget proposes an income tax credit for each
dependent child under age 13, as the President
first proposed in 1994. The credit would bene1 That

is, up-front deductions.

111

112

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 8–1.

THE PRESIDENT’S TAX PLAN
(In billions of dollars)
Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Total,
1998–
2002

Provide tax relief:
Middle Class Bill of Rights:
Tax credit for dependent children .............................
–0.7
Expand individual retirement accounts .................... ..........
Incentives for education and training .......................
–0.1

–9.9
–1.5
–4.0

–6.8
–0.5
–6.2

–8.6
–0.8
–7.8

–10.4
–1.2
–8.6

–10.4
–1.7
–9.4

–46.0
–5.5
–36.1

–0.8

–15.4

–13.5

–17.2

–20.2

–21.4

–87.6

–0.1
..........
..........
–*

–0.3
–0.1
–0.1
–0.4

–0.3
–0.2
–0.1
–0.5

–0.3
–0.1
–0.2
–0.5

–0.3
–*
–0.1
–0.5

–0.2
–*
–0.1
–0.4

–1.4
–0.4
–0.6
–2.3

..........
–0.4
–*

–*
–0.8
–*

–*
–0.5
–*

–*
–0.2
–*

–*
–0.1
–*

–*
–*
–*

–*
–1.7
–*

–0.1

–0.6

–0.7

–0.8

–0.2 ..........

–2.3

–0.1
–0.1
–0.2
–*

–0.1
–0.1
–0.2
–*

–0.4
–0.3
–0.7
–0.1

–0.1

–0.1

–0.6

–* .......... .......... ..........

–0.1

Subtotal, Middle Class Bill of Rights .............
Additional targeted tax relief:
Capital gains exclusion on sale of principal residence
Extend the work opportunity tax credit for one year
Targeted welfare-to-work tax credit .............................
Tax incentives for distressed areas ..............................
Tax credit for investment in community development
institutions and venture capital funds .....................
Extend the R&E tax credit for one year ......................
Extend the orphan drug credit for one year ................
Extend the income exclusion for employer-provided
educational assistance through 2000 ........................
Extend and modify credit for corporations in U.S.
possessions ..................................................................
District of Columbia tax incentive ................................
Estate tax relief for small business ..............................
Equitable tolling .............................................................
Tax benefits to Foreign Sales Corporations for software licenses ...............................................................
Extend the deduction for contributions of appreciated
stock to private foundations for one year .................

..........
–*
–0.1
–0.1
..........
–*
–*
–0.1
..........
–*
–0.2
–0.2
.......... .......... .......... ..........
–*

–0.1

–0.1

–0.1

..........

–*

Total, Provide tax relief ........................................

–1.4

–17.9

–16.2

–19.6

–21.9

–22.8

–98.4

Eliminate unwarranted benefits ................................

0.6

4.1

6.3

7.3

7.6

8.9

34.3

Other changes affecting receipts ............................... ..........

1.0

1.1

1.1

1.2

1.1

5.5

Extension of expired excise tax provisions .............

2.4

5.8

7.5

7.5

7.7

7.8

36.2

Total proposals ...............................................................

1.6

–7.0

–1.4

–3.7

–5.5

–4.9

–22.4

* Less than $50 million.

fit about 18 million families with 34 million
dependent children. It would be phased in,
starting at $300 per child in tax years 1997
through 1999, and rising to $500 in 2000 and
beyond. It would be phased out for taxpayers
with adjusted gross incomes between $60,000
and $75,000. Starting in the year 2001, the
credit and the phase-out range would be indexed for inflation. The credit would be nonrefundable, but working families would first
deduct the child credit from their income taxes
before deducting the refundable EITC—making it easier for them to get the benefit of
both credits.

This tax cut would benefit middle-income
families; they have not enjoyed large gains
in their incomes over the past 25 years.
For a two-parent, two-child family with
$50,000 of income and $12,500 of itemized
deductions, the credit would cut taxes by
25 percent when fully in place in 2000.
In total, the credit would lower families’
taxes by $46 billion from 1998 to 2002.
HOPE Scholarships and the Education
and Job Training Tax Deduction: The
President believes that the tax system should
better encourage investment in college edu-

8.

PROMOTING TAX FAIRNESS

cation and job training. Therefore, the budget
proposes:
• HOPE scholarships, which are tuition tax
credits of up to $1,500 per year, available
for the first two years of post-secondary
education. To receive the credit in the second year, the student must maintain at
least a B average. The $1,500 amount (for
each of two years) is a per student cap.2
HOPE scholarships are modeled after a
successful program in Georgia.
• The education and job training deduction,
which would be available to families for
tuition and fees for any college, graduate
school, or qualified lifelong learning program. The deduction, which the President
first proposed in 1994, would phase up
from an annual cap of $5,000 per family
in 1997 and 1998 to $10,000 in 1999 and
beyond. It would cover tuition at any education or training program that is at least
half-time or related to a worker’s career.
Students who use the HOPE scholarships
in their first two years of schooling could
claim the tax deduction in their remaining
years of qualified education or training (although families could not claim both the
credit and the deduction for the same student at the same time).
Both the credit and the deduction would
be phased out for joint filers with incomes
between $80,000 and $100,000. For single
filers, the benefits would phase out between
$50,000 and $70,000. From 1998 through
2002, these two provisions would save taxpayers $36.1 billion.
Expanded Individual Retirement Accounts (IRAs): The budget also repeats another proposal from 1994—to expand IRAs to
provide greater incentives for long-term savings for retirement and other important purposes. Currently, for taxpayers who participate
in employer-sponsored retirement plans and
file joint returns, the tax code phases out the
availability of deductible IRAs between
$40,000 and $50,000 of adjusted gross income.
The President’s plan would double this range
over time, to $80,000 and $100,000, and double
the range for single taxpayers to between
2 The budget also would increase Pell Grant college scholarships
for low-income families who lack the tax liability to benefit from
the tax cuts.

113
$50,000 and $70,000. The plan also would
index for inflation both of these limits and the
current maximum contribution of $2,000.
In addition, the budget proposes that eligible
taxpayers be able to contribute to a ‘‘Special
IRA’’ as an alternative to a deductible IRA.
Contributions to Special IRAs would not be
tax deductible, but distributions of the contributions would be tax-free. If contributors
kept their funds in the account for at least
five years, earnings on the contributions
would be available tax-free, too. Many taxpayers would be eligible to convert deductible
IRAs to Special IRAs. Also, contributors to
both types of IRAs could, under this proposal,
withdraw funds without penalty at any time
to pay for higher education, first-time home
purchases, or expenses during a long period
of unemployment.
The greater availability of IRAs would
enable many two-earner families to cut their
taxes by up to $1,120 a year, if they make
the maximum allowable IRA contributions.
From 1998 to 2002, it would cut taxes
by an estimated $5.5 billion.
Additional Targeted Tax Incentives and
Relief
Targeted Homeownership Tax Cut: The
budget proposes to allow married taxpayers to
exclude from capital gains taxes up to
$500,000 in gains from selling a home; single
taxpayers could exclude up to $250,000. The
exclusion would replace both the one-time exclusion of $125,000, now available for taxpayers over age 55, and the deferral of capital
gains, now available when purchasing a more
expensive home.
This change would exempt over 99 percent
of home sales from capital gains taxes, and
dramatically simplify taxes and record-keeping
for over 60 million homeowners. It would
benefit, in particular, older Americans moving
to smaller homes and families moving to
lower-cost areas. Taxpayers could use the
exclusion every two years.
Work Opportunity Tax Credit: The President wants to replace welfare with work, and
to promote the hiring of the economically disadvantaged. The President and Congress last
year enacted the Work Opportunity Tax Credit

114
(WOTC) to replace the Targeted Jobs Tax
Credit. Employers can claim a tax credit of
35 percent of the first $6,000 that they pay
to members of target groups during their first
year of employment.
In August, the President also unveiled
a Welfare-to-Work initiative, with two proposals that would build on the WOTC:
• A new Welfare-to-Work Credit, targeted to
long-term welfare recipients. It would let
employers claim a 50-percent credit on the
first $10,000 of annual wages that they
pay to long-term welfare recipients for up
to two years. It would treat education and
training, health care, and dependent care
benefits as wages eligible for the credit.
• An expansion of the WOTC to include
able-bodied childless adults aged 18 to 50
who, under the Administration’s Food
Stamp proposal, would face a more rigorous work requirement in order to continue
receiving Food Stamps.
Tax Incentives to Boost Investment in
Distressed Areas: The budget proposes a
three-part strategy to increase investment in
disadvantaged areas:
• Expanded Empowerment Zones (EZs) and
Enterprise Communities (ECs): The budget
proposes a second round of competition to
designate additional EZs and ECs and provides over $1 billion in tax incentives to
these areas through 2002. Among other
things, the plan would create 20 new EZs
and 80 new ECs. The plan promises to
mobilize communities to promote business
development and create jobs. (For more information on EZs and ECs, see Chapter
6.)
• Brownfields Cleanup: The budget proposes
to allow businesses to deduct, in the year
incurred, certain costs associated with
cleaning up ‘‘brownfields’’—contaminated,
and often abandoned, industrial sites—in
economically distressed urban and rural
areas.
(For
more
information
on
brownfields, see Chapter 3.)
• Community Development Financial Institution (CDFI) Tax Credits: The budget proposes non-refundable tax credits for equity

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

investments in qualified CDFIs. (For more
information on CDFIs, see Chapter 6.)
Research and Experimentation Tax
Credit (R&E): The budget proposes to extend
the R&E tax credit for one year, from its current expiration date of May 31, 1997 to May
31, 1998. 3 It provides a credit against 20 percent of a business’s qualified research spending
above a base level. Research and experimentation contribute greatly to the Nation’s
growth in productivity, and the private sector
may under-invest in this activity in the absence of this Federal incentive.
Employer-Provided Education: The budget proposes to extend, through December 31,
2000, the income exclusion for employer-provided educational assistance that Congress recently extended through mid-1997, and to expand the exclusion to cover graduate education. The exclusion enables employees to get
additional forms of training and education benefits without facing income taxes on those benefits. Small businesses also would be able to
claim a 10-percent tax credit for providing
such benefits to their employees.
Economic Incentives for U.S. Businesses
in Puerto Rico: The budget proposes to modify Section 936 of the tax code, which allows
U.S. companies to claim a credit against the
tax they pay for income that they derive in
Puerto Rico—specifically, to extend the availability of the economic activity credit and to
allow new firms to claim it.
Estate Tax Benefits for Closely Held
Businesses: The budget proposes to ease the
burden of estate taxes on farms and other
small businesses, allowing their owners to
defer taxes on $2.5 million of value, up from
$1 million under current law. The deferred
taxes could be paid over 14 years, at a favorable interest rate. In addition, the budget
would expand the types of businesses eligible
for such treatment by making the form of business organization irrelevant. It also would cut
the administrative burden on taxpayers who
elected deferral.
3 The credit, which was first enacted in 1981, expired in mid1995. The Small Business Job Protection Act of 1996, however, reinstated the credit for the period from July 1, 1996 to May 31,
1997.

8.

PROMOTING TAX FAIRNESS

115

Equitable Tolling: The budget proposes to
extend the period during which taxpayers with
serious disabilities can file claims for refunds,
helping to ensure that such taxpayers are not
unfairly disadvantaged by the tax system.

• Clarifies the treatment of new financial
instruments that aim to exploit the different tax treatment of equity and debt,
by denying or deferring interest deductions on certain instruments that have
substantial equity features.

Unwarranted Benefits and Other
Measures

• Limits the ability of some corporations to
deduct the cost of interest associated with
purchasing tax-exempt debt.

The budget eliminates or shrinks a wide
range of tax loopholes and preferences that
are no longer warranted. Some involve highly
specialized financial and accounting techniques. Restricting them would help balance
the budget, increase the equity and efficiency
of the tax system, and keep corporations
focused on productivity and profits, rather
than on tax minimization.
For example, the plan:
• Prevents certain tax-motivated financial
manipulations, used to avoid capital gains
taxes.

• Increases the penalty for substantial understatement of taxes, to reduce incentives
for excessively aggressive tax planning by
corporations with tax liabilities of $100
million or more.
Finally, the plan extends the Airport and
Airway excise taxes, the Leaking Underground
Storage Tank excise tax, and the Hazardous
Substance Superfund excise and corporate
income taxes, through 2007. The Administration, however, will propose legislation to replace the Airport and Airway excise taxes
with fees for services that the Federal Aviation
Adminstration provides.

9.

SUPPORTING AMERICA’S GLOBAL
LEADERSHIP

The challenge before us plainly is two-fold—to seize the opportunities for more people to enjoy
peace and freedom, security and prosperity, and to move strongly and swiftly against the dangers
that change has produced.
President Clinton
September 24, 1996

This budget fully supports America’s global
leadership and advances our national goals—
protecting our vital strategic interests and
expanding the reach of democratic governance,
ensuring our influence in the international
community, promoting sustainable development and the expansion of free markets
and American exports, and responding to
new international problems and humanitarian
emergencies that can undermine our security.
Protecting America’s key strategic interests
remains a timeless goal of our diplomacy.
As we move toward the 21st Century, we

Table 9–1.

have a great opportunity to expand the
scope of democracy, further ensuring that
our interests remain unthreatened. Facing
the dilemmas of peacekeeping, regional crises,
and economic change, the international community needs the United States as a leader
and a full partner, meeting its international
commitments. Advancing U.S. interests in
a global economy brings expanded missions
to our diplomacy and trade strategy. A lessorderly world also creates new challenges
to our security—from regional and ethnic
conflicts, the proliferation of weapons of mass

INTERNATIONAL DISCRETIONARY PROGRAMS
(Budget authority, dollar amounts in millions)
1993
Actual

Percent
1997
1998
2002
Change:
Estimate 1 Proposed Proposed 1993 to
1997

International development and humanitarian assistance .......................
International security assistance ........
Conduct of foreign affairs ....................
Foreign information and exchange activities ................................................
International financial programs ........
IMF programs ...................................

1,247
1,098
12,662
549
(12,063) ...............

Total, International discretionary
programs ..........................................
Total, excluding IMF programs .....

33,257
21,194

8,900
6,148
4,300

6,644
5,928
3,890

18,109
18,109

7,712
5,959
4,164

Percent
Change:
1997 to
2002

6,978
6,041
4,026

–25%
–4%
–10%

+5%
+2%
+3%

1,087
1,070
4,052
647
(3,521) ..............

–12%
–96%
NA

–3%
+18%
NA

–46%
–15%

+4%
+4%

22,974
19,453

18,762
18,762

NA = Not applicable.
1 Consistent with changes in the 1996 Farm Bill, the P.L. 480 Title I direct credit program has been reclassified from International Affairs programs to Agriculture programs starting in 1996.

117

118
destruction, international terrorism and crime,
narcotics, and environmental degradation.
With such a broad agenda for leadership,
America must not withdraw into isolationism
and protectionism or fail to provide the
resources required to carry out this mission.
The budget proposes $19.5 billion for ongoing
international affairs programs. While this
request is seven percent above the 1997
level, it constitutes only slightly over one
percent of the budget and 0.25 percent of
Gross Domestic Product.
Protecting American Security and
Promoting Democracy
The first goal of America’s international
strategy must be to promote and protect
our interests in regions that historically have
been critical to our security. The Administration’s record is encouraging. Through skilled
diplomacy, the judicious use of military force,
and carefully targeted bilateral and multilateral economic assistance, the United States
has advanced the peace process in Europe
and the Middle East, reducing threats to
our interests in these key regions. Through
diplomatic leadership, economic assistance,
and trade negotiations, we have maintained
our leadership in Asia. Our goals are to
secure these achievements, advance the peace
process, and deepen regional cooperation in
the future.
Perhaps the most serious national security
threat facing the Nation today hinges on
the course of events over the next few
years in the New Independent States (NIS)
of the former Soviet Union. We have made
substantial progress in helping encourage the
emergence of free markets and democracy
in the NIS. In particular, our relations with
Russia are strong. The United States has
provided unwavering support for the emergence of democracy in Russia, leading this
past year to the first free presidential reelection in Russian history. Some other NIS
countries are progressing more slowly toward
democracy and free markets, but overall regional progress has been remarkable.
Nevertheless, the June 1996 Russian elections represent not only a success but a
warning—the latter embodied in the large
vote for President Yeltsin’s opposition, an

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

opposition that derived its strength from
Russia’s severe economic distress. The Administration believes it is absolutely critical,
at this turning point, to demonstrate our
continuing support for democratic reform and
free markets in Russia and throughout the
NIS; the ultimate success of this process
is vital to our national security. Moreover,
we must begin to shape our assistance program in ways that support the mature trade
and investment relationship that is starting
to emerge between the United States and
the countries in this region. Thus, the budget
proposes $900 million for NIS funding, a
44-percent increase over 1997. The increase
includes a Partnership for Freedom initiative,
designed to initiate a new phase of U.S.
engagement with NIS countries focused on
trade and investment, long-term cooperative
activities, and partnerships.
The region at the heart of the Cold War
conflict—Central Europe—has made enormous
progress toward institutionalizing free markets
and democracy. It is no longer a threat
to American and European security; it is
starting to be a partner in the transatlantic
community. The economies of the Northern
tier countries, such as Poland, the Czech
Republic, and Hungary, are largely free and
privatized; they are moving from direct assistance, which soon they will no longer require,
to significant economic integration with the
United States and Western Europe. At the
same time, countries in this region are reshaping their security relationships with the West
as they move toward potential membership
in NATO.
Central European countries in the Southern
tier also have made great progress. U.S.
leadership has been critical in ending the
bloody hostilities in Bosnia, establishing new
governments through free elections, and beginning economic reconstruction. The pace of
reconciliation and recovery remains gradual,
and the need for continued American leadership is great. The other countries in the
southern part of this region also look to
the United States to remain committed to
their struggle to create democratic governments and free, open markets.

9.

SUPPORTING AMERICA’S GLOBAL LEADERSHIP

The budget proposes to increase funding
for economic assistance in Central Europe
to $492 million—including the final $200
million installment on the U.S. commitment
to Bosnian reconstruction. While programs
for the Northern tier are phasing down,
we must continue to support implementation
of the Dayton Peace Accords and to sustain
the emergence of free market democracies
in the Southern tier. In addition, the budget
seeks to increase support for foreign military
financing for the countries of Central and
Eastern Europe through the President’s Partnership for Peace initiative, which will facilitate their efforts to meet the conditions
for membership in NATO.
Our strategic interest in peace in the
Middle East is as strong as ever. The peace
process has achieved much already. The need
for reconciliation remains urgent, and America
continues to play a leadership role in the
effort to craft a durable, comprehensive regional peace. The budget proposes $5.3 billion
for military financing grants and economic
support to sustain the Middle East peace
process. The proposed increase of nearly $100
million includes $52.5 million for an initial
U.S. contribution for the Bank for Economic
Cooperation and Development in the Middle
East and North Africa, which will play a
key role in promoting regional economic integration. The budget also provides additional
security assistance to Jordan, recognizing that
country’s needs and its important contribution
to the peace process.
The rest of our economic and security
assistance programs are designed to support
peace and democracy in countries and regions
where our leadership has helped those processes emerge: consolidating democratic gains
in Haiti; supporting reconciliation and peace
in Guatemala and Cambodia; and strengthening the capacity of African governments to
provide regional peacekeeping on that troubled
continent.
Ensuring America’s Leadership in the
International Community
Following World War II, the United States
assumed a unique leadership role in building
international institutions to bring the world’s
nations together to meet mutual security

119
and economic needs. It took an alliance
to win the war, and it clearly would take
an alliance to ensure the peace. We sponsored
and provided significant funding for the United
Nations, the International Monetary Fund,
and the World Bank, along with specialized
and regional security and financial institutions
that became the foundation of international
cooperation during the Cold War.
To ensure financial stability for this international community, the members of many
of these organizations entered into treaties
or similar instruments committing them to
pay shares (or ‘‘assessments’’) of the organizations’ budgets. Congress ratified these agreements, making them binding on us. For
international financial institutions, like the
World Bank and its regional partners, the
United States has made firm commitments
to regular replenishments, subject to the
congressional authorization and appropriations
processes.
Now, America’s leadership in this international institutional network is threatened.
In recent years, Congress has not fully appropriated the funds needed to meet the treatybound assessments of international organizations or our commitments to the multilateral
banks. As a result, U.S. arrears now total
over $1 billion to the United Nations and
other organizations, much of it for peacekeeping operations, and over $850 million to
financial institutions. Congress has raised
some legitimate concerns about how these
organizations operate, but America’s failure
to meet its obligations has undercut our
efforts to achieve reforms on which the Administration and Congress agree. Today, our
ability to lead, especially in the process
of institutional reform, is being seriously
undermined.
The Administration believes that we must
end the stalemate this year—and that we
can do so consistent with our goal of institutional reform. With new leadership in the
United Nations, we have a unique opportunity.
The budget proposes to fully fund the 1998
assessments for the United Nations, affiliated
organizations, and peacekeeping, and to pay
$100 million of our arrears. It also seeks
a one-time, $921 million advance appropriation
for the balance of U.N. and related organiza-

120
tion arrears, to become available in 1999.
The release of these appropriated arrears
would depend on the adoption of a series
of reforms in the coming year, specific to
each organization, that should reduce the
annual amount that we must pay these
organizations, starting with their next biennial
budgets. These reforms would include a reduction in the U.S. share of organizational
budgets, management reforms yielding lower
organizational budgets, and the elimination
of, or U.S. withdrawal from, low-priority
programs and organizations.
The Administration wants to work closely
with Congress to shape this package, lowering
out-year funding requirements while maintaining strong U.S. leadership in organizations
and programs important to our national interests. Enacting the advance appropriation is
an essential step in achieving these objectives.
It would show that we recognize our legal
obligations and are determined to maintain
the sanctity of our treaty commitments as
we press for changes in the organizations.
It would give us the leverage to mobilize
support from other nations for the reforms
we seek and for the lowering of our future
assessments. Failure to arrive at an agreedupon solution this year will put U.S. international leadership at risk in the next century.
We are equally committed to restoring
our leadership in, and reforming, the multilateral development banks (MDBs). Our commitments to them represent America’s full-faith
pledge. Moreover, the MDBs already have
undertaken significant reforms in response
to Administration and congressional concerns,
including cuts in administrative expenses.
The budget would eliminate our arrears over
the next three years while meeting ongoing
commitments that were negotiated down by
40 percent from previous funding agreements.
The budget also includes funds to eliminate
all arrears to the World Bank’s International
Development Association affiliate that lends
to the world’s poorest countries, many of
them in Africa. Future budgets would seek
to eliminate all of the arrears, while continuing our success in lowering the level of
future U.S. commitments.
Our leadership in international institutions
also has been critical in preventing inter-

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

national financial crises. As the Mexican
peso crisis demonstrated, the increased interdependence of our trading and monetary
systems means that a monetary crisis in
any major trading nation affects all nations.
Consequently, the G-10 nations and a number
of other current and emerging economic powers have negotiated the New Arrangements
to Borrow (NAB), in order to provide a
credit line for the International Monetary
Fund (IMF) in cases when a monetary crises
in any country could threaten the stability
of the international monetary system. The
budget proposes a one-time appropriation of
$3.5 billion in budget authority for the U.S.
share, but it will not count as an outlay
or increase the deficit; the United States
will receive an increase in its international
reserve assets that corresponds to any transfer
to the IMF under the NAB.
Promoting an Open Trading System
The Administration remains committed to
opening global markets and integrating the
global economic system, which has become
a key element of continuing economic prosperity here at home. Achieving this goal is
increasingly central to our global diplomatic
activities.
We are helping to lay the groundwork
for sustained, non-inflationary growth into
the next century by implementing the North
American Free Trade Agreement and the
multilateral trade agreements concluded during the Uruguay Round. We are conducting
a vigorous follow-up to ensure that we receive
the full benefit of these agreements. At
the December 1996 World Trade Organization
ministerial meeting in Singapore, for example,
negotiators reached agreement on lowering
many of the remaining barriers to trade
in information technology, which will significantly benefit U.S. firms and workers. We
are finalizing our anti-dumping and countervailing duty regulations, which implement
commitments made in the Uruguay Round.
To promote other, mutually-beneficial trade
relationships, the Administration will propose
legislation for ‘‘fast-track’’ authority to nego-

9.

121

SUPPORTING AMERICA’S GLOBAL LEADERSHIP

tiate greater trade liberalization.1 It also
will propose to extend the authorization of
the Generalized System of Preferences for
developing countries beyond its current expiration date of May 31, 1997 and to give
the eligible countries of the Caribbean Basin
Initiative expanded trade benefits.
We are more closely integrating the Government’s trade promotion activities through the
Trade Promotion Coordinating Committee
(TPCC), creating a synergy among agency
trade programs that will significantly improve
American business’ ability to win contracts
overseas, and creating export-related jobs at
home. The budget puts a high priority on
programs that help U.S. exporters meet foreign
competition, and TPCC agencies are developing rigorous performance measures to help
ensure that programs in this area are effective.
As discussed earlier in this chapter, U.S.
assistance is important in encouraging the
emergence of free market economies in Central
Europe and the NIS, where our programs
increasingly focus on facilitating a mature
trade and investment relationship with the
United States.
Over time, our bilateral development assistance, provided through the U.S. Agency for
International Development (USAID), likewise
promotes the emergence of growing market
economies in developing countries by supporting market-friendly policies and key institutions. Economic growth and market-oriented
policy reforms in the developing world create
growing demand for U.S. goods and services
as well as investment opportunities for U.S.
businesses. On a larger scale, the multilateral
development banks also promote economic
growth and increased demand for our exports.
The budget proposes that our bilateral development assistance and contributions to the
multilateral development banks grow by 25
percent—from $2.6 billion to $3.3 billion.
Three smaller agencies provide U.S. Government financial support for American exports.
The Export-Import Bank is a principal source
of export assistance, offering loans, loan guarantees, and insurance for exports, primarily
of capital goods. To assure that its programs
1 Fast track is a procedure designed to expedite congressional approval of trade agreements between the United States and other
nations.

operate as economically as possible, the Bank
is considering raising some fees, thereby
lowering net spending in 1998 while maintaining a strong overall level of export support.
The Overseas Private Investment Corporation
(OPIC) provides political risk insurance for,
and finances, U.S. investment in developing
countries, leading to greater U.S. exports.
The budget proposes to maintain 1998 OPIC
funding close to the 1997 level. The Trade
and Development Agency (TDA) makes grants
for feasibility studies of capital projects
abroad; subsequent implementation of these
projects can generate exports of U.S. goods
and services. The budget increases funding
for TDA over the 1997 level. With the
new emphasis on trade and investment in
the NIS, the Export-Import Bank, OPIC,
and TDA may well become important channels
for further funding directed at this region.
Along with the Government’s financial support for U.S. exports, the Commerce Department’s International Trade Administration
(ITA) promotes U.S. trade through its network
of Export Assistance Centers and overseas
offices. These centers and offices provide
export counseling to the American sector.
The budget proposes a slight increase for
ITA compared to 1997.
Leading the Response to New
International Challenges
Another fundamental goal of our international leadership, and an increasing focus
of our diplomacy, is meeting the new
transnational threats to U.S. and global security—the proliferation of weapons of mass
destruction, drug trafficking and the spread
of crime and terrorism on an international
scale, unrestrained population growth, and
environmental degradation. We also must
sustain our leadership in meeting the continuing challenge of refugee flows and natural
and human-made disasters.
In 1997, the Administration will seek Senate
ratification of the Comprehensive Test Ban
Treaty and the Chemical Weapons Convention,
both critical to our long-term security and
to preventing the spread of weapons of mass
destruction. The budget supports the implementation of these agreements. U.S. diplomacy
and law enforcement activities are playing

122
a key role in preventing the spread of
such weapons to outlaw states such as Libya,
Iraq, Iran, Syria, and North Korea. The
Defense Department’s Nunn-Lugar program
and the State Department’s Nonproliferation
and Disarmament Fund help support these
efforts. (For more information on the NunnLugar program, see Chapter 10.) In addition,
U.S. support for such organizations as the
International Atomic Energy Agency and the
Korean Peninsula Energy Development Organization is critical to meeting our non-proliferation goals.
U.S. bilateral assistance programs are also
critical
to
tackling
other
important
transnational problems. Our international
counter-narcotics efforts are making real
progress in drug-producing countries. After
several years of deeply cutting the Administration’s budget requests for counter-narcotics
purposes, Congress provided the full requested
amount for 1997, permitting the United States
to intensify its efforts to curb cocaine production in the Andean countries by offering
growers attractive economic alternatives. The
budget proposes $230 million for the State
Department’s narcotics and anti-crime programs, eight percent more than in 1997,
with most of the increase focussed on programs in Peru.
In addition, USAID development assistance
and U.S. contributions to international efforts,
such as the Global Environment Facility,
support large and successful programs to
improve the environment and reduce population growth. The United States is the
recognized world leader in promoting safe
and effective family planning projects.
Disasters, humanitarian crises, and refugee
flows are certain to remain central challenges
to our leadership. The budget continues our
historically strong commitment to refugee
and disaster relief, proposing $1.7 billion,
which sustains these programs at the 1997
level. This assistance, which reflects the humanitarian spirit of all Americans, has long
enjoyed bipartisan support.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Conducting Foreign Affairs
An effective American diplomacy is the
critical foundation for meeting our foreign
policy goals. The budget supports a strong
U.S. presence at over 250 embassies and
other posts overseas, promoting U.S. interests
abroad and protecting and serving Americans
by providing consular services. These activities
include the basic work of diplomacy—the
reporting, analysis, and negotiations that often
go unnoticed but that allow us to anticipate
and prevent threats to our national security
as well as discover new opportunities to
promote American interests. The budget proposes $2.7 billion for the State Department
to maintain its worldwide operations, modernize its information technology and communications systems, and accommodate security and
facility requirements at posts abroad.
The budget also proposes two significant
innovations in State Department management.
• One would make about $600 million in immigration, passport, and other fees, which
now go to the Treasury Department, available to finance State Department operations directly. Improvements in how
these State Department operations perform will, thus, be directly linked to the
receipts they generate.
• The other innovation restructures the
management of the diplomatic platform to
support the overseas activities of other
Federal agencies. This reform recognizes
the magnitude of the State Department’s
overseas administrative workload, the
need to carry it out efficiently, and the
need to allocate the costs of overseas support fairly among agencies. With approval
of the President’s Management Council,
the various agencies represented abroad
have designed a new overseas administrative arrangement—the International Cooperative Administrative Support Services
program. The Administration will propose
to fund this new arrangement in a budget
amendment that it will send to Congress
shortly after transmitting the budget.

10. SUPPORTING THE WORLD’S
STRONGEST MILITARY FORCE
I want America to enter the 21st Century as the world’s strongest force for peace, freedom and
prosperity.
President Clinton
October 1996

Our defense capability sustains America’s
global leadership and provides the backbone
of our national security policy, safeguarding
America’s interests, deterring conflict, and
securing the peace, where necessary.
• When America’s diplomatic leadership
helped achieve the Dayton Peace Accord,
our military led the effort that has
brought a year of peace in Bosnia. With
our NATO, central European, and Russian
partners, our military continues to secure
the Bosnian accord.
• America’s armed forces remain in the Persian Gulf, deterring war in that critical
region of the world.
• In Asia and the Pacific region, U.S. military forces provide the critical foundation
for peace, security, and stability, in partnership with Japan and other nations.
• In our own region, America’s soldiers have
supported the return of democracy in Haiti
and helped end the exodus of refugees to
our shores.
To fulfill such missions, support our allies,
and reassure our friends that America is
prepared to use force in defense of our
common interests, our armed forces must
be highly ready and armed with the best
equipment that technology can provide. In
the 21st Century, we also must be prepared
and trained for new post-Cold War threats
to American security, such as ethnic and

required conflicts that undermine stability.
Some of these post-Cold War threats, such
as the proliferation of weapons of mass
destruction, terrorism, and drug trafficking,
know no national borders and can directly
threaten our free and open society.
Sustaining a Strong Military Capability
The United States is the only nation with
the logistics, mobility, intelligence, and communications capabilities required to conduct
large-scale, effective military operations on
a global scale. Coupled with our unique
position as the security partner of choice
in many regions, America’s military capability
provides a foundation for regional stability
through mutually beneficial partnerships.
The budget continues to support the defense
policy laid out by the Administration over
the past four years—to sustain and modernize
the world’s strongest and most ready military
force, a force capable of prevailing in two
nearly simultaneous regional conflicts. It fully
funds our commitment to maintain the highest
levels of training and readiness for that
force, and to equip our uniformed men and
women with the most advanced technologies
in the world (see Table 10–1). The Quadrennial Defense Review, now underway in the
Department of Defense (DOD), will ensure
that the armed forces are shaped, trained,
and armed for emerging threats and missions,
and remain capable of global military operations in the next century.

123

124

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 10–1.

MILITARY FORCE TRENDS
Cold War
(1990)

1998

Force Target

Army:
Divisions (active/National Guard) ...........................

18/10

10/8 1

10/8 1

Air Force:
Fighter wing (active/reserve) ...................................

24/12

13/7

13/7

Navy:
Aircraft carriers (active/training) ............................
Air wings (active/reserve) ........................................
Total battle force ships 2 ..........................................

15/1
13/2
546

11/1
10/1
346

11/1
10/1
330–346

Marine Corps:
Divisions (active/reserve) .........................................
Wings (active/reserve) ..............................................

3/1
3/1

3/1
3/1

3/1
3/1

Strategic nuclear forces:
Intercontinental ballistic missiles/warheads ..........
Ballistic missile submarines ....................................
Sea-launched ballistic missiles/warheads ..............

1,000/2,450
31
568/4,864

550/2,000
18
432/3,456

Heavy bombers .........................................................

324

87 4

500/500 3
14 3
336/not
over 1,750 3
92 4

Military personnel:
Active .........................................................................
Selected reserve ........................................................

2,069,000
1,128,000

1,431,000
892,000

1,422,000
889,000

1 Plus

15 enhanced readiness brigades.
active and reserve ships of the following types: aircraft carriers, surface combatants, submarines, amphibious warfare ships, mine warfare ships and combat logistics force and other support ships.
3 Upon entry-into-force of START II.
4 Does not include 95 B-1 bombers dedicated to conventional missions.
2 Includes

Providing the Necessary Funding
For the Defense Department’s military functions, the budget proposes discretionary funding of $251.6 billion in budget authority
and $248.4 billion in outlays for 1998. Through
2002, the budget continues the Administration’s plan of the last four years, completing
the careful resizing of our military forces,
ensuring full support for military readiness
and quality of life programs in the nearterm, and providing for the modernization
of our forces as new technologies become
available later in this decade and after the
turn of the century.
DOD funding keeps pace with inflation
in 1999, and then increases slightly faster
than inflation through 2002. Over this period,
the budget reflects the impact of marginally
lower estimates of inflation, offset by increases
in procurement programs necessary to ensure

the continued modernization of our military
forces.
The budget also proposes $2 billion in
1997 emergency supplemental appropriations
to fund continuing operations in Bosnia and
Southwest Asia, and a $4.8 billion rescission
of 1997 defense resources to offset the cost
of the supplemental and other funding requirements.
Ensuring the Nation’s Security
Expanding Arms Control.—The President
is strongly committed to reducing the threat
of weapons of mass destruction through arms
control agreements. Over the past four years,
the Administration has worked hard to implement the START I treaty, indefinitely and unconditionally extend the Nuclear Nonproliferation Treaty, obtain the signing of the Comprehensive Test Ban Treaty (CTBT), and

10.

SUPPORTING THE WORLD’S STRONGEST MILITARY FORCE

achieve a Conventional Forces in Europe
(CFE) Flank Agreement and terms of reference
for follow-on CFE adaptation. The START II
treaty, which the Senate approved 87 to 4 on
January 26, 1996, awaits approval by the Russian Republic. Following Russian acceptance,
implementing this treaty in combination with
START I will reduce the number of warheads
deployed on long-range missiles and bombers
to a third of the Cold War level and will eliminate all land-based, multiple-warhead ICBMs.
Securing the Senate’s support of the Chemical Weapons Convention (CWC) is one of
the President’s top legislative priorities for
this year. It is vital to national security
for the United States to be an original
party to this landmark agreement, which
will become effective on April 29, 1997.
The CWC will dramatically reduce the chemical threat to U.S. servicemembers and civilians
by requiring parties to eliminate existing
stockpiles and restricting the flow of dualuse chemicals that can be used to make
chemical weapons. Furthermore, a global ban
on the use, production, stockpiling, and transfer of anti-personnel landmines remains a
Presidential priority.
Reducing Weapons of Mass Destruction
in the Former Soviet Union.—The Cooperative Threat Reduction program (also called the
Nunn-Lugar program) has made a major contribution to U.S. security by ensuring a safe
and speedy relocation and dismantling of nuclear forces in the former Soviet Union. The
budget proposes $382 million to continue this
important program in 1998.
Countering Proliferation of Weapons of
Mass Destruction.—The budget also proposes
almost $600 million to develop capabilities to
locate and neutralize weapons of mass destruction before they can be used, and to protect
our troops against their effects. High-priority
efforts include developing the means to identify and destroy underground storage sites,
and methods to detect and track weapons shipments. Key efforts to protect troops against
chemical and biological agents include developing advanced detection devices, vaccines, and
protective clothing.
Maintaining the Nation’s Nuclear Deterrent: The budget proposes $5.1 billion in 1998,
and $20.1 billion over the next five years, for

125

the Department of Energy (DOE) to ensure
the safety and reliability of our nuclear weapons stockpile. The $20.1 billion reflects the
President’s commitment to $4 billion a year
for five years. The year-to-year stream in the
budget reflects full ‘‘up-front funding’’ for
major construction projects, which allocates a
larger share of the total cost to 1998 and lower
costs to later years. DOE will continue building new facilities to ensure safety and reliability without underground testing. The President is committed to the CTBT, which would
prohibit all nuclear testing and which he
signed in September at the United Nations.
The Administration plans to submit the treaty
to the Senate for ratification.
Developing and Deploying Defenses
Against Tactical Ballistic Missiles.—With
over $2 billion in proposed funding for 1998,
the Administration’s Theater Missile Defense
(TMD) program will provide defenses against
missiles that directly threaten American and
allied ground, naval, and air forces deployed
abroad. Funding for TMD supports initial procurement of an advanced version of the Patriot
missile, as well as development of advanced
systems to meet future threats.
Developing Technologies to Defend
Against Strategic Ballistic Missiles.—The
budget proposes $0.5 billion in 1998 for a vigorous effort to develop the elements of a national missile defense system to protect the
United States. Although we do not need such
a system now, the development of a contingency capability will ensure that deployment
could proceed rapidly, if a missile threat to
the United States should emerge sooner than
our intelligence community now estimates. A
decision now to force early deployment would
not only waste billions of dollars, it would force
adoption of immature technologies that are unlikely to provide an effective defense.
Ensuring Successful Contingency Operations.—U.S. forces have provided leadership
in contingency operations that support American interests—from monitoring U.N. sanctions
on Iraq, to permitting the return of democracy
to Haiti, to implementing the Dayton Peace
Accord in Bosnia. The budget funds ongoing
contingency operations in Southwest Asia and
Bosnia. Congressional approval of these funds
would allow DOD to avoid redirecting funds

126
from operations and maintenance programs to
these operations, thereby maintaining our
force’s high level of readiness.
Though Congress provided funding for contingency operations in 1997, unfunded 1997
costs (mainly for Bosnia) total about $2
billion. To fund them, the budget proposes
a 1997 emergency supplemental appropriation.
The budget also proposes $2.2 billion for
the cost of contingency operations in 1998.
Of the $2.2 billion, $0.7 billion is included
in the Services’ operation and maintenance
accounts for ongoing operations in Southwest
Asia, and the remaining $1.5 billion is included in the Overseas Contingency Operations Transfer Account for operations in
Bosnia.
Providing Humanitarian and Disaster
Assistance.—The unique capabilities and
global presence of U.S. forces often dictate that
DOD respond to international disasters and
human tragedies. Such responses may occur
at the direction of U.S. commanders who have
the only assets in place to respond quickly to
a regional problem, or at the President’s direction when he determines that DOD is the appropriate agency to provide U.S. support. The
proposed $80 million for the Overseas Humanitarian, Disaster, and Civic Aid account would
allow DOD to provide support without diverting readiness-related resources from their intended use.
Establishing Information Dominance.—
Our preeminence in information technology
has helped us field the world’s strongest military force. The Administration seeks to preserve information dominance in order to support our military operations and national security strategy.
Intelligence is critical to information dominance, and it continues to play a large
role in both military operations and national
security decision-making. This year’s intelligence budget is guided by explicit intelligence
priorities that the President established for
the post-Cold War era.
A new intelligence initiative exemplifies
the Administration’s efforts. The National
Reconnaissance Office will develop a new
generation of smaller intelligence satellites
that will increase coverage and permit greater

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

operational flexibility. Also, this budget is
the first to provide funds for the newly
established National Imagery and Mapping
Agency (NIMA), which will consolidate disparate imagery processing and mapping activities
throughout DOD and the Central Intelligence
Agency. NIMA will more efficiently use imagery resources and ensure that imagery
products are more responsive to military
commanders and civilian decision-makers.
Maintaining Military Readiness
Ensuring Adequate Resources for Readiness.—Maintaining the readiness and sustainability of U.S. military forces remains the
Administration’s top defense priority. The
budget provides full funding for operations and
support programs critical to sustaining the
military’s current high readiness levels. These
programs include unit training activities, recruiting and retention programs, joint exercises, and equipment maintenance.
DOD continues to improve its capacity
to assess current and future military readiness, particularly through the Senior Readiness Oversight Council and the Joint Monthly
Readiness Review process. These efforts enhance DOD’s ability to ensure that critical
readiness programs receive sufficient resources
and that our forces remain prepared to
accomplish their missions.
Enhancing Quality of Life of Military
Personnel.—The Administration strongly supports quality of life programs that help attract
and retain motivated and enthusiastic highquality personnel. The budget continues this
commitment by providing a 2.8 percent military pay raise, effective January 1998, and
substantial funding to continue upgrading and
improving barracks and family housing.
Protecting our Forces and Combating
Terrorism.—The protection of U.S. service
members, whether deployed or at home,
against the threat of terrorism is a fundamental task of our defense planning. The terrorist
attack against U.S. forces at Khobar Towers
in Saudi Arabia reminded all Americans of the
increasing terrorist threat that we face—at
home and abroad. In light of the threat, the
Administration amended the 1997 budget to
propose $1 billion for anti-terrorism programs
across the Federal Government, which Con-

10.

SUPPORTING THE WORLD’S STRONGEST MILITARY FORCE

gress approved. The DOD portion, $350 million, consisted of specific Persian Gulf security
measures; general overseas facilities and force
protection upgrades; and training, awareness,
and other programs designed to combat terrorism.
The budget fully funds DOD’s anti-terrorism/
force protection program at $4.5 billion. The
funds are designed to improve our preparedness to respond to a terrorist attack that
employs weapons of mass destruction, and
they will enable DOD to initiate a sweeping
vulnerability assessment program to identify
and respond to force protection needs beyond
those already identified and funded.
Modernizing Our Military Forces
Modernizing Equipment.—As the armed
forces prepare to enter the 21st Century, modernizing U.S. military hardware is a central
goal of our defense budget planning. The next
generation of military equipment promises to
provide greater combat capabilities, and enhance the readiness of our forces. Most important, the marked technological advantage of
the next generation will mean fewer casualties
and a quicker resolution of conflict.
Providing
Adequate
Modernization
Funding.—The budget proposes that procurement funding grow, in real terms, by over 40
percent from 1998 to 2002. Critical modernization programs that are now in production
would continue—including DDG-51 guidedmissile destroyers and precision munitions
such as the Joint Standoff Weapon. Low-rate
production of Marine Corps V-22 aircraft and
the Navy’s multi-role F/A-18E/F fighter would
continue in 1998. Initial procurement of the
Navy’s New Attack Submarine would begin in
1998, and low-rate production of the Air
Force’s F-22 Advanced Tactical Fighter would
begin in 1999. Full-rate production of the V22, F/A-18E/F, and the F-22 would start at,
or near, the turn of the century. DOD would
modernize and improve U.S. mobility forces
through continued acquisition of large, medium speed roll-on/roll-off sealift ships and the
highly capable C-17 strategic airlift aircraft.
Providing Modernization for the LongTerm.—The budget proposes major investments in research and development for advanced systems that would enter production

127

in the middle of the next decade. The Air
Force, Navy, and Marine Corps are developing
a Joint Strike Fighter as a cost-effective replacement for today’s tactical fighter and attack aircraft. Other major weapons in development include the Army’s Comanche helicopter,
a new surface ship for the Navy, and an advanced amphibious-assault vehicle for the Marine Corps.
Managing Our Defense Resources More
Efficiently
As we shape U.S. defense strategy for
managing conflict and ensuring peace in
the post-Cold War era, the Nation also must
develop new, innovative approaches to managing our defense program. DOD is launching
various efforts to meet this challenge, which
would help ensure that we can afford our
defense program.
Redesigning Military Strategy.—As the
1997 Defense Authorization Act requires, the
Quadrennial Defense Review will reassess current defense strategy and the defense program
in light of U.S. interests, fiscal constraints,
and emerging new technologies. Areas that it
will review include force structure, readiness,
modernization, and infrastructure. The law requires that DOD report the results of this review by May 15, 1997.
Implementing the Information Technology
Management
Reform
Act
(ITMRA).—By implementing ITMRA, DOD
will bring modern command, control, communications, and computing systems into operational use. DOD is restructuring work processes and applying modern technology to improve performance and cut costs. In addition,
DOD’s new Chief Information Officer is establishing information technology investment criteria and performance measures to ensure that
DOD’s $10 billion investment in information
technology and processes produces measurable
results and a significant return on investment.
For example, DOD’s Office of Health Affairs
and the Defense Logistics Agency have used
information technology to enable them to work
with commercial suppliers to significantly reduce supply delivery times and on-hand DOD
stocks, thus greatly cutting costs.

128
Implementing Base Closure and Realignment.—Since 1988, four Base Closure
and Realignment Commissions have approved
the elimination of about 20 percent of our defense infrastructure (recommending the closure of 97 out of 495 major military installations and over 200 smaller installations). The
$5.6 billion in projected annual savings (after
all closure activities are completed by 2001)
would help fund the modernization of our military forces. To achieve these savings, the budget fully funds the implementation of the final
recommendations of the 1995 Base Closure
and Realignment Commission.
Improving Financial Management.—The
Administration remains committed to reforming DOD’s financial management activities and
systems. DOD must overcome major impediments to create an effective agency-wide accounting system structure and to produce
auditable financial statements. It has, however, taken steps to improve its financial management in such areas as problem disbursements, contractor overpayments, fraud detection and controls, and standardized accounting
systems. For example, DOD has cut the category known as problem disbursements from
a total of $51.2 billion in June 1993 to $18.1
billion in June 1996.
Streamlining the Civilian Work Force.—
DOD will continue to streamline its civilian
work force while maintaining its quality. The

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

budget reflects a cut of almost 218,000, or
about 25 percent, in DOD civilian positions
from 1993 to 1999. Consistent with the principles of the Vice President’s National Performance Review, DOD is reducing headquarters,
procurement, finance, and administrative
staffs.
Implementing the Government Performance and Results Act (GPRA).—DOD continues to incorporate performance evaluation
into its decision-making for such broad-based
programs as weapons purchases, transportation methods, and inventory control. It has
designated seven programs as demonstration
projects to provide a blueprint for full GPRA
implementation.
Using the Private Sector for Support
Functions.—To cut costs and make operations
more efficient, the Commission on Roles and
Missions of the Armed Forces recommended
that DOD increase its use of the private sector
to provide support functions. In August 1995,
the Deputy Secretary of Defense established
an Integrated Product Team for Privatization,
which now includes senior representatives
from the military departments, defense agencies, OMB, and the Secretary’s staff. Also,
DOD and OMB are working together to develop competition, outsourcing, and other
privatization initiatives by forming an interagency Senior Policy Group for Privatization.

VI. INVESTING IN THE COMMON
GOOD: THE MAJOR FUNCTIONS
OF THE FEDERAL GOVERNMENT

129

11.

OVERVIEW

The President’s determination to balance
the budget—a determination that Congress
shares—will continue to place a spotlight
on every Federal agency and program, forcing
each to justify its existence. As part of
these efforts, the President will continue
his practice of the past four years and
work with Congress to eliminate or scale
back unnecessary and lower-priority programs.
Balancing the budget goes hand-in-hand
with another of the President’s major efforts—
improving Government’s performance. In an
era of limited resources, the President wants
to make sure that the programs the Government funds do, in fact, accomplish the goals
set out for them.
Led by Vice President Gore’s National Performance Review (NPR), the Administration
has made real progress in creating a Government that, in the words of the NPR, ‘‘works
better and costs less.’’ We have eliminated
layers of bureaucracy, cut paperwork burdens,
scrapped thousands of pages of regulations
and, most important, improved service to
Government’s customers—the American people.
These efforts will continue. Federal departments and agencies are implementing the
landmark 1993 Government Performance and
Results Act, which will hold them more
accountable for what their programs achieve.

The Administration also will continue to
look for ways to provide better service. (For
a detailed discussion of the Administration’s
effort to improve performance, see Section
IV.)
All too often, however, the focus of political
debate revolves almost exclusively around
proposals for incremental change: How much
more does the President want to spend
on program X? How much less on program
Y? How do his proposals compare to what
Congress proposes to do?
Such proposals capture only a portion of
what the Federal Government does from
year to year. The base of Federal activity—
from Social Security to defense to interest
on the Federal debt—does not change much,
if at all. Nor does the base of activity
include just the estimated $1.7 trillion that
the Federal Government will spend in 1998.
The Government provides hundreds of billions
of dollars in benefits through the tax code,
and it seeks to accomplish other goals through
regulation.
If we want to continue improving performance, to ensure that taxpayers get the highquality Government they deserve, we have
to understand the full range of Federal
Government activities. This section provides
a broad overview, categorizing the activities
according to their budget ‘‘function.’’

131

132

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 11–1.

FEDERAL RESOURCES BY FUNCTION
(In billions of dollars)

Function

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

NATIONAL DEFENSE:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
265.0
263.1
266.0
269.8
275.5
282.0
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
–0.2
–0.8
–0.7
–0.7
–0.5
–0.5
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. .............. .............. .............. .............. ..............
Credit Activity:
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
0.3
*
0.2
0.5
0.8
0.8
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
2.1
2.1
2.1
2.1
2.1
2.2
INTERNATIONAL AFFAIRS:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
18.1
18.1
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
–4.8
–4.7
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. ..............
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
1.7
2.2
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
8.4
12.7
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
6.5
7.0
Proposed legislation ........................................................... ..............
*
GENERAL SCIENCE, SPACE, AND TECHNOLOGY:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
16.7
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
*
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
0.8
Proposed legislation ........................................................... ..............

23.0

20.1

19.1

18.8

289.8
–0.5
–0.2
0.8
2.2

18.8

–4.4
–4.0
–3.8
–3.7
–3.5
* .............. .............. .............. ..............
1.9
12.1

2.2
13.1

2.2
13.7

2.0
13.7

2.0
14.0

7.6
–0.8

8.2
–1.4

8.8
–1.5

9.4
–1.7

10.1
–1.8

16.6

16.4

16.4

16.2

16.2

16.2

*

*

*

*

*

*

0.9
0.4

1.5
0.8

0.8
0.5

0.8
0.2

0.8
0.1

0.8
*

4.9

4.6

4.5

4.4

–3.7
–*

–2.8
–*

–3.0
–0.1

–3.7
–1.2

1.7

2.7

1.8

1.7

2.4
–0.1

2.5
–0.1

2.5
–0.1

2.5
–0.1

22.4

22.4

21.8

21.7

21.8

1.0
0.1

0.9
0.1

0.9
0.1

0.9
0.1

0.8
0.1

*

*

*

*

*

1.7
–0.1

1.7
–0.1

1.7
–0.1

1.7
–0.1

1.7
–0.1

ENERGY:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
4.9
4.3
4.7
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
–3.1
–2.9
–2.8
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. .............. ..............
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
1.0
2.5
2.1
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
2.2
2.3
2.2
Proposed legislation ........................................................... ..............
–*
–0.1
NATURAL RESOURCES AND ENVIRONMENT:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
20.7
21.1
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
0.7
1.0
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. ..............
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
*
*
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
1.6
1.7
Proposed legislation ........................................................... ..............
–*

11.

133

OVERVIEW

Table 11–1.

FEDERAL RESOURCES BY FUNCTION—Continued
(In billions of dollars)

Function

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

AGRICULTURE:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
4.2
4.1
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
5.0
6.1
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. ..............
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
6.2
7.1
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
5.1
7.9
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
0.3
0.3
Proposed legislation ........................................................... ..............
–*

2000

2001

2002

4.0

3.9

3.9

3.9

8.2
*

7.6
*

7.2
*

6.1
*

5.9
*

8.7
8.1

8.6
8.0

8.3
8.0

7.7
8.0

7.2
8.0

0.3
–0.1

0.3
–0.1

0.4
–0.1

0.4
–0.1

0.4
–0.1

3.3

3.8

5.2

3.2

3.2

0.7
–0.7

2.5
0.1

6.9
0.3

5.7
–1.7

6.8
–1.9

5.0
161.6

1.7
161.5

1.9
163.4

2.3
166.2

2.4
169.2

195.9
0.2

204.8
0.2

213.5
0.2

222.0
0.2

229.7
0.1

13.5

14.6

14.7

15.0

15.2

2.4
*

2.3
*

2.2
*

2.0
–0.1

2.0
–0.7

0.6
0.5

0.8
0.5

0.9
0.5

0.9
0.5

0.9
0.5

1.4

1.5

1.5

1.6

1.6

9.3

10.9

8.3

7.7

7.8

7.9

0.3
0.2

–0.1
*

0.1
0.1
* ..............

0.3
–*

0.1
–*

2.3
1.5

2.5
1.9

1.9
2.1

2.1
2.1

2.2
2.2

2.1
2.0

2.7
*

2.7
0.4

2.7
0.6

2.7
0.6

2.6
0.5

2.4
0.5

42.4

46.4

47.4

48.5

49.5

50.3

10.5
–0.3

10.8
2.8

10.5
4.6

10.6
5.0

10.8
4.5

11.3
1.9

TRANSPORTATION:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
13.6
13.8
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
2.5
2.4
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. ..............
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
*
0.2
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
0.8
1.1
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
1.3
1.4

EDUCATION, TRAINING, EMPLOYMENT, AND
SOCIAL SERVICES:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
36.1
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
13.9
Proposed legislation ....................................................... ..............

1999

4.1

COMMERCE AND HOUSING CREDIT:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
3.7
2.4
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
–13.8
–11.4
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. ..............
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
1.6
8.8
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
181.3
169.0
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
182.4
188.9
Proposed legislation ........................................................... ..............
0.1

COMMUNITY AND REGIONAL DEVELOPMENT:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
11.6
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
0.3
Proposed legislation ....................................................... ..............
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
2.0
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
0.8
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
2.6
Proposed legislation ........................................................... ..............

1998

134

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 11–1.

FEDERAL RESOURCES BY FUNCTION—Continued
(In billions of dollars)

Function

1996
Actual

Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
9.1
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
19.8
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
25.2
Proposed legislation ........................................................... ..............
HEALTH:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
23.3
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
96.8
Proposed legislation ....................................................... ..............
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
*
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
0.2
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
72.7
Proposed legislation ........................................................... ..............

Estimate
1997

1999

2000

2001

2002

12.0
21.0

14.5
21.3

17.6
20.5

20.2
20.5

21.7
21.5

23.1
22.9

27.0
0.2

27.9
4.9

29.2
7.2

30.5
8.9

31.9
9.0

33.3
9.5

25.0

25.1

25.1

25.1

25.2

25.2

103.5
*

109.6
3.9

116.3
3.7

124.8
2.1

134.6
–0.2

145.1
–5.0

* .............. .............. .............. .............. ..............
0.3
0.1
* .............. .............. ..............
79.2
*

85.1
*

91.2
*

97.3
*

103.7
*

110.4
*

2.8

2.8

2.7

2.7

2.7

208.6
–4.3

228.2
–11.4

248.8
–22.2

271.1
–27.8

295.1
–34.6

26.0

32.6

36.1

38.9

40.4

41.8

197.4
0.6

203.6
2.3

212.4
2.2

222.2
2.3

225.6
1.9

235.4
2.6

0.1
*

0.1
*

84.8
0.7

86.3
11.3

MEDICARE:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
2.9
2.6
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
171.3
191.6
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. ..............
INCOME SECURITY:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
27.8
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
188.0
Proposed legislation ....................................................... ..............
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
0.1
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
*
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
83.0
Proposed legislation ........................................................... ..............

1998

87.9
7.3

89.5
9.3

91.3
11.5

93.0
12.0

3.3

3.2

3.2

3.3

398.6
–*

417.7
*

438.0
*

459.7
*

26.5

27.8

28.9

29.9

18.8

18.7

18.7

18.7

18.7

21.7
0.6

22.8
0.3

24.4
0.7

21.5
1.1

23.2
1.5

2.2
28.9

2.2
25.5

2.3
25.0

2.3
24.6

2.3
24.1

SOCIAL SECURITY:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
3.1
3.5
3.3
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
347.1
364.2
380.9
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. .............. ..............
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
22.9
24.2
25.3
VETERANS BENEFITS AND SERVICES:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority 1 .....................................
18.4
18.9
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
18.8
20.6
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. ..............
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
1.4
1.9
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
28.7
30.2

* .............. .............. ..............
*
*
*
*

11.

135

OVERVIEW

Table 11–1.

FEDERAL RESOURCES BY FUNCTION—Continued
(In billions of dollars)

Function

Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
ADMINISTRATION OF JUSTICE:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

2.8

2.9

3.1

3.3

3.5

3.7

3.9

20.7

22.8

24.4

25.2

24.4

24.8

25.5

–*

0.8

0.6

0.5

0.4

0.4

0.4

GENERAL GOVERNMENT:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
11.5
11.8
12.8
12.5
12.1
11.8
11.8
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
0.1
0.9
0.8
0.8
0.9
0.7
0.7
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. ..............
–*
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
0.4
0.5 .............. .............. .............. .............. ..............
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
46.7
48.1
49.5
50.8
52.1
53.6
55.1
Proposed legislation ........................................................... .............. ..............
*
*
*
0.1
0.1
NET INTEREST:
Spending:
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
241.1
Proposed legislation ....................................................... ..............
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................................................
1.3

247.5
–0.2

249.8
*

251.8
0.1

248.1
0.1

244.9
0.1

238.6
0.1

1.3

1.3

1.3

1.2

1.2

1.2

UNDISTRIBUTED OFFSETTING RECEIPTS:
Spending:
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................................................
–37.6
–46.5
Proposed legislation ....................................................... .............. ..............

–52.9
–2.7

–41.1
–2.4

–41.6
–4.4

–43.2
–6.9

–45.3
–22.7

FEDERAL GOVERNMENT TOTAL:
Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......................................
502.5
505.8
530.5
535.4
542.5
549.4
560.6
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law .................................................................... 1,026.0 1,080.7 1,137.9 1,205.9 1,266.5 1,312.2 1,372.0
Proposed legislation ....................................................... ..............
0.3
2.1
–2.7
–16.0
–28.7
–59.5
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................................................
23.6
37.6
37.5
36.8
40.5
40.9
41.7
Guaranteed loans ...............................................................
245.4
243.6
234.7
231.7
234.0
237.5
241.5
Notes:
Revenue estimates for proposed legislation affecting tax expenditures are not directly comparable to estimates for current law tax expenditures, because the current law estimates do not reflect behavioral effects.
* $50 million or less.
1 Proposed legislation will supplement budget authority with receipts (estimated at $0.5 billion in 1998).

12.
Table 12–1.

NATIONAL DEFENSE

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF NATIONAL
DEFENSE
(In millions of dollars)

Function 050

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority ....... 265,007 263,072 265,974 269,834 275,517 281,997
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
–208
–782
–740
–682
–542
–528
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................ ................ ................ ................ ................
Credit Activity:
Guaranteed loans ...............................
276
50
250
500
800
800
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
2,060
2,080
2,095
2,120
2,140
2,160

Through its budget, the Federal Government
in recent years has provided about $265
billion a year to defend the United States,
its citizens, and its allies, and to protect
and advance American interests around the
world. National defense programs and activities are designed to ensure that the United
States maintains strong, ready, and modern
military forces that will promote U.S. objectives in peacetime, deter and prevent war,
and successfully defend our Nation and its
interests in wartime, in conjunction with
our allies, when necessary.
Over the past half-century, our defense
program has deterred both conventional and
nuclear attack upon U.S. soil and brought
a successful end to the Cold War. Today,
the United States is the sole remaining
superpower in the world, with unique military
capabilities unsurpassed by any nation. As
the world’s best trained and best equipped
fighting force, the U.S. military continues
to provide the strength and leadership that
serves as the foundation upon which to
promote peace, freedom, and prosperity around
the globe.

2002

289,760
–514
–200
800
2,180

Again and again in the past three years,
U.S. troops have demonstrated the continued
readiness and strength required to achieve
these objectives:
• Our forces maintain a continuous presence
in the Persian Gulf, providing security for
a volatile region of the world; in 1994,
rapid deployment of additional U.S. forces
to the Persian Gulf turned back a potential Iraqi threat to Kuwait;
• With the 82nd Airborne division en route
to Haiti, we forced the Cedras regime to
relinquish power, and the peaceful introduction of U.S. forces to the island established a secure environment for the Haitian people to find freedom and re-create
a democratic government;
• Hundreds of thousands of lives in Rwanda
and Somalia were saved through U.S. humanitarian missions; and,
• By helping to enforce United Nations mandates in the former Yugoslavia and by
subsequently deploying a substantial U.S.
force under NATO command, the United
States is helping to successfully implement
the Dayton Peace Agreement.

137

138
Department of Defense
The Department of Defense (DOD) budget
provides for the pay, training, operation and
maintenance, and support of U.S. military
forces, and for the development and acquisition
of modern equipment to:
• Assure that the U.S. military remains the
world’s most ready and capable force;
• Sustain U.S. defense forces at levels sufficient to meet post-Cold War challenges;
• Give U.S. forces the military hardware
that employs the best available technologies; and
• Assure the Nation’s security by seeking
arms control agreements, reducing weapons of mass destruction while preventing
their proliferation, and combating terrorism.
To achieve these objectives, DOD supports
these capabilities:
Conventional Forces.—The Nation needs
conventional forces to deter aggression and,
when that fails, to respond to it. Funds to
support these forces cover pay and benefits for
military personnel; the purchase, operation,
and maintenance of conventional systems such
as tanks, aircraft and ships; the purchase of
ammunition and spare parts; and training.
Major acquisitions in the President’s budget
plan include combat vehicle and aircraft enhancements for the Army, such as the Abrams
tank and the Apache helicopter; ships for the
Navy, such as DDG–51 destroyers and the
New Attack Submarine; aircraft for the Air
Force, such as F–15E multi-role fighters and
a JSTARS surveillance aircraft; and the V–22
aircraft for the Marine Corps.
Mobility Forces.—Mobility forces provide
the airlift and sealift that transport military
personnel and materiel throughout the world.
They play a critical role in current U.S. defense strategy and are a vital component of
America’s response to contingencies that range
from humanitarian relief efforts to major regional conflicts. Airlift aircraft provide a flexible, rapid way to deploy forces and supplies
quickly to distant regions, while sealift ships
allow the deployment of large numbers of
heavy forces together with their fuel and supplies. The mobility program also includes

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

prepositioning of equipment and supplies at
sea or on land near the location of a potential
crisis. This allows U.S. forces that must respond rapidly to crises overseas to quickly
draw upon these prepositioned items. Major
acquisitions in this area include the C–17 strategic airlift aircraft and large medium-speed
roll on/roll off ships.
Strategic Forces.—Funding for nuclear
forces is at its lowest level in over 30 years.
Nonetheless, strategic forces are an important
component of our capability. Within treaty-imposed limits, the primary mission of strategic
forces is to deter nuclear attack against the
United States and its allies, and to convince
potential adversaries that they will never gain
a nuclear advantage against the United States.
The budget enhances land, air, and sea-based
forces by supporting service life extension programs for the Minuteman III intercontinental
ballistic missile, continued modifications to
B–2 bombers, and procurement of additional
Trident II (D–5) submarine launched ballistic
missiles.
Supporting Activities.—Supporting defense activities include research and development, communications, intelligence, training
and medical services, central supply and maintenance, and other logistics activities. The goal
of defense research and development programs
is to provide new and better weapons systems
that will be superior to the weapons of potential adversaries.
Department of Energy
The unifying mission of the Energy Department’s (DOE) defense activities is to reduce
the global nuclear danger. DOE works to
accomplish this goal by:
• Supporting and maintaining a safe, secure, reliable, and smaller nuclear weapons stockpile without nuclear testing,
within the framework of the Comprehensive Test Ban Treaty;
• Dismantling excess nuclear weapons;
• Providing technical leadership for national
and global nonproliferation efforts; and
• Reducing the environmental, safety, and
health risks from current and former facilities in the nuclear weapons complex.

12.

NATIONAL DEFENSE

Defense-Related Activities
Other activities in this function that support
national defense include programs of the:
• Coast Guard, which supports the defense
mission through training, aids to navigation, international icebreaking, equipment
maintenance, and support of the Coast
Guard Reserve;
• Federal Bureau of Investigation, which
conducts counterintelligence and surveillance activities;

139
• Maritime Administration, which helps
maintain a fleet of active, military-useful,
privately owned U.S. vessels that would
be available in times of national emergency; and the
• Selective Service System, which is initiating a Service to America program that will
give almost two million young Americans
a year the chance to volunteer for
Americorps or the Armed Services.

13.

INTERNATIONAL AFFAIRS

Table 13–1.

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF
INTERNATIONAL AFFAIRS
(In millions of dollars)

Function 150

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
18,122
18,109
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
–4,840
–4,744
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
1,674
2,150
Guaranteed loans ...............................
8,418
12,692
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
6,520
6,980
Proposed legislation ........................... ................
10

The International Affairs function, for which
the Administration proposes $23 billion for
1998, encompasses a wide range of activities
that advance American interests through diplomacy, foreign assistance, support for American exports, and the activities of international
organizations. Certain tax provisions also support American business. The conduct of foreign
relations is inherently a governmental function, which explains the need for sustained
Government activity and budgetary support.
Diplomacy
The State Department and its overseas
operations are at the heart of international
affairs activities and programs, and they
consume $2.7 billion, or 14 percent, of the
resources. These funds finance the salaries
and related operating expenses of the Foreign
Service and other Department personnel, and
the costs of overseas facilities. The Department
carries out foreign policy planning and oversight in Washington, conducts diplomacy, and
represents the United States at over 250
overseas embassies and other posts. Overseas
posts also provide administrative support to
about 25 other Federal departments and
agencies.

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

22,974

20,079

19,095

18,811

18,762

–4,433
–3,963
–3,839
–3,655
–3,487
37 ................ ................ ................ ................
1,900
12,059

2,191
13,093

2,162
13,736

2,013
13,702

2,023
14,000

7,565
–820

8,165
–1,408

8,790
–1,484

9,445
–1,674

10,125
–1,773

The major achievement of American diplomacy over the past half century was creating
and sustaining the alliances, notably NATO,
that successfully countered the Soviet bloc’s
threat to world security. More recently, diplomatic objectives include establishing viable
democracies in formerly totalitarian countries
such as in Eastern Europe and the former
Soviet Union, curbing regional instability in
areas of importance to U.S. security such
as Bosnia, promoting the American economy
through trade negotiations and the support
of U.S. businesses, and addressing transnational issues such as the environment through
multilateral and bilateral negotiations. American diplomacy also has been critical over
the past 20 years in promoting peace and
reconciliation in the Middle East. Finally,
the Department has the continuing responsibility to protect and assist U.S. citizens
abroad.
Foreign Assistance
The largest single part of international
affairs spending—$13.7 billion, or 74 percent
of the total—goes for a wide variety of
overseas assistance programs traditionally cat141

142
egorized as security assistance, development
aid, and humanitarian assistance.
Security Assistance: International Security
Assistance comes mainly through the Foreign
Military Financing program (FMF, which the
State Department oversees and the Defense
Security Assistance Agency manages) and the
Economic Support Fund (ESF, which State
oversees and the U.S. Agency for International
Development manages). Over the past 50
years, security aid helped support the military
establishments of friendly countries, mainly
around the perimeter of the Soviet Union, and
helped ease the economic strain of their defense forces. On the whole, these countries
played a critical role in containing the Soviet
Union.
The FMF program finances the transfer
of military goods and services to eligible
countries, using grant funds and a small
loan program. The ESF program provides
only grant funding. Currently, these two
programs devote an overwhelming share of
their resources to supporting the Middle
East peace process. For a number of years,
over $5 billion a year has gone for this
purpose. This funding demonstrates strong
U.S. support for the actions that regional
leaders are taking to advance the peace
process. Most of the remaining funds support
the transition of Eastern European countries
to NATO membership, the establishment of
democracy in countries such as Angola, Cambodia and Haiti, and the training of foreign
military personnel, primarily from developing
countries.
Development Assistance: Development
assistance is carried out through a range of
programs:
• The Treasury Department manages contributions to multilateral development
banks. A major portion of them support
the World Bank group of institutions,
which make development loans both at
near-market rates and on highlyconcessional terms, and which provide financing and investment insurance for private sector activity in the developing
world. Contributions also go to four regional development banks for Africa, Asia,
Europe (lending to Eastern Europe and
the New Independent States of the former

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Soviet Union), and Latin America. All but
the European bank have concessional loan
programs. Two special programs also receive U.S. contributions: the Global Environment Facility, which supports environmental activities related to development
projects; and the North American Development Bank, which was established in conjunction with the North American Free
Trade Agreement and which supports environmental projects along the U.S.-Mexican border.
• The bilateral development assistance programs of the U.S. Agency for International
Development (USAID) target five sectors:
broad-based economic growth, population
(for which the United States is the leading
donor worldwide), health, the environment, and democracy building. In recent
years, USAID has significantly restructured its program to focus on countries
most likely to adopt economic reforms, in
order to encourage free markets along
with improvements in democratic governance. USAID has developed performance
measures to help it allocate resources, and
has made major internal management reforms to improve its effectiveness and cut
costs.
• State, USAID, and other agencies (the
U.S. Information Agency, Export-Import
Bank, Peace Corps, and Overseas Private
Investment Corporation) also carry out
grant and lending programs similar to development assistance to support the transition to free market democracy in Central
Europe and the New Independent States.
Encouraging economic development has
proven a difficult task, requiring far more
time for success than policy makers assumed
in the early 1960s when they initiated many
of the current programs. Nevertheless, a
number of developing countries have shifted
from grants and highly concessional loans
to near-market rate loans, and a few countries
have graduated from the ranks of foreign
assistance recipients. Some early recipients
of U.S. bilateral assistance in East Asia
are now among the world’s most dynamic
economies, and the major Latin American
countries no longer require large-scale grant
aid.

13.

143

INTERNATIONAL AFFAIRS

Humanitarian Assistance: Humanitarian
assistance programs also encompass various
activities:
• USAID manages two food aid programs
under Public Law 480, first enacted in
1954. The agency makes humanitarian
food donations, under Title II of the law,
through U.S. voluntary agencies and the
United Nations World Food Program, and
directly to foreign governments. Depending on the circumstances each year, about
half of this program goes to disaster relief—with recent large donations in such
areas as central Africa and Bosnia—and
half to longer-term development projects.
Under Title III, USAID provides food to
governments that sell it, then use the proceeds to carry out agricultural reforms.
• State and USAID also manage funds for
refugee support and disaster assistance.
State manages humanitarian refugee relief
funding —mainly grants to international
agencies such as the United Nations High
Commissioner for Refugees and the International Committee of the Red Cross.
USAID manages the Office of Foreign Disaster Assistance, which provides grants to
deal with natural and human disasters
overseas. In a crisis, these two programs
and Title II of Public Law 480 are closely
coordinated.
The United States continues to lead the
world in responding to humanitarian crises,
due to Americans’ support for such assistance
and U.S. voluntary agencies’ unequaled capacity to implement relief programs quickly
and effectively. This humane concern and
excellent program delivery has, over the years,
countered world food shortages, alleviated
the impact of major droughts in particular
countries, managed surges of refugees, and
dealt with man-made disasters such as genocide in Rwanda.
Export Promotion
While U.S. diplomacy and foreign assistance
promote open markets and export opportunities for U.S. business, three other international
affairs agencies more directly support or
finance American exports. The Export-Import
Bank provides short- and long-term loans
and loan guarantees and insurance to support

U.S. exports, primarily exports of capital
goods. Bank support is designed to remedy
imperfections in private capital markets, and
to counter financing by the official export
credit agencies of other countries. The Overseas Private Investment Corporation provides
loans, guarantees, and insurance for U.S.
business investment overseas. The Trade and
Development Agency provides grant financing
for feasibility studies on major infrastructure
and other development projects abroad. These
agencies’ activities generate considerable payoffs for U.S. exports.
A series of tax preferences also benefit
U.S. trade activities. Americans working
abroad, for example, often may exclude
$70,000 of income and a portion of their
housing costs from taxes. In addition, U.S.
exporters who work through Foreign Sales
Corporations may exempt significant portions
of their income from U.S. taxes. U.S. exporters
also may allocate more of their earnings
abroad (and thereby reduce their tax obligations). Finally, earnings from U.S.-controlled
foreign corporations benefit from a tax deferral—they are not subject to U.S. taxes until
they are received by U.S. shareholders as
dividends or other distributions.
International Organizations
The United States promotes its foreign
policy goals through a wide variety of international organizations, to which it makes
both assessed and voluntary contributions.
While our global leadership is most clear
in the United Nations, other organizations
are important to U.S. interests.
The International Atomic Energy Agency,
for example, strongly supports America’s nonproliferation goals, while the World Health
Organization pursues our goal of eradicating
disease. NATO advances our national security
goals in Europe. We support our development
assistance goals as a leading contributor
to the United Nations Development Program.
Finally, our assessed contributions to U.N.supported peacekeeping operations, and our
voluntary contributions to such peacekeeping
efforts as the Multilateral Force in the Sinai,
support peace-keeping in regions that are
important to our interests.

14.

GENERAL SCIENCE, SPACE, AND
TECHNOLOGY

Table 14–1.

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF GENERAL
SCIENCE, SPACE, AND TECHNOLOGY
(In millions of dollars)

Function 250

1996
Actual

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
16,692
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
28
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
845
Proposed legislation ........................... ................

Technology has become a major engine
of economic growth, a significant contributor
to our national security, a generator of new
knowledge, and a critical tool in protecting
our health and environment. Not only has
technological innovation accounted for at least
half of the Nation’s productivity growth in
the last 50 years, but the development of
such new technologies as computers and
jet aircraft has created new industries as
well as millions of high-skilled, high-wage
jobs.
All too often, though, companies will not
make the investments that could benefit
all of us down the road—either the risk
is too great, or the return to the companies
is too small. Thus, by making such investments, the Federal Government plays an
indispensable role in science and technology.
Federal investments must run the gamut
from basic research, to applied research,
to technology development—because scientific
discovery and technological innovation are
so profoundly interwoven.
The budget proposes $16.5 billion in 1998
to conduct science, space, and technology
activities through the National Aeronautics
and Space Administration (NASA), the National Science Foundation (NSF), and the

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

16,629

16,439

16,427

16,246

16,235

16,226

38

38

31

31

31

31

880
430

1,475
787

830
540

790
234

780
111

770
41

Energy Department’s (DOE) general science
programs. The Government also seeks to
stimulate private investment in these activities through nearly $1 billion to $2 billion
a year in tax credits and other preferences
for research and development (R&D).
National Aeronautics and Space
Administration
The Government created NASA in 1958
as the successor to the National Advisory
Committee on Aeronautics, which had supported aeronautical technology since World
War I. NASA, for which the budget proposes
$12.1 billion in 1998, is the lead Federal
agency for R&D in civil space activities,
working to expand frontiers in air and space
in order to serve America and improve the
quality of life on Earth.
NASA pursues this vision through balanced
investment in:
Space Science: These programs are designed to enhance our understanding of the
creation of the universe, the formation of planets, and the possible existence of life beyond
Earth. NASA has enjoyed major successes of
late, including its discovery of possible evidence of past life on Mars. Also, NASA’s
Galileo spacecraft arrived at Jupiter, dropped
145

146
a probe into Jupiter’s atmosphere, and found
evidence of ice, possibly liquid waters, and volcanic activities on Jupiter’s moons. NASA is
shifting away from large, once-a-decade spacecraft missions and is instead focusing on
smaller, cheaper missions that can fly frequently.
Environmental Research: These programs
focus on examining Earth’s natural and
human-induced
environmental
changes
through long-term observation, research, and
analysis of Earth’s land, oceans, and atmospheric processes. NASA will launch the first
in a series of environmental monitoring spacecraft in 1998.
Space Transportation Technology: Working with the private sector, these programs
explore technologies that could help produce
an ambitious experimental launch vehicle—
X–33—which should complete its first test
flight by March 1999 and dramatically cut the
costs of putting payloads in space.
Human Exploration: These programs focus
on establishing a permanent human presence
in Earth’s orbit by developing and operating
the International Space Station. What we
learn from the Space Station also will support
future decisions on whether to conduct further
human space exploration. In 1996, this program supported the successful launch of eight
Space Shuttle flights, three missions to the
Russian Mir space station, and continued construction of the International Space Station.
NASA has about 21,000 employees at its
headquarters and Federal research centers,
and it conducts about 90 percent of its
work through procurements with the private
sector, leading to jobs for another 175,000
people. With a constrained budget, NASA
has cut redundant operations, privatized some
operations, improved its management processes, and reformed its procurement process.
National Science Foundation
The Government created the NSF in 1950
to support research and education in science
and engineering. NSF-supported activities
have led to breakthroughs and advances
in many areas, including superconducting
materials, Doppler radar, the Internet and
World Wide Web, medical imaging systems,

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

computer-assisted-design, genetics, polymers,
plate tectonics, and global climate change.
While NSF represents just three percent
of Federal R&D spending, it supports nearly
half of the non-medical basic research conducted at academic institutions. NSF also
provides 30 percent of Federal support for
mathematics and science education.
The budget proposes $3.3 billion in 1998
for NSF, which it would invest in four
key program functions:
Research: Support for research projects,
comprising 56 percent of NSF’s budget, includes individual, small group, and centerbased activities.
Education and Training: Education and
training activities, accounting for 20 percent
of NSF’s budget, revolve around efforts to improve teaching and learning in science, mathematics, engineering, and technology at all educational levels.
Facilities: Investments in facilities, representing nearly 20 percent of NSF’s budget,
include support for large, multi-user facilities
for cutting-edge research, such as observatories, supercomputing facilities, and oceanographic research vessels.
Administration: Administration, covering
four percent of NSF’s budget, includes internal
salaries and expenses.
NSF, recognized around the world for its
high standards of quality and efficiency, relies
on a rigorous, competitive process of merit
review to choose which among the 30,000
proposals it receives each year to fund. NSF
funds about a third (although it views about
70 percent as deserving support). NSF-supported activities leverage over $1.4 billion
a year in cooperative investments from outside
sources, including $250 million by some 600
private corporations.
NSF funds support over 25,000 senior scientists, and its research funds support over
50,000 other professionals and graduate and
undergraduate students. NSF education programs reach over 120,000 teachers in kindergarten through 12th grade. As evidence of
the high quality of science that NSF supports,
five of the six U.S. Nobel prize winners

14.

147

GENERAL SCIENCE, SPACE, AND TECHNOLOGY

in 1996 received NSF support early in their
careers.
Department of Energy General Science
Programs
DOE’s general science programs, for which
the budget proposes just over $1 billion,
fund its high-energy and nuclear physics
R&D to expand knowledge about the fundamental nature of matter and energy. DOE
is responsible for long-range planning for
the Federal Government’s program in general
science, for maintaining a balanced national
program between investing in new facilities
and supporting researchers, for assuring U.S.
leadership in the world, and for coordinating
its efforts with NSF—the other leading Federal supporter of these programs.
DOE provides over 90 percent of total
Federal support for high-energy physics and
85 percent for nuclear physics. It also supports
the premiere scientific facilities in both fields.
DOE-supported research in these fields is
conducted by 4,100 scientists and students
from over 150 universities, 12 national laboratories, and other nations. About 2,000 U.S.
users tap DOE’s nuclear physics research
facilities, and 2,500 U.S. users tap DOE’s
high-energy physics research facilities. DOE’s
high-energy and nuclear physics laboratories
host about 500 visiting foreign scientists

at any given time, and about 250 students
a year earn their Ph.D.’s for research supported by these programs.
Scientists supported by DOE’s high-energy
and nuclear physics programs, or who conducted their research in DOE’s laboratories,
have been recognized around the world for
their contributions to a variety of important
fields. Thirty researchers have won Nobel
Prizes since 1939 (most recently in 1995),
and 49 researchers have won DOE’s own
highly-prestigious prizes—the Enrico Fermi
Awards and the E.O. Lawrence Awards—
demonstrating the excellence of DOE’s programs.
Tax Incentives
Along with direct spending on R&D, the
Federal Government has sought to stimulate
private investment in these activities with
nearly $1 billion to $2 billion in tax preferences a year. The law provides a 20–percent
tax credit for private research and experimentation expenditures above a certain base
amount. The credit, which has expired in
the past, is due to expire once again on
May 31, 1997, but the President’s tax plan
would extend it for one year—that is, through
May 31, 1998. The law also enables companies
to deduct, up front, the costs of certain
kinds of research and experimentation.

15.
Table 15–1.

ENERGY

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF ENERGY
(In millions of dollars)

Function 270

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
4,900
4,256
4,703
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
–3,122
–2,913
–2,766
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................ ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
1,036
2,527
2,093
Tax Expenditures: 1
Existing law ........................................
2,200
2,255
2,230
Proposed legislation ........................... ................
–14
–64
1 Excludes

1999

2000

2001

2002

4,891

4,645

4,498

4,391

–3,703
–24

–2,823
–35

–3,021
–65

–3,715
–1,226

1,731

2,663

1,814

1,682

2,425
–96

2,505
–99

2,490
–101

2,520
–102

alcohol fuels excise tax.

The Federal Government’s energy programs
contribute not just to energy security, but
to economic prosperity. Funded mainly
through the Department of Energy (DOE),
they range from protecting against disruptions
in petroleum supplies, to conducting research
on renewable energy sources, to developing
radioisotope power sources for space missions,
to restructuring wholesale electricity markets
throughout the United States. The Administration proposes $4.7 billion for these programs
in 1998. In addition, the Federal Government
allocates about $3 billion a year in tax
breaks mainly to encourage the development
of both traditional and alternative sources
of energy.
The Federal Government has a longstanding
role in energy, one that has changed over
the last half-century and will continue to
evolve. Most of the programs and agencies
identified below perform functions that have
no State or private counterparts, and that
clearly involve the national interest. The
federally-owned petroleum reserves, for instance, protect against supply disruptions and
consumer price shock, while Federal regulators
protect the public’s heath and environment
as they ensure fair, efficient energy rates.
DOE’s basic research programs focus on the

long-term, high-risk problems that lack any
obvious short-term payoff and, thus, are programs that industry has no incentives to
fund.
Energy Security, and Energy Research
and Development
DOE maintains the Strategic Petroleum
Reserve (SPR) and operates various research
and development (R&D) investments to protect
against disruptions in petroleum supplies and
reduce the environmental impacts of energy
production and use.
Created in 1975, SPR now has 563 million
barrels of crude oil in underground salt
caverns at four Gulf Coast sites. In an
emergency, the oil reserves would meet military needs and cut the economic costs of
large, sudden oil price increases caused by
a severe interruption of our oil supply. As
the United States was entering the Persian
Gulf War in early 1991, for instance, the
President announced an energy emergency,
prompting an SPR drawdown that—along
with the allied nations’ early and overwhelming military success—caused oil prices to
drop by $10 per barrel (or, by about a
third of their price).
149

150

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

DOE’s R&D energy investments cover a
broad array of resources and technologies
to make the production and use of all forms
of energy—including renewables, fossil, and
nuclear—more efficient and less environmentally damaging. Federal R&D support
can help develop these technologies, which
benefit society by cutting emission rates of
greenhouse gases, acid rain precursors, and
air pollutants. Investments in these areas
are not only laying the foundation for a
more sustainable energy future, but also
opening major international markets for manufacturers of advanced U.S. technology.

try to develop advanced technologies to
produce and use coal, oil, and gas resources
more efficiently and cleanly. The program’s
successes will affect many consumers. For
instance, the federally-funded development of
clean, highly-efficient gas-fired generating systems will make electricity production less
expensive than other technologies. The programs also help boost the domestic production
of oil and natural gas by funding R&D
projects with industry to cut exploration,
development, and production costs.

Energy conservation programs, for which
the budget proposes $688 million in 1998,
are designed to improve the fuel economy
of various transportation modes, increase the
productivity of our most energy-intensive industries, and improve the energy efficiency
of buildings and appliances. They also include
grants to States to fund energy-efficiency
programs and low-income home weatherization. Many of these programs rely on privatesector partners to cut Federal spending and
increase the likelihood that these technologies
will be used commercially. Energy-efficiency
technologies that have already come to market
include heat-reflecting windows, high-efficiency
lights, geothermal heat pumps, high-efficiency
electric motors and compressors, and software
for designing energy-efficient buildings. Meanwhile, five other technologies that have been
available for at least five years have generated, to date, $11 billion in total consumer
and business savings on energy bills.

The Nation receives enormous benefits from
investing in DOE’s basic research and specialized research facilities, for which the budget
proposes $1.5 billion. The programs focus
on research related to energy production,
conversion, and use, and to identifying and
mitigating the health and environmental effects of those activities. One Federally-funded
basic research project discovered how to cut
energy losses from electric grid transformers
by 90 percent, thus paving the way for
about $1 billion less in lost power for electric
companies and, in turn, lower prices for
consumers.

Solar and renewable energy programs, for
which the budget proposes $330 million, focus
on technologies that will help the Nation
use its abundant renewable resources such
as wind, solar, and biomass, to produce
low-cost, clean energy. The United States
is the world’s technology leader in wind
energy, with a growing export market. In
addition, utilities are producing some solar
thermal power, photovoltaics are becoming
increasingly useful in remote power applications, and DOE is now working with Amoco
on producing ethanol from wood and paper
wastes.
Fossil fuel energy R&D programs, for which
the budget proposes $346 million, help indus-

Basic Energy Research

DOE’s state-of-the-art scientific facilities also
provide the cutting-edge experimental and
theoretical techniques that provide insights
into dozens of applications—from next-generation semi-conductors to microbiological studies
of tumor growth. The facilities are available
on a competitive basis for researchers funded
by the National Science Foundation, other
Federal agencies, and public and private
entities. DOE also invests in research to
develop the scientific and technological foundation for the next generation of user facilities.
Environmental Management and
Stewardship
DOE manages the Nation’s most complex
environmental cleanup program, the result
of over four decades of research and production
of nuclear energy technology and materials
at both Federal and private sector locations.
The Department also faces the crucial task
of developing a long-term solution to the
problem that the Nation’s commercial spent
nuclear fuel poses.

15.

ENERGY

Environmental Management: The budget
proposes $934 million to reduce the environmental risk and manage the waste at: (1) sites
run by DOE’s predecessor agencies that involved researching and producing uranium and
thorium; (2) sites contaminated with uranium
production from the 1950s to the 1970s; and
(3) DOE’s uranium processing plants that the
United States Enrichment Corporation runs.
In recent years, the clean-up and safe disposal
of radioactive and hazardous wastes and materials has progressed substantially. Over 60
percent of private sites contaminated during
the research, processing, and production of
uranium and thorium will be cleaned up by
the end of 1998, allowing these private sites
and facilities to return to productive use.
Civilian Radioactive Waste Management
Program (RW): RW oversees the management and disposal of spent nuclear fuel from
commercial nuclear reactors, and high-level radioactive waste from Federal cleanup sites. In
1998, DOE expects to complete the first stage
of evaluating a Nevada site as a possible geologic repository—representing an important
step in a long process that eventually will
produce a DOE site recommendation to the
President and a DOE license application to the
Nuclear Regulatory Commission.
Energy Production and Power Marketing
The Federal Government is reshaping programs that produce, distribute, and finance
oil, gas, and electric power—hoping to eventually de-Federalize them and their agencies.
The Naval Petroleum Reserve, commonly
known as Elk Hills, is a federally-owned
oil and gas field located in California. Set
aside early this century to provide an oil
reserve for Navy ships, the Government no
longer needs it for that purpose. Congress
voted in 1996 to require the sale of Elk
Hills, which produced $368 million of oil,
gas, and other products in 1995. The Government plans to sell the reserve in 1998
and deposit the proceeds to the Treasury.
The five Federal Power Marketing Administrations (Alaska, Bonneville, Southeastern,
Southwestern, and Western) market electricity
generated at 129 multi-purpose Federal dams
through over 33,000 miles of federally-owned
transmission lines, located in 34 States. The

151
Government plans to finish selling the Alaska
Power Administration, as Congress authorized,
to the State of Alaska and current customers
in 1998. The PMAs sell about six percent
of the Nation’s total electricity, and sell
it at preferred rates to such public entities
as counties, cities, and publicly-owned utilities
and power authorities. The PMAs, however,
face growing challenges as the electricity
industry moves toward open, competitive markets—and away from regulated monopolies.
In 1998, the PMAs will begin to use
their receipts from selling electric power
to cover the full costs of Civil Service Retirement System and Post-Retirement Health
Benefits for their employees. Curently, the
PMAs cover the full costs for employees
who work under the Federal Employees Retirement System.
The Tennessee Valley Authority (TVA) is
a Federal Government corporation and the
Nation’s largest electric utility, serving 7.3
million customers in seven States. TVA supplies power through 11 coal-fired plants,
30 hydropower facilities, and three nuclear
power plants. It also operates a series of
water supply, flood control, recreation, and
economic development programs. TVA power
sales will grow an estimated 3.7 percent—
from $5.8 billion in 1997 to an estimated
$6 billion in 1998. For the first time, TVA
in 1997 will reduce the debt it owes to
the investing public. The planned $50 million
debt repayment in 1997 and the planned
$225 million debt repayment in 1998 reflect
TVA’s efforts to ensure the agency’s financial
health, position itself to succeed as competition
increases in the Nation’s electricity markets,
and serve the interests of TVA’s customers
and bondholders and the Federal Government.
(For information on TVA’s non-power activities, see Chapter 20, Community and Regional
Development.)
In 1997, the Agriculture Department’s Rural
Utilities Service (RUS) will make $1.4 billion
in direct loans to nonprofit associations, rural
electric cooperatives, public bodies, and other
utilities in rural areas for generating, transmitting, and distributing electricity. RUS
charges interest at or below Treasury rates
for debt of comparable maturity, in order
to cut the high cost of electric service to

152
rural customers that results from the low
customer density in rural areas.
DOE also has large reserves of uranium
that the Government no longer needs for
their original purpose, including high enriched
uranium (HEU) from dismantled nuclear
weapons. The Government plans to sell some
of that material in a manner that will
not disrupt uranium markets—$100 million
worth of natural uranium a year through
2001 and $200 million in 2002. If, after
an inter-agency review, the President declares
that the remaining HEU exceeds national
security needs, DOE will sell, in 2002, another
$750 million of low enriched uranium, derived
from HEU for commercial use through 2007.
Energy Regulation
The Federal Government’s regulation of
energy industries is designed to protect public
health and safety, and promote fair and
efficient interstate energy markets. The Federal Energy Regulatory Commission (FERC),
an independent agency within DOE, regulates
the transmission and wholesale prices of
electric power, including non-Federal hydroelectric power, and the transportation of oil
and natural gas by pipeline in interstate
commerce. Over the long run, FERC seeks
to increase economic efficiency by promoting
competition in the natural gas industry and
in wholesale electric power markets. FERC’s
recent reforms give consumers competitive
choices in services and suppliers that were
not available just a few years ago. Its actions
will cut consumer energy bills by $3 billion
to $5 billion a year.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

The Nuclear Regulatory Commission (NRC),
an independent agency, regulates nuclear facilities—commercial nuclear reactors, the medical and industrial use of nuclear materials,
and the transport and disposal of nuclear
waste. The NRC seeks to protect public
health and the environment from nuclear
materials. The companies and other entities
that the NRC regulates finance most of
its budget through fees.
DOE also seeks to improve the Nation’s
use of energy resources through its appliance
energy efficiency program. Federal regulations
specify minimum levels of energy efficiency
for all major home appliances, such as water
heaters, air conditioners, and refrigerators.
Tax Incentives
Federal tax incentives are mainly designed
to encourage the domestic production or use
of fossil and other fuels, and to promote
the vitality of our energy industries and
diversification of our domestic energy supplies.
The largest incentive lets certain fuel producers cut their taxable income as their fuel
resources are depleted. An income tax credit
helps promote the development of certain
non-conventional fuels. It applies to oil produced from shale and tar sands, gas produced
from a number of unconventional sources
(including coal seams), some fuels processed
from wood, and steam produced from solid
agricultural byproducts. Another tax provision
provides a credit to producers who make
alcohol fuels—mainly ethanol—from biomass
materials. The law also allows a partial
exemption from Federal gasoline taxes for
gasolines blended with ethanol.

16.

Table 16–1.

NATURAL RESOURCES AND
ENVIRONMENT
FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF NATURAL
RESOURCES AND ENVIRONMENT
(In millions of dollars)

Function 300

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
20,668
21,071
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
667
1,045
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
34
45
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
1,650
1,670
Proposed legislation ........................... ................
–8

The Federal Government spends over $20
billion a year to protect the environment,
conserve Federal resources, provide recreational opportunities, and construct and
operate water projects. 1 The Federal Government manages about 700 million acres—
a third of the U.S. continental land area—
including 25 million acres managed by the
Defense Department (DOD) and 56 million
that the Interior Department holds in trust
for Indian Tribes and individual Indians.
The lands generate about $2.7 billion in
receipts a year, mainly from royalties and
revenues from the oil and gas, coal, and
timber industries. About half of the receipts
go to the Federal Treasury, the rest to
States and to various Federal land and
water resource programs. The Government
also allocates nearly $1 billion a year in
tax incentives for natural resource industries,
especially timber and mining.
Federal lands include the National Park
System, with such unique resources as Grand
1 The Natural Resources and Environment function does not reflect total Federal support for the environment and natural resources. It does not include, for instance, the environmental cleanup programs at the Departments of Energy and Defense.

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

22,393

22,393

21,848

21,741

21,829

1,012
113

863
74

911
62

907
97

843
104

38

37

37

39

40

1,680
–89

1,690
–92

1,705
–94

1,685
–96

1,655
–97

Canyon National Park, Everglades National
Park, Yellowstone National Park and Gettysburg National Military Park; the 156 National
Forests that the Forest Service manages
for various uses, including timber harvesting,
wildlife habitat, and recreation; the National
Wildlife Refuge System, comprising 510 refuges for the conservation of migratory birds
and other important species; and the 264
million acres that the Bureau of Land Management (BLM) manages in 11 Western States
for economic, conservation, and recreational
purposes. Visitors make about 700 million
recreational visits a year on Federally-owned
lands.
Federal spending on natural resources and
the environment also includes the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), for which
the budget proposes $7.6 billion in 1998.
EPA implements most of the Nation’s major
environmental laws, including the Clean Air,
Clean Water, and Safe Drinking Water Acts;
administers the Superfund program; and finances water infrastructure projects.
Largely due to Federal efforts, the air
and water are cleaner across most of the
153

154
United States, and a much larger share
of Americans are served by secondary
wastewater treatment. Our natural resources
are better conserved—with national forests
and public rangelands returned to sustainable
levels of productivity, soil erosion substantially
reduced, thousands of wetland acres restored,
unique ecosystems protected, contaminated
areas cleaned up by a record rate, and
billions of dollars in flood damages averted.
Formerly endangered or threatened species
like bald eagles, wolves, and condors again
grace the landscape in the lower 48 States.
Finally, one of America’s best inventions—
its national park system—has been improved
and preserved for future generations.
Parks and Recreation
The Federal Government invests over $1.4
billion a year to maintain the National Park
System, which has 374 parks, covering over
83 million acres in 49 States, the District
of Columbia, and various territories. The
popularity of national parks has prompted
a steady rise in congressional funding (almost
five percent a year since 1986) for the
National Park Service (NPS), but has generated even faster growth in the number
of new parks and other NPS responsibilities.
Since 1986, the number of national parks
has grown by 10 percent, including the
five designated in the 1996 Omnibus Parks
Act. NPS also maintains an infrastructure
of aging facilities, fragile ruins, and declining
historic structures.
So, with demands growing faster than available funding (and with an estimated 280
million park visitors in 1996), NPS is taking
new, creative approaches to managing parks,
including broader cooperative arrangements
with public and private groups. The Government, for instance, is establishing the
Tallgrass Prairie National Preserve in Kansas
at substantially less cost than a traditional
national park unit, due to a partnership
with a private group that owns most of
the land. At the Presidio of San Francisco,
a government corporation will be able to
lease and manage hundreds of unused buildings in a manner consistent with park purposes, but that cuts taxpayer costs. More
park managers also are accepting the support
of individuals and corporate citizens that

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

donate their time and money to help protect
national parks. Finally, NPS is seeking additional resources by asking Congress for permanent authority to collect fees and retain
all the receipts from new fees, and for
reforms in park concessions policies to increase
competition for concessions contracts and provide incentives for parks to negotiate higher
returns from concessioners.
Conservation and Land Management
How we use the public lands that BLM
manages (the 264 million acres in 11 Western
States) has evolved over time—and continues
to. To meet changing and diverse demands,
BLM is promoting both biological diversity
and the sustainable development of natural
resources. In 1996, BLM provided for nearly
65 million recreational visits while accommodating more traditional users, including 20,000
Western ranchers, the timber industry, and
other commercial interests.
BLM and the Forest Service, with combined
annual budgets of about $3 billion, manage
Federal forests for multiple purposes. Federal
forest lands in the Pacific Northwest and
northern California were plagued by conflict
between environmentalists and industry over
logging and, eventually, a court injunction
that brought Federal timber sales to a virtual
halt in 1991. To end the impasse, the President established his Northwest Forest Plan
in 1994. Now, Federal forest management
is nearing a fully sustainable level. The
Federal Government offered for sale over
1.7 billion board feet from Federal forest
lands in Washington, Oregon, and northern
California from 1994 to 1996—enough to
build 142,000 average homes and employ
about 11,700 people. The Forest Plan also
supports area communities by distributing
grants and loans to help over 100 communities
further diversify their economies.
Federal and non-Federal agencies also are
implementing long-term restoration plans for
the South Florida and Bay-Delta, California
ecosystems. The South Florida ecosystem is
a national treasure that includes the Everglades, Florida Bay, and other internationallyrenowned natural resources. Its long-term
viability and sustainability is critical for the
tourism and fishing industries, as well as

16.

155

NATURAL RESOURCES AND ENVIRONMENT

for the water supply, economy, and quality
of life for South Florida’s population of over
six million people. As with South Florida,
the lack of enough clean water in the San
Francisco Bay-San Joaquin Delta ecosystem
has reduced the quality and quantity of
wildlife habitat, endangered several species,
and reduced the estuary’s reliability as a
source of high quality water.
The Interior Department’s Fish and Wildlife
Service (FWS) and Commerce Department’s
National Marine Fisheries Service (NMFS)
protect species under the Endangered Species
Act (ESA) while allowing economic development to continue. To protect species on
non-Federal lands, these agencies work with
States and local governments, private groups,
and landowners to develop Habitat Conservation Plans (HCPs), which provide the flexibility
and certainty that everyone needs to plan
for, and use, their land. From 1983 to
1992, such parties devised only 14 HCPs
but, from 1993 to 1997, the number issued
or under development soared to 300—covering
8.4 million acres in the Pacific Northwest
alone. To protect species on Federal lands,
Federal agencies consult with State and local
governments, groups, and others before allowing private parties to use the land.
Another important land conservation program is the Land and Water Conservation
Fund (LWCF), which uses the royalties of
offshore oil and gas leases to help Federal,
State, and local governments acquire land
for conservation and outdoor recreation. From
its inception in 1964, the program has helped
Federal, State, and local governments to
acquire about seven million acres of parks
and other lands. The program, for instance,
is funding the acquisition of Sterling Forest
in New York and New Jersey, the largest
undeveloped tract of forest and open lands
within 45 miles of downtown New York
City, thus creating vast new recreational
opportunities for the whole area.
Half of the continental United States is
cropland, pastureland, and rangeland owned
and managed by two percent of Americans—
farmers and ranchers. The Agriculture Department’s (USDA) Natural Resources Conservation Service provides these private interests
with technical assistance to ensure the health

and sound management of this land. Other
USDA programs mainly provide financial conservation assistance, the largest of which
is the Conservation Reserve Program (CRP)
through which USDA can maintain up to
36 million acres under land retirement contracts, reducing soil erosion by over 600
million tons a year. The 1996 Farm Bill
should greatly enhance CRP’s conservation
benefits. Under it, for instance, producers
may enroll partial fields into the CRP (e.g.,
filterstrips, riparian buffer areas, and grassed
waterways) to gain the maximum conservation
for the least cost.
Pollution Control and Abatement
The Federal Government helps achieve the
Nation’s pollution control goals in three ways.
It (1) takes direct action, (2) funds action
by State, local, and Tribal governments, and
the private sector, and (3) imposes mandates
on these parties. The Environmental Protection Agency’s (EPA) $7 billion discretionary
budget and the Coast Guard’s $100 million
Oil Spill Liability Trust Fund (which funds
oil spill clean-ups in U.S. waters) finance
the first two activities. EPA’s discretionary
budget, in turn, has three major parts—
the operating program, Superfund, and water
infrastructure financing.
• EPA’s $3 billion operating program is the
main Federal funding source to implement
most Federal pollution control laws, including the Clean Air, Clean Water, Solid
Waste Disposal, Safe Drinking Water, and
the Toxic Substance Control Acts. EPA
protects public health and the environment by developing national pollution control standards, which States largely implement and enforce under the authority that
EPA delegates. These standards have led
to major environmental improvements.
EPA’s pollution abatement efforts since
1970 also have generated major environmental improvements (see Chart 16–1).
• Superfund’s $2 billion program pays for
cleaning up hazardous substance spills
and abandoned hazardous waste sites, and
for compelling responsible parties to clean
up inactive sites—with a goal of 900 completed cleanups by the year 2000 of the
roughly 1,400 sites on EPA’s high-priority

156

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 16-1. AIR QUALITY TRENDS IN URBAN AREAS
NUMBER OF DAYS PSI EXCEEDED 100*
2250

2,055
2000
1750

1,584

1,572

1500

1,266
1250

1,034

1,017

1000
750

691

694

1992

1993

629

707

500
250
0
1986

1987

1988

1989

1990

LOS ANGELES

1991

1994

1995

OTHER MSAs

MSA= Metropolitan Statistical Area
PSI=Pollutant Standards Index (Air Quality)
*Note: A PSI level greater than 100 is the level which denotes that residents are breathing unhealthy air.

list. Private parties subject to Superfund’s
enforcement spend another $2 billion a
year, and Federal agencies (largely DOD
and the Energy Department) spend about
$5 billion a year on hazardous waste
cleanup. Superfund also supports the Federal brownfields program, designed to assess, clean up, and re-use former contaminated sites.
• Federal water infrastructure funds go primarily for capitalization grants to State
revolving funds, which make low-interest
loans to help municipalities pay for
wastewater treatment and drinking water
treatment systems, as Federal law requires. The more than $67 billion in Federal assistance since the 1972 Clean Water
Act has dramatically increased the percentage of Americans served by secondary
treatment (as shown in Chart 16–2) and
better water quality. State and local governments (and private companies) also
benefit from a tax break (costing $700 million in 1998) allowing State and local gov-

ernments to issue tax-exempt bonds to
construct private waste disposal facilities.
Water Resources
The Army Corps of Engineers and Interior’s
Bureau of Reclamation are the main Federal
agencies that build and operate multi-purpose
water projects. The Corps operates Nationwide, while the Bureau operates in the 17
western States. They both seek to develop
or manage water resources to meet changing
needs. The budget proposes $4.6 billion for
the agencies in 1998—$3.7 billion for the
Corps, $0.9 billion for the Bureau.
• While navigation and flood damage reduction remain the Corps’ major focus, its
projects, programs, and regulatory responsibilities increasingly address environmental objectives, including wetlands protection. The Administration will work with
Congress to develop a consensus on priorities for the Corps Civil Works program
in an era of stable or falling budgets.

16.

157

NATURAL RESOURCES AND ENVIRONMENT

Chart 16-2. POPULATION SERVED BY SECONDARY
TREATMENT OR BETTER
MILLIONS
180

171

173

1997

1998

159
160

146

140

128

120
100

104
85

80
60
40
20
0
1972

1977

1982

ACTUAL

• The Bureau was designed to support economic development in the West by financing and constructing reliable water supplies for irrigation and hydropower generation. With the West developed, the Bureau
has sought since the late 1980s to remake
itself into a customer-oriented ‘‘water resources management’’ agency, operating
projects more efficiently and providing expertise on the best way to manage water
resources, consistent with sound environmental and economic objectives.
Regulation
Millions of Americans have benefited not
just from the spending programs discussed
above, but from Federal regulations that
are designed to protect the environment and
public health. In issuing regulations, however,
the Administration has sought to carefully
protect the public without unduly burdening
private interests. In this area and in others,
the Administration has worked to eliminate
unnecessary regulations while improving the
regulations that are clearly necessary.

1987

1992

ESTIMATES

State, local, and Tribal governments and
the private sector devote considerable resources to comply with Federal environmental
laws and regulations to make the air and
water cleaner and reduce risks from hazardous
wastes.
Tax Incentives
The tax code offers incentives for natural
resource industries, especially timber and mining. The timber industry can deduct certain
costs for growing timber, pay lower capital
gains rates on profits, take a credit for
investment, and quickly write-off reforestation
costs—all told, costing about $500 million
in 1998. The mining industry benefits from
percentage depletion provisions (which allow
deductions that exceed the economic value
of resource depletion) and can deduct certain
exploration and development costs—together,
costing about $335 million in 1998.

17.
Table 17–1.

AGRICULTURE

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF AGRICULTURE
(In millions of dollars)

Function 350

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
4,206
4,140
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
5,023
6,132
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
6,183
7,074
Guaranteed loans ...............................
5,082
7,880
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
320
325
Proposed legislation ........................... ................
–28

Early in our history, the Federal Government helped improve food production. Today,
it aims to do much more for agriculture
and its related activities, which account for
16 percent of the Gross Domestic Product.
The Government helps our bountiful human,
natural, and capital resources work together
to produce the highest possible benefit at
the lowest cost for Americans and others.
Federal programs disseminate economic and
agronomic information, ensure the integrity
of crops and safety of meat and poultry,
and help farmers face risks from weather
and unfamiliar export conditions. The results
are found in the public welfare that Americans
enjoy, free of severe dislocations that can
occur when commodity markets are left to
take their natural time to correct themselves.
The Federal Government spends about $10
billion a year for agriculture, but the Agriculture Department’s (USDA) $50 billion a
year in other spending includes investments
that support farms and farmers’ income (noted
below and in other chapters). The tax code
also offers $500 million a year in incentives
for farmers.

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

4,115

4,014

3,944

3,905

3,914

8,181
17

7,605
43

7,156
23

6,069
10

5,866
13

8,670
8,075

8,573
7,988

8,294
7,974

7,670
7,970

7,159
7,969

330
–136

345
–121

350
–124

355
–124

360
–124

Conditions on the Farm
In the 1980s, record-high Federal price
supports, global recession, and the strong
dollar led to steep declines in farm exports,
market prices, and cropland values, creating
the most severe financial crisis in the farm
sector since the 1930s. The Government responded with the largest-ever Federal acreage
idling program, more market-oriented and
lower price supports, and export subsidies
to counteract unfair foreign trade practices.
At the same time, the demand for food
increased around the world.
U.S. agriculture has now recovered. In
1995 and 1996, short supplies of corn and
wheat lifted the sector’s economic indicators,
and agricultural exports hit a record $60
billion in 1996. Market prices for major
crops such as corn and wheat reached their
highest levels in recent history; farmer debtto-asset ratios are low; farm land prices
are high; and net farm income rose to
record levels in 1996, despite the cyclical
downturn in livestock.
Exports are key to future farm incomes.
The Nation now exports 30 percent of U.S.
farm production, and agriculture produces
the greatest balance of payments surplus,
159

160

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

payments were tied to the gap between
market prices and a legislated ‘‘target price’’
for major commodities, such as wheat, corn,
cotton, and rice. The program distorted market
signals, as farmers planted ‘‘for the program.’’
The Farm Bill eliminated most planting restrictions. Further, the Government will provide fixed, but declining payments to eligible
farmers for the next seven years, regardless
of market prices or production. Thus, the
law ‘‘decouples’’ Federal income support from
planting decisions and market prices.

for its share of national income, of any
economic sector. The farm sector generally
supported the North American Free Trade
Agreement and the recent Uruguay Round
of the General Agreement on Tariffs and
Trade, believing that U.S. agriculture can
compete successfully in a world market free
of trade barriers and export subsidy distortions.
Federal Farm Programs and Markets
The farm sector can grow when markets
send signals to plant crops, buy machines,
hire workers, and sell food. The historic
1996 Farm Bill will greatly increase the
market’s influence in U.S. farm policy.

Because commodity prices were high in
1996, the fixed payments provided an estimated $3 billion to $4 billion more in income
transfers than farmers would have received
under the old law (see Chart 17–1). Payments
in 1997 likely will exceed previous law levels
by similar amounts, but the excess will
decline in later years. In signing the Farm
Bill, the President expressed concern that
it did not provide an adequate ‘‘safety net’’
for farm income. As a result, the budget

Known officially as the Federal Agriculture
Improvement and Reform Act of 1996, the
Farm Bill will significantly alter the basis
for planting decisions and Federal income
support for most farmers. Under previous
laws dating to the 1930s, farmers who reduced
plantings when prices were low could get
income support payments. These ‘‘deficiency’’

Chart 17-1. PRODUCTION FLEXIBILITY CONTRACT PAYMENTS
EXCEED PROJECTED DEFICIENCY PAYMENTS
MILLIONS
8
7

6.4
5.8

6

5.6

5.3

5.1

5
4.1

4.0

4
3
2.3

2.4
2.0

2

1.5

1.5

1.1
1

0.5

0
1996

1997

1998

1999

2000

PROJECTED DEFICIENCY PAYMENTS UNDER PREVIOUS LEGISLATION 1/
PRODUCTION FLEXIBILITY CONTRACT PAYMENTS

1/ Source: USDA Long-term Projections, February 1996.

2001

2002

17.

AGRICULTURE

proposes to strengthen the safety net, largely
in partnership with private sector approaches.
The Farm Bill also uses incentives to
encourage farmers to protect the natural
resource base of U.S. agriculture. For example,
the new $200 million-a-year Environmental
Quality Incentive Program helps farmers address water quality concerns; the new Flood
Risk Reduction Program provides incentives
to move farming operations from frequentlyflooded land; and the revised Conservation
Farm Option gives producers incentives to
create comprehensive conservation farm plans.
USDA’s conservation programs give technical and financial help to farmers and
communities. They include the Conservation
and Wetlands Reserve Programs, which remove land from farm uses; and the Natural
Resources Conservation Service, which provides technical assistance. For more information on conservation, and USDA’s investments
in forestry and public land management,
see Chapter 16, Natural Resources and Environment. USDA programs also help to maintain vital rural communities, as described
in Chapter 20, Community and Regional
Development.
Risk Management: USDA helps farmers
manage their financial risks by providing subsidized crop insurance, delivered mainly
through the private sector. On average, farmers pay no premiums for coverage against catastrophic losses, and the Government subsidizes
their premiums for additional coverage. USDA
pays private companies for all costs associated
with administering Federal crop insurance.
Over the past three years, an average 80 percent of eligible acres have been insured, with
losses averaging $1.10 for every $1 in premiums—down from the historical average of
$1.40. Since the Farm Bill ended USDA’s traditional price and income support programs,
producers now bear the added price risk. In
1996, USDA began to pilot-test to farmers,
through the private sector, several products
that mitigate revenue risk, along with the traditional coverage for production risk. Initial results indicate that farmers generally want
these types of products. Crop insurance costs
the Federal Government about $1.7 billion a
year.

161
Inspection and Market Regulation: A
half-billion dollars a year in Federal spending
helps secure U.S. cropland from pests and diseases and make U.S. crops more marketable.
In addition, USDA’s Food Safety and Inspection Service ensures that U.S. meat and poultry do not threaten consumers’ health (as described in Chapter 22, Health.) The Animal
and Plant Health Inspection Service inspects
agricultural products that enter the country;
controls and eradicates diseases and infestations; helps control damage to livestock and
crops from animals; and monitors plant and
animal health and welfare. The Agricultural
Marketing Service and the Grain Inspection,
Packers, and Stockyards Administration help
to market U.S. farm products in domestic and
global markets, ensure fair trading practices,
and promote a competitive and efficient marketplace.
Economic Research and Statistics: Annual Federal spending of about $150 million
aims to improve U.S. agricultural competitiveness by reporting and analyzing economic
information. The Economic Research Service
provides economic and other social science information and analysis for decision-making on
agriculture, food, natural resources, and rural
America. The National Agricultural Statistics
Service develops estimates of production, supply, price, and other aspects of the farm economy. In 1998, it will fund the Census of Agriculture, conducted every five years.
Agricultural Research: The Federal Government plays an important role in supporting
agricultural research and the enhanced productivity it can foster, and spends over $1.5
billion a year for that purpose. The Agricultural Research Service is USDA’s in-house
research agency, addressing a broad range of
food, farm, and environmental issues. It puts
a high priority on transferring its research
findings to the private sector, and in 1998 it
expects to submit 70 new patent applications,
participate in 75 new Cooperative Research
and Development Agreements, license 25 new
products, and develop 70 new plant varieties
to release to industry for further development
and marketing. The Cooperative State Research, Education, and Extension Service provides grants for agricultural, food, and environmental research; higher education; and extension activities. The National Research Ini-

162
tiative competitive research grant program,
launched in 1990 on the recommendation of
the National Research Council, works to improve the quality and increase the quantity
of USDA’s farm, food, and environmental research. The average annual return to publiclyfunded agricultural research exceeds 35 percent, according to recent academic estimates.
Agricultural Credit: USDA provides about
$500 million a year in direct loans and over
$2.5 billion in guaranteed loans for farm operating and ownership purposes. Direct loans
generally go to beginning or socially disadvantaged farmers. Participants must be unable to
secure credit, and the loans carry interest
rates at or below the rates on Treasury securities, depending on the farmer’s expected income. In addition, the Farm Credit System and
‘‘Farmer Mac’’—which are Government-Sponsored Enterprises—enhance the supply of farm
credit through ties with national and global
credit markets. The Farm Credit System
(which lends directly to farmers) has recovered
strongly from its financial problems of the
1980s, in part through Federal help. Farmer
Mac increases the liquidity of commercial
banks and the farm credit system by purchasing agricultural loans. In 1996, Congress gave
the institution authority to pool loans and additional years to attain required capital standards.
Trade: USDA spends over $1 billion a year
on export activities, including subsidies to U.S.
firms facing unfairly-subsidized overseas competitors and loan guarantees to foreign buyers
of U.S. farm products. Much of USDA’s export
promotion, however, comes through other avenues. It helps firms overcome technical requirements, trade laws, and customs that often
discourage the smaller, less experienced ones
from taking advantage of export opportunities.
Also, it shares some of the risk when firms
or trade organizations experiment in the export market. USDA helps educate firms about
the requirements and process of developing an
overseas market. By participating in the Mar-

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

ket Access Program or USDA-organized trade
shows, firms are better placed to export different products to new locations on their own.
The programs are working. U.S. firms, especially the smaller ones, are exporting more aggressively, and high-value products now comprise a growing share of export value. Overall,
the trade surplus for agriculture in recent decades has grown faster than for any other civilian sector of the economy.
Personnel, Infrastructure, and the Regulatory Burden: USDA administers its many
farm programs through 2,500 county offices
with over 17,000 staff. The Farm Bill significantly cut USDA’s workload, prompting the department to re-examine its staff-intensive field
office-based infrastructure. In 1997, USDA will
launch three efforts: (1) conduct a study to
find ways to operate more efficiently, (2) undertake an Administration initiative to scrap
duplicative and unnecessary regulations and
paperwork, and (3) review and upgrade its
computer systems to streamline its collection
of information from farmers and better disseminate information across USDA agencies.
Tax Incentives
Farmers can deduct certain costs in the
year they incur them, even for inventories
or for items that provide future benefits
and, thus, normally would be deducted over
time. In addition, solvent farmers do not
have to recognize the forgiveness of their
farm debt as income. And farmers can pay
lower, capital gains rates on their gains
from
selling
certain
assets,
including
unharvested crops. Under Federal estate taxes,
farmers benefit because their land is valued
based on its current use as farmland—not
its market potential for development—and
they can pay estate taxes in installments.
Finally, feedgrain growers receive indirect
benefits from the tax subsidy for ethanol
production, which boosts the market price
for corn.

18.

COMMERCE AND HOUSING CREDIT

Table 18–1.

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF COMMERCE
AND HOUSING CREDIT
(In millions of dollars)

Function 370

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
3,721
2,362
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law .................................... –13,793 –11,418
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
1,570
8,824
Guaranteed loans ............................... 181,277 168,959
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................ 182,415 188,935
Proposed legislation ........................... ................
69

The Federal Government provides financing
and encourages private support for commerce
and housing in many ways. It provides direct
loans and loan guarantees to ease access
to mortgage and commercial credit; sponsors
private enterprises that support the secondary
market for home mortgages; regulates private
credit intermediaries, especially depository institutions; and offers tax incentives. All told,
the Government provides about $1.5 billion
a year in support for housing credit that,
in turn, supports over $100 billion in housing
loans and loan guarantees. (Another $16
billion in subsidies for low-income housing
programs is classified in the Income Security
function.)
The Federal Government also dedicates
about $2 billion a year to promote business
and maintain the safety and soundness of
our financial institutions. The Small Business
Administration (SBA) provides aid and counsel
to small businesses, particularly minorityand women-owned ones. The Commerce Department helps expand U.S. sales and create
jobs by promoting technological development
and policies that enhance U.S. industrial
competitiveness and expand exports. Government regulators protect depositors against

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

3,308

3,770

5,242

3,221

3,230

710
–714

2,512
56

6,925
271

5,708
–1,683

6,778
–1,909

4,973
161,613

1,682
161,534

1,928
163,350

2,258
166,218

2,405
169,216

195,875
243

204,780
228

213,495
202

222,030
174

229,670
144

losses when insured commercial banks, thrifts,
and credit unions fail.
Mortgage Credit
The Government provides loans and loan
guarantees to expand access to homeownership, and helps low-income families afford
suitable apartments. It helps meet the needs
of would-be homeowners who lack the savings,
income, or credit history to qualify for a
conventional mortgage. It also helps provide
credit to finance the purchase, construction,
and rehabilitation of rental housing for lowincome persons. Housing credit programs run
by the Departments of Housing and Urban
Development (HUD), Agriculture (USDA), and
Veterans Affairs (VA) supported over $100
billion in loan and loan guarantee commitments in 1996, helping over 1.3 million
households (see Table 18–2).
HUD’s Mutual Mortgage Insurance (MMI)
Fund, which the Federal Housing Administration (FHA) runs, helps increase access to
single-family mortgage credit in metropolitan
areas. In 1996, the MMI Fund guaranteed
over $59 billion in mortgages for over 739,000
households. Over two-thirds of such mortgages
163

164

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 18–2. SELECTED FEDERAL COMMERCE AND HOUSING
CREDIT PROGRAMS PORTFOLIO CHARACTERISTICS

Dollar
volume of
loans/guarantees
written in
1996
(in millions)

Number of
housing
units/small
businesses
financed by
loans/guarantees
written in
1996

Dollar
volume of
total outstanding
loans/guarantees as
of the end
of 1996
(in millions)

Mortgage Credit:
HUD FHA Mutual Mortgage Insurance (MMI) Fund ........
HUD General Insurance and Special Risk Insurance (GI/
SRI) Fund ...........................................................................
USDA/RHS Section 502 single-family loans .......................
USDA/RHS multifamily loans ..............................................
VA guaranteed loans .............................................................

59,221

739,603

363,994

12,220
2,700
150
28,676

301,730
48,000
1,894
291,635

91,176
21,054
11,410
130,031

Subtotal, Mortgage Credit ....................................................

102,967

1,382,862

617,665

SBA guaranteed loans ..............................................................

8,205

50,520

28,329

Total Assistance .....................................................................

111,172

1,433,382

645,994

go to first-time homebuyers. Fees and premiums paid to the MMI Fund fully offset
program costs—the program receives no annual appropriation from Congress.
USDA’s Rural Housing Service (RHS) offers
direct and guaranteed loans and grants to
help very low- to moderate-income rural residents buy and maintain adequate, affordable
housing. Its 502 direct loan program provides
loans for buying, rehabilitating, or repairing
single-family homes. Its 502 guaranteed loan
program guarantees up to 90 percent of
a private loan for buying new or existing
housing. Together, the two 502 programs
provided $2.7 billion in loans and loan guarantees in 1996, supporting 48,000 households.
RHS’s 515 program, which generally lends
to private developers, finances both the construction and rehabilitation of rural rental
housing for low- to moderate-income, elderly,
and handicapped rural residents. It provided
$150 million in direct loans in 1996, supporting over 1,800 households.
VA helps veterans and active duty personnel
buy and improve homes. Its Loan Guarantee
Program (classified in the Veterans Benefits
and Services function) provides housing credit
assistance to veterans and service members.

The Government partially guarantees the
loans from private lenders, providing $29
billion in loan guarantees in 1996. VA also
provides direct loans to the buyers of acquired
properties, including $1.3 billion in loans
in 1996.
The Government plays an important role
in supporting the secondary mortgage market.
Congress created the Government National
Mortgage Association (Ginnie Mae) in 1968
to support the secondary mortgage market
for FHA, VA, and USDA single- and multifamily mortgages. Under its Mortgage-Backed
Securities (MBS) program, Ginnie Mae guarantees the timely payment of principal and
interest on securities backed by pools of
FHA, VA, and USDA mortgages issued by
private mortgage institutions. The program
raises liquidity in the secondary mortgage
market and attracts new sources of capital
for residential loans. To date, Ginnie Mae
has originated over $1 trillion in securities,
of which over $480 billion remain outstanding.
Its MBS single-family program has helped
over 19 million low- and moderate-income
families buy homes.
The Federal National Mortgage Association
(Fannie Mae) and the Federal Home Loan

18.

165

COMMERCE AND HOUSING CREDIT

Mortgage Corporation (Freddie Mac) are congressionally chartered, shareholder-owned corporations known as Government Sponsored
Enterprises (or GSEs). Congress chartered
them to provide stability in the secondary
market for residential mortgages, and promote
access to mortgage credit throughout the
Nation, including under-served areas. The
GSEs issue and guarantee mortgage-backed
securities (MBS), and they hold debt-financed
portfolios of mortgages, MBS, and other mortgage-related securities. By the end of 1996,
Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac had financed
$1.51 trillion in mortgages and other assets.
As of September 30, 1996, the two GSEs
had outstanding $1.4 trillion in mortgages
purchased or guaranteed. Because they are
classified as private, Fannie Mae and Freddie
Mac are not included in the budget.
A third housing GSE, the Federal Home
Loan Bank System (FHLBS), is a memberowned cooperative that provides liquidity to
mortgage lenders by making collateralized
loans, called advances. At the end of 1996,
outstanding FHLBS advances totaled $153
billion.
The Government also plays an important
role in ensuring that consumers get the
information they need to make informed
housing decisions. For example, HUD and
the Environmental Protection Agency jointly
issued a regulation in 1996 to require owners
of housing built before 1978 to disclose,
to prospective buyers or renters, information
about any known lead-based paint hazards.
Informed buyers and renters are best-positioned to decide how to protect their families
at an affordable cost.
Rental Housing and Homeless Assistance
Grants
The Federal Government also provides support for housing assistance through a number
of HUD programs in the Income Security
function. HUD’s rental programs provided
subsidies for over 4.8 million low-income
households in 1996—1.4 million for units
in conventional public housing projects; 1.8
million in rental subsidies attached to privately-owned multifamily housing projects; and
1.6 million in rental vouchers not tied to

specific projects. In addition, USDA’s RHS
rental assistance grants to low-income rural
households provided $541 million to support
40,050 new and existing rental units in
1996.
The Federal Government also makes grants
to help the homeless, supporting emergency
shelters and transitional and permanent housing. Four agencies—HUD, VA, the Department
of Health and Human Services, and the
Federal Emergency Management Agency—provide 98 percent of the Federal help targeted
to the homeless. For 1996, HUD provided
$823 million in homeless assistance grants,
representing 73 percent of the $1.13 billion
targeted Government-wide funding total.
Housing Tax Incentives
The Government provides significant support for housing through tax preferences.
The two largest tax benefits are the mortgage
interest deduction for owner-occupied homes
(which will cost the Government $285 billion
in lost revenue from 1998 to 2002) and
the deductibility of State and local property
tax on owner-occupied homes (costing $95
billion over the same five years).
Other tax provisions also encourage investment in housing: (1) homeowners can avoid
capital gains taxes from selling their homes
if they use the gains to buy another one
(costing $81 billion from 1998 to 2002);
(2) taxpayers 55 and older can avoid capital
gains taxes on up to $125,000 from selling
their homes (costing $27 billion); (3) States
and localities can issue tax-exempt mortgage
revenue bonds, whose proceeds subsidize purchases by first-time, low- and moderate-income
home buyers; and (4) installment sales provisions let some real estate sellers defer taxes.
Finally, the Low-Income Housing Tax Credit
provides incentives for constructing or renovating rental housing that helps low-income
tenants for at least 15 years. The President
proposes to expand tax benefits for homeowners, which would ensure that 99 percent
of all home sales are exempt from capital
gains taxes.

166
Commerce, Technology, and International
Trade
The Commerce Department and SBA promote industrial competitiveness.
Commerce promotes the development of
technology and advocates sound technology
policies. Commerce’s Advanced Technology
Program provides cost-shared, competitive
grants for industry research and development
that are paying off in jobs created, strategic
alliances formed, and technology developed.
Commerce’s Manufacturing Extension Partnership (MEP) provides technological information
and expertise to the Nation’s 381,000 smaller
manufacturers. MEP’s clients indicate an 8to-1 return on Federal investment in firm
sales, jobs created or retained, and labor
and material savings. Commerce’s Patent and
Trademark Office (PTO) protects U.S. intellectual property rights around the world through
bilateral and multilateral negotiation, and
through its domestic patent and trademark
system, now issuing over 100,000 patents
a year. Its International Trade Administration
(ITA) promotes exports, fights unfair foreign
trade barriers, and negotiates multilateral
and bilateral trade agreements. In 1995 alone,
ITA estimates that it supported $15.5 billion
in gross exports and 248,000 jobs.
Commerce’s Census Bureau collects, tabulates, and distributes a wide variety of
statistical information about Americans and
the economy. A key effort is the constitutionally-mandated decennial census—the basis
for reapportioning seats in the U.S. House
of Representatives, redrawing State legislative
districts, and distributing billions of dollars
of Federal, State, and local funds. In addition,
Commerce’s Bureau of Economic Analysis prepares and interprets U.S. economic accounts,
including the gross domestic product, wealth
accounts, and the U.S. balance of payments.
SBA, which Congress created in 1953 to
aid, counsel, assist, and protect small business,
expands access to capital by guaranteeing
private loans. The loans carry longer terms
and lower rates than the small businesses
otherwise would have received. SBA guaranteed over $8.2 billion in small business
loans in 1996.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Financial Regulation
The Government protects depositors against
losses when insured commercial banks, thrifts,
and credit unions fail. Deposit insurance
also wards off widespread disruption in financial markets by making it less likely that
one institution’s failure will cause a financial
panic and a cascade of other failures. From
1985 to 1995, Federal deposit insurance protected depositors in over 1,400 failed banks
and 1,100 savings associations, with total
deposits of over $700 billion. The Resolution
Trust Corporation (RTC), a temporary agency
created to handle thrift failures from 1989
to 1995, protected 25 million deposit accounts
in 747 failed institutions.
The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
(FDIC) insures the deposits of banks and
savings associations (thrifts) through two separate insurance funds, the Bank Insurance
Fund (BIF) and the Savings Association Insurance Fund (SAIF). The National Credit Union
Administration (NCUA) insures the deposits
of credit unions. Currently, these varied kinds
of deposits are insured for up to $100,000
per account. The FDIC insures deposits at
over 9,500 commercial banks and almost
2,000 savings institutions, for a total of
$2.7 trillion in insured deposits. The NCUA
insures about 11,500 credit unions, with $260
billion in insured deposits.
Because the Government bears the risk
of losses, it regulates banks, thrifts, and
credit unions to ensure that they operate
in a safe and sound manner. Five agencies
regulate Federally-insured depository institutions: The Office of the Comptroller of the
Currency regulates national banks, the Office
of Thrift Supervision regulates thrifts, the
Federal Reserve regulates State-chartered
banks that are Fed members, the FDIC
regulates other State-chartered banks, and
the NCUA regulates credit unions.
Other regulatory institutions include the
Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC)
and the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC). The SEC oversees U.S. capital
markets and regulates the securities industry,
protecting investors and maintaining the fairness and integrity of domestic securities markets by preventing fraud and abuse and
ensuring the adequate disclosure of informa-

18.

COMMERCE AND HOUSING CREDIT

tion. The CFTC regulates U.S. futures and
options markets, preventing fraud and abuse.
Commerce Tax Incentives
The tax law provides incentives to encourage
business investment and savings. Those who
inherit capital assets, for instance, do not
pay taxes on gains that accrued during
the original owner’s lifetime—a benefit that
will cost the Government an estimated $173

167
billion from 1998 to 2002. Capital gains
also are subject to a maximum 28 percent
rate, making them attractive to taxpayers
who are paying higher income tax rates.
Other capital gains provisions benefit investments in small businesses. Other tax provisions benefit small firms, including the graduated corporate income tax and up-front
deductions, or ‘‘expensing,’’ for certain investments by small businesses.

19.
Table 19–1.

TRANSPORTATION
FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF
TRANSPORTATION
(In millions of dollars)

Function 400

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Spending: 1
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
13,628
13,782
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
2,501
2,450
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
47
216
Guaranteed loans ...............................
826
1,065
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
1,320
1,365
1 This

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

13,534

14,566

14,722

14,978

15,236

2,381
35

2,329
22

2,151
6

2,031
–51

1,954
–651

591
477

791
477

863
477

879
477

879
477

1,405

1,455

1,505

1,560

1,620

table excludes spending subject to obligation limitations.

America’s transportation network moves
people through a combination of public and
private systems, financed by Federal, State,
and local governments and the private sector.
Maintaining and improving these systems
requires infrastructure investment, safe operations, and new technology.
Though the Federal Government plays a
major role in each of these areas, it does
not act alone in any of them. With just
a few exceptions, Federal transportation programs are designed to promote transportation
access for all citizens, ensure the safe design
and movement of privately-owned and operated vehicles, help a struggling segment of
the transportation industry, or advance transportation research. In total, Federal transportation spending comes to about $39 billion
a year.
Infrastructure Investment
America has four million miles of roads,
580,000 bridges, 123,000 miles of railway,
5,500 public-use airports, 6,000 transit systems, and 25,000 miles of commercially-navigable waterways. This extensive, multi-modal
network is essential to the Nation’s commerce,

and a more efficient system would help
the economy.
The Federal Government has helped develop
large parts of the system, with much of
the help financed by user fees and transportation taxes. Total Federal investment in
transportation represents about half of total
public investment—that is, $27 billion of
the $54 billion of Federal, State, and local
spending on transportation infrastructure in
1993.
Highways and Bridges: About 950,000
miles of roads and all bridges are eligible for
Federal support, including the Interstate highway system, urban freeways, urban and rural
principal and minor arterials, defense highways, and Federal lands roads. In 1998, the
Federal Government plans to spend $19.8 billion to maintain and expand these roads, with
the Federal funds financed by motor fuels
taxes, mainly the gasoline tax. The Federal
gas tax is 18.4 cents a gallon, of which 12
cents finances formula grants to States for
highway-related repair and improvement.
State and local governments provide 56
percent of total highway and bridge infrastructure spending, most of which they generate
169

170
through their own fuel and vehicle taxes.
The average State gasoline tax was 19.3
cents per gallon in 1995. State and local
governments also are accelerating their infrastructure projects by using debt financing,
such as bonds and revolving loan funds.
Under the new State Infrastructure Banks
program, the Federal Government is providing
funds to States to help underwrite debt
issuance for highway and transit projects.
In addition, the new Transportation Infrastructure Credit Program promises to provide
similar financing innovations for nationally
significant projects.
The Interstate highway system is virtually
complete, with 45,481 of the 45,500-mile
system open to the public. Its completion
marks the end of America’s largest-ever public
works project, begun during the Eisenhower
Administration as a ‘‘grand plan’’ to meet
the transportation needs of a rapidly growing
Nation.
Transit: As with highways, the Federal
Government plays a partnership role with
State and local governments on mass transit.
Two cents a gallon of the Federal gas tax goes
to fund transit grants to municipalities and
States. Federal capital grants comprise about
half of the total spent each year to maintain
and expand the Nation’s 6,000 bus, rail, trolley, van, and ferry systems. Together, States
and localities invest over $3 billion a year on
transit infrastructure and equipment, including funds to ‘‘match’’ Federal grants.
In 1998, the Federal Government plans
to spend $4 billion on transit capital. The
Federal role is especially important to finance
capital-intensive urban rail systems and lowvolume rural bus and van networks. About
80 million Americans depend on public transportation due to age, disability, or income.
Furthermore, transit use by commuters eases
roadway congestion and reduces polluting
emissions.
Passenger Rail: The Federal Government
will invest about $424 million in 1998 to support the passenger rail system’s infrastructure
and equipment needs. The extension of the
Northeast Corridor high-speed rail to Boston
highlights the partnership between the Federal Government and private sector to improve
passenger rail. The Federal Government funds

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

the electrification of the rail line, while the
private sector helps to finance the high-speed
trainsets that will begin operating in late
1999, introducing three-hour service between
New York City and Boston.
Airports: The Airport Improvement Program (AIP) provides grants to States, localities, and airport authorities to maintain and
enhance airport safety, preserve airport infrastructure, and expand capacity and efficiency
throughout the system. The AIP typically
funds a fourth to a third of all capital development at public use airports, while airport revenues (e.g., concession revenues, landing fees,
passenger facility charges) finance the rest.
Other Transportation: With regard to
commercial shipping infrastructure, Federal
loan guarantees facilitate the construction of
new vessels and the renovation of existing vessels. Port development is left largely to State
and local authorities, which have invested over
$14 billion in infrastructure improvements
over the past 50 years. Of America’s 541 private freight railroads, the largest 11 moved
over one trillion ton-miles of freight in 1994—
about a third of the total ton-miles shipped.
Freight railroads finance their own infrastructure, spending over $7 billion a year to upgrade and maintain track and structures.
Safe Operations
The Federal Government works with State
and local governments and private groups
to mitigate the safety risks inherent in the
transportation system. It regulates motor vehicle design and operation, inspects commercial
vehicles, educates the public about safe behavior, directs air and waterway traffic, and
rescues boaters in danger.
A broad range of Federal activities are
designed to cut the number of deaths and
injuries from highway crashes, which number
about 41,000 and five million a year, respectively. Due to Federal, State, local, and
private efforts, safety belt usage reached
an all-time high of 68 percent in December
1995. Federal programs reach out to State
and local partners, including health care
professionals, to identify the causes of crashes
in each community and develop new strategies
to reduce deaths, injuries, and the resulting
medical costs. These programs will be increas-

19.

171

TRANSPORTATION

ingly important as the number of young
drivers grows. In addition to coordinating
national traffic safety campaigns, the National
Highway
Traffic
Safety
Administration
(NHTSA) regulates the design of automobiles
and light trucks, investigates reported safety
defects, and distributes traffic safety grants
to States. The budget proposes $333 million
for NHTSA, a 10-percent increase over 1997.
The Federal Government’s most visible safety function is operating the air traffic control
and air navigational systems. The Federal
Aviation Administration (FAA) handles about
two flights a second, moving 1.5 million
passengers to where they want to go each
day. The FAA also uses its regulatory and
certification power to ensure that every aspect
of aviation is safe—from aircraft design and
maintenance to the flight crew. In 1996,
the FAA performed over 300,000 inspections
to ensure compliance with safety regulations.
To meet safety needs in 1998, the Administration plans to spend $7.2 billion on FAA
operations and capital, five percent more
than in 1997.
The Federal Government also plays an
operational role on major waterways. The
Coast Guard places and maintains waterborne
aids-to-navigation, operates radio navigation
and distress systems, guides vessels through
busy ports, and regulates vessel design and
operation. The Coast Guard helps ensure
safety on minor waterways and inland lakes
by providing boating safety grants to States,
and by supporting a 35,000-member voluntary
auxiliary that performs complimentary boat
safety inspections and educates boaters about
safety. In 1998, the Coast Guard will invest
$3.1 billion in its operating and capital
programs, which are mainly dedicated to
safety.
The National Motor Carriers Program, for
which the budget proposes $100 million in
1998, provides grants to States to enforce
Federal and compatible State standards for
commercial motor vehicle safety inspections,
traffic enforcement, and compliance reviews.
Uniform standards help coordinate law enforcement activities, and simplify the safety
requirements of interstate trucking. Federal
grants are designed to help States boost
safety.

Research and Technology
The Federal Government has long led efforts
to advance transportation technology. Federal
transportation research has focused on building stronger roads and bridges, designing
safer cars, and reducing human error in
operating vehicles of all types. Today, the
increasing congestion of roadways and airways
is colliding with Federal budget constraints
and with environmental and land-use concerns. Consequently, transportation planners
believe that better management of the existing
infrastructure is a cost-effective alternative
to building more highways and airports. In
1998, the Federal Government will spend
over $1 billion on transportation research
and technology.
The Federal Highway Administration’s Intelligent Transportation Systems (ITS) program
is developing and deploying technologies that
will help States and localities improve traffic
flow and safety on their streets and highways.
These technologies include intelligent cruise
control, passive tolling and inspection, and
automated highways. The private sector, which
works closely with the ITS program, will
initially deploy many of the technologies
developed with ITS funding.
The FAA’s research, engineering, and development programs help improve safety, security, capacity, and efficiency in the National
Airspace System. For instance, the advanced
traffic management system and the early
introduction of satellite navigation capabilities
will improve the aviation industry’s competitiveness and the FAA’s efficiency. In general,
FAA research focuses on the causes of human
error; aircraft safety and fire protection methods; aviation weather research; quieter engines
and reduced aircraft emissions; and security
and explosives detection systems.
The National Aeronautics and Space Administration’s Aeronautical Research and Technology program funds partnerships with industry that may revolutionize the next generation
of airplanes, making them faster, more efficient, and more compatible with the environment. These activities include programs to
advance the capabilities of sub-sonic aircraft,
to help develop large, high-speed civilian
airplanes, and to enhance the performance

172
of aeronautics-related computing and communications facilities.
Regulation of Transportation
Federal rules greatly influence transportation. Over the past two decades, deregulation
of the domestic railroad, airline, and interstate
trucking industries has contributed to the
Nation’s economic growth. More recently, deregulation has continued. In 1993, for example,
the Federal Government deregulated intrastate trucking, saving shippers and consumers
an estimated $3 billion to $8 billion a year.
The Federal Government also issues regulations to spur safer, cleaner transportation.
The regulations improve safety—of cars,
trucks, trains, and airplanes—leading to substantial reductions in transportation-related
deaths and injuries. In addition, they help
reduce the number of oil spills and provide
a faster response when spills occur.
The Government has taken other regulatory
steps to meet transportation-related environmental and safety goals in a cost-effective
manner. For example, between now and 2015,

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

the costs of oil shipments to the United
States will fall by hundreds of millions of
dollars due to ‘‘lightering zone’’ regulations
that permit older, single-hull vessels in the
Gulf of Mexico to off-load oil. The Federal
Government is also making its regulations
parallel with those of other countries. An
agreement on aviation safety rules—now
under negotiation with the European Community—promises to save airlines at least $100
million, and possibly $1 billion, over 10
years.
Tax Expenditures
Employer-provided parking and transit
passes are, for the most part, not subject
to income taxes, costing the Government
an estimated $6.9 billion from 1998–2002;
the estimate does not include the value
of employer-owned parking. To finance infrastructure, State and local governments issue
tax-exempt bonds whose costs to the Federal
Government, in lost revenues, are reflected
in the General Government and Community
and Regional Development functions.

20.

Table 20–1.

COMMUNITY AND REGIONAL
DEVELOPMENT
FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF COMMUNITY
AND REGIONAL DEVELOPMENT
(In millions of dollars)

Function 450

1996
Actual

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
11,645
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
317
Proposed legislation ....................... ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
1,963
Guaranteed loans ...............................
839
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
2,650
Proposed legislation ........................... ................

Federal support for community and regional
development helps build the Nation’s economy,
and helps economically distressed urban and
rural communities earn a larger share of
America’s prosperity. The Federal Government
spends over $12 billion a year, and offers
about $2.7 billion in tax incentives, to help
States and localities create jobs and economic
opportunity, and build infrastructure to support commercial and industrial development.
The needs of States and localities are
varied and hard to measure. Still, Federal
programs in this area have proved successful
in creating stable and healthy communities
that offer greater economic opportunity. The
Government helps communities with basic
infrastructure needs pay for constructing
roads, improving water and sewage systems,
and constructing affordable housing. For those
affected by layoffs and rising job insecurity,
Federal programs promote jobs skills through
employment training and education, and promote access to jobs by helping businesses
and rehabilitating commercial properties. Communities that are hard hit by natural disasters
receive Federal assistance to rebuild infra-

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

9,313

10,920

8,333

343
157

–112
5

2,313
1,454

2,460
1,941

1,908
2,055

2,700
40

2,740
450

2,720
551

2001

2002

7,681

7,751

7,870

63
126
20 ................

255
–15

63
–13

2,118
2,090

2,210
2,159

2,143
2,022

2,700
565

2,640
544

2,425
489

structure, businesses, and homes. States and
localities also use these Federal funds to
leverage private resources for their community
revitalization strategies.
Department of Housing and Urban
Development (HUD)
HUD provides communities with flexible
funds to promote commercial and industrial
development; enhance infrastructure; clean
up abandoned industrial sites, or ‘‘brownfields’’; and develop strategies for providing
affordable housing close to jobs. HUD estimates that projects for which it provided
economic assistance from 1993 to 1996 created
or saved 1.4 million jobs.
Community Development Block Grant
(CDBG): The CDBG program, for which the
budget proposes $4.6 billion, gives States and
localities flexible funds for activities that meet
one of three national objectives: (1) benefit lowand moderate-income persons, (2) help prevent
or eliminate slums or blight, or (3) meet other
urgent community needs that pose immediate
threats to public health. Every Federal dollar
spent for CDBG leverages an estimated $2.31
173

174
in private and other investment. Communities
spend CDBG funds to improve housing, public
works, public services, and economic development, and to acquire or clear land.
Seventy percent of CDBG funds go to
over 900 designated central cities and urban
counties, the remaining 30 percent to States
to award to smaller localities. CDBG’s Section
108 Loan Guarantee Program gives Federal
guarantees to private investors who buy debt
obligations issued by local governments, thus
giving communities efficient financing for
housing rehabilitation, economic development,
and large-scale physical development projects.
Indian CDBG programs provide services for
Native Americans, primarily focusing on public
infrastructure, community facilities, and economic development. In 1996, 84 Tribes received a total of $49 million in CDBG grants
through competition.
HOME: The budget proposes $1.3 billion in
flexible HOME grants to States and communities to address their most severe housing
needs. This program (classified in the Income
Security function) generates an estimated
$1.80 in private and other investment for
every Federal dollar spent. Eligible activities
include new construction, rehabilitation, acquisition of standard housing, assistance to home
buyers, and tenant-based rental assistance.
From the program’s inception in 1992 to June
1996, recipients have committed or used
HOME funds to build or rehabilitate 201,000
housing units and to help 26,500 families pay
their rent.
Department of Agriculture
The Agriculture Department (USDA) gives
financial assistance to rural communities and
businesses to provide safe drinking water
and adequate wastewater treatment facilities;
boost employment; and further diversify the
rural economy. The budget proposes $2.5
billion in such assistance. Grants, loans,
and loan guarantees go for constructing rural
community facilities, such as health clinics
and day care centers; constructing water
and wastewater systems; and creating or
expanding rural businesses. USDA offers loan
assistance for building community facilities
and water and wastewater facilities at interest
rates tied to the community’s income—the

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

lowest-income communities receive significantly subsidized interest rates. These programs are designed to help rural communities
with fewer than 10,000 residents. Since 1993,
over 4,500 communities have received financial
assistance to build or upgrade drinking water
or wastewater systems, and the rural business
and industry loan guarantee program has
created or saved over 110,00 rural jobs.
Department of the Treasury
Treasury’s Community Development Financial Institutions (CDFI) Fund, for which the
budget proposes $125 million, provides grants,
loans, equity investments, and technical assistance to qualified CDFIs—including community
development banks, low-income credit unions,
microenterprise funds, and many multi-bank
community development corporations. The assistance, which must be matched by comparable non-Federal money, is designed to
promote economic revitalization and community development. Federal funds may be used
for small business, low-income housing, community facilities, the provision of basic financial services, and other community development activities. In 1996, the CDFI Fund
approved $37 million for 32 CDFIs, serving
46 states and the District of Columbia. The
fund also awarded $13 million to 38 traditional
banks and thrifts for increasing their activities
in economically distressed communities and
investing in CDFIs.
Department of the Interior
The Interior Department’s Bureau of Indian
Affairs (BIA), for which the budget proposes
$1.7 billion in 1998, helps Tribes, Native
American organizations, and individuals develop resources to improve their economies
through financial assistance programs, various
loans and grants, assistance in getting financing from other sources, and technical assistance in using agricultural and rangeland
resources. BIA’s guaranteed business loans
in 1996 generated about $40 million in total
financing, creating or sustaining over 1,700
jobs.
Each year, BIA helps Tribes manage 16
million acres of forest land and conduct
timber sales of $250 million that sustain
over 10,000 forest and timber-related jobs,
and helps Tribes manage mineral resources

20.

175

COMMUNITY AND REGIONAL DEVELOPMENT

and generate mineral income. BIA funds
housing improvement and maintains over
4,500 single family housing units for BIA
teachers and other reservation-based staff.
Finally, BIA (with the Transportation Department) maintains and improves over 40,000
miles of public and BIA roads and 745
bridges, and addresses deficiencies at over
100 high-hazard dams on reservations.
The Tennessee Valley Authority (TVA)
The TVA adds to the prosperity of seven
States by: (1) providing reliable supplies of
electricity at rates that are among the Nation’s
lowest, (2) paying over $250 million a year
to State and local governments in lieu of
taxes, and (3) operating economic and regional
development programs that provide flood protection, recreational facilities, navigation, and
various other services. The budget proposes
$106 million for these purposes, but TVA
will develop a plan to eliminate Federal
funding for these programs for 1999 and
beyond. In 1997 and 1998, TVA will work
with Congress, State and local governments,
and other interested parties and undertake
a major effort to find alternate ways to
fund, organize, and manage these programs.
The proposal reflects TVA’s efforts over several
years to decrease its reliance on Federal
funds to finance its activities.
The Economic Development
Administration (EDA)
The EDA creates jobs and stimulates commercial and industrial growth in economically
distressed areas—rural and urban areas with
high unemployment, a large share of poor
people, or sudden and severe distress. EDA’s
public works grants help build or expand
public facilities to stimulate and foster industrial and commercial growth. Typical projects
include industrial parks, business incubators,
access roads, water and sewer lines, and
port and terminal developments. From 1992
to 1996, EDA awarded 821 public works
grants, totaling $810 million, to help economically distressed communities build these types
of infrastructure projects.
EDA’s capacity building grants help communities pay for expertise to plan, implement,
and coordinate comprehensive economic development projects. The grants also provide

technical assistance to communities and firms
to find solutions to problems that stifle
economic growth. In addition, EDA’s economic
adjustment assistance grants help communities solve severe adjustment problems, such
as those resulting from natural disasters
and industry relocations or major downsizings.
To date, EDA has approved 479 disaster
recovery grants, totaling $403 million, to
help impacted communities recover from natural disasters that include hurricanes, flooding,
earthquakes, and tropical storms.
Disaster Relief
The Federal Government provides financial
help to cover a large share of the Nation’s
losses from natural hazards. Over the past
several years, spending from the two major
Federal disaster assistance programs—the
Federal Emergency Management Agency’s
(FEMA) Disaster Relief Fund and the Small
Business Administration’s (SBA) Disaster
Loan program—has risen significantly, and
private casualty insurers experienced their
five most costly natural disasters. Why? Because the natural hurricane cycle seems to
be entering a phase in which more hurricanes
strike our shores; demographic and economic
growth has been great in hurricane- and
earthquake-prone areas; and global climate
changes or cyclical weather trends seem to
be increasing the number and severity of
events.
The Federal Government shares the costs
with States for infrastructure rebuilding;
makes disaster loans to individuals and businesses; and provides grants for emergency
needs and housing assistance, unemployment
assistance, and crisis counseling. In addition,
the National Flood Insurance Program enables
property owners to purchase flood insurance
that’s unavailable in the commercial market.
To mitigate losses and in exchange for flood
insurance, communities must adopt and enforce floodplain management measures to protect lives and new construction from future
flooding. FEMA also encourages and supports
mitigation measures before disasters strike
by providing hazard mitigation grants, and
sponsoring training, preparedness, and other
planning events.

176
Tax Expenditures
The Federal Government provides several
tax incentives to encourage community and
regional development activities: (1) A 10 percent investment tax credit for rehabilitating
buildings that were built before 1936 for
non-residential purposes (costing $340 million
from 1998 to 2002); (2) tax-exempt bonds
for airports, docks, and wharves, as well
as high-speed rail facilities which need not
be government-owned (costing $9.3 billion
over the same five years); (3) tax-exemptions

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

for qualifying mutual and cooperative telephone and electric companies (costing $325
million over the five years); and, (4) tax
incentives for qualifying businesses in economically distressed areas that qualify as
Empowerment Zones—including an employer
wage credit, higher up-front deductions for
investments in equipment, tax-exempt financing, and accelerated depreciation (costing $3.2
billion over the five years). In addition,
the law provides tax credits for contributions
to certain community development banks.

21.

EDUCATION, TRAINING, EMPLOYMENT,
AND SOCIAL SERVICES

Table 21–1. FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF EDUCATION,
TRAINING, EMPLOYMENT, AND SOCIAL SERVICES
(In millions of dollars)
Function 500

1996
Actual

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
36,147
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
13,881
Proposed legislation ....................... ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
9,120
Guaranteed loans ...............................
19,816
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
25,200
Proposed legislation ........................... ................

The Federal Government helps States and
localities educate young people, helps the
low- skilled and jobless train for and find
jobs, helps youth and adults of all ages
overcome financial barriers to postsecondary
education and training, helps employers and
employees maintain safe and stable workplaces, and helps provide social services for
the needy. The Government spends about
$60 billion a year on grants to States and
localities; on grants, loans, and scholarships
to individuals; on direct Federal program
administration; and on subsidies leveraging
over $30 billion in loans to individuals.
It also allocates nearly $33 billion a year
in tax incentives for individuals.
Education
Education has long been a national priority,
and for good reason. Education has served
as the steppingstone for Americans who wanted better lives for themselves and their
families. At the same time, Americans view
education as mainly the province of State
and local governments, and of families and
individuals. Education spending reflects these

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

42,387

46,425

47,420

48,455

49,459

50,335

10,487
–340

10,785
2,791

10,475
4,589

10,625
4,986

10,796
4,524

11,299
1,938

11,984
20,958

14,536
21,256

17,636
20,548

20,162
20,540

21,736
21,538

23,076
22,872

27,020
166

27,865
4,919

29,165
7,201

30,480
8,862

31,880
9,038

33,340
9,506

views—of the more than $500 billion a year
that the Nation spends on elementary, secondary, and postsecondary education, 91 percent
comes from State, local, and private sources.
The Federal Government contributes just nine
percent.
But, though a small share of the overall
investment, Federal spending targets important national needs, such as equal opportunity
and high academic standards. For postsecondary education, three-fourths of all student
financial aid comes in federally-backed student
loans, Pell Grants, and other Federal help—
and Federal aid helps half of all students
pay for college. To expand access to college,
the Administration is proposing a new HOPE
scholarship tax credit and a tax deduction,
to make two years of postsecondary education
universally available and to open the doors
to lifelong learning.
At elementary and secondary schools, most
disadvantaged students get extra help to
succeed through the Federal Title I program,
launched as part of the War on Poverty
and providing supplementary services, such
177

178
as special tutoring in math, to low-income
children. The return on this Federal investment has been dramatic. Citing Title I,
as well as Head Start and child nutrition
programs, a 1994 RAND study found that
‘‘the most plausible’’ way to explain big
education gains of low-income and minority
children in the past 30 years is ‘‘some
combination of increased public investment
in education and social programs and changed
social policies aimed at equalizing educational
opportunities.’’ Minority students have made
substantial gains in science, math, and reading
since the 1970s, narrowing the gap between
minority and Caucasian student achievement.
But progress has slowed in recent years,
prompting the Federal Government to redirect
its strategies. The Goals 2000 program is
designed to elevate academic expectations
for all students, by encouraging every State
to set challenging standards in core subject
areas. Recent changes to the Elementary
and Secondary Education Act give schools
more flexibility in return for greater accountability, creating an environment in which
the schools use resources more efficiently.
Similarly, Federal support for ‘‘charter schools’’
enables parents, teachers, and communities
to create new, innovative public schools, which
the States free from most rules and regulations and, at the same time, hold accountable
for raising student achievement. Federal
progress in helping students with disabilities
also has proved significant. High school graduation rates have risen significantly, and
57 percent of youth with disabilities are
competitively employed within five years of
graduating from high school.
But in the last 30 years, perhaps the
Federal Government’s most important role
in education has been to help Americans
afford to attend college. Federal grants, loans,
and work study, which went to 7.2 million
students in 1996, particularly help low- and
middle-income families. From 1964 to 1993,
college enrollment nearly tripled, the share
of high school graduates that attended college
rose by a third, and college enrollment rates
for minority high school graduates rose by
nearly two-thirds.
While enrollment rates rose for all groups,
gaps by race and family income have widened

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

since 1980. One reason seems to be rising
tuition, caused mainly by cuts in State support; 76 percent of all students attend State
public higher education institutions. Lowincome families are particularly sensitive to
tuition increases, and minority families have
been reluctant to take out loans, which
have been the fastest-growing component of
Federal aid. The availability of income-contingent loan repayments since 1993, and other
flexible repayment options, are designed to
help address the appropriate fears of lowincome families about assuming loans. In
addition, the proposed 21 percent increase
in the maximum Pell grant scholarship between 1996 and 1998 is designed to help
these families.
The economic returns to a college education
are large. In 1993, full-time male workers
over 25 years old with at least a bachelor’s
degree earned 89 percent more than comparable workers with only a high school
degree. But not only do the college graduates
themselves benefit. The higher socioeconomic
status of parents also leads to greater educational achievement by their children.
Skill Training
The elementary, secondary, and postsecondary avenues cited above lay the groundwork
for Americans to get the skills they need
to acquire good jobs in an increasingly competitive global economy. Most workers also
acquire additional skills on the job or through
the billions of dollars that employers spend
to improve worker skills and productivity.
These efforts help the vast majority of working-age Americans.
Nevertheless, others need additional kinds
of assistance. Consequently, the Federal Government spends nearly $7 billion a year
through Labor Department programs to help
dislocated workers train for, and find, new
jobs, and to help economically-disadvantaged
Americans learn skills with which they can
move into the labor force. This aid includes
a labor exchange—the State Employment
Service—for anyone who wants to learn about
job openings.
The Federal Government helps dislocated
workers move from one job to the next.
Nearly 70 percent of participants in the

21.

EDUCATION, TRAINING, EMPLOYMENT, AND SOCIAL SERVICES

Job Training Partnership Act’s (JTPA) Dislocated Worker program have jobs when they
leave, with average earnings of 92 percent
of their previous wages. In addition, JTPA’s
Title II help disadvantaged adults, including
welfare recipients, to get jobs. Over half
of the welfare recipients who received help
under Title II started jobs, with wages that
averaged nearly $7 an hour.
Other programs help youth move from
high school to more schooling or work by
helping States and localities build Schoolto-Work systems, support vocational training
in secondary and postsecondary institutions,
and provide a ‘‘second chance’’ to low-income
youth who have not fared well in school
or the labor market. States began to implement School-to-Work systems in 1994.
For youth who need it, the Job Corps
provides intensive skill training, academic
and social education, and support services
in a structured, residential setting. Other
programs provide summer work experience
or more job training.
Workplace Safety and Law Enforcement
The Federal Government spends about $500
million a year to promote safe and healthy
workplaces for 100 million workers in six
million workplaces, mainly through the Labor
Department’s Occupational Safety and Health
Administration (OSHA) and Mine Safety and
Health Administration. Regulations that help
business create and maintain safe and healthy
workplaces have significantly reduced illness,
injury, and death from exposure to hazardous
substances and dangerous equipment. The
regulations clearly produce results that far
exceed what Federal funds could achieve.
OSHA also helps employers institute effective
safety and health programs, while maintaining
its strong enforcement capability.
The Government also regulates compliance
with various laws that grant workers other
protections—a minimum wage for virtually
all workers, prevailing wages for workers
on government contracts, overtime pay, restrictions on child labor, and time off for family
illness or childbirth. In these cases, as with
worker health and safety, the Federal Government works with the private sector to achieve

179

important social goals that the Government
could never achieve through Federal financing
alone.
National Service
The Corporation for National and Community Service, which the Government established in 1993 at the President’s urging,
encourages Americans of all ages to engage
in community-based service. The budget proposes about $800 million to support these
programs in 1998.
AmeriCorps, the Corporation’s signature initiative, each year enables thousands of young
Americans of all backgrounds to serve their
local communities full- or part-time. In return,
they receive a minimum living allowance
and an education award to help pay for
post-secondary education. About 70,000 individuals have participated in AmeriCorps in
its first three years, with another 35,000
expected to serve under the budget proposals.
About a third of new participants in 1998
would participate in America Reads—an effort
through which volunteers will help children
read by themselves, and well, by the third
grade.
Along with AmeriCorps, the Corporation
supports the National Senior Volunteer Corps
through which older Americans volunteer their
time and energy to help their communities,
children with disabilities, and the infirm
elderly. Nearly 600,000 older Americans would
participate in 1998.
Public Broadcasting
The budget proposes $325 million for the
Corporation for Public Broadcasting (CPB)
to help the 352 public television stations
and the 692 radio stations provide quality
educational programming through such avenues as National Public Radio and the Public
Broadcasting Service. Stations use CPB funds
to produce original children’s and educational
programs, and to acquire historical and cultural programs. CPB also helps finance several
system-wide activities, including national satellite interconnection services and payments
of music royalty fees.

180
Social Services
Along with helping youth and adults gain
basic and higher education and advanced
workplace skills, the Federal Government
provides about $xx billion a year in grants
to States and local public and private institutions to help defray the cost of social services.
Those who receive these services include
low-income individuals, the elderly, people
with disabilities, children, and youth.
Tax Incentives
The Federal Government helps individuals,
families, and employers (on behalf of their
employees) plan for and buy education and
training through numerous tax preferences,
totaling $32.8 billion in 1998. The budget
proposes new HOPE scholarship tax credits
of up to $1,500 a year for two years of
postsecondary education, and again proposes
tax deductions of up to $10,000 for tuition
and fees for college, graduate school, or
job training.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

The tax code already provides other avenues
for saving, and paying, for education and
training. State and local governments can
issue tax-exempt debt to finance student
loans or the construction of facilities used
by non-profit educational institutions. Interest
from certain U.S. Savings Bonds also is
tax-free if the bonds are used solely to
finance educational costs. Also under the
tax code, many employers can, and do, provide
employee benefits that are not counted as
income.
The law offers employers a Work Opportunity Tax Credit, enabling them to claim
a tax credit for a portion of wages they
pay to certain hard-to-employ individuals who
work for the employer for a minimum period.
The budget proposes: (1) to enhance the
credit with regard to long-term welfare recipients, and (2) to extend the existing credit
to able-bodied childless adults aged 18 to
50 who, under the Administration’s Food
Stamp proposal, would face a more rigorous
work requirement in order to continue receiving Food Stamps.

22.
Table 22–1.

HEALTH

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF HEALTH
(In millions of dollars)

Function 550

Estimate

1996
Actual

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
23,303
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
96,806
Proposed legislation ....................... ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
25
Guaranteed loans ...............................
210
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
72,745
Proposed legislation ........................... ................

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

25,045

25,070

25,123

25,139

25,154

25,170

103,541
39

109,601
3,940

116,321
3,669

124,764
2,059

134,621
–175

145,107
–4,998

The Federal Government helps meet America’s health care needs by directly providing
health care services, by promoting disease
prevention and consumer and occupational
safety, by conducting and supporting research,
and by training and helping to train the
Nation’s health care work force. All together,
the Federal Government will spend about
$138 billion in 1998, and allocate $85 billion
in tax incentives.
President Johnson and Congress created
Medicaid in 1965 to provide health insurance
for the low-income elderly and the poor.
Since then, the Nation’s leaders have expanded the program from time to time to
meet emerging needs. In 1986, for instance,
they answered public concerns about high
infant mortality rates and the decline in
private insurance coverage by expanding Medicaid coverage for prenatal and child health
services.
In addition, the Federal Government helps
to expand health care coverage to those
with which it has a special obligation (including veterans, uniformed military personnel,
and American Indians and Alaska Natives),
and conducts and sponsors vital biomedical
research that would not otherwise take place.

20 ................ ................ ................ ................ ................
274
105
6 ................ ................ ................
79,245
8

85,095
19

91,185
12

97,255
3

103,675
3

110,445
1

Together, all of these Federal activities have
helped to extend life expectancy, cut the
infant mortality rate to historic lows, level
the death rate among those with HIV/AIDS,
and make other progress.
Health Care Services
Of the estimated $138 billion in Federal
health care outlays in 1998 1, 89 percent
finances or supports direct heath care services
to individuals.
Medicaid: This Federal-State health care
program served about 37 million low-income
Americans in 1996—with the Federal Government spending $92 billion (57 percent of the
total), while States spent $70 billion (43 percent). States that participate in Medicaid must
cover several categories of eligible people, including certain low-income elderly, people with
disabilities, low-income women and children,
and several mandated services, including hospital care, nursing home care, and physician
services. States also may cover optional populations and services. Under current law, Federal experts expect total Medicaid spending to
1 Excluding Medicare and the military and veterans medical programs.

181

182
grow an average of 7.2 percent a year from
1997 to 2002.
Medicaid covers a fourth of the Nation’s
children and is the largest single purchaser
of maternity care as well as of nursing
home services and other long-term care services; the program covers almost two-thirds
of nursing home residents. The elderly and
disabled made up only 30 percent of Medicaid
beneficiaries in 1995, but accounted for 61
percent of spending on benefits. Adults and
children made up 70 percent of recipients,
but accounted for only 25 percent of spending
on benefits. Medicaid serves at least half
of all adults living with AIDS (and up
to 90 percent of children with AIDS), and
is the largest single payor of direct medical
services to adults living with AIDS.
States increasingly rely on managed care
arrangements to provide health care through
Medicaid, with enrollment in such arrangements rising from 7.8 million in 1994 to
11.6 million (about a third of all recipients)
in 1995.
Other Health Care Services: The Department of Health and Human Services (HHS)
supplements Medicare (discussed in Chapter
23) and Medicaid with a number of ‘‘gap-filling’’ grant activities to support health services
for low-income or specific populations, including Consolidated Health Center grants; Ryan
White AIDS treatment grants; the Maternal
and Child Health block grant; Family Planning; and the Substance Abuse block grant.
In addition, the Indian Health Service (IHS)
provides direct care to 1.4 million American
Indians and Alaskan Natives as part of the
Federal Government’s trust obligations. The
IHS system, located primarily on or near reservations, includes 49 hospitals, 190 health
centers, and almost 300 other clinics.
Prevention Services: Prevention can go a
long way to improve American’s health. Measures to protect public health can be as basic
as providing good sanitation and as sophisticated as preventing bacteria from developing
resistance to antibiotics. State and local health
departments traditionally lead such efforts,
but the Federal Government—through HHS’
Centers for Disease Control and Prevention—
also provides financial and technical support.
For a half-century, CDC has worked with

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

State and local governments to prevent syphilis and eliminate smallpox and other communicable diseases. More recently, CDC has focused its efforts on preventing a host of diseases, including breast cancer, prostate cancer,
lead poisoning among children, and HIV/AIDS.
National Institutes of Health (NIH): NIH
is among the world’s foremost biomedical research centers and the Federal focal point for
biomedical research in the United States. NIH
research is designed to gain knowledge to help
prevent, detect, diagnose, and treat disease
and disability. NIH conducts research in its
own laboratories and clinical facilities; supports research by non-Federal scientists in universities, medical schools, hospitals, and research institutions across the Nation and
around the world; helps train research investigators; and fosters communication of biomedical information.
At any one time, NIH supports 35,000
grants to universities, medical schools, and
other research and research training institutions. It also conducts over 2,000 projects
in its own laboratories and clinical facilities.
NIH research has helped to achieve many
of the Nation’s most important public health
advances, such as reducing mortality from
heart disease, the Nation’s number one killer,
by four percent from 1971 to 1991; reducing
death rates from stroke by 59 percent over
the same period; and increasing the fiveyear survival rate for people with cancer
to 52 percent. Recent NIH-sponsored research
has generated significant advances in treatments for individuals infected with HIV,
medications for Alzheimer’s disease, and revolutionary innovations in molecular genetics
and genomics research.
Food and Drug Administration: The Food
and Drug Administration (FDA) spends about
$1 billion a year to promote public health by
helping to ensure—through pre-market review
and post-market surveillance—that foods are
safe, wholesome, and sanitary; human and veterinary drugs, biological products, and medical
devices are safe and effective; and cosmetics
and electronic products that emit radiation are
safe. FDA also helps the public gain access
to important new life-saving drugs, biological
products, and medical devices. It leads Federal
efforts to ensure the timely review of products

22.

183

HEALTH

and ensure that regulations enhance public
health, not serve as an unnecessary regulatory
burden. In addition, the FDA supports research, consumer education, and the development of both voluntary and regulatory measures to ensure the safety and efficacy of drugs,
medical devices, and foods.
Food Safety and Inspection Service
(FSIS): FSIS inspects the Nation’s meat, poultry, and egg products, ensuring that they are
safe, wholesome, and not adulterated. With annual funding of almost $600 million, agency
staff inspect all domestic livestock and poultry
in slaughter plants, and conduct at least daily
inspections of meat, poultry, and egg product
processing plants. In 1996, FSIS issued a
major regulation that will begin to shift responsibility for ensuring meat and poultry
safety from FSIS to the industry. The regulation should allow FSIS to better target its inspection resources to the higher-risk elements
of the meat and poultry production, slaughter,
and marketing processes.
Federal Employees Health Benefits Program (FEHBP): Established in 1960, the
FEHBP is America’s largest employer-sponsored multiple-choice health program, providing $17 billion in comprehensive hospital and
major medical benefits a year to about 9.6 million Federal workers, annuitants, and their dependents. About 86 percent of all eligible Federal employees participate in the FEHBP, and
they select from nearly 400 health insurance
carriers that offer a broad choice of delivery
systems. The FEHBP offers full coverage upon
enrollment—without medical examinations or
restrictions based on age, current health, or
pre-existing condition.
Veterans’ Health Care
With a proposed 1998 health budget of
$17.5 billion (including receipts), the Department of Veterans Affairs (VA) provides health
care services to 2.9 million veterans through
its national system of 22 integrated health
networks, consisting of 173 hospitals, 491
outpatient clinics, 135 nursing homes, and
40 domiciliaries 2. VA is an important part
of the Nation’s social safety net because
almost half of its patients are low-income
2 Domiciliaries serve homeless veterans and veterans who require short-term rehabilitation.

veterans who might not otherwise receive
care. It also is a leading health care provider
for veterans with substance abuse problems,
mental illness, HIV/AIDS, and spinal cord
injuries because private insurance usually
does not fully cover these illnesses.
VA’s core mission is to meet the health
care needs of veterans who have compensable
service-connected injuries or very low incomes.
The law makes these ‘‘core’’ veterans the
highest priority for available Federal dollars
for health care. But, VA may provide care
to lower-priority veterans if resources allow
and if the needs of higher-priority veterans
have been met.
In recent years, VA has reorganized its
field facilities from 173 largely independent
medical centers into 22 Veterans Integrated
Service Networks charged with giving veterans
the full continuum of care. VA also has
won legislation easing restrictions on its ability
to contract for care and share resources
with Defense Department hospitals, state facilities, and local health care providers.
Health Research: VA’s research program,
for which the budget proposes $234 million in
1998, conducts basic, clinical, epidemiological,
and behavioral studies across the entire spectrum of scientific disciplines. The program
seeks to improve the medical care and health
of veterans, and enhance the Nation’s knowledge of disease and disability.
Health Care Education and Training:
The Veterans Health Administration is the
Nation’s largest trainer of health care professionals. About 108,000 students a year get
some or all of their training in VA facilities
through affiliations with over 1,000 educational institutions. The program provides
training to medical, dental, nursing, and associated health professions students to support
VA and national work force needs.
Defense Department Health Care
The Defense Department (DOD) has two
basic, related medical missions: (a) provide,
and be ready to provide, medical services
and support to the armed forces during
military operations, and (b) provide peacetime
medical services to members of the armed

184
forces, their dependents, and other beneficiaries entitled to DOD health care.
The Defense Health Program (DHP) utilizes
over 100,000 military members and 43,000
civilians in 115 hospitals and 471 clinics
world-wide to provide medical and dental
services. DOD beneficiaries also receive medical care from private health professionals
under the Civilian Health and Medical Program of the Uniformed Services (CHAMPUS)
medical insurance program, and its managed
care component, TRICARE.
About 8.2 million people across the world
are eligible for benefits from DOD’s health
system. DHP’s annual direct costs, including
operations and procurement, are about $10.2
billion; personnel costs add another $5.2 billion.
DOD’s medical research and development
(R&D) program funds activities ranging from
basic and applied research through development on health issues unique to deployed
military forces. The program works to develop
vaccines against diseases endemic to countries
outside of the U.S.; field-deployable blood
products, blood substitutes, and resuscitation
fluids; technologies for assessing and treating
massive hemorrhage and severe trauma; and
methods to prevent injury during military
operations. The budget also proposes $25
million in 1998 for HIV R&D.
Regulatory and Administrative Issues
The sheer size and market share of Medicare
and Medicaid significantly affects the private

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

health care market. Medicare and Medicaid’s
coverage, reimbursement, quality of care, and
information policies frequently become the
accepted standards for the private sector
over time. In addition, the Federal Government monitors Medicare and Medicaid’s regulation of quality of care and reporting and
record-keeping requirements for health facilities in order to evaluate possible additional
costs on privately-insured individuals, private
health care providers, and State and local
governments.
Tax Incentives
Federal tax laws help finance health insurance. First, employer contributions for workers’ health insurance premiums are excluded
from workers’ taxable income. Second, selfemployed people may deduct a certain percent
(30 percent in 1996, rising to 80 percent
in 2006 and beyond) of what they pay
for health insurance for themselves, their
spouses, and their dependents. Third, individuals who itemize may deduct certain expenses
for health care—such as insurance premiums
that employers do not pay; expenses to diagnosis, treat, or prevent disease; and expenses
for certain long-term care services and insurance policies—to the extent that these expenses exceed 7.5 percent of the individuals’
adjusted gross income. Total health-related
tax incentives (including other minor provisions) will reach an estimated $85 billion
in 1998, and $487.7 billion from 1998 to
2002.

23.
Table 23–1.

MEDICARE

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF MEDICARE
(In millions of dollars)

Function 570

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
2,939
2,598
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law .................................... 171,272 191,556
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................

Created by the Social Security Amendments
of 1965 (and expanded in 1972), Medicare
is a Nation-wide health insurance program
for the elderly and certain people with disabilities. The program, which will spend an
estimated $211 billion in 1998 on benefits
and administrative costs, consists of two
complementary but distinct parts, each tied
to a trust fund: (1) Hospital Insurance (Part
A) and (2) Supplementary Medical Insurance
(Part B).
Over 30 years ago, Medicare was designed
to address a serious, national problem in
health care—the elderly often could not afford
to buy health insurance, which was more
expensive for them than for other Americans
because they had higher health care costs.
Through Medicare, the Federal Government
created one insurance pool for all of the
elderly while subsidizing some of the costs,
thus making insurance much more affordable
for almost all elderly Americans.
Medicare has very successfully expanded
access to quality care for the elderly. Its
trust funds, however, face financing challenges
as the Nation approaches the 21st Century.
Along with legislative proposals discussed
elsewhere in the budget, the Health Care
Financing Administration (HCFA) is working
to improve Medicare through its regulatory
authority and demonstration programs.

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

2,755

2,751

2,728

2,727

2,728

208,641
–4,310

228,211
–11,390

248,760
–22,150

271,089
–27,820

295,065
–34,550

Part A
Part A covers almost all Americans age
65 or older, and most persons who are
disabled for 24 months or more and who
are entitled to Social Security or Railroad
Retirement benefits. People with end-stage
renal disease (ESRD) also are eligible for
Part A coverage. About 99 percent of Americans aged 65 or older are enrolled in Part
A, along with an estimated 93 percent of
ESRD patients. Part A reimburses providers
for the inpatient hospital, skilled nursing
facility, home health, and hospice services
provided to beneficiaries. Part A’s Hospital
Insurance (HI) Trust Fund receives most
of its income from the HI payroll tax—
2.9 percent of payroll, split evenly between
employers and employees.
Part B
Part B coverage is optional, and it is
available to almost all resident citizens 65
years of age or older and to people with
disabilities who are entitled to Part A. About
96 percent of those enrolled in Part A
have chosen to enroll in Part B. Enrollees
pay monthly premiums that cover about 25
percent of Part B costs, while general taxpayer
dollars subsidize the remaining costs. For
most beneficiaries, the Government simply
deducts the Part B premium from their
monthly Social Security checks.
185

186

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Part B pays for medically necessary physician services; outpatient hospital services;
diagnostic clinical laboratory tests; certain
durable medical equipment (e.g., wheelchairs)
and medical supplies (e.g., oxygen); and physical and occupational therapy, speech pathology services, and outpatient mental health
services. Part B also covers kidney dialysis
and transplants for ESRD patients.

As of December 1, 1996, over 4.7 million
beneficiaries have enrolled in 336 Medicare
managed care plans. In 1995, enrollment
in the capitated managed care plans called
‘‘risk contracts’’ grew by 36 percent, and
by an annualized rate of 30 percent in
the first six months of 1996. Managed care
plans can potentially provide coordinated care
that is focused on prevention and wellness.

Fee-for-Service vs. Managed Care

In addition, Medicare is working to protect
the integrity of its payment systems. Building
on the success of Operation Restore Trust,
a five-State demonstration aimed at cutting
fraud and abuse in home health agencies
and nursing homes, Medicare is increasing
its efforts to root out fraud and abuse.
Recent legislation provided more Federal funds
and authority to prevent inappropriate payments to fraudulent providers, and to seek
out and prosecute providers who continue
to defraud Medicare and other health care
programs.

Beneficiaries can choose the coverage they
prefer.
Under the ‘‘traditional,’’ fee-for-service option, beneficiaries can go to virtually any
provider in the country. Medicare pays providers primarily based on either an established
fee schedule or reasonable costs. About 90
percent of Medicare beneficiaries now opt
for fee-for-service coverage.
Alternatively, beneficiaries can enroll in
a Medicare managed care plan, and the
10 percent who do are concentrated in a
few geographic areas. Generally, enrollees
receive care from a network of providers,
although Medicare managed care plans are
starting to offer a point-of-service benefit,
allowing beneficiaries to receive certain services from non-network providers. Most managed care plans receive a monthly, per enrollee
‘‘capitated’’ payment that covers the cost
of Part A and B services.
Successes
Medicare dramatically increased access to
health care for the elderly—from slightly
over half when the program began in 1966
to almost 100 percent today.
Ninety-six percent of Medicare beneficiaries
reported no trouble obtaining care in 1994. 1
Further, less than one percent of beneficiaries
reported trouble getting care because a physician would not accept Medicare patients.
Medicare beneficiaries have access to the
most up-to-date medical technology and procedures.
Medicare also gives beneficiaries a choice
of managed care plans. Today, managed care
is a major, and growing, part of Medicare.
1 Physician

Congress.

Payment Review Commission, 1996 Annual Report to

Spending and Enrollment
With no changes in law, net Medicare
outlays will rise by an estimated 54 percent
from 1997 to 2002—from $191.6 billion to
$295.1 billion. 2 Net Medicare outlays will
grow by an average of nine percent a year
over this period. Part A outlays are larger
than Part B outlays, and grow more slowly.
Nevertheless, Part A outlays will grow by
an estimated 46 percent over the period—
from $135.1 billion to $197.7 billion—or an
average of 7.9 percent a year. Part B outlays
will grow by an estimated 72 percent—
from $55.9 billion to $96.4 billion—or an
average of 11.5 percent a year.
Medicare has consumed a growing share
of the budget, and it will continue to under
current law. In 1980, Federal spending on
Medicare benefits was $31 billion, comprising
5.2 percent of all Federal outlays. In 1995,
Federal spending on Medicare benefits was
$156.6 billion, or just over 10 percent of
all Federal outlays. By 2002, assuming no
changes in current law, Federal spending
on Medicare benefits will total an estimated
2 These figures cover Federal spending on Medicare benefits, but
do not include spending financed by beneficiaries’ premium payments or administrative costs.

23.

187

MEDICARE

$295.1 billion, or almost 16 percent of all
Federal outlays.
Medicare enrollment will grow slowly until
2010, then take off as the baby boom generation begins to reach age 65. From 1995
to 2010, enrollment will grow at an estimated
average annual rate of 1.4 percent, from
37.6 million enrollees in 1995 to 46.4 million
in 2010. But after 2010, average annual
growth will almost double, with enrollment
reaching an estimated 78 million in 2030—
one in five Americans.
The Two Trust Funds
HI Trust Fund: As discussed above, the HI
Trust Fund is financed by a 2.9 percent payroll
tax, split evenly between employers and employees. In 1995, HI expenditures began to exceed the annual income to the Trust Fund and,
as a result, Medicare is drawing down the
Trust Fund’s accounts to partially finance Part
A spending. The Government’s career actuaries predict that the HI Trust Fund would become insolvent in 2001 in current law, but the
President’s proposals to strengthen the Trust
Fund would push back the date into 2007. (For
a detailed discussion of the proposals, see
Chapter 1.)
Beyond the impending insolvency, Medicare
also faces a longer-term financing challenge.
The baby boomers’ retirement, starting in
2010, will cause Medicare spending to grow
significantly. From 2010 to 2030, enrollment
is expected to double while the workforce
shrinks. As a result, only 2.2 workers will
be available to support each beneficiary in
2030—compared to the current four workers
per beneficiary. The President proposes to
work with Congress on a bipartisan basis
to develop a long-term solution to this financing challenge.
SMI Trust Fund: The SMI Trust Fund receives 75 percent of its income from general

Federal revenues, 25 percent from beneficiary
premiums. Unlike HI, the SMI Trust Fund is
really a trust fund in name only—the law lets
the SMI Trust Fund tap directly into general
revenues to ensure its annual solvency. Nonetheless, the trustees of the SMI Trust Fund
noted in 1996 ‘‘that program costs have been
growing faster than the GDP and that this
trend is expected to continue under present
law.’’
Demonstrations
HCFA also conducts demonstration programs to determine the efficacy of new service
delivery or payment approaches. For instance,
it is launching a Choices demonstration project
to allow provider-sponsored organizations in
certain areas to enroll Medicare beneficiaries.
The plans will offer new benefit structures
to
beneficiaries.
Another
demonstration
project, Centers of Excellence, has experimented with bundled payments for hospital
and physician costs, for selected procedures
performed at certain high-quality facilities.
Regulations
Through its regulatory authority, HCFA
continually improves Medicare. In the last
year, HCFA issued regulations to address
concerns about the payment incentives that
managed care plans offer to physicians that,
in turn, may encourage physicians to deny
services. Specifically, it barred health plans
that contract with Medicare from limiting
physicians’ ability to discuss all appropriate
treatment options with Medicare enrollees.
In addition, the Administration is focusing
more on patient health outcomes and giving
information to consumers that should boost
competition among health plans, generating
higher-quality care and a more cost-effective
Medicare program.

24.
Table 24–1.

INCOME SECURITY

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF INCOME
SECURITY
(In millions of dollars)

Function 600

Estimate

1996
Actual

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
27,752
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law .................................... 187,994
Proposed legislation ....................... ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
93
Guaranteed loans ...............................
5
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
83,027
Proposed legislation ........................... ................

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

26,015

32,592

36,113

38,892

40,402

41,811

197,391
586

203,649
2,282

212,394
2,246

222,232
2,258

225,644
1,869

235,394
2,569

95
5

73
17

84,768
718

86,279
11,343

The Federal Government provides about
$220 billion a year in cash or in-kind benefits
to individuals through ‘‘income security’’ programs, including about $120 billion for programs that are part of the ‘‘social safety
net.’’ Since the 1930s, these ‘‘safety net’’
programs, plus Social Security, Medicare, and
Medicaid, have grown enough in size and
coverage so that even in the worst economic
times, most Americans can count on some
form of minimum support to prevent complete
destitution. The combined effects of these
programs represent one of the most significant
changes in national social policy in this
century, improving the lives of millions of
lower-income families.
The remaining $100 billion for income security supports general retirement and disability
insurance programs (excluding Social Security), Federal employee retirement and disability programs, and housing assistance.
Major Programs
The largest means-tested income security
programs are Food Stamps, Supplemental
Security Income (SSI), Temporary Assistance

8 ................ ................ ................
34
40
40
37
87,922
7,283

89,509
9,305

91,266
11,544

93,019
12,043

for Needy Families (TANF), and various kinds
of low-income housing assistance (discussed
in other chapters)—and the Earned Income
Tax Credit (EITC). These programs, along
with unemployment compensation (which is
not means-tested), form the backbone of cash
and in-kind ‘‘safety net’’ assistance in the
Income Security function.
Food Stamps: Food Stamps helps most lowincome people get a more nutritious diet. The
program reaches more people than any other
means-tested income security program—in an
average month in 1996, 25.5 million people,
or 10.6 million households, received benefits
and that year, the program provided total benefits of $23 billion. Food Stamps is the only
Nation-wide, low-income assistance program
available to essentially all financially-needy
households that does not impose non-financial
criteria, such as whether households include
children or elderly persons. (The new welfare
law limits the number of months that childless, able-bodied individuals can receive benefits while unemployed.) The average monthly,
per-person Food Stamp benefit was about $73
in 1996.
189

190
Supplemental Security Income: SSI provides benefits to the needy aged, blind, and
disabled adults and children. In 1996, 6.5 million individuals received $24 billion in benefits.
Eligibility rules and payment standards are
uniform across the Nation. Average monthly
benefit payments range from $256 for aged
adults to $448 for blind and disabled children.
Most States supplement the SSI benefit.
Temporary Assistance for Needy Families: In last year’s welfare reform law, the
President and Congress enacted TANF as the
successor to the 60–year-old Aid to Families
with Dependent Children (AFDC) program.
TANF, on which the Federal Government will
spend about $16 billion in 1998, is designed
to meet the President’s goal of dramatically
changing the focus of welfare—from a system
focused on benefits to one that moves recipients from welfare to work. TANF grants give
States broad flexibility to determine eligibility
for assistance and the kind of cash, in-kind,
and work-related assistance they provide.
Earned Income Tax Credit: The EITC, a
refundable tax credit for low-income working
families, has two broad goals: (1) to encourage
families to move from welfare to work by making work pay; and (2) to reward work so parents who work full-time do not have to raise
their children in poverty. In 1996, the EITC
provided $24.3 billion of credits, including
spending on tax refunds and lower tax receipts
for non-refunded portions of the credit. For
every dollar that low-income workers earn—
up to certain limits—they receive between
seven and 40 cents as a tax credit. In 1996,
the EITC provided an average credit of nearly
$1,400 to over 20 million workers and their
families. A two-parent family of four with one
full-time worker who works at minimum wage
levels and receives Food Stamps would rise
above the poverty level in 1998 because of the
EITC.
Unemployment Compensation: Unemployment compensation provides benefits, which
are taxable, to individuals who are temporarily
out of work and whose employer has previously paid payroll taxes to the program. The
State payroll taxes finance the basic benefits
out of a dedicated trust fund. States set benefit
levels and eligibility criteria, which are not
means-tested. Regular benefits are typically

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

available for up to 26 weeks of unemployment.
In 1996, about 8.5 million persons claimed unemployment benefits that totaled $23 billion.
By design, benefits are available to experienced workers who lose their jobs through
no fault of their own. Thus, unemployment
compensation does not cover all of the unemployed in any given month. In 1996, on
average, the ‘‘insured unemployed’’ represented
about 35 percent of the estimated total number
of unemployed. Those who are not covered
include new labor force entrants, re-entrants
with no recent job experience, and those
who quit their jobs voluntarily and, thus,
are not eligible for benefits.
Other important income security programs
include the Special Supplemental Nutrition
Program for Women, Infants, and Children
(known as WIC); school lunch, school breakfast, and other child nutrition programs;
child care assistance; refugee assistance; and
low-income home energy assistance.
Effects of Income Security Programs
Last year’s welfare reform debate focused
on means-tested income security programs.
The resulting law not only replaced the
program at the heart of the debate, AFDC,
but also made big cuts and changes in
other programs, including Food Stamps and
SSI. But the basic question remains—what
effect do these safety net programs have
on poverty, and to what extent do they
target assistance to the poor? Chapter 25,
Social Security, explores the impact of Social
Security alone on the income and poverty
of the elderly. This chapter looks at the
cumulative impact across the major programs.
For purposes below, ‘‘means-tested benefits’’
include AFDC, SSI, certain veterans pensions,
Food Stamps, child nutrition meals subsidies,
rental assistance, and State-funded general
assistance. Medicare and Medicaid greatly
help eligible families who need medical services during the year, but experts do not
agree about how much additional income
Medicare or Medicaid coverage represents
to those covered. Consequently, we did not
include these benefits in the analysis that
follows. ‘‘Social insurance programs’’ include
Social Security, railroad retirement, veterans
compensation, unemployment compensation,

24.

191

INCOME SECURITY

Pell grants, and workers’ compensation. The
definition of income for this discussion (cash
and in-kind benefits), and the notion of
pre- and post-Government transfers, do not
match the Census Bureau’s definitions for
developing official poverty statistics. Census
counts income from cash alone, including
Government transfers.
Effectiveness in Reducing Poverty: Based
on special tabulations from the March 1996
Current Population Survey, 57.6 million people
were poor in 1995 before accounting for the
effect of Government programs. Of the 57.6
million, 27 percent were elderly (age 65 and
above), 30 percent were children below age 18,
and 43 percent were non-elderly adults (age
18–64). Census data show that after accounting for the effects of Government programs:
• The number of people in poverty fell to
30.3 million, a drop of 47 percent.
• The programs lifted 82 percent of the elderly poor out of poverty.
• The programs lifted about a third of poor
children and poor non-elderly adults out
of poverty.
• Social insurance programs accounted for
two-thirds of individuals who were removed from poverty, including 93 percent
of the elderly, 55 percent of the non-elderly adults, and 25 percent of the children.
• Means-tested benefits were responsible for
28 percent of the individuals who were removed from poverty, including close to 60
percent of poor children and over 40 percent of non-elderly adults.
• Federal tax policies, including the EITC,
accounted for five percent of those removed from poverty, including close to 20
percent of the children.
• The number of people removed from poverty in 1995 reached an all-time high.
Efficiency in Reducing Poverty: The poverty gap is the amount by which the incomes
of all poor people fall below the poverty line.
‘‘Efficiency’’ in reducing poverty is defined as
the percentage of Government benefits of a
particular type (e.g., social insurance programs) that help cut the poverty gap. So, for
example, if $1 out of every $2 in Category

A helps cut the poverty gap, the ‘‘efficiency’’
of Category A would be 50 percent.
Before counting government benefits, the
poverty gap was $194.5 billion in 1995.
Benefits from government programs cut it
by $135 billion, or 69 percent. Of the $135
billion cut, social insurance programs accounted for $90 billion, means-tested benefits
for $43 billion, and Federal tax provisions
for $2 billion.
All told, according to Census Bureau data,
social insurance benefits totaled $338 billion
in 1995. Thus, 26 percent of their funding
(the $90 billion, above) helped cut the poverty
gap. Means-tested benefits totaled $78 billion,
according to Census data. Thus, 56 percent
of their funding (the $43 billion, above)
helped cut the poverty gap. 1
The evidence is clear—whether measured
by their impact on poverty gaps, or on
moving families out of poverty, income security
programs largely succeed. Social insurance
programs play the largest role in cutting
poverty, but means-tested programs—targeted
more narrowly on the poor—are more efficient.
Employee Retirement Benefits
Federal Employee Retirement Benefits:
The Civil Service Retirement and Disability
Program covers 1.9 million Federal employees
and 750,000 United States Postal Service employees, and provides retirement benefits to
1.7 million retirees and 600,000 survivors. The
Civil Service Retirement System (CSRS) covers
employees hired before 1984. The Federal Employees Retirement System (FERS) covers employees hired since January 1, 1984. Along
with the FERS defined benefit, FERS employees also participate in Social Security and the
Thrift Savings Plan—a defined contribution
plan to which the Government makes contributions on their behalf. The average Federal retiree receives an annual benefit of about
$20,000. (Military retirement programs are
discussed in Chapter 26, Veterans Benefits
and Services.)
The budget proposes
CSRS and FERS. First,
cost-of-living adjustment
months each year for
1 Budget

several changes to
it would delay the
(COLA) for three
1998–2002. Second,

data may differ from Census data.

192
it would increase employee contributions by
0.25 percent of base pay on January 1,
1999, another 0.15 percent in 2000, and
a final 0.10 percent in 2001, with the higher
rates remaining in effect through December
31, 2002. Third, it would increase agency
contributions on behalf of CSRS employees
by 1.51 percent of base pay beginning on
October 1, 1997, and continuing through
September 30, 2002.
Private Pensions: The Pension and Welfare
Benefits Administration (PWBA) establishes
and enforces safeguards to protect the roughly
$3 trillion in pension assets. The Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation (PBGC) protects the
pension benefits of nearly 42 million workers
and retirees who earn traditional (i.e., ‘‘defined
benefit’’) pensions. Through its early warning
program, PBGC also works with solvent companies to more fully fund their pension prom-

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

ises, protecting the benefits of 1.2 million people in 1996 alone. To encourage retirement
savings, the President signed legislation in
1996 that establishes a new, simplified pension
plan for small businesses.
Tax Treatment of Retirement Savings:
The Federal Government encourages retirement savings by providing income tax benefits.
Generally, earnings devoted to workplace pension plans and to many individual retirement
accounts (IRAs) are exempt from taxes when
earned and ordinarily are taxed only in retirement, when lower tax rates usually prevail.
Moreover, taxpayers can defer taxes on the interest and other gains that add value of these
retirement accounts, including all forms of
IRAs. These tax incentives amount to $69 billion a year—one of the three largest sets of
preferences in the income-tax system.

25.
Table 25–1.

SOCIAL SECURITY

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF SOCIAL
SECURITY
(In millions of dollars)

Function 650

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
3,140
3,457
3,303
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law .................................... 347,051 364,232 380,935
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................ ................
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
22,890
24,170
25,285

The Old-Age, Survivors, and Disability Insurance (OASDI) program, popularly known
as Social Security, will spend about $380
billion in 1998 to provide a comprehensive
package of protection against the loss of
earnings due to retirement, disability, or
death.
OASDI provides monthly benefits as a
matter of earned right to retired and disabled
workers who gain insured status, and to
their eligible spouses, children, and survivors
(see Chart 25–1). The Social Security Act
of 1935 provided retirement benefits, and
the 1939 amendments provided benefits for
survivors and dependents. These benefits now
comprise the Old Age and Survivors Insurance
Program (OASI). Congress provided disability
benefits by enacting the Disability Insurance
(DI) program in 1956, and benefits for the
dependents of disabled workers by enacting
the 1958 amendments.
Social Security was founded on two important principles, social adequacy and individual
equity. Social adequacy means that benefits
will provide a certain standard of living
for all contributors. Individual equity means
that contributors receive benefits directly related to the amount of their contributions.
These principles still guide Social Security
today.

1999

2000

2001

2002

3,256

3,246

3,246

3,251

398,622
–5

417,735
1

437,963
7

459,686
13

26,465

27,765

28,875

29,935

What Social Security Does
Social Security helps alleviate poverty, provide income security, and maintain the lifestyles of beneficiaries.
Alleviating Poverty: Before the 1960s,
when an economist at the Social Security Administration developed a measure to assess
poverty, experts believed that a large share
of the elderly were poor, although it was not
clear exactly how many. In 1970, an estimated
25 percent of the elderly were living in poverty. Now, only about 11 percent of them do. 1
Social Security is largely responsible for
the progress (see Chart 25–2). In 1995,
17 percent of elderly, unmarried beneficiaries
had family incomes below the poverty line.
Without Social Security retirement benefits,
60 percent of them would have fallen into
poverty. For elderly couples, Social Security
had a similar effect. In 1995, three percent
of the elderly who were married had incomes
below the poverty line. Without Social Security
retirement benefits, 42 percent of them would
have.
1 These estimates as well as those that follow are based on a definition of poverty that uses pre-tax cash income—the Census Bureau’s definition of income for official income and poverty statistics.
In the Income Security function discussion of how cash and noncash means-tested benefits affect poverty, a more comprehensive
definition of income is used. The estimated impacts on poverty are
not directly comparable across chapters.

193

194

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 25-1. COMPOSITION OF SOCIAL SECURITY RECIPIENTS

SPOUSES AND
CHILDREN
12%

DISABLED
WORKERS
10%

SURVIVORS OF
DECEASED WORKERS
17%

RETIRED WORKERS
61%

Income Security: Social Security was originally designed to provide a continuing income
base for eligible workers so they could maintain a reasonable income when they retired.
In 1935, personal savings, family support, and
Federal welfare programs were the main
sources of income for those 65 and older who
did not work. Today, two-thirds of those over
65 get the major portion of their income from
Social Security (see Chart 25–3). The average
retiree receives a Social Security benefit equal
to 43.1 percent of pre-retirement income. In
1996, Social Security paid about $300 billion
in retirement, survivor, and family benefits to
about 38 million beneficiaries.
Along with retirement benefits, Social Security also provides income security for survivors
and dependents. In 1996, Social Security
paid about $69 billion in benefits to over
seven million survivors and deceased workers.
The Disability Insurance (DI) program also
provides income security for workers and

their families who lose earned income when
the family provider becomes disabled. Before
DI, workers often had no protection against
income loss due to disability. To be sure,
employees disabled on the job may have
benefited from State workmen’s compensation
laws. But in 1956, only about five percent
of all permanent and total disability cases
were work-related. Congress enacted DI to
protect the resources, self-reliance, dignity,
and self-respect of disabled workers, according
to congressional committee reports. DI protection can be extremely valuable, especially
for young families that have not been able
to sufficiently protect themselves against the
risk of the worker’s disability.
Maintaining Lifestyles: Before Social Security, about half of those over 65 depended on
others, primarily relatives and friends, for all
of their income. The same was often true for
people with disabilities. Now, with Social Security, the vast majority of those over age 65
and those with disabilities can live relatively

25.

195

SOCIAL SECURITY

Chart 25-2. BENEFICIARY POPULATION WITH FAMILY INCOME
ABOVE AND BELOW THE POVERTY LINE
PERCENT

AGED INDIVIDUALS

AGED COUPLES

100
80

WITH
SOCIAL
SECURITY

60
40
20

WITHOUT
SOCIAL
SECURITY

WITH
SOCIAL
SECURITY
WITHOUT
SOCIAL
SECURITY

0
-20
-40
-60
-80

CALENDAR YEAR 1994

independent lives. Moreover, their families no
longer carry the sole responsibility of providing
their financial support.
Growth in Retirement Benefits
The retirement part of Social Security is
facing financial stress, due to changing demographics and the program’s financing. The
retirement program is largely a ‘‘pay as
you go’’ program—current retirement benefits
are financed by current payroll contributions.
Such financing has worked well in the past,
when five workers were paying for every
retiree. But, when the baby boom generation
retires, eventually only two workers will
be paying for every retiree.
Adding to the financial stress, baby boomers
are having fewer babies and living longer.
In 1957, women had an average of 3.7
babies, compared to 2.03 today. Males born
in 1935 had an average life expectancy of
60 years, and females of 63 years. By contrast,
baby boom males have an average life expect-

ancy of about 67 years, and females of
about 73. The longer people live, the longer
they will collect Social Security. The more
time that people spend retired, the more
people there are to support at any one
time and the fewer there are working and
contributing to provide that support.
Growth in Disability Benefits
DI has grown rapidly. The program provided
about $43 billion to about six million disabled
beneficiaries and their families in 1996, compared to $57 million for 150,000 disabled
workers in 1957. Growth has been especially
rapid in the last 10 years, with the number
of beneficiaries rising by 75 percent and
benefits rising by 125 percent.
Why? Because growing numbers of baby
boomers are reaching the age at which they
are increasingly prone to disabilities; more
women are insured; and laws, regulations,
and court decisions have expanded eligibility
for benefits. In addition, the annual share

196

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 25-3. PORTION OF BENEFICIARIES THAT RELY
HEAVILY ON SOCIAL SECURITY
(Calendar year 1994)

16%

14%

34%

36%

100% OF INCOME

50%-89% OF INCOME

90%-99% OF INCOME

LESS THAN 50% OF INCOME

of beneficiaries leaving the rolls has fallen
steadily, raising questions about whether those
remaining on the rolls are all, in fact,
eligible for benefits. To maintain DI’s integrity,
the Administration proposes to maintain support for continuing disability reviews (CDRs)—
a periodic review of individual cases that
ensures that only those eligible continue
to receive benefits.
The budget proposes a pilot program to
encourage DI beneficiaries (and recipients
of Supplemental Security Income, or SSI)
to re-enter the workforce. Currently, the
Social Security Administration refers DI or
SSI beneficiaries to State Vocational Rehabilitation agencies. Under the Administration’s
proposal, beneficiaries could choose their own
public or private vocational rehabilitation provider—and the provider could keep a share
of the DI and SSI benefits that the Federal

Government no longer pays to these individuals after they leave the rolls.
A Long-range Problem, but No Crisis
The OASDI trust funds are not in balance
over the next 75 years—the period over
which the Social Security Trustees measure
Social Security’s well-being. The President
wants to work with Congress on a bipartisan
basis to develop a long-term solution to
the financing challenge, but it does not
constitute an imminent crisis.
In their 1996 report, the Trustees estimated
that the combined OASDI trust funds would
have a cash imbalance in 2012 and be
insolvent in 2029. The OASI Trust Fund
would have a cash imbalance in 2014 and
be insolvent in 2031. The DI Trust Fund
would face a cash imbalance in 2003 and
be insolvent in 2015.

25.

SOCIAL SECURITY

Tax Expenditures
Social Security recipients pay taxes on
their Social Security benefits when their
combined income (including Social Security)

197
exceeds certain income thresholds. These exclusions reduce Social Security beneficiary
taxes by $25 billion in 1998 and $138 billion
from 1998 to 2002.

26.

VETERANS BENEFITS AND SERVICES

Table 26–1.

FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF VETERANS
BENEFITS AND SERVICES
(In millions of dollars)

Function 700

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority 1 .....
18,359
18,910
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
18,820
20,579
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
1,442
1,933
Guaranteed loans ...............................
28,676
30,230
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
2,775
2,940
1 Proposed

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

18,750

18,719

18,715

18,702

18,706

21,735
593

22,850
294

24,443
690

21,463
1,057

23,151
1,547

2,189
28,948

2,249
25,458

2,273
25,032

2,287
24,566

2,269
24,059

3,105

3,285

3,480

3,680

3,895

legislation will supplement the budget authority with receipts (estimated at $0.5 billion in 1998).

The Federal Government provides a broad
range of benefits and services, to veterans
(and their survivors) who served in conflicts
as long ago as the Spanish-American War
and as recent as the Persian Gulf War.
In providing these benefits and services, the
Government recognizes the sacrifices that
wartime and peacetime veterans made during
their service in the military. The $40 billion
a year in veterans benefits and services,
and $4.7 billion in tax benefits, compensate
for service-related disabilities, provide medical
care to low-income and disabled veterans,
and help returning veterans prepare for reentry into civilian life through education
and training. In addition, veterans benefits
provide financial assistance to needy veterans
of wartime service and their survivors.
About six percent of veterans are military
retirees. This group of veterans can receive
both military retirement from the Defense
Department (DOD) and veterans benefits from
the Department of Veterans Affairs (VA).
Active duty military personnel are eligible
for veterans housing benefits, and they can
make contributions to the Montgomery GI
Bill program for education benefits that are
paid later. To deliver these services to veter-

ans, VA employs about 20 percent of the
non-Defense workforce of the Federal Government—almost 250,000 people. About 220,000
of these employees deliver medical services
to veterans (as described in Chapter 22,
Health).
The veteran population is declining, with
much of the decline among draft-era veterans,
meaning that a rising share of veterans
is coming from the All-Volunteer Force (see
Chart 26–1). Thus, the types of needed benefits and services likely will change. Further,
as the veteran population shrinks and technology improves, access to, and the quality
of, service should continue to improve.
The Veterans Benefits Administration (VBA)
processes veterans claims for benefits in 58
regional offices across the country. Several
factors, including the introduction of judicial
review to the claims adjudication process
in 1988 and DOD downsizing from 1992
to 1994, significantly increased the claims
and appeals workload. Workload peaked in
1993 and 1994, with 500,000 backlogged
claims and 214 days needed to process a
claim.
199

200

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 26-1. ESTIMATED VETERAN POPULATION
VETERANS IN MILLIONS

28

27.2
26

26.4
25.1

24

23.5
22

21.8
20

20

18

0
16
1990

1994

1998

But, as the veteran population declines,
the number of new claims and appeals will
decline with it. At the end of 1996, the
backlog shrunk to 346,000 claims, and the
number of days needed to process a new
claim averaged 150. To further the progress
to date, VBA is developing a comprehensive
strategic plan that will reengineer the way
it processes claims, including the post-decision
review process, and integrate information technology into program administration.
The following discussion describes the major
components of benefits and services (other
than health care) to which veterans are
entitled.
Income Security
Along with Federal income security programs for the general population, such as
Social Security and unemployment insurance,
several VA programs help certain veterans
and their survivors maintain their income
when the veteran is disabled or deceased.

2002

2006

2010

Spending for this purpose will total an estimated $19.8 billion in 1998, including the
funds that Congress approves each year to
subsidize life insurance for certain veterans
who are too disabled to get affordable coverage
from private insurance.
Service-Connected Compensation: Veterans with disabilities resulting from, or coincident with, military service receive monthly
compensation payments scaled to the degree
of disability. The payment does not depend on
the veteran’s income or age, or on whether
the disability is the result of combat or a natural-life affliction. The amount depends on the
average fall in earnings capacity that the Government presumes for individuals with the
same degree of disability. Survivors of veterans
who die from service-connected injuries receive
payments in the form of dependency and indemnity compensation. Benefits are indexed
annually by the same cost-of-living adjustment
(COLA) as Social Security, which is 2.7 percent
for 1998.

26.

201

VETERANS BENEFITS AND SERVICES

The number of veterans and survivors
of deceased veterans receiving compensation
benefits will total an estimated 2.6 million
in 1998, remaining at that level through
2002. While the overall veteran population
will decline, the compensation caseload is
expected to remain relatively constant due
to changes in eligibility and enhanced outreach
efforts. At the same time, mainly due to
anticipated COLAs, spending for compensation
benefits will rise from an estimated $16.8
billion in 1998 to $18.8 billion in 2002.
Non-Service-Connected Pensions: The
Government provides pensions to lower-income, wartime-service veterans, or veterans
who have become permanently and totally disabled after their military service. Survivors of
wartime-service veterans may qualify for pension benefits based on financial need. Veterans
pensions, which also increase annually with
COLAs, will cost an estimated $3.2 billion in
1998. The number of pension recipients will
continue to fall from an estimated 714,000 in
1998 to 650,000 in 2002, as the population
of wartime veterans drops.
Burial and Other Benefits: Families of
deceased veterans who received pension or
compensation benefits and who are buried in
private cemeteries may receive burial benefits
to help defray funeral costs. For veterans buried in VA’s National Cemeteries, the Government reimburses additional amounts to the
National Cemetery System for headstones,
markers, and graveliners. Over 90,000 veterans’ survivors received a burial allowance in
1996. Spending for these benefits will total an
estimated $119 million in 1988.
Insurance Programs: Because most private insurance excludes coverage of war-time
service, the VA administers life insurance
programs. Veterans pay the total cost for this
insurance through premiums, calculated by assuming that the veteran will see no combat.
If insurance claims in any year exceed expectations due to combat, DOD pays the extra cost
of coverage. These programs will continue to
provide over $480 billion of coverage to nearly
5.5 million veterans and active duty personnel
in 1998.

Veterans Eeducation, Training, and
Rehabilitation
Several Federal programs support job training and finance education for veterans and
others. The Labor Department runs several
programs exclusively for veterans. In addition,
several VA programs provide education, training, and rehabilitation benefits to veterans
and military personnel who meet specific
criteria. The programs include the Montgomery GI bill (the largest of them), the postVietnam-era education program, the Vocational Rehabilitation program, and the WorkStudy program. Spending for all VA programs
in this area will total an estimated $1.4
billion in 1998.
The Montgomery GI Bill (MGIB): The
Government created MGIB as a test program,
with more generous benefits than the postVietnam-era education program, to help veterans move to civilian life as well as to help
the armed forces with their recruitment. The
President and Congress made the program
permanent in 1987. Service members electing
to enter the program have their pay reduced
by $100 a month during their first year of
military service. The VA administers the program and pays the costs of basic benefits once
the service-member leaves the military. Basic
benefits now total about $15,000 (about 12
times the original reduction in the service
members’ pay).
MGIB beneficiaries receive a monthly check
based on whether they are enrolled in school
on a full- or part-time basis. They are
entitled to 36 months worth of payment,
but they must certify monthly that they
are in school. DOD may provide additional
benefits to help recruit certain specialties
and critical skills. Nearly 350,000 veterans
and service members will use these benefits
in 1998. The MGIB also provides education
benefits to reservists while they are in service.
DOD pays these benefits, and the VA administers the program. In 1998, over 80,000
reservists are expected to use this program.
Over 90 percent of MGIB beneficiaries use
their benefits to attend a college or university.

202
Veterans Housing
Along with the mortgage assistance available to veterans through the Federal Housing
Administration (FHA) insurance program, VAguaranteed and direct loan programs will
help an estimated 280,000 veterans get mortgages in 1998. Guaranteed commitments for
mortgage loans in 1998 are expected to
reach almost $29 million. The $192 million
in estimated spending in 1998 reflects the
estimated Federal subsidies that are implicit
in the veterans’ home loans issued during
the year. Slightly over 40 percent of veterans
who have owned homes have used the VA
loan guaranty program. In 1996, 56 percent
of all guaranteed loans went to first-time
home buyers.
National Cemetery System
The VA provides burial in its National
Cemetery System for eligible veterans, active
duty military personnel, and their dependents—with the VA managing over 100 national
cemeteries across the country. Spending for
VA cemetery operations, excluding reimbursements from other accounts, will total an
estimated $84 million in 1998. Over 70,000
veterans and their family members were
buried in National Cemeteries in 1996.
Related Programs
Many veterans get help from other Federal
income security, health, housing credit, education, training, employment, and social service programs that are available to the general
population. A number of these programs
have components specifically designed to assist
veterans. Some veterans also receive preference for Federal jobs. In addition, starting
in 1998, the children of Vietnam veterans
will receive compensation if they are afflicted
with spina bifida, which the Government
will presume was caused by a veteran parent’s
exposure to herbicides.
Military Retirement
About 1.6 million military retirees and
survivors will receive an estimated $28 billion

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

in retirement benefits in 1988. Normal retirement eligibility occurs after 20 years of
service. The initial annuity base for most
current retirees is 2.5 percent of final pay
for each year of service—50 percent at 20
years—up to a maximum 75 percent of final
pay at 30 years. For those entering between
September 1980 and July 1986, the Government will use the average of the highest
three years of basic pay to calculate the
annuity base, instead of final basic pay.
Benefits for both groups are fully indexed
to the Consumer Price Index (CPI).
Members entering military service after
August 1, 1986 face a cut in their initial
retirement benefit if they retire before age
62 with less than 30 years of service. The
initial formula for their annuity remains
at 2.5 percent per year of service, but this
multiplier is cut by one percent for each
year of service below 30. The cut ends
when the member reaches age 62. Also,
benefits for these retirees rise at the rate
of the CPI minus one percent, with a onetime catch-up at age 62 to restore the
full purchasing power of the annuity. After
age 62, the benefit is again adjusted by
CPI minus one percent. In addition, to help
shrink the size of the military forces, the
Government has provided temporary authority
for certain military members to retire with
as little as 15 years of service.
Tax Incentives
Along with direct Federal funding, certain
tax benefits help veterans. The law keeps
all cash benefits that the VA administers
(disability compensation, pension, and GI bill
benefits) free from tax. Together, these three
exclusions will cost about $3 billion in 1998.
The Federal Government also helps veterans
obtain housing through veterans bonds that
State and local governments issue, the interest
on which is not subject to Federal tax.
In 1998, this provision will cost the Government an estimated $35 million.

27.

ADMINISTRATION OF JUSTICE

Table 27–1. FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF
ADMINISTRATION OF JUSTICE
(In millions of dollars)
Function 750

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

20,684

22,819

24,415

25,186

24,382

24,806

25,518

–36

767

566

539

400

404

400

Federal, State, and local governments share
the responsibility for fighting crime. Most
of the effort occurs at the State and local
level. The Federal Government primarily addresses criminal acts that require a national
response, and supports State and local law
enforcement and criminal justice activities.

enforcement activities; (2) litigation and judicial activities; (3) correctional activities; and
(4) financial assistance to State and local
entities. Most of these funds go to the
Departments of Justice and the Treasury,
and to the Judiciary (see Chart 27–2).

Federal Activities

Law Enforcement: The budget proposes
$24.9 billion in 1998 to enforce a wide range
of laws, reflecting the unique Federal role in
law enforcement. Some responsibilities—such
as customs enforcement—date from the beginning of the country. The Justice Department’s
Federal Bureau of Investigation (FBI), Drug
Enforcement Administration (DEA), and Immigration and Naturalization Service (INS) enforce diverse Federal laws dealing with terrorism, white collar crime, border control, drug
smuggling, and many other criminal acts. The
Treasury Department enforces laws related to
smuggling drugs and contraband across our
borders, and to regulating trade, telecommunications, financial institutions, and the alcohol,
tobacco, and firearms industries. Treasury also
trains Federal law enforcement agency personnel and protects the President, the Vice President, and foreign dignitaries. These Federal
agencies, and the ones discussed below, also
work with State and local law enforcement
agencies, often through joint task forces to address drug, gang, and other violent crime problems, as well as civil rights laws.

Federal funding for the Administration of
Justice function includes: (1) Federal law

The Federal responsibility to enforce civil
rights laws in the areas of employment

Federal, State, and local resources devoted
to the administration of justice—including
law enforcement, litigation, judicial, and correctional—have grown from $68.3 billion in
1988 to an estimated $139.4 billion in 1997—
by 104 percent or, as Chart 27–1 illustrates,
by 53 percent in constant 1988 dollars. During
this same period, the Federal law enforcement
component, including transfer payments to
State and local law enforcement activities,
grew by 151 percent, from $9.5 billion in
1988 to $23.9 billion in 1997. Despite this
growth, Federal resources account for only
about 17 percent of total governmental spending for administration of justice.
Nevertheless, Federal resources devoted to
law enforcement and crime prevention are
consuming a larger slice of total Federal
discretionary spending. In 1988, administration of justice expenditures were about two
percent of Federal discretionary spending.
In 1997, they will consume nearly five percent.

203

204

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

CHART 27-1. ADMINISTRATION OF JUSTICE EXPENDITURES

(In constant 1988 dollars)
DOLLARS IN BILLIONS
110
100
90
80
70

LOCAL

60
50
40
30

STATE

20
10

FEDERAL
0
1988

1989

1990

1991

1992

and housing arises from Title VII and Title
VIII of the Civil Rights Act of 1964, as
amended, and is further augmented by more
recent civil rights legislation, including the
Age Discrimination in Employment Act and
the Americans with Disabilities Act. The
Department of Housing and Urban Development’s (HUD) Office of Fair Housing and
Equal Opportunity enforces laws that prohibit
discrimination on the basis of race, color,
sex, religion, disability, familial status, or
national origin in the sale or rental, provision
of brokerage services, or financing of housing.
The Equal Employment Opportunity Commission enforces laws that prohibit employment
discrimination on the basis of race, color,
sex, religion, disability, age, and national
origin.
Litigation and Judicial Activities: Of
course, after such law enforcement agencies as
the FBI, DEA, and Treasury’s Bureau of Alcohol, Tobacco and Firearms have investigated
and apprehended perpetrators of Federal
crimes, the United States must prosecute

1993

1994

1995

1996

1997

1998

them—and the budget proposes $6.7 billion for
this purpose. This task falls to the 93 United
States Attorneys and the 4,450 Assistant United States Attorneys. Along with prosecuting
cases referred by Federal law enforcement
agencies, the U.S. Attorneys work with State
and local police and prosecutors in their efforts
to bring to justice those who have violated
Federal laws—whether international drug traffickers, organized crime ringleaders, or perpetrators of white collar fraud.
In addition, the Justice Department contains
several legal divisions specializing in specific
areas of criminal and civil law. These divisions—including the Civil, Criminal, Civil
Rights, Environment and Natural Resources,
Tax, and Antitrust Divisions—work with the
U.S. Attorneys to ensure that violators of
a myriad assortment of Federal laws are
brought to justice. Individuals and corporations who would knowingly and illegally pollute a local river, evade Federal income
taxes, or conspire to fix consumer prices
are all targets of Federal prosecutors. The

27.

205

ADMINISTRATION OF JUSTICE

Chart 27-2. FEDERAL JUSTICE EXPENDITURES
DOLLARS IN BILLIONS
25

20
CRIMINAL JUSTICE ASSISTANCE

15
CORRECTIONS

10
LITIGATIVE/JUDICIAL

5
LAW ENFORCEMENT

0
1988

1989

1990

1991

1992

Federal Government, through the Legal Services Corporation, also promotes equal access
to the Nation’s legal system by funding
local organizations that provide legal assistance to the poor in civil cases.
As for the Federal Judiciary, its rapid
growth is a result of increased Federal law
enforcement efforts over the recent past.
Accounting for 14 percent of total law enforcement spending, the Judiciary comprises the
Supreme Court and 196 courts of appeals,
bankruptcy courts, and district courts, and
is overseen by 2,102 Federal and Supreme
Court judges.
Corrections Activities: The budget proposes $3.2 billion for corrections activities. Due
to higher spending on law enforcement and
other factors, the number of criminals incarcerated also has risen. The U.S. inmate population has doubled since 1988, with the total
number of sentenced inmates exceeding a million during 1996. The Federal inmate popu-

1993

1994

1995

1996

1997

1998

lation—slightly less than a tenth of the State
inmate population—will continue to grow due
to the abolition of parole, minimum mandatory
sentences, and sentencing guidelines. State inmate populations will grow, in part, due to
stringent sentencing requirements tied to Federal prison grant funds. In the Federal system,
about 61 percent of the inmates serving time
have been convicted on drug-related charges.
Criminal Justice Assistance: The 1994
Crime Act fueled the rapid post-1994 growth
in Federal criminal justice assistance to State
and local governments, which has increased
from $800 million in 1994 to a proposed $4.4
billion in 1998. The Act authorized such programs as the Community Oriented Policing
Services (COPS) program, prison grants, and
the State Criminal Alien Assistance Program.
Most funding authorized under the Act supports grants to States and localities—designed
to help States and local criminal justice systems perform their roles as the primary agents
of law enforcement.

206
The Results—and Long-term Trends
The Justice Department’s national crime
statistics show that criminal offenses reported
by law enforcement agencies fell by three
percent from 1995 to 1996—marking the
fifth straight year the crime rate has dropped.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

The decrease in crime, when compared with
increases in anti-crime spending during the
same period, appears to suggest a general
relationship. Many factors unrelated to Federal spending, however, also probably played
an important role in the drop in crime.

28.
Table 28–1.

GENERAL GOVERNMENT
FEDERAL RESOURCES IN SUPPORT OF GENERAL
GOVERNMENT
(In millions of dollars)

Function 800

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Spending:
Discretionary Budget Authority .......
11,539
11,807
12,809
12,514
12,052
11,796
11,828
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law ....................................
129
934
787
761
942
726
731
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................
–15
57
162
281
419
Credit Activity:
Direct loan disbursements ................
379
461 ................ ................ ................ ................ ................
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
46,745
48,130
49,500
50,770
52,130
53,560
55,140
Proposed legislation ........................... ................ ................
11
37
46
53
57

The General Government function encompasses the central management activities of
the executive and legislative branches. Its
major activities include Federal finances, tax
collection, personnel management, and general
administrative and property management.
Four central management agencies, for
which the budget proposes a combined $12.2
billion for 1998, establish policies and provide
administrative and other services—the Treasury Department ($11.8 billion); the General
Services Administration (GSA, $226 million);
the Office of Personnel Management (OPM,
$188 million); and the Office of Management
and Budget, in the Executive Office of the
President (OMB, $56 million). The Federal
Government also provides tens of billions
of dollars in tax incentives to help State
and local governments and those who are
subject to their taxes.
Department of the Treasury
Treasury is the Federal Government’s chief
financial agent—producing and protecting U.S.
currency; helping to set the Nation’s fiscal,
tax, and economic policies; regulating financial
institutions and the alcohol, tobacco, and
firearms industries; protecting citizens against

criminals who launder money and threaten
our borders; and helping agencies to strengthen their financial systems. In 1996, Treasury
collected $1.4 trillion in revenues and issued
nearly 850 million payments (99 percent
on time and 50 percent electronically). Treasury plans to further improve its performance
by issuing Government-wide Audited Financial
Statements and modernizing the Nation’s tax
administration systems.
The Internal Revenue Service (IRS), a part
of Treasury, administers the Federal tax
system with the goal of collecting the proper
revenue at the least cost. In 1996, the
IRS collected $1.36 trillion in net revenue,
including $38 billion in direct enforcement
collections, at a cost of $7.3 billion. The
IRS estimates that compliance with Federal
tax laws is now 86 percent—calculated by
adding together the income and employment
taxes that come in through voluntary compliance (83 percent), with those that come
in through direct enforcement (three percent).
The IRS processed over 195 million individual tax returns (including over 20 million
which were transmitted electronically) and
one billion information returns in 1996, and
it issued 90.5 million individual refunds.
207

208

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

It provides customer service through telephone
assistance (answering close to 45 million
TeleTax calls and 54 million live assisted
calls in 1995) and maintains information
for taxpayers on the Internet.

agencies themselves provide most of the funding for GSA’s activities. In 1997, for example,
GSA’s budget authority was $550 million,
but projected obligations through its revolving
funds exceeded $11 billion.

The IRS is improving the administration
of Federal tax laws by investing in changes
in work practices and information technology.
Of the over 20 million taxpayers filing electronically in 1996, 2.8 million used the Telefile
option, which allows taxpayers to file a
simple tax return over the telephone in
under 10 minutes. Forms and other information are readily available on the Internet.
Ongoing investments in modern technology
will allow the IRS to improve taxpayer compliance by improving access to data and allowing
the Federal Government to target resources
to cases of deliberate noncompliance.

GSA also is working to develop a new
Federal management model, focusing on performance measurement, accountability for
agencies and employees, and the effective
use of technology in changing work environments.

The complexity of our tax laws, and of
the systems designed to administer them,
imposes a significant burden on individuals
and businesses—by some estimates, a burden
of over $70 billion a year. The IRS is
taking steps to reduce the burden by providing
alternative ways to file and pay taxes, easing
reporting requirements, expanding access to
needed information, making it easier for
taxpayers to contact the IRS, and reducing
the need for the IRS to contact taxpayers.
General Services Administration
GSA provides administrative services to
other agencies, including housing, supplies,
transportation, and telecommunications. GSA
also works with the agencies to establish
and oversee the implementing of policies
and standards for administrative services—
except for personnel and financial management—that affect work environments.
In the last two years, GSA has aggressively
responded to the changing needs of its customer agencies by working to transform itself
into a market-driven, customer-oriented agency. Two recent initiatives, Can’t Beat GSA
Space Alterations and Can’t Beat GSA Leasing, focus on revising the way it delivers
services to meet or beat private sector performance standards.
Since GSA provides services on a reimbursable basis, the budgets of the individual

Office of Personnel Management
Working with agencies and employees, OPM
provides human resource management leadership and services, based on merit principles.
It provides policy guidance, advice, and direct
personnel services. OPM also operates a Nation-wide job information and application system every hour of every day, available to
the public through multiple electronic (including the Internet) and traditional sources
at convenient and accessible locations. It
also develops and administers compensation
systems for both blue-collar and white-collar
employees.
But perhaps OPM’s most important function
is administering the Federal civil service
merit systems, which includes recruiting, examining, and promoting people on the basis
of their knowledge and skills—regardless of
race, religion, sex, political influence, or other
non-merit factors. OPM runs an aggressive
oversight program, identifying opportunities
for improving Federal personnel policies and
programs and helping agencies meet mission
goals by effectively recruiting, developing,
and utilizing employees. It encourages maximum employment and advancement opportunities in the Federal service for disabled veterans and others qualified for veteran’s preference.
Likewise, OPM helps to implement the
President’s directive for helping dislocated
and surplus employees by assisting agencies
with career transition planning and, when
vacancies arise, protecting hiring preferences
for dislocated and surplus employees. Working
with the National Partnership Council, OPM
supports and promotes labor-management
partnerships
throughout
the
executive
branch—partnerships that help transform

28.

209

GENERAL GOVERNMENT

agencies into organizations that can deliver
the highest-quality services to the American
people.

rules, testimony, and proposed legislation are
consistent with the President’s budget and
with Administration policies.

OPM helps Federal program managers in
their personnel responsibilities through a
range of programs, such as training and
performance management, designed to develop
the most effective Federal employee. OPM
also provides fast, friendly, accurate, and
cost effective retirement, health benefit, and
life insurance services to employees, annuitants, and agencies.

OMB oversees and coordinates the Administration’s procurement, financial management,
information technology, and regulatory polices.
In each area, OMB helps improve administrative management, develop better performance
measures and coordinating mechanisms, and
reduce unnecessary burdens on the public.

Other Federal agencies with personnel management responsibilities are the Merit Systems
Protection Board, the Office of Special Counsel,
the Office of Government Ethics, and the
Federal Labor Relations Authority.
Office of Management and Budget
OMB provides direction and management
to Federal agencies, helping the President
discharge his responsibilities for budget, management, policy development, and other executive matters.
OMB’s most dominant function each year
is preparing the President’s budget, working
with the departments and agencies across
the Government. In helping to formulate
the President’s spending plans, OMB evaluates
the effectiveness of agency programs, policies,
and procedures; assesses competing funding
demands among agencies; and sets funding
priorities according to the President’s direction. OMB also ensures that agency reports,

Due to OMB’s predominantly cross-cutting
approach to budget and management matters,
it is continuously and actively involved in
agency efforts to develop strategic plans (under
the 1993 Government Performance and Results Act), streamline organizations and work
processes, downsize, and improve human resource management.
Tax Incentives
The Federal Government provides significant tax breaks for State and local governments. State and local tax-exempt borrowing
for public purposes, for instance, will cut
Federal revenues by an estimated $77 billion
from 1998 to 2002 1. Taxpayers also can
deduct their State and local income taxes
against their Federal income tax, and State
death taxes are creditable against Federal
estate taxes up to certain limits. Finally,
corporations that conduct business in Puerto
Rico also receive a special tax credit.
1 The budget describes various forms of tax-exempt borrowing for
non-public purposes in other functions.

29. NET INTEREST
Table 29–1. NET INTEREST
(In millions of dollars)
Function 900

Estimate

1996
Actual

Spending:
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law .................................... 241,090
Proposed legislation ....................... ................
Tax Expenditures:
Existing law ........................................
1,300

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

247,539
–157

249,840
19

251,792
51

248,126
77

244,857
106

238,623
139

1,290

1,285

1,270

1,215

1,170

1,155

The Federal Government pays large
amounts of interest to the public, mainly
on the securities it sells to finance the
budget deficit.
The Government also pays interest from
one account to another, mainly due to the
Government’s investing of trust fund balances
in Treasury securities. These payments move
money from one budget account to another.
Thus, net interest—which does not include
these payments—closely measures Federal interest transactions with the public. In 1998,
Federal outlays for net interest will total
an estimated $249.9 billion.
The Interest Burden
As noted above, net interest directly relates
to debt held by the public. It also relates
to the interest rates on the Treasury securities
that comprise that debt. In essence, debt
held by the public is the total of all deficits
that have accumulated in the past—minus
the amount offset by budget surpluses. Recent
large deficits sharply increased the ratio
of debt held by the public as a percentage
of Gross Domestic Product (GDP)—from 26.8
percent in 1980 to 51.9 percent in 1993.
Partly due to the huge rise in debt, interest
rates on Treasury securities also rose sharply.
The combination of much more debt and
higher interest rates caused Federal net interest costs to mushroom—from 2.0 to 3.4 percent

of GDP between 1980 and 1993 (see Chart
29–1).
Now that the budget deficits have fallen,
the ratio of net interest to GDP has begun
to fall as well, from 3.4 percent in 1990
to 3.2 percent in 1996. The President’s plan
to balance the budget by 2002 would further
reduce the ratio, to 2.4 percent by 2002,
reflecting not just the gradually falling deficits
but also lower interest rates on Treasury
securities—both in the recent past and projected for the future.
Components of Net Interest
Net interest is gross interest on the public
debt minus interest received by on-budget
and off-budget trust funds and minus all
of the activities that fall in the category
of ‘‘other interest’’ (discussed later in this
chapter).
Gross Interest on the Public Debt: Gross
interest on the public debt will total an estimated $366.1 billion in 1998 and $376.8 billion
in 2002. At the end of 1996, the gross debt
totaled $5.147 trillion, of which $3.698 trillion
was held by the public. The debt held by the
public accounted for about a quarter of the
total credit market debt owed by the non-financial sector.
The Treasury Department’s management
of the debt, including its decisions about
how much to invest in securities with different
211

212

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Chart 29-1. NET INTEREST
PERCENT OF GDP

4

3

PROJECTED
2

1

0
1960

1965

1970

1975

1980

maturities, may substantially influence Federal interest payments. Since 1993, the average maturity of marketable, privately held
public debt shrunk from five years and ten
months to five years and two months, cutting
total interest outlays by an estimated $9.6
billion in 1994–1998. In 1997, Treasury plans
to issue 10-year notes indexed to the
Consumer Price Index. The principal, paid
at maturity, is adjusted each month for
inflation while interest, paid semiannually,
is computed on the inflation-adjusted principal.
Indexed bonds may have a lower yield than
fixed-rate securities of similar maturity because the holder faces less risk from inflation.
Interest Received by On-Budget Trust
Funds: On-budget trust funds will earn, in
interest, an estimated $63.7 billion in 1998
and $67.4 billion in 2002. The civil service retirement and disability fund will receive almost half of it, while the military retirement
fund will receive a fifth. The Medicare Hospital Insurance (HI) trust fund will receive

1985

1990

1995

2000

over $10 billion in 1998. Without changes in
policy, the interest receipts of that fund will
approach zero as it sells its Treasury securities
to offset a growing deficit.
Interest Received by Off-Budget Trust
Funds: Under current law, the receipts and
disbursements of Social Security’s old-age and
survivors insurance (OASI) trust fund and disability insurance (DI) trust fund are excluded
from the budget. Social Security, however, is
a Federal program. Thus, net interest includes
the off-budget interest earnings. Because Social Security will accumulate large surpluses
over the next several years, interest earnings
of the off-budget trust funds will rise from an
estimated $45.2 billion in 1998 to $61.6 billion
in 2002.
Other Interest: Other interest includes both
interest payments and interest collections—
much of it consisting of intra-governmental
payments and collections that arise from Federal revolving funds. These funds borrow from

29.

NET INTEREST

the Treasury to carry out lending or other
business-type activities.
Budgetary Effect, including the Federal
Reserve
The Federal Reserve System trades Treasury securities in the open market to implement

213
monetary policy. The interest that Treasury
then pays on the securities falls within
net interest, but virtually all of it comes
back to the Treasury as ‘‘deposits of earnings
of the Federal Reserve System.’’ These budget
receipts will total an estimated $23.0 billion
in 1998 and $24.2 billion in 2002.

30.

UNDISTRIBUTED OFFSETTING
RECEIPTS

Table 30–1.

UNDISTRIBUTED OFFSETTING RECEIPTS
(In millions of dollars)

Function 950

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Spending:
Mandatory Outlays:
Existing law .................................... –37,620 –46,487
Proposed legislation ....................... ................ ................

Offsetting receipts, totaling $52.9 billion
in 1998, fall into two categories: (1) the
Government’s receipts from performing business-like activities, such as proceeds from
the sale of postage stamps or a Federal
asset, and (2) the amounts that the Government shifts from one account to another,
such as agency payments to retirement funds.
Rents and Royalties on the Outer
Continental Shelf (OCS)
The Interior Department’s Outer Continental Shelf Lands leasing program, which began
in 1954, generates 15 percent and 24 percent
of U.S. domestic oil and natural gas production, respectively. Since the program began,
it has held 120 lease sales, covering areas
three to 200 miles offshore and generating
over $110 billion in rents, bonuses, and
royalties—mainly for the Treasury.
OCS revenues help to reduce the deficit,
but they also provide most funding for the
Land and Water Conservation Fund and
Historic Preservation Fund programs. The
OCS program will generate about $4 billion
in receipts in 1997. In 1998, the Administration will continue the leasing moratoria for
the environmentally sensitive areas—offshore
California, Oregon, and Washington; the Eastern Seaboard; the southwestern coastline of
Florida, including the Everglades; and certain
parts of Alaska.

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

–52,869
–2,721

–41,127
–2,404

–41,610
–4,388

–43,174
–6,877

–45,283
–22,667

Asset Sales
The United States Enrichment Corporation (USEC): USEC, which began operations
in July 1993, sells enriched uranium globally
to utilities as fuel for nuclear power plants.
Congress created USEC as a wholly-owned
government corporation—the first step in a series of actions designed to lead to privatization.
USEC’s sale, now planned for 1998, will raise
an estimated $1.8 billion.
Elk Hills: The Defense Authorization Act
of 1996 requires the sale of Naval Petroleum
Reserve 1 in California (commonly known as
Elk Hills) by February 10, 1998. As a result,
the budget assumes that the Government will
receive $2.4 billion in sale proceeds in 1998.
The Government is privatizing Elk Hills because the private, rather than public, sector
should perform commercial oil and gas operations.
Alaska Power Administration: The Administration plans to focus on completing the
sale of the power plants at Anchorage and
Juneau to current customers, as authorized
under a 1995 law. The sale, which will raise
an estimated $85 million for the Federal Government, is scheduled for completion by August 1998.

215

216
Employee Retirement
Federal agencies will pay an estimated
$35.5 billion on behalf of their employees
in 1998 to the Federal retirement funds,1
the Medicare health insurance trust fund,
and the Social Security trust funds. As the
Federal Government raises the pay of civilian
employees, agencies must make commensurate
1 The major funds are the Military Retirement Funds, the Civil
Service Retirement System, and the Federal Employee Retirement
System.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

increases in their payments to recognize the
increased cost of retirement.
Other Undistributed Offsetting Receipts
The President and Congress gave the Federal Communications Commission authority
in 1993 to auction spectrum licenses, rather
than give them away. These auctions have
been extraordinarily successful, raising $23
billion to date and cutting the time to
award a license by 90 percent in some
cases.

31.

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

050 National defense:
Discretionary:
Department of Defense—Military:
Military personnel ......................
69,776
69,919
69,474
70,098
71,410
73,256
75,257
Operation and maintenance ......
93,640
92,906
93,667
91,521
92,166
93,924
91,947
Procurement ...............................
42,417
44,156
42,606
50,716
56,997
60,662
68,336
Research, development, test and
evaluation ................................
34,971
36,589
35,934
35,044
33,403
32,897
34,249
Military construction .................
6,891
5,862
4,715
4,245
4,267
4,211
3,370
Family housing ...........................
4,259
4,122
3,668
3,876
3,941
3,985
3,913
Revolving, management and
trust funds ...............................
1,761
2,275
1,615
1,668
1,328
1,362
1,370
DOD-wide savings proposals ..... ...................
–4,800 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Proposed legislation (nonPAYGO) ................................... ................... ................... ...................
85
85
85
85
Discretionary offsetting receipts
–100
–102
–102
–92
–92
–92
–92
Total, Department of Defense—Military .............

253,615

250,927

251,577

257,161

263,505

270,290

278,435

3,455

3,911

3,576

3,497

3,400

3,362

3,321

Atomic energy defense activities:
Weapons activities .....................
Defense environmental restoration and waste management
Defense nuclear waste disposal
Other atomic energy defense activities ......................................

5,545
248

5,619
200

5,052
190

4,647
190

4,778
190

4,674
190

4,533
190

1,447

1,622

4,797

3,489

2,795

2,636

2,484

Total, Atomic energy defense activities .............

10,695

11,352

13,615

11,823

11,163

10,862

10,528

Defense-related activities:
Discretionary programs .............

697

793

782

850

849

845

797

Total, Discretionary ...................

265,007

263,072

265,974

269,834

275,517

281,997

289,760

Mandatory:
Department of Defense—Military:
Revolving, trust and other DoD
mandatory ...............................
1,374
132
187
183
163
162
Proceeds from sales from National Defense Stockpile (Proposed PAYGO legislation) ...... ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Offsetting receipts ......................
–583
–1,069
–1,067
–1,029
–901
–901
Total, Department of Defense—Military .............

791

–937

–880

–846

–738

–739

162

–200
–901

–939

217

218

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Atomic energy defense activities:
Proceeds from sales of excess
DOE assets ..............................

–5

–25

–15

–15

–15

–15

–15

Defense-related activities:
Mandatory programs .................

214

196

197

210

223

237

251

Total, Mandatory ........................

1,000

–766

–698

–651

–530

–517

–703

Total, National defense .............

266,007

262,306

265,276

269,183

274,987

281,480

289,057

2,141

2,149

2,200

2,244

2,290

2,336

2,384

1,163

1,014

1,604

1,490

1,476

1,192

1,149

518
836
721

576
877
700

900
877
700

850
900
718

800
923
737

750
946
756

675
971
775

463

475

492

300

175

100

50

285
218

272
220

365
222

365
228

365
234

365
240

365
246

303

361

352

351

351

350

363

Total, International development, humanitarian assistance ..........

6,648

6,644

7,712

7,446

7,351

7,035

6,978

International security assistance:
Foreign military financing
grants and loans .....................
Economic support fund ..............
Other security assistance ..........

3,351
2,341
236

3,308
2,363
257

3,340
2,445
174

3,340
2,503
174

3,340
2,511
174

3,340
2,519
174

3,340
2,527
174

Total, International security assistance ..............

5,928

5,928

5,959

6,017

6,025

6,033

6,041

1,721

1,721

1,721

1,721

1,721

595

595

595

595

595

150 International affairs:
Discretionary:
International development,
humanitarian assistance:
Development assistance and operating expenses .....................
Multilateral development banks
(MDB’s) ....................................
Assistance for the New Independent States ........................
Food aid ......................................
Refugee programs .......................
Assistance for Central and
Eastern Europe .......................
Voluntary contributions to
international organizations ....
Peace Corps ................................
Other development and humanitarian assistance ....................

Conduct of foreign affairs:
State Department operations ....
2,097
2,102
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, State Department
operations .........................

2,097

2,102

2,316

2,316

2,316

2,316

2,316

Foreign buildings .......................

321

389

373

373

373

373

373

31.

219

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

1999

Assessed contributions to international organizations ............
892
882
1,023
Assessed contributions for international peacekeeping ............
359
352
286
Arrearage payment for international organizations and
peacekeeping ........................... ................... ................... ...................
Other conduct of foreign affairs
156
165
166
Total, Conduct of foreign
affairs ............................
Foreign information and exchange activities:
U.S. Information Agency ...........
Other information and exchange activities .....................
Total, Foreign information and exchange activities ...........................

2000

2001

2002

900

900

925

925

240

240

240

240

921 ................... ................... ...................
168
169
171
172

3,825

3,890

4,164

4,918

3,998

4,025

4,026

1,124

1,090

1,079

1,075

1,071

1,070

1,070

6

8

8

6

3

1,130

1,098

1,087

1,081

1,074

International financial programs:
Export-Import Bank ...................
764
715
Special defense acquisition fund
–173
–166
IMF new arrangements to borrow ........................................... ................... ...................
Other IMF ................................... ................... ...................

630
–106

1 ...................

1,071

1,070

630
630
630
630
–30 ................... ................... ...................

3,521 ................... ................... ................... ...................
7
17
17
17
17

Total, International financial programs .........

591

549

4,052

617

647

647

647

Total, Discretionary ...................

18,122

18,109

22,974

20,079

19,095

18,811

18,762

–521

–457

–452

–472

–468

–458

–13

–13

–13

–13

–13

–13

–564

–534

–470

–465

–485

–481

–471

–661

–637

–535

–364

–268

–183

–133

–229

–203

–191

–189

–201

–228

–227

–890

–840

–726

–553

–469

–411

–360

Mandatory:
International development,
humanitarian assistance:
Credit liquidating accounts .......
–564
Other development and humanitarian assistance .................... ...................
Total, International development, humanitarian assistance ..........
International security assistance:
Repayment of foreign military
financing loans ........................
Foreign military loan liquidating account ..............................
Total, International security assistance ..............

220

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

Foreign affairs and information:
Conduct of foreign affairs ..........
8
3
U.S. Information Agency trust
funds ........................................
1
1
Japan-U.S. Friendship Commission .......................................... ...................
1
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Japan-U.S.
Friendship Commission
Total, Foreign affairs and
information ...................
International financial programs:
Foreign military sales trust
fund (net) .................................
Exchange stabilization fund ......
Other international financial
programs .................................

...................

9

1999

2000

2001

2002

3

3

3

3

3

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

46 ................... ................... ................... ...................

1

47

1

1

1

1

5

51

5

5

5

5

552
760
90
–820
–580
–150
–10
–778 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
–55

–108

–110

–112

–190

–142

–50

Total, International financial programs .........

–281

652

–20

–932

–770

–292

–60

Total, Mandatory ........................

–1,726

–717

–1,165

–1,945

–1,719

–1,179

–886

Total, International affairs ......

16,396

17,392

21,809

18,134

17,376

17,632

17,876

3,156

3,207

3,305

3,311

3,318

3,325

3,332

966

996

1,003

996

996

996

996

Total, General science
and basic research .......

4,122

4,203

4,308

4,307

4,314

4,321

4,328

Space flight, research, and
supporting activities:
Science, aeronautics and technology .......................................
Human space flight ....................
Mission support ..........................

5,032
5,457
2,065

4,746
5,540
2,123

4,722
5,327
2,064

4,789
5,306
2,006

4,947
5,077
1,889

5,135
4,832
1,928

5,172
4,676
2,031

250 General science, space, and
technology:
Discretionary:
General science and basic research:
National Science Foundation
programs .................................
Department of Energy general
science programs ....................

31.

221

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Other NASA programs ..............

16

17

18

19

19

19

19

Total, Space flight, research, and supporting
activities .......................

12,570

12,426

12,131

12,120

11,932

11,914

11,898

Total, Discretionary ...................

16,692

16,629

16,439

16,427

16,246

16,235

16,226

Mandatory:
General science and basic research:
National Science Foundation
donations .................................

24

38

38

31

31

31

31

Total, Mandatory ........................

24

38

38

31

31

31

31

Total, General science, space,
and technology ........................

16,716

16,667

16,477

16,458

16,277

16,266

16,257

3,323

3,094

3,062

3,400

3,210

3,085

3,011

148
343
–350
151
316

144
201
–377
182
233

117
249
–388
190
237

48
220
–398
190
241

48
190
–410
190
231

48
190
–421
190
219

48
190
–435
190
201

124
–18

66
–4

59
87

55
48

55
48

55
48

55
48

4,037

3,539

3,613

3,804

3,562

3,414

3,308

688
209

691
209

688
209

690
209

689
209

270 Energy:
Discretionary:
Energy supply:
Research and development ........
Naval petroleum reserves operations .......................................
Uranium enrichment activities
Decontamination transfer ..........
Nuclear waste program .............
Federal power marketing ..........
Rural electric and telephone
discretionary loans .................
Financial management services
Total, Energy supply .......

Energy conservation and preparedness:
Energy conservation ...................
533
550
Emergency energy preparedness ................... ...................
Total, Energy conservation and preparedness
Energy information, policy,
and regulation:
Nuclear Regulatory Commission
(NRC) .......................................
Federal Energy Regulatory
Commission fees and recoveries, and other ..........................

533

550

897

900

897

899

898

18

15

19

19

19

19

19

–52

–31

–22

–22

–23

–24

–24

222

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Departmental and other administration ...................................

364

183

196

190

190

190

190

Total, Energy information, policy, and regulation ................................

330

167

193

187

186

185

185

Total, Discretionary ...................

4,900

4,256

4,703

4,891

4,645

4,498

4,391

–10

–10

–10

2

2

2

–8

–8

–8

Mandatory:
Energy supply:
Naval petroleum reserves oil
and gas sales ...........................
–419
–444
–175
–20
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Naval petroleum
reserves oil and gas sales

–419

Federal power marketing ..........
–996
Tennessee Valley Authority ......
55
United States Enrichment Corporation ................................... ...................
Nuclear waste fund program .....
–634
Rural electric and telephone liquidating accounts ....................
–259
Total, Energy supply .......

–2,253

–444

–175

–20

–798
–182

–828
–773
–744
–746
–799
–285 ................... ................... ................... ...................

–29
–649

–100
–655

–89
–657

–80
–659

–100
–660

–940
–660

–1,193

–770

–2,166

–1,038

–1,573

–863

–3,295

–2,813

–3,705

–2,529

–3,087

–3,270

Emergency energy preparedness:
Lease excess SPR capacity (Proposed PAYGO Legislation) ..... ................... ................... ...................
–14
–37
–67
Sale of Weeks Island Oil (Proposed PAYGO Legislation) ..... ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Total, Emergency energy
preparedness ................ ................... ................... ...................

–83
–1,145

–14

–37

–67

–1,228

Total, Mandatory ........................

–2,253

–3,295

–2,813

–3,719

–2,566

–3,154

–4,498

Total, Energy ...............................

2,647

961

1,890

1,172

2,079

1,344

–107

300 Natural resources and environment:
Discretionary:
Water resources:
Corps of Engineers .....................
Bureau of Reclamation ..............

3,340
808

3,443
774

3,671
906

3,305
883

3,342
874

3,273
740

3,306
742

31.

223

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Other discretionary water resources programs ....................
261
210
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

1999

2000

2001

2002

164

164

164

164

169

–7

–14

–14

–14

–14

Subtotal, Other discretionary water resources
programs ..........................

261

210

157

150

150

150

155

Total, Water resources ....

4,409

4,427

4,734

4,338

4,366

4,163

4,203

2,431

2,476

2,525

1,041

1,065

1,086

42

63

35

Conservation and land management:
Forest Service .............................
2,336
2,556
2,340
2,386
Management of public lands
(BLM) .......................................
1,017
947
989
1,020
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Management of
public lands (BLM) ..........

1,017

947

989

1,020

1,083

1,128

1,121

Conservation of agricultural
lands ........................................
Other conservation and land
management programs ...........

740

655

687

687

687

687

687

604

580

684

687

687

687

587

Total, Conservation and
land management ........

4,697

4,738

4,700

4,780

4,888

4,978

4,920

2,167

2,237

2,357

2,375

2,423

2,477

2,534

39

40

40

40

40

40

40

2,206

2,277

2,397

2,415

2,463

2,517

2,574

2,383

2,464

2,725

2,722

2,799

2,842

2,926

2,813
1,311

2,910
1,394

2,793
2,094

2,890
2,094

2,861
1,444

2,885
1,394

2,908
1,394

128

132

141

141

141

141

141

Total, Pollution control
and abatement .............

6,635

6,900

7,753

7,847

7,245

7,262

7,369

Other natural resources:
NOAA ..........................................

1,933

1,977

2,052

2,256

2,129

2,066

2,008

Recreational resources:
Operation of recreational resources .....................................
Other recreational resources activities ......................................
Total, Recreational resources ..........................
Pollution control and abatement:
Regulatory, enforcement, and
research programs ..................
State and tribal assistance
grants .......................................
Hazardous substance superfund
Other control and abatement
activities ..................................

224

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Other natural resource program
activities ..................................

788

752

757

757

757

755

755

Total, Other natural resources ..........................

2,721

2,729

2,809

3,013

2,886

2,821

2,763

Total, Discretionary ...................

20,668

21,071

22,393

22,393

21,848

21,741

21,829

Mandatory:
Water resources:
Mandatory water resource programs .......................................

–155

51

–46

–95

–110

–111

–109

2,347

2,204

2,311

2,313

2,296

–25

–25

–25

–25

–25

2,322

2,179

2,286

2,288

2,271

564

511

508

506

506

35

3

5

4

3

599

514

513

510

509

–2,079

–2,115

–2,129

–2,156

–2,200

–35

–77

–98

–70

–70

Conservation and land management:
Conservation Reserve Program
1,924
2,121
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Conservation Reserve Program ..................

1,924

2,121

Other conservation programs ....
812
603
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other conservation programs ...................

812

603

Offsetting receipts ......................
–1,856
–2,011
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Offsetting receipts

–1,856

–2,011

–2,114

–2,192

–2,227

–2,226

–2,270

Total, Conservation and
land management ........

880

713

807

501

572

572

510

759

795

748

765

784

16

17

75

77

85

775

812

823

842

869

–308

–317

–236

–236

–240

–1

–1

–78

–80

–88

Recreational resources:
Operation of recreational resources .....................................
684
780
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Operation of recreational resources ..........

684

780

Offsetting receipts ......................
–239
–294
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Offsetting receipts

–239

–294

–309

–318

–314

–316

–328

Total, Recreational resources ..........................

445

486

466

494

509

526

541

31.

225

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Pollution control and abatement:
Superfund resources and other
mandatory ...............................
–205
–147
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

–125

–100

–100

–101

–101

200

200

200

200

200

Subtotal, Superfund resources and other mandatory ...................................

–205

–147

75

100

100

99

99

Other natural resources:
Other fees and mandatory programs .......................................

–23

–68

–12

–29

–29

–29

–29

Total, Mandatory ........................

942

1,035

1,290

971

1,042

1,057

1,012

Total, Natural resources and
environment .............................

21,610

22,106

23,683

23,364

22,890

22,798

22,841

318

318

318

318

318

90
1,017

90
943

90
880

90
857

90
860

–53

–51

–62

–75

–88

350 Agriculture:
Discretionary:
Farm income stabilization:
Agriculture credit insurance
loan subsidies ..........................
422
384
P.L.480 market development activities ......................................
238
142
Administrative expenses ............
801
817
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Administrative
expenses ...........................

801

817

964

892

818

782

772

Total, Farm income stabilization .......................

1,461

1,343

1,372

1,300

1,226

1,190

1,180

1,213
418
51

1,192
418
51

1,204
418
51

1,211
418
51

1,222
418
51

431

431

431

431

431

–10

–10

–10

–10

–10

Agricultural research and
services:
Research programs .....................
1,225
1,275
Extension programs ...................
428
426
Marketing programs ..................
48
40
Animal and plant inspection
programs .................................
459
438
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Animal and plant
inspection programs ........

459

438

421

421

421

421

421

Economic intelligence .................

134

153

174

161

156

147

155

226

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

Grain inspection user fees .........
23
23
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

1999

2000

2001

2002

26

26

26

26

26

–16

–19

–19

–19

–19

Subtotal, Grain inspection
user fees ...........................

23

23

10

7

7

7

7

Other programs and
unallocated overhead ..............

428

442

456

464

461

460

460

Total, Agricultural research and services ......

2,745

2,797

2,743

2,714

2,718

2,715

2,734

Total, Discretionary ...................

4,206

4,140

4,115

4,014

3,944

3,905

3,914

7,483

7,297

6,824

5,621

5,378

1,590

1,512

1,578

1,660

1,759

26

22

23

25

25

Mandatory:
Farm income stabilization:
Commodity Credit Corporation
5,129
6,668
Crop insurance and other farm
credit activities .......................
1,605
1,791
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Crop insurance
and other farm credit activities ...............................

1,605

1,791

1,616

1,534

1,601

1,685

1,784

Credit liquidating accounts
(ACIF and FAC) ......................

–1,301

–1,241

–1,190

–1,129

–1,073

–1,016

–1,011

Total, Farm income stabilization .......................

5,433

7,218

7,909

7,702

7,352

6,290

6,151

Agricultural research and
services:
Fund for Rural America (Proposed PAYGO legislation) ...... ................... ...................
Miscellaneous mandatory programs .......................................
136
221
Offsetting receipts ......................
–148
–136

50 ...................

–50 ................... ...................

182
–137

235
–137

239
–137

194
–137

200
–137

Total, Agricultural research and services ......

–12

85

95

98

52

57

63

Total, Mandatory ........................

5,421

7,303

8,004

7,800

7,404

6,347

6,214

Total, Agriculture .......................

9,627

11,443

12,119

11,814

11,348

10,252

10,128

905

–311

181

152

150

146

142

5

3

3

3

3

3

3

370 Commerce and housing credit:
Discretionary:
Mortgage credit:
Federal Housing Administration (FHA) Loan Subsidies ....
Other Housing and Urban Development ................................

31.

227

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Rural housing insurance fund ...

646

557

580

580

580

580

580

Total, Mortgage credit .....

1,556

249

764

735

733

729

725

Postal service:
Payments to the Postal Service
fund (On-budget) ....................

85

85

86

85

87

88

88

Deposit insurance:
FSLIC Resolution Fund (transfer of balances) ........................ ...................
Other discretionary ....................
11
Total, Deposit insurance

–26
–34 ................... ................... ................... ...................
1 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

11

–25

–34 ................... ................... ................... ...................

516
572

555
598

556
720

554
762

554
778

554
851

555
937

Other advancement of commerce:
Small and minority business assistance ....................................
Science and technology ..............
Economic and demographic statistics .......................................
Regulatory agencies ...................
International Trade Administration ......................................
Other discretionary ....................

330
251

392
140

713
155

1,154
160

2,620
150

527
152

452
153

267
133

270
98

272
76

272
48

272
48

272
48

272
48

Total, Other advancement of commerce ........

2,069

2,053

2,492

2,950

4,422

2,404

2,417

Total, Discretionary ...................

3,721

2,362

3,308

3,770

5,242

3,221

3,230

–1,315

–1,637

–1,712

–1,793

–1,953

–52

–97

–137

–180

–228

–370

–446

–404

–397

–395

–1,737

–2,180

–2,253

–2,370

–2,576

Mandatory:
Mortgage credit:
FHA and GNMA negative subsidies ........................................
–1,012 ...................
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, FHA and GNMA
negative subsidies ...........

–1,012 ...................

FHA Multifamily portfolio reengineering (Proposed
PAYGO Legislation) ............... ................... ...................
–665 ................... ................... ................... ...................
FHA Multifamily portfolio reengineering (Proposed nonPAYGO Legislation) ............... ................... ...................
523
899
864 ................... ...................
Mortgage credit liquidating accounts ......................................
732
–10
–724
401
301
1,131
1,116
Other mortgage credit activities
13
22 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Total, Mortgage credit .....

–267

12

–2,603

–880

–1,088

–1,239

–1,460

228

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Postal service:
Payments to the Postal Service
fund for nonfunded liabilities
(On-budget) .............................
37
36
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Payments to the
Postal Service fund for
nonfunded liabilities (Onbudget) ..............................

37

1999

2000

2001

2002

35

33

32

30

29

–35

–33

–32

–30

–29

36 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

Postal Service (Off-budget) ........
3,441
8,000
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

4,932
35

1,442

1,157

2,411

3,326

8 ................... ................... ...................

Subtotal, Postal Service
(Off-budget) ......................

3,441

8,000

4,967

1,450

1,157

2,411

3,326

Total, Postal service ........

3,478

8,036

4,967

1,450

1,157

2,411

3,326

–79

–82

–86

–89

–93

Deposit insurance:
Total, Deposit insurance

................... ...................

Other advancement of commerce:
Universal Service Fund .............
944
1,400
2,240
6,350
11,325
12,194
12,838
Payments to copyright owners
223
243
245
255
263
271
282
Spectrum auction subsidy .........
1
838
388 ................... ................... ................... ...................
Regulatory fees ...........................
–41
–38
–38
–38
–38
–38
–38
Patent and trademark fees ........
–111
–115
–119 ................... ................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................
–119
–119
–119
–119
Subtotal, Patent and trademark fees ..........................

–111

–115

–119

–119

–119

–119

–119

Credit liquidating accounts .......
22 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Other mandatory ........................
370
102
43
44
96
97
99
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
–69
–69
–69
–69
–69
Subtotal, Other mandatory

370

102

–26

–25

27

28

30

Total, Other advancement of commerce ........

1,408

2,430

2,690

6,423

11,458

12,336

12,993

Total, Mandatory ........................

4,619

10,478

4,975

6,911

11,441

13,419

14,766

Total, Commerce and housing
credit ..........................................

8,340

12,840

8,283

10,681

16,683

16,640

17,996

82
150

100
150

100
150

100
150

100
150

100
150

400 Transportation:
Discretionary:
Ground transportation:
Highways 1 ..................................
278
State infrastructure banks ........ ...................

31.

229

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Highway safety 1 .........................
10
111
Mass transit 1 .............................
1,275
823
Railroads .....................................
868
1,032
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Railroads .............

868

Regulation ...................................

22

Total, Ground transportation .............................

2,453

1,032

1999

2000

2001

2002

148
339
897

148
189
897

148
139
897

148
139
897

148
139
897

–60

–60

–60

–60

–60

837

837

837

837

837

12 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

2,210

Air transportation:
Airports and airways (FAA) ......
6,695
7,027
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

1,574

1,424

1,374

1,374

1,374

7,111 ................... ................... ................... ...................
75

2,159

2,215

2,275

2,336

225

6,475

6,647

6,824

7,006

8,634

8,862

9,099

9,342

Subtotal, Airports and airways (FAA) .......................

6,695

7,027

7,411

Aeronautical research and technology .......................................
Payments to air carriers ............

1,315
–23

1,283
–14

1,369
1,290
1,268
1,287
1,302
–39 ................... ................... ................... ...................

7,987

8,296

8,741

9,924

10,130

10,386

10,644

Water transportation:
Marine safety and transportation .......................................
Ocean shipping ...........................

2,708
135

2,784
130

2,861
123

2,861
123

2,861
123

2,861
123

2,861
123

Total, Water transportation .............................

2,843

2,914

2,984

2,984

2,984

2,984

2,984

229

228

228

228

228

1

1

1

1

1

5

5

5

5

5

Total, Air transportation

Other transportation:
Other discretionary programs ...
345
362
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other discretionary programs .............

345

362

235

234

234

234

234

Total, Discretionary ...................

13,628

13,782

13,534

14,566

14,722

14,978

15,236

22,335

22,333

22,343

22,386

22,413

152

21

–85

–156

–192

22,487

22,354

22,258

22,230

22,221

Mandatory:
Ground transportation:
Highways 1 ..................................
17,871
22,185
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Highways .............

17,871

22,185

230

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Highway safety 1 .........................
Mass transit 1 .............................
Offsetting receipts and liquidating accounts ............................

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

266
2,775

270
4,800

331
4,771

331
4,921

331
4,971

331
4,971

331
4,971

–19

–25

–35

–26

–30

–30

–30

Total, Ground transportation .............................

20,893

27,230

27,554

27,580

27,530

27,502

27,493

Air transportation:
Airports and airways (FAA) ......
Payments to air carriers ............

1,550
39

2,230
39

2,397
89

50
50

50
50

50
50

50
50

1,589

2,269

2,486

100

100

100

100

646

676

710

746

782

–21

20

22

25

25

31

–30

–29

–29

–29

Total, Air transportation

Water transportation:
Coast Guard retired pay ............
579
612
Other water transportation programs .......................................
–43
–31
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other water
transportation programs
Total, Water transportation .............................

–43

–31

10

–10

–7

–4

–4

536

581

656

666

703

742

778

Other transportation:
Sale of Governor’s Island and
Union Station Air Rights
(Proposed PAYGO Legislation) .......................................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Other mandatory transportation
programs .................................
–33
–32
–32
–32
–32
–32

–540
–32

Total, Other transportation .............................

–33

–32

–32

–32

–32

–32

–572

Total, Mandatory ........................

22,985

30,048

30,664

28,314

28,301

28,312

27,799

Total, Transportation ................

36,613

43,830

44,198

42,880

43,023

43,290

43,035

33

33

30

30

30

30

30

4,650

4,600

4,600

4,600

4,100

4,100

4,100

45

50

125

130

170

225

350

450 Community and regional development:
Discretionary:
Community development:
Community development loan
guarantees ...............................
Community development block
grant ........................................
Community development financial institutions .......................

31.

231

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Other community development
programs .................................
355
250
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

1998

1999

2000

2001

252

2002

283

262

252

227

100

100 ................... ................... ...................

Subtotal, Other community
development programs ....

355

250

383

362

252

252

227

Total, Community development ..........................

5,083

4,933

5,138

5,122

4,552

4,607

4,707

867

878

897

916

936

343
1,036

338
1,036

237
1,036

233
1,036

232
1,036

Area and regional development:
Rural development .....................
777
790
Economic Development Administration ...................................
372
374
Indian programs .........................
968
935
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Indian programs

968

935

Appalachian Regional Commission ...........................................
Tennessee Valley Authority ......

170
109

160
106

Total, Area and regional
development .................

2,396

2,365

Disaster relief and insurance:
Small Business Administration
disaster loans ..........................
331
327
Disaster relief .............................
3,393
1,320
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

7 ................... ................... ................... ...................
1,043

1,036

1,036

1,036

1,036

165
70
70
70
70
106 ................... ................... ................... ...................

2,524

2,322

2,240

2,255

2,274

173
2,708

192
320

192
320

192
320

192
320

50

50

50

50

50

Subtotal, Disaster relief .....

3,393

1,320

2,758

370

370

370

370

Other disaster assistance programs .......................................

442

368

327

327

327

327

327

Total, Disaster relief and
insurance ......................

4,166

2,015

3,258

889

889

889

889

Total, Discretionary ...................

11,645

9,313

10,920

8,333

7,681

7,751

7,870

Mandatory:
Community development:
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ...................

157 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

232

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Area and regional development:
Indian programs .........................
490
544
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Indian programs

490

544

Rural development programs ....
137
451
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

1998

1999

457

2000

461

2001

468

2002

474

476

–7 ................... ................... ................... ...................
450

461

468

474

476

5

55

55

5

5

50 ...................

–50 ................... ...................

Subtotal, Rural development programs ................

137

451

55

55

5

5

5

Credit liquidating accounts .......
Offsetting receipts ......................

103
–359

128
–258

188
–254

270
–254

204
–258

219
–264

64
–268

Total, Area and regional
development .................

371

865

439

532

419

434

277

114
–1

–31
–52
–71
–93
–113
–1 ................... ................... ................... ...................

Disaster relief and insurance:
National flood insurance fund ...
527
Credit liquidating accounts ....... ...................
Total, Disaster relief and
insurance ......................

527

113

–32

–52

–71

–93

–113

Total, Mandatory ........................

898

1,135

407

480

348

341

164

Total, Community and regional development ................

12,543

10,448

11,327

8,813

8,029

8,092

8,034

530
1,218

691
1,426

1,245
1,299

1,261
1,333

1,208
1,368

1,045
1,403

687
1,440

5,896
3,245
693
1,340
583

7,690
4,036
730
1,487
610

8,077
4,210
658
1,566
625

8,287
4,319
680
1,607
626

8,502
4,432
697
1,649
628

8,723
4,547
710
1,692
630

8,950
4,665
718
1,736
631

178
7

262
7

354
7

363
7

373
7

382
7

392
7

13,690

16,939

18,041

18,483

18,864

19,139

19,226

500 Education, training, employment, and social services:
Discretionary:
Elementary, secondary, and
vocational education:
Education reform ........................
School improvement programs
Education for the disadvantaged ........................................
Special education ........................
Impact aid ...................................
Vocational and adult education
Indian education programs .......
Bilingual and immigrant education .......................................
Other ...........................................
Total, Elementary, secondary, and vocational
education ......................

31.

233

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

Higher education:
Student financial assistance .....
6,258
7,560
9,263
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Student financial
assistance .........................

6,258

7,560

Higher education account ..........
837
879
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Higher education
account .............................
Federal family education loan
program ...................................
Other higher education programs .......................................
Total, Higher education

2000

2001

2002

8,752

8,972

9,193

9,422

752

780

812

842

9,263

9,504

9,752

10,005

10,264

903

926

949

972

995

132

141

145

148

150

837

879

1,035

1,067

1,094

1,120

1,145

30

46

48

49

50

52

53

309

325

327

335

343

353

362

7,434

8,810

10,673

10,955

11,239

11,530

11,824

Research and general education aids:
Library of Congress ....................
Public broadcasting ....................
Smithsonian institution .............
Education research, statistics,
and improvement ....................
Other ...........................................

254
313
459

258
296
461

277
286
515

278
286
457

281
364
457

284
364
457

290
366
457

351
704

598
701

511
784

519
805

528
824

541
848

527
872

Total, Research and general education aids .......

2,081

2,314

2,373

2,345

2,454

2,494

2,512

Training and employment:
Training and employment services ...........................................
4,140
4,716
5,295
5,349
5,411
5,492
5,631
Older Americans employment ...
373
463 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Federal-State employment service .............................................
1,192
1,249
1,252
1,208
1,180
1,196
1,219
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
–50
–50
–50
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
19
38
38
38
38
Subtotal, Federal-State employment service ..............

1,192

1,249

Welfare to work jobs .................. ................... ...................

1,271

1,246

1,168

6

6

7

1,184

1,207

3 ...................

234

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

Other employment and training
83
81
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

1999

2000

2001

2002

86

86

86

86

86

6

12

12

12

12

Subtotal, Other employment and training ...........

83

81

92

98

98

98

98

Total, Training and employment .......................

5,788

6,509

6,664

6,699

6,684

6,777

6,936

Other labor services:
Labor law, statistics, and other
administration ........................

957

1,003

1,063

1,063

1,063

1,063

1,063

Social services:
National service initiative .........
Children and families services
programs .................................
Aging services program .............
Other ...........................................

600

616

809

834

858

883

910

4,766
829
2

5,364
830
2

5,499
1,278
25

5,751
1,278
12

6,013
1,278
2

6,301
1,278
–6

6,599
1,278
–13

Total, Social services .......

6,197

6,812

7,611

7,875

8,151

8,456

8,774

Total, Discretionary ...................

36,147

42,387

46,425

47,420

48,455

49,459

50,335

7

7

7

7

7

–7

–7

–7

–7

–7

Mandatory:
Elementary, secondary, and
vocational education:
Vocational and adult education
7
7
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Vocational and
adult education ................

7

7 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

School construction (Proposed
PAYGO legislation) ................ ................... ...................
America Reads Challenge (Proposed PAYGO legislation) ...... ................... ...................
Total, Elementary, secondary, and vocational
education ......................

7

Higher education:
Federal family education loan
program ...................................
3,546
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ...................
Subtotal, Federal family
education loan program

3,546

5,000 ................... ................... ................... ...................
260

290

335

380

460

7

5,260

290

335

380

460

471

2,539

2,343

2,348

2,463

2,605

–340

–1,192

–354

–418

–437

–1,548

131

1,347

1,989

1,930

2,026

1,057

31.

235

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Federal direct loan program ......
680
600
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Federal direct
loan program ....................
Other higher education programs .......................................
Credit liquidating account
(Family education loan program) .......................................
Total, Higher education
Research and general education aids:
Mandatory programs .................

1999

2001

2002

1,395

1,523

1,388

1,285

1,357

–112

199

227

244

261

680

600

1,283

1,722

1,615

1,529

1,618

–88

–79

–82

–78

–76

–76

–73

1,153 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
5,291

652

2,548

3,633

3,469

3,479

2,602

21

17

18

21

22

21

22

97

97

97

97

23

23

24

24

120

120

121

121

Training and employment:
Trade adjustment assistance .....
123
114
119
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Trade adjustment
assistance .........................

2000

123

114

119

Welfare to work jobs (Proposed
PAYGO legislation) ................ ................... ...................
750
1,000
1,250 ................... ...................
Payments to States for AFDC
work programs ........................
1,000
1,000 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Total, Training and employment .......................

1,123

1,114

869

Social services:
Payments to States for foster
care and adoption assistance
4,322
4,445
4,311
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................

1,120

1,370

121

121

4,631

4,986

5,345

5,773

6

12

20

30

Subtotal, Payments to
States for foster care and
adoption assistance .........

4,322

4,445

4,311

4,637

4,998

5,365

5,803

Family support and preservation ...........................................
Social services block grant ........
Rehabilitation services ...............

225
2,381
2,456

240
2,500
2,509

255
2,380
2,583

255
2,380
2,653

255
2,380
2,722

255
2,380
2,794

255
2,380
2,870

236

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Other social services ..................

12

16

20

24

27

31

34

Total, Social services .......

9,396

9,710

9,549

9,949

10,382

10,825

11,342

Total, Mandatory ........................

15,838

11,500

18,244

15,013

15,578

14,826

14,547

Total, Education, training, employment, and social services ..............................................

51,985

53,887

64,669

62,433

64,033

64,285

64,882

1,885
1,984

2,134
2,054

2,156
2,122

2,141
2,132

2,126
2,142

2,111
2,152

2,096
2,162

5,038

5,473

5,424

5,440

5,414

5,387

5,360

8,907

9,661

9,702

9,713

9,682

9,650

9,618

11,928
261

12,741
295

13,078
133

13,132
126

13,186
123

13,240
120

13,294
118

231

307

286

281

277

273

269

12,420

13,343

13,497

13,539

13,586

13,633

13,681

591

591

591

591

591

–390

–390

–390

–390

–390

201

201

201

201

201

568

568

568

568

568

865

850

835

820

805

237

252

267

282

297

550 Health:
Discretionary:
Health care services:
Substance abuse and mental
health services ........................
Indian health ..............................
Other discretionary health care
services programs ...................
Total, Health care services ................................
Health research and training:
National Institutes of Health ....
Clinical training .........................
Other health research and
training ....................................
Total, Health research
and training .................

Consumer and occupational
health and safety:
Food safety and inspection ........
545
574
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Food safety and
inspection .........................

545

574

Occupational safety and health
514
536
Other consumer health programs .......................................
917
931
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other consumer
health programs ..............

917

931

1,102

1,102

1,102

1,102

1,102

Total, Consumer and occupational health and
safety .............................

1,976

2,041

1,871

1,871

1,871

1,871

1,871

Total, Discretionary ...................

23,303

25,045

25,070

25,123

25,139

25,154

25,170

31.

237

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Mandatory:
Health care services:
Medicaid grants ..........................
82,142
101,212
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Medicaid grants

82,142

101,212

Federal employees’ and retired
employees’ health benefits .....
3,727
3,067
Coal miners retirees health benefits ..........................................
351
342
Health initiatives (Proposed
PAYGO legislation) ................ ................... ...................
Other mandatory health services activities ...........................
332
413

1999

2000

2001

2002

99,591

111,203

119,580

129,105

139,171

1,456

412

–1,414

–3,884

–5,783

101,047

111,615

118,166

125,221

133,388

4,318

4,432

4,649

5,015

5,414

336

328

320

314

307

2,610

3,294

3,484

3,721

785

356

312

324

336

347

Total, Health care services ................................

86,552

105,034

108,667

119,981

126,943

134,607

140,241

Health research and safety:
Health research and training ....

14

38

32

29

28

26

22

Total, Mandatory ........................

86,566

105,072

108,699

120,010

126,971

134,633

140,263

Total, Health ................................

109,869

130,117

133,769

145,133

152,110

159,787

165,433

570 Medicare:
Discretionary:
Medicare:
Hospital insurance (HI) administrative expenses ...................
Supplementary medical insurance (SMI) administrative expenses ......................................

1,169

1,114

1,209

1,207

1,194

1,193

1,194

1,770

1,484

1,546

1,544

1,534

1,534

1,534

Total, Medicare ................

2,939

2,598

2,755

2,751

2,728

2,727

2,728

Total, Discretionary ...................

2,939

2,598

2,755

2,751

2,728

2,727

2,728

147,274

159,875

171,833

185,375

200,044

–19,410

–25,470

–33,770

–38,450

–44,320

127,864

134,405

138,063

146,925

155,724

82,463

91,166

100,039

109,691

120,643

14,889

14,578

13,059

13,288

14,047

97,352

105,744

113,098

122,979

134,690

Mandatory:
Medicare:
Hospital insurance (HI) .............
130,931
136,141
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Hospital insurance (HI) ..........................

130,931

136,141

Supplementary medical insurance (SMI) ...............................
67,139
74,931
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Supplementary
medical insurance (SMI)

67,139

74,931

238

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Medicare premiums and collections .........................................
–21,357
–19,600
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

–21,307

–22,416

–23,286

–24,192

–25,181

211

–498

–1,439

–2,658

–4,277

Subtotal, Medicare premiums and collections .....

–21,357

–19,600

–21,096

–22,914

–24,725

–26,850

–29,458

Total, Medicare ................

176,713

191,472

204,120

217,235

226,436

243,054

260,956

Total, Mandatory ........................

176,713

191,472

204,120

217,235

226,436

243,054

260,956

Total, Medicare ...........................

179,652

194,070

206,875

219,986

229,164

245,781

263,684

600 Income security:
Discretionary:
General retirement and disability insurance:
Railroad retirement ...................
Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation ...................................
Pension and Welfare Benefits
Administration and other ......

319

300

284

264

248

233

219

11

10

11

11

11

11

11

68

78

86

86

86

86

86

Total, General retirement
and disability insurance ...............................

398

388

381

361

345

330

316

Federal employee retirement
and disability:
Civilian retirement and disability program administrative
expenses ..................................
Armed forces retirement home

82
56

86
56

82
80

82
73

82
56

82
56

82
56

Total, Federal employee
retirement and disability ..................................

138

142

162

155

138

138

138

Unemployment compensation:
Unemployment programs administrative expenses .............

2,272

2,361

2,650

2,451

2,453

2,456

2,458

2,500

2,520

2,555

2,590

2,626

17,804

21,182

23,308

24,541

25,762

–855

–573

Housing assistance:
Public and Indian housing performance funds ....................... ................... ...................
Subsidized, public, homeless
and other HUD housing .........
15,808
14,610
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

–152 ................... ...................

Subtotal, Subsidized, public, homeless and other
HUD housing ...................

15,808

14,610

16,949

20,609

23,156

24,541

25,762

Rural housing assistance ...........

601

579

664

747

841

843

900

31.

239

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Other housing assistance ..........

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

1 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

Total, Housing assistance

16,410

15,189

20,113

23,876

26,552

27,974

29,288

Food and nutrition assistance:
Special supplemental food program for women, infants, and
children (WIC) ........................
Other nutrition programs ..........

3,694
525

3,830
513

4,108
510

4,140
496

4,248
486

4,358
476

4,472
476

Total, Food and nutrition
assistance .....................

4,219

4,343

4,618

4,636

4,734

4,834

4,948

396

396

396

396

396

1,000

1,000

1,000

1,000

1,000

1,000

1,000

1,000

1,000

1,000

2,232

2,168

2,194

2,194

2,177

40

70

80

80

90

Other income assistance:
Refugee assistance .....................
413
427
Low income home energy assistance ..........................................
1,080
1,005
Child care and development
block grant ..............................
935
19
Supplemental security income
(SSI) administrative expenses
1,887
2,141
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Supplemental security income (SSI) administrative expenses .....

1,887

2,141

2,272

2,238

2,274

2,274

2,267

Total, Other income assistance .........................

4,315

3,592

4,668

4,634

4,670

4,670

4,663

Total, Discretionary ...................

27,752

26,015

32,592

36,113

38,892

40,402

41,811

4,250

4,247

4,294

4,459

4,400

31

46

46

47

47

Mandatory:
General retirement and disability insurance:
Railroad retirement ...................
4,459
4,240
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Railroad retirement ..................................
Special benefits for disabled
coal miners ..............................
Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation ...................................
Special workers’ compensation
expenses ..................................
Total, General retirement
and disability insurance ...............................

4,459

4,240

4,281

4,293

4,340

4,506

4,447

1,210

1,177

1,103

1,068

1,023

976

931

–11

–10

–11

–10

–11

–11

–12

129

150

151

158

168

175

183

5,787

5,557

5,524

5,509

5,520

5,646

5,549

240

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Federal employee retirement
and disability:
Federal civilian employee retirement and disability ...........
40,387
42,081
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Federal civilian
employee retirement and
disability ...........................
Military retirement ....................
Federal employees workers’
compensation (FECA) .............
Federal employees life insurance fund .................................
Total, Federal employee
retirement and disability ..................................

1999

2000

2002

44,117

46,288

48,307

50,369

52,646

–278

–285

–293

–301

–309

40,387

42,081

43,839

46,003

48,014

50,068

52,337

28,991

30,195

31,345

32,485

33,577

34,616

35,644

218

214

202

201

197

194

191

20

28

31

35

38

41

44

69,616

72,518

75,417

78,724

81,826

84,919

88,216

26,999

28,096

29,145

–200

–200

–200

25,734

26,799

27,896

28,945

226

242

244

246

17

24

25

26

Unemployment compensation:
Unemployment insurance programs .......................................
22,469
22,567
24,327
25,734
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Unemployment
insurance programs .........

2001

22,469

22,567

24,327

Trade adjustment assistance .....
223
211
230
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Trade adjustment
assistance .........................

223

211

230

243

266

269

272

Total, Unemployment
compensation ................

22,692

22,778

24,557

25,977

27,065

28,165

29,217

Housing assistance:
Mandatory housing assistance
programs .................................

20

46

46

46

44

44

43

27,624

27,540

28,732

29,518

30,420

31,304

365

845

635

600

405

835

27,661

27,989

28,385

29,367

30,118

30,825

32,139

7,966

8,659

7,770

8,912

9,367

9,836

10,347

Food and nutrition assistance:
Food stamps (including Puerto
Rico) .........................................
27,661
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ...................
Subtotal, Food stamps (including Puerto Rico) ........
State child nutrition programs

31.

241

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Funds for strengthening markets, income, and supply
(Sec.32) ....................................

588

423

461

417

417

417

417

Total, Food and nutrition
assistance .....................

36,215

37,071

36,616

38,696

39,902

41,078

42,903

26,711

23,718

26,437

29,717

26,454

29,722

224

1,703

1,820

2,092

1,904

2,181

26,935

25,421

28,257

31,809

28,358

31,903

6,958

607

1,641

2,839

2,901

3,112

–839

–1,032

–1,097

–1,106

–1,110

–1,208

13,703
1,967

16,836
2,175

17,145
2,270

17,191
2,463

17,212
2,653

16,960
2,791

21,163
32
–1,324

21,983
66
–1,390

22,864
65
–1,452

23,818
68
–1,626

24,634
69
–1,474

25,518
69
–1,648

Other income support:
Supplemental security income
(SSI) .........................................
23,828
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ...................
Subtotal, Supplemental security income (SSI) ..........

23,828

Family support payments ..........
18,014
Federal share of child support
collections ................................ ...................
Temporary assistance for needy
families and related programs
111
Child care entitlement to states ...................
Earned income tax credit
(EITC) ......................................
19,159
Other assistance .........................
37
SSI recoveries and receipts .......
–1,187
Total, Other income support ................................

59,962

68,595

64,666

69,693

75,456

73,243

77,497

Total, Mandatory ........................

194,292

206,565

206,826

218,645

229,813

233,095

243,425

Total, Income security ..............

222,044

232,580

239,418

254,758

268,705

273,497

285,236

1,828

2,069

2,131

2,082

2,031

2,031

2,034

1,307

1,382

1,162

1,164

1,205

1,205

1,207

5

6

10

10

10

10

10

Total, Social security .......

3,140

3,457

3,303

3,256

3,246

3,246

3,251

Total, Discretionary ...................

3,140

3,457

3,303

3,256

3,246

3,246

3,251

305,791

317,816

331,803

345,960

360,951

377,392

393,956

650 Social security:
Discretionary:
Social security:
Old-age and survivors insurance (OASI)administrative
expenses ..................................
Disability insurance (DI) administrative expenses .............
Office of the Inspector General—Social Security Adm. ....

Mandatory:
Social security:
Old-age and survivors insurance (OASI)(Off-budget) .........
Quinquennial OASI and DI adjustments .................................

–332 ................... ................... ................... ...................

–553 ...................

242

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

1999

Disability insurance (DI)(Offbudget) .....................................
43,522
45,997
50,715
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Disability insurance (DI)(Off-budget) ......
Intragovernmental transactions

43,522
15

45,997

50,715

2000

2001

2002

54,433

58,625

63,048

67,731

–5

1

7

13

54,428

58,626

63,055

67,744

10 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

Total, Social security .......

348,996

363,823

382,518

400,388

419,577

439,894

461,700

Total, Mandatory ........................

348,996

363,823

382,518

400,388

419,577

439,894

461,700

Total, Social security .................

352,136

367,280

385,821

403,644

422,823

443,140

464,951

700 Veterans benefits and services:
Discretionary:
Veterans education, training,
and rehabilitation:
Loan fund program account ......

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

17,253

17,253

17,253

17,253

17,253

591

670

749

825

903

17,844

17,923

18,002

18,078

18,156

–591

–670

–749

–825

–903

319

287

287

287

287

Hospital and medical care for
veterans:
Medical care and hospital services ...........................................
16,871
17,336
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Medical care and
hospital services ..............

16,871

17,336

Transfer in of collections for
medical care (Proposed
PAYGO legislation) ................ ................... ...................
Construction of medical facilities ...........................................
373
453
Total, Hospital and medical care for veterans ....

17,244

17,789

17,572

17,540

17,540

17,540

17,540

Veterans housing:
Housing program loan subsidies

118

139

160

156

151

149

150

Other veterans benefits and
services:
Other general operating expenses ......................................

996

981

1,017

1,022

1,023

1,012

1,015

Total, Discretionary 2 ................

18,359

18,910

18,750

18,719

18,715

18,702

18,706

31.

243

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Mandatory:
Income security for veterans:
Compensation .............................
15,415
16,163
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Compensation .....

15,415

16,163

1998

2000

2001

2002

16,438

16,577

16,662

16,746

16,830

331

740

1,162

1,595

2,042

–17

–38

–60

–76

–95

16,752

17,279

17,764

18,265

18,777

3,714

3,765

3,823

3,876

–516

–539

–566

–592

Pensions ......................................
3,074
3,144
3,178
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Pensions ..............

1999

3,074

3,144

3,178

3,198

3,226

3,257

3,284

Burial benefits and miscellaneous assistance .........................
National service life insurance
trust fund ................................
All other insurance programs ...
Insurance program receipts .......

114

117

119

121

124

127

130

1,288
50
–238

1,230
46
–258

1,182
57
–218

1,113
56
–207

1,045
55
–193

987
55
–178

929
54
–163

Total, Income security for
veterans ........................

19,703

20,442

21,070

21,560

22,021

22,513

23,011

1,155

1,377

1,366

1,465

1,469

1,514

1,530

–143

–331

–224

–234

–235

–240

–234

1,012

1,046

1,142

1,231

1,234

1,274

1,296

–468

–308

–355

–404

–452

468

309

356

403

452

1

1

192

396

386

377

374

–29

–234

–229

–228

–223

163

162

157

149

151

Veterans education, training,
and rehabilitation:
Readjustment benefits (GI Bill
and related programs) ............
All-volunteer force educational
assistance trust fund ..............
Total, Veterans education, training, and rehabilitation ...................

Hospital and medical care for
veterans:
Fees, charges and other mandatory medical care ....................
–432
–415
Transfer out of collections for
medical care (Proposed
PAYGO legislation) ................ ................... ...................
Total, Hospital and medical care for veterans ....

–432

–415 ...................

Veterans housing:
Housing loan subsidies ..............
94
–581
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Housing loan subsidies .................................

94

–581

–1 ...................

244

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Other veterans programs:
Other mandatory veterans programs .......................................

27

34

41

41

80

65

32

Total, Mandatory ........................

20,404

20,526

22,416

22,995

23,493

24,000

24,490

Total, Veterans benefits and
services ......................................

38,763

39,436

41,166

41,714

42,208

42,702

43,196

3,634

4,057

4,261

3,861

3,951

4,057

4,150

393

468

552

497

514

525

552

3,198

3,785

4,143

3,536

3,636

3,738

3,857

233

240

246

246

246

246

246

1,121

1,231

1,406

1,351

1,366

1,395

1,429

8,579

9,781

10,608

9,491

9,713

9,961

10,234

2,226

2,382

2,600

2,587

2,654

2,722

2,814

278

283

340

349

359

368

378

2,841

3,046

3,410

3,511

3,609

3,708

3,808

5,345

5,711

6,350

6,447

6,622

6,798

7,000

Correctional activities:
Discretionary programs .............

2,883

3,193

3,249

3,257

3,344

3,433

3,555

Criminal justice assistance:
Discretionary programs .............

3,877

4,134

4,208

5,991

4,703

4,614

4,729

Total, Discretionary ...................

20,684

22,819

24,415

25,186

24,382

24,806

25,518

Mandatory:
Federal law enforcement activities:
Assets forfeiture fund ................
Border enforcement activities
(Customs and INS) .................
Customs and INS fees ...............

304

350

367

362

372

381

391

1,270
–2,161

1,599
–2,261

1,489
–2,319

1,497
–2,390

1,550
–2,476

1,604
–2,542

1,661
–2,622

750 Administration of justice:
Discretionary:
Federal law enforcement activities:
Criminal investigations (DEA,
FBI, FinCEN, ICDE) ..............
Alcohol, tobacco, and firearms
investigations (ATF) ...............
Border enforcement activities
(Customs and INS) .................
Equal Employment Opportunity
Commission .............................
Other law enforcement activities ...........................................
Total, Federal law enforcement activities 3 ...
Federal litigative and judicial
activities:
Civil and criminal prosecution
and representation .................
Representation of indigents in
civil cases ................................
Federal judicial and other
litigative activities ..................
Total, Federal litigative
and judicial activities 3

31.

245

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Other mandatory law enforcement programs ........................

288

294

309

309

312

315

318

Total, Federal law enforcement activities 3 ...

–299

–18

–154

–222

–242

–242

–252

Federal litigative and judicial
activities:
Mandatory programs .................

411

415

403

411

421

430

439

Correctional activities:
Mandatory programs .................

–2

–4

–4

–4

–4

–4

–5

Criminal justice assistance:
Mandatory programs .................

257

559

208

213

218

225

231

Total, Mandatory ........................

367

952

453

398

393

409

413

Total, Administration of justice ..............................................

21,051

23,771

24,868

25,584

24,775

25,215

25,931

800 General government:
Discretionary:
Legislative functions:
Legislative branch discretionary
programs .................................

1,829

1,878

2,068

2,084

2,101

2,113

2,124

89

218

351

351

351

351

351

179

176

195

195

195

195

195

2

8

2

2

2

8

2

Total, Executive direction
and management .........

270

402

548

548

548

554

548

Central fiscal operations:
Tax administration ....................
Other fiscal operations ...............

7,335
527

7,031
583

7,869
700

7,776
698

7,283
702

7,295
705

7,308
709

Total, Central fiscal operations ............................

7,862

7,614

8,569

8,474

7,985

8,000

8,017

Executive direction and management:
Drug control programs ...............
Executive Office of the President ..........................................
Presidential transition and
former Presidents ...................

General property and records
management:
Real property activities ..............
Records management .................
Other general and records management ...................................

68
203

393
214

84 ................... ................... ................... ...................
213
213
213
213
213

151

152

138

137

137

137

137

Total, General property
and records management ..............................

422

759

435

350

350

350

350

246

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Central personnel management:
Discretionary central personnel
management programs ...........

1996
Actual

154

Estimate
1997

1998

150

General purpose fiscal assistance:
Payments and loans to the District of Columbia .....................
712
719
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

1999

2000

2001

2002

148

148

148

148

148

712

712

712

712

712

58

–74

–65

–355

–346

Subtotal, Payments and
loans to the District of
Columbia ..........................

712

719

770

638

647

357

366

Payments to States and counties from Federal land management activities ...................
Payments in lieu of taxes ..........
Other ...........................................

11
114
1

11
114
1

10
102
1

10
102
1

10
102
1

10
102
1

10
102
1

Total, General purpose
fiscal assistance ...........

838

845

883

751

760

470

479

Other general government:
Discretionary programs .............

164

159

158

159

160

161

162

Total, Discretionary ...................

11,539

11,807

12,809

12,514

12,052

11,796

11,828

Mandatory:
Legislative functions:
Congressional members compensation and other ................

96

95

102

94

96

96

95

–162

–164

–167

–169

–170

–15

–10

–5

–5

–5

Central fiscal operations:
Mandatory programs .................
–184
–142
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Mandatory programs ................................

–184

–142

–177

–174

–172

–174

–175

General property and records
management:
Mandatory programs .................
Offsetting receipts ......................

16
–23

18
–21

14
–21

13
–20

11
–18

11
–18

11
–18

Total, General property
and records management ..............................

–7

–3

–7

–7

–7

–7

–7

General purpose fiscal assistance:
Payments and loans to the District of Columbia .....................

–12

–12

–12

–12

–12

–15 ...................

31.

247

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

Payments to States and counties ...........................................
747
810
840
Payments to territories and
Puerto Rico ..............................
110
123
127
Tax revenues for Puerto Rico
(Treasury, BATF) ....................
221
230
230
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................

2000

2001

2002

778

800

821

844

130

134

138

143

230

230

230

230

67

167

286

424

Subtotal, Tax revenues for
Puerto Rico (Treasury,
BATF) ...............................

221

230

230

297

397

516

654

Other general purpose fiscal assistance ....................................

90

92

94

96

98

100

102

Total, General purpose
fiscal assistance ...........

1,156

1,243

1,279

1,289

1,417

1,560

1,743

175
509

268
750

167
635

165
635

167
615

169
615

169
615

66
–63

66
–48

66
–60

66
–60

66
–60

66
–60

66
–60

Total, Other general government ........................

687

1,036

808

806

788

790

790

Deductions for offsetting receipts:
Offsetting receipts ......................

–1,694

–1,184

–1,184

–1,184

–1,184

–1,184

–1,184

Total, Mandatory ........................

54

1,045

821

824

938

1,081

1,262

Total, General government ......

11,593

12,852

13,630

13,338

12,990

12,877

13,090

365,344

370,406

369,987

369,816

367,643

763

2,063

4,300

7,087

9,149

366,107

372,469

374,287

376,903

376,792

Other general government:
Territories ...................................
Treasury claims ..........................
Presidential election campaign
fund ..........................................
Other mandatory programs .......

900 Net interest:
Mandatory:
Interest on the public debt:
Interest on the public debt ........
343,955
356,740
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Interest on the
public debt ........................

343,955

356,740

248

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Interest received by on-budget
trust funds:
Civil service retirement and disability fund ..............................
–28,530
–30,727
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Civil service retirement and disability
fund ..................................

–28,530

–30,727

Military retirement ....................
–11,501
–11,600
Medicare ......................................
–11,777
–11,389
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Medicare ..............

–11,777

–11,389

Other on-budget trust funds .....
–9,061
–9,096
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

–32,012

–32,757

–33,059

–33,493

–34,000

–40

–110

–190

–277

–369

–32,052

–32,867

–33,249

–33,770

–34,369

–11,800
–10,314

–12,000
–8,654

–12,300
–6,405

–12,500
–3,661

–12,700
–1,562

–302

–1,886

–4,004

–6,662

–8,584

–10,616

–10,540

–10,409

–10,323

–10,146

–8,876

–9,193

–9,427

–9,800

–10,175

–402

–16

–29

–42

–57

Subtotal, Other on-budget
trust funds .......................

–9,061

–9,096

–9,278

–9,209

–9,456

–9,842

–10,232

Total, Interest received
by on-budget trust
funds .............................

–60,869

–62,812

–63,746

–64,616

–65,414

–66,435

–67,447

Interest received by off-budget
trust funds:
Interest received by social security trust funds .......................

–36,507

–41,238

–45,199

–49,228

–53,181

–57,272

–61,554

–6,458

–4,351

–3,958

–3,503

–3,121

–2,779

–2,425

2,172

2,644

2,753

2,855

2,991

3,143

3,295

2,328

2,328

2,328

2,328

2,328

2,328

2,328

2,350

2,438

2,452

2,491

2,541

2,601

2,674

–3,031

–4,391

–5,754

–7,045

–8,336

–9,661

–10,976

–757

–736

–750

–750

–750

–750

–750

Other interest:
Interest on loans to Federal Financing Bank ..........................
Interest on refunds of tax collections .........................................
Payment to the Resolution
Funding Corporation ..............
Interest paid to loan guarantee
financing accounts ..................
Interest received from direct
loan financing accounts ..........
Interest on deposits in tax and
loan accounts ...........................
Interest received from Outer
Continental Shelf escrow account, Interior .........................

–1 ...................

–1,142 ................... ................... ................... ...................

31.

249

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

All other interest ........................
–2,091
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ...................
Subtotal, All other interest

Estimate
1997
–3,083

1998
–3,232

1999
–3,158

2000
–3,142

2001
–3,115

2002
–3,175

–157 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

–2,091

–3,240

–3,232

–3,158

–3,142

–3,115

–3,175

Total, Other interest .......

–5,488

–5,308

–7,303

–6,782

–7,489

–8,233

–9,029

Total, Mandatory ........................

241,091

247,382

249,859

251,843

248,203

244,963

238,762

–10,544

–10,566

–10,730

–10,850

–11,078

–6,103

–6,065

–6,280

–6,488

–6,733

–8,535

–8,746

–9,153

–9,640

–10,178

–621

–604

–588

–577

–567

950 Undistributed offsetting receipts:
Mandatory:
Employer share, employee retirement (on-budget):
Contributions to military retirement fund ................................
–11,174
–11,180
Postal Service contributions to
Civil Service Retirement and
Disability Fund .......................
–5,712
–5,916
Other contributions to civil and
foreign service retirement and
disability fund .........................
–7,991
–8,303
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other contributions to civil and foreign
service retirement and
disability fund ..................

–7,991

–8,303

–9,156

–9,350

–9,741

–10,217

–10,745

–2,382

–2,470

–2,625

–2,777

–2,942

–3,072

–3,259

Total, Employer share,
employee retirement
(on-budget) ....................

–27,259

–27,869

–28,428

–28,758

–29,693

–30,627

–31,815

Employer share, employee retirement (off-budget):
Contributions to social security
trust funds ...............................

–6,278

–6,505

–7,028

–7,633

–8,356

–8,942

–9,781

Rents and royalties on the
Outer Continental Shelf:
OCS Receipts ..............................

–3,741

–4,152

–4,375

–4,036

–3,885

–4,050

–4,254

Contributions to HI trust fund

Sale of major assets:
Proceeds from Sale of U.S. Enrichment Corporation ............. ................... ...................
Privatization of Elk Hills ........... ................... ...................

–1,800 ................... ................... ................... ...................
–2,415 ................... ................... ................... ...................

250

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–1.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND
PROGRAM—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Proceeds from sale of Power
Marketing Administrations ... ................... ...................

–85 ................... ................... ................... ...................

Total, Sale of major assets ................................ ................... ...................

–4,300 ................... ................... ................... ...................

Other undistributed offsetting
receipts:
Spectrum Auction .......................
–342
–7,961
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

–9,359

–1,304

–264

–132 ...................

–2,100

–1,800

–3,800

–6,300

–22,100

Subtotal, Spectrum Auction

–342

–7,961

–11,459

–3,104

–4,064

–6,432

–22,100

Total, Mandatory ........................

–37,620

–46,487

–55,590

–43,531

–45,998

–50,051

–67,950

Total ......................................................

1,581,063

1,652,881

1,709,547

1,777,401

1,831,705

1,879,990

1,922,332

On-budget ........................................... (1,274,092) (1,332,287) (1,378,612) (1,437,280) (1,477,932) (1,509,376) (1,535,315)
Off-budget ..........................................
(306,971) (320,594) (330,935) (340,121) (353,773) (370,614) (387,017)
1 Highway, highway safety, and transit programs are funded through mandatory contract authority and subject to obligation limitations that may be lower than the budget authority shown above.
2 Proposed legislation will supplement the budget authority with receipts (estimated at $0.5 billion in 1998).
3 For 1999—2002, Federal law enforcement and Federal litigation and judicial totals do not include Violent Crime Reduction Trust Fund spending. That spending appears under the correctional activities and justice assistance subfunction
pending decisions on specific allocation.

31.

251

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

050 National defense:
Discretionary:
Department of Defense—Military:
Military personnel ......................
66,669
70,053
69,346
Operation and maintenance ......
88,754
92,135
92,574
Procurement ...............................
48,913
45,575
43,142
Research, development, test and
evaluation ................................
36,494
36,034
34,645
Military construction .................
6,683
6,568
5,593
Family housing ...........................
3,828
4,352
3,928
Revolving, management and
trust funds ...............................
2,363
2,612
383
General transfer authority ........ ...................
280
220
DOD-wide savings proposals ..... ...................
–2,282
–1,315
Proposed legislation (nonPAYGO) ................................... ................... ................... ...................
Discretionary offsetting receipts
–100
–102
–102
Total, Department of Defense—Military .............

1999

2000

2001

2002

69,839
91,636
44,647

73,865
91,553
47,616

70,285
93,090
51,641

74,769
91,912
55,399

35,152
5,171
3,881

33,960
4,512
3,885

33,158
4,258
3,922

33,552
3,860
3,880

545
778
700
–998
100 ................... ................... ...................
–815 ................... ................... ...................
81
–92

–168
–92

–39
–92

18
–92

253,604

255,225

248,414

250,145

255,909

256,923

262,300

3,873

4,020

3,660

3,513

3,419

3,370

3,329

Atomic energy defense activities:
Weapons activities .....................
Defense environmental restoration and waste management
Defense nuclear waste disposal
Other atomic energy defense activities ......................................

6,130
151

6,074
182

4,962
195

4,920
233

4,762
232

4,720
190

4,723
190

1,490

1,688

2,100

2,450

2,565

2,520

2,544

Total, Atomic energy defense activities .............

11,644

11,964

10,917

11,116

10,978

10,800

10,786

Defense-related activities:
Discretionary programs .............

708

769

797

840

849

846

822

Total, Discretionary ...................

265,956

267,958

260,128

262,101

267,736

268,569

273,908

Mandatory:
Department of Defense—Military:
Revolving, trust and other DoD
mandatory ...............................
166
116
145
152
151
151
Proceeds from sales from National Defense Stockpile (Proposed PAYGO legislation) ...... ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Offsetting receipts ......................
–583
–1,069
–1,067
–1,029
–901
–901

151

–200
–901

Total, Department of Defense—Military .............

–417

–953

–922

–877

–750

–750

–950

Atomic energy defense activities:
Proceeds from sales of excess
DOE assets ..............................

–5

–25

–15

–15

–15

–15

–15

252

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Defense-related activities:
Mandatory programs .................

214

196

197

210

223

237

251

Total, Mandatory ........................

–208

–782

–740

–682

–542

–528

–714

Total, National defense .............

265,748

267,176

259,388

261,419

267,194

268,041

273,194

2,499

2,308

2,130

2,189

2,232

2,280

2,310

1,751

1,698

1,630

1,318

1,431

1,340

1,418

765
798
638

696
1,094
852

697
880
734

701
892
715

752
913
733

767
936
753

774
960
772

444

497

491

379

313

257

192

302
213

287
239

342
223

365
226

365
233

365
239

365
245

225

313

321

322

314

324

330

Total, International development, humanitarian assistance ..........

7,635

7,984

7,448

7,107

7,286

7,261

7,366

International security assistance:
Foreign military financing
grants and loans .....................
Economic support fund ..............
Other security assistance ..........

3,012
2,237
196

3,252
2,465
203

3,505
2,423
205

3,542
2,475
199

3,486
2,480
191

3,404
2,441
174

3,344
2,467
174

Total, International security assistance ..............

5,445

5,920

6,133

6,216

6,157

6,019

5,985

1,774

1,743

1,725

1,721

1,721

506

566

589

595

595

150 International affairs:
Discretionary:
International development,
humanitarian assistance:
Development assistance and operating expenses .....................
Multilateral development banks
(MDB’s) ....................................
Assistance for the New Independent States ........................
Food aid ......................................
Refugee programs .......................
Assistance for Central and
Eastern Europe .......................
Voluntary contributions to
international organizations ....
Peace Corps ................................
Other development and humanitarian assistance ....................

Conduct of foreign affairs:
State Department operations ....
2,008
2,113
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, State Department
operations .........................
Foreign buildings .......................
Assessed contributions to international organizations ............
Assessed contributions for international peacekeeping ............

2,008

2,113

2,280

2,309

2,314

2,316

2,316

496

435

403

391

368

373

373

903

886

1,021

902

900

925

925

190

514

287

241

240

240

240

31.

253

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

1999

Arrearage payment for international organizations and
peacekeeping ........................... ................... ................... ...................
Other conduct of foreign affairs
156
167
166
Total, Conduct of foreign
affairs ............................

2000

2001

2002

921 ................... ................... ...................
168
170
171
172

3,753

4,115

4,157

4,932

3,992

4,025

4,026

1,177

1,154

1,091

1,079

1,072

1,070

1,070

8

9

8

6

3

Total, Foreign information and exchange activities ...........................

1,185

1,163

1,099

1,085

1,075

1,071

1,070

International financial programs:
Export-Import Bank ...................
Special defense acquisition fund
Other IMF ...................................

436
–137
19

492
–134
26

524
–84
24

526
–22
22

531
12
19

532
4
16

528
1
7

Total, International financial programs .........

318

384

464

526

562

552

536

Total, Discretionary ...................

18,336

19,566

19,301

19,866

19,072

18,928

18,983

–1,476

–1,472

–1,350

–1,253

–1,238

–1,221

–1,192

1

–14

–12

–19

–12

–12

–12

–1,475

–1,486

–1,362

–1,272

–1,250

–1,233

–1,204

–661

–637

–535

–364

–268

–183

–133

–219

–203

–191

–189

–201

–229

–228

–880

–840

–726

–553

–469

–412

–361

8

–55

–4

7

3

3

3

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

Foreign information and exchange activities:
U.S. Information Agency ...........
Other information and exchange activities .....................

Mandatory:
International development,
humanitarian assistance:
Credit liquidating accounts .......
Other development and humanitarian assistance ....................
Total, International development, humanitarian assistance ..........
International security assistance:
Repayment of foreign military
financing loans ........................
Foreign military loan liquidating account ..............................
Total, International security assistance ..............
Foreign affairs and information:
Conduct of foreign affairs ..........
U.S. Information Agency trust
funds ........................................

1 ...................

254

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

Japan-U.S. Friendship Commission ..........................................
1
1
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Japan-U.S.
Friendship Commission
Total, Foreign affairs and
information ...................
International financial programs:
Foreign military sales trust
fund (net) .................................
International monetary fund .....
Exchange stabilization fund ......
Credit liquidating account
(Exim) ......................................
Other international financial
programs .................................

1999

1

2000

2001

2002

1 ................... ................... ...................

37 ................... ................... ................... ...................

1

1

38

1 ................... ................... ...................

10

–53

35

9

4

4

4

–424
–100
–120
30
80
130
120
675 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
–1,643
–1,660
–1,745
–1,715
–1,749
–1,764
–1,820
–1,048

–497

–368

–350

–265

–238

–176

–55

–108

–110

–112

–190

–142

–50

Total, International financial programs .........

–2,495

–2,365

–2,343

–2,147

–2,124

–2,014

–1,926

Total, Mandatory ........................

–4,840

–4,744

–4,396

–3,963

–3,839

–3,655

–3,487

Total, International affairs ......

13,496

14,822

14,905

15,903

15,233

15,273

15,496

2,934

3,176

3,153

3,263

3,299

3,313

3,322

1,054

989

988

1,001

998

996

996

Total, General science
and basic research .......

3,988

4,165

4,141

4,264

4,297

4,309

4,318

Space flight, research, and
supporting activities:
Science, aeronautics and technology .......................................
Human space flight ....................
Mission support ..........................
Other NASA programs ..............

4,199
5,452
2,035
1,007

4,483
5,420
2,039
406

4,574
5,604
2,066
65

4,843
5,246
1,972
66

4,835
5,089
1,905
29

4,902
4,876
1,935
29

4,971
4,733
2,024
19

Total, Space flight, research, and supporting
activities .......................

12,693

12,348

12,309

12,127

11,858

11,742

11,747

Total, Discretionary ...................

16,681

16,513

16,450

16,391

16,155

16,051

16,065

250 General science, space, and
technology:
Discretionary:
General science and basic research:
National Science Foundation
programs .................................
Department of Energy general
science programs ....................

31.

255

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Mandatory:
General science and basic research:
National Science Foundation
donations .................................

28

38

38

31

31

31

31

Total, Mandatory ........................

28

38

38

31

31

31

31

Total, General science, space,
and technology ........................

16,709

16,551

16,488

16,422

16,186

16,082

16,096

3,832

3,467

3,475

3,433

3,395

3,268

3,125

170
439
–350
195
329

154
299
–377
166
269

134
254
–388
186
232

117
224
–398
190
240

69
195
–410
190
237

48
190
–421
190
226

48
190
–435
190
211

124
29

137
18

102
48

81
68

66
72

61
70

55
67

Total, Energy supply .......

4,768

4,133

4,043

3,955

3,814

3,632

3,451

Energy conservation and preparedness:
Energy conservation ...................
Emergency energy preparedness

624
141

565
31

589
226

668
215

690
214

689
214

689
214

765

596

815

883

904

903

903

57

20

18

19

19

19

19

–52

–31

–22

–22

–23

–24

–24

420

248

191

191

189

189

189

Total, Energy information, policy, and regulation ................................

425

237

187

188

185

184

184

Total, Discretionary ...................

5,958

4,966

5,045

5,026

4,903

4,719

4,538

270 Energy:
Discretionary:
Energy supply:
Research and development ........
Naval petroleum reserves operations .......................................
Uranium enrichment activities
Decontamination transfer ..........
Nuclear waste program .............
Federal power marketing ..........
Rural electric and telephone
discretionary loans .................
Financial management services

Total, Energy conservation and preparedness
Energy information, policy,
and regulation:
Nuclear Regulatory Commission
(NRC) .......................................
Federal Energy Regulatory
Commission fees and recoveries, and other ..........................
Departmental and other administration ...................................

256

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

Mandatory:
Energy supply:
Naval petroleum reserves oil
and gas sales ...........................
–419
–444
–175
–20
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Naval petroleum
reserves oil and gas sales

2000

2001

2002

–10

–10

–10

2

2

2

–419

–444

–175

–20

–8

–8

–8

–943
650

–818
–111

–853
–285

–776
–303

–750
–434

–754
–436

–799
–443

–100
–655

–89
–657

–80
–659

–100
–660

–940
–660

Federal power marketing ..........
Tennessee Valley Authority ......
United States Enrichment Corporation ...................................
Nuclear waste fund program .....
Rural electric and telephone liquidating accounts ....................

–1,504

–891

–698

–1,868

–890

–1,061

–863

Total, Energy supply .......

–3,122

–2,913

–2,766

–3,713

–2,821

–3,019

–3,713

–278 ...................
–628
–649

Emergency energy preparedness:
Lease excess SPR capacity (Proposed PAYGO Legislation) ..... ................... ................... ...................
–14
–37
–67
Sale of Weeks Island Oil (Proposed PAYGO Legislation) ..... ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Total, Emergency energy
preparedness ................ ................... ................... ...................

–83
–1,145

–14

–37

–67

–1,228

Total, Mandatory ........................

–3,122

–2,913

–2,766

–3,727

–2,858

–3,086

–4,941

Total, Energy ...............................

2,836

2,053

2,279

1,299

2,045

1,633

–403

3,361
803

3,300
886

3,321
885

3,322
835

3,313
742

186

169

164

164

169

–7

–14

–14

–14

–14

300 Natural resources and environment:
Discretionary:
Water resources:
Corps of Engineers .....................
3,676
3,631
Bureau of Reclamation ..............
769
975
Other discretionary water resources programs ....................
369
358
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other discretionary water resources
programs ..........................

369

358

179

155

150

150

155

Total, Water resources ....

4,814

4,964

4,343

4,341

4,356

4,307

4,210

Conservation and land management:
Forest Service .............................

2,331

2,600

2,379

2,385

2,426

2,471

2,520

31.

257

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

Management of public lands
(BLM) .......................................
915
1,109
1,002
1,016
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Management of
public lands (BLM) ..........

2001

2002

1,037

1,061

1,082

15

36

39

915

1,109

1,002

1,016

1,052

1,097

1,121

Conservation of agricultural
lands ........................................
Other conservation and land
management programs ...........

773

806

739

709

707

704

687

600

596

642

677

687

687

637

Total, Conservation and
land management ........

4,619

5,111

4,762

4,787

4,872

4,959

4,965

2,290

2,295

2,403

2,417

2,444

2,497

2,550

23

34

40

40

40

40

40

2,313

2,329

2,443

2,457

2,484

2,537

2,590

2,273

2,589

2,641

2,703

2,814

2,858

2,898

2,573
1,416

2,500
1,376

2,522
1,551

2,655
1,751

2,821
1,690

2,985
1,551

2,863
1,498

151

126

133

137

139

141

141

6,413

6,591

6,847

7,246

7,464

7,535

7,400

2,027

1,936

2,042

2,106

2,177

2,075

2,086

761

797

752

760

760

758

758

Total, Other natural resources ..........................

2,788

2,733

2,794

2,866

2,937

2,833

2,844

Total, Discretionary ...................

20,947

21,728

21,189

21,697

22,113

22,171

22,009

Mandatory:
Water resources:
Mandatory water resource programs .......................................

–197

44

–147

–44

–81

–74

–98

Recreational resources:
Operation of recreational resources .....................................
Other recreational resources activities ......................................
Total, Recreational resources ..........................
Pollution control and abatement:
Regulatory, enforcement, and
research programs ..................
State and tribal assistance
grants .......................................
Hazardous substance superfund
Other control and abatement
activities ..................................
Total, Pollution control
and abatement .............
Other natural resources:
NOAA ..........................................
Other natural resource program
activities ..................................

258

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Conservation and land management:
Conservation Reserve Program
1,739
2,010
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Conservation Reserve Program ..................

1,739

2,010

Other conservation programs ....
894
810
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other conservation programs ...................

894

810

Offsetting receipts ......................
–1,856
–2,011
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

2,219

2,182

2,268

2,270

2,261

–25

–25

–25

–25

–25

2,194

2,157

2,243

2,245

2,236

734

552

535

533

533

16

–1

5

4

3

750

551

540

537

536

–2,079

–2,115

–2,129

–2,156

–2,200

–35

–77

–98

–70

–70

Subtotal, Offsetting receipts

–1,856

–2,011

–2,114

–2,192

–2,227

–2,226

–2,270

Total, Conservation and
land management ........

777

809

830

516

556

556

502

735

742

696

711

730

16

16

74

76

84

751

758

770

787

814

–308

–317

–236

–236

–240

–1

–1

–78

–80

–88

Recreational resources:
Operation of recreational resources .....................................
599
711
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Operation of recreational resources ..........

599

711

Offsetting receipts ......................
–239
–294
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Offsetting receipts

–239

–294

–309

–318

–314

–316

–328

Total, Recreational resources ..........................

360

417

442

440

456

471

486

–124

–100

–100

–101

–101

142

162

184

192

200

18

62

84

91

99

Pollution control and abatement:
Superfund resources and other
mandatory ...............................
–233
–143
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Superfund resources and other mandatory ...................................

–233

–143

31.

259

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Other natural resources:
Other fees and mandatory programs .......................................

–40

–82

–18

–37

–42

–40

–42

Total, Mandatory ........................

667

1,045

1,125

937

973

1,004

947

Total, Natural resources and
environment .............................

21,614

22,773

22,314

22,634

23,086

23,175

22,956

321

318

318

318

318

118
926

93
959

90
889

90
858

90
857

–34

–52

–58

–70

–83

350 Agriculture:
Discretionary:
Farm income stabilization:
Agriculture credit insurance
loan subsidies ..........................
409
370
P.L.480 market development activities ......................................
286
162
Administrative expenses ............
756
842
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Administrative
expenses ...........................

756

842

892

907

831

788

774

Total, Farm income stabilization .......................

1,451

1,374

1,331

1,318

1,239

1,196

1,182

1,262
420
45

1,267
418
52

1,255
418
51

1,240
418
51

1,220
418
51

444

443

431

431

431

–10

–10

–10

–10

–10

434

433

421

421

421

172
26

163
26

157
26

148
26

154
26

–16

–19

–19

–19

–19

Agricultural research and
services:
Research programs .....................
1,175
1,255
Extension programs ...................
403
419
Marketing programs ..................
42
40
Animal and plant inspection
programs .................................
481
429
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Animal and plant
inspection programs ........

481

429

Economic intelligence .................
128
150
Grain inspection user fees .........
22
23
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Grain inspection
user fees ...........................

22

23

10

7

7

7

7

Other programs and
unallocated overhead ..............

434

430

469

464

465

461

461

Total, Agricultural research and services ......

2,685

2,746

2,812

2,804

2,774

2,746

2,732

Total, Discretionary ...................

4,136

4,120

4,143

4,122

4,013

3,942

3,914

260

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

Mandatory:
Farm income stabilization:
Commodity Credit Corporation
4,634
5,836
Crop insurance and other farm
credit activities .......................
1,573
1,589
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

1999

2000

2001

2002

7,739

7,278

6,774

5,573

5,299

1,528

1,472

1,455

1,520

1,605

4

23

23

25

25

Subtotal, Crop insurance
and other farm credit activities ...............................

1,573

1,589

1,532

1,495

1,478

1,545

1,630

Credit liquidating accounts
(ACIF and FAC) ......................

–1,181

–1,325

–1,155

–1,213

–1,164

–1,113

–1,117

Total, Farm income stabilization .......................

5,026

6,100

8,116

7,560

7,088

6,005

5,812

–15

–12

Agricultural research and
services:
Fund for Rural America (Proposed PAYGO legislation) ...... ................... ...................
Miscellaneous mandatory programs .......................................
145
168
Offsetting receipts ......................
–148
–136

13

20 ...................

206
–137

205
–137

228
–137

226
–137

216
–137

Total, Agricultural research and services ......

–3

32

82

88

91

74

67

Total, Mandatory ........................

5,023

6,132

8,198

7,648

7,179

6,079

5,879

Total, Agriculture .......................

9,159

10,252

12,341

11,770

11,192

10,021

9,793

370 Commerce and housing credit:
Discretionary:
Mortgage credit:
Federal Housing Administration (FHA) Loan Subsidies ....
Other Housing and Urban Development ................................
Rural housing insurance fund ...

398

–242

274

238

241

222

213

1
671

2
626

3
609

3
584

3
579

3
579

3
578

Total, Mortgage credit .....

1,070

386

886

825

823

804

794

Postal service:
Payments to the Postal Service
fund (On-budget) ....................

85

85

86

85

87

88

88

Deposit insurance:
FSLIC Resolution Fund (transfer of balances) ........................
Other discretionary ....................
Total, Deposit insurance

4 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
7
1 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
11

1 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

31.

261

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Other advancement of commerce:
Small and minority business assistance ....................................
Science and technology ..............
Economic and demographic statistics .......................................
Regulatory agencies ...................
International Trade Administration ......................................
Other discretionary ....................

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

505
595

541
708

558
680

553
703

553
741

553
776

553
818

306
178

371
173

644
152

1,063
154

2,701
149

578
150

447
150

246
151

261
84

267
90

274
98

272
78

272
61

272
64

Total, Other advancement of commerce ........

1,981

2,138

2,391

2,845

4,494

2,390

2,304

Total, Discretionary ...................

3,147

2,610

3,363

3,755

5,404

3,282

3,186

–1,315

–1,637

–1,712

–1,793

–1,953

–52

–97

–137

–180

–228

–370

–446

–404

–397

–395

–1,737

–2,180

–2,253

–2,370

–2,576

Mandatory:
Mortgage credit:
FHA and GNMA negative subsidies ........................................
–1,012 ...................
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, FHA and GNMA
negative subsidies ...........

–1,012 ...................

FHA Multifamily portfolio reengineering (Proposed
PAYGO Legislation) ............... ................... ...................
FHA Multifamily portfolio reengineering (Proposed nonPAYGO Legislation) ............... ................... ...................
Mortgage credit liquidating accounts ......................................
–4,824
–3,624
Other mortgage credit activities
13
18
Total, Mortgage credit .....

–5,823

–3,606

Postal service:
Payments to the Postal Service
fund for nonfunded liabilities
(On-budget) .............................
37
36
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Payments to the
Postal Service fund for
nonfunded liabilities (Onbudget) ..............................

37

–665 ................... ................... ................... ...................

523
–629
5

899

864

–888

–1,069

–1,153
–1,367
–1,537
–1,475
2 ................... ................... ...................

–2,503

–2,432

–2,756

–4,795

–5,120

35

33

32

30

29

–35

–33

–32

–30

–29

36 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

262

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Postal Service (Off-budget) ........
–626
1,976
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

1999

4,059
35

2000

844

2001

–171

–1,760

2002
–1,343

8 ................... ................... ...................

Subtotal, Postal Service
(Off-budget) ......................

–626

1,976

4,094

852

–171

–1,760

–1,343

Total, Postal service ........

–589

2,012

4,094

852

–171

–1,760

–1,343

Deposit insurance:
Resolution Trust Corporation
Fund ........................................
–2,428 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Bank Insurance Fund ................
–1,089
–3,528
–1,100
156
–293
–834
–864
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
–81
–87
168 ................... ...................
Subtotal, Bank Insurance
Fund .................................
FSLIC Resolution Fund .............
Savings Association Insurance
Fund ........................................
National Credit Union Administration ......................................
Other deposit insurance activities ...........................................
Total, Deposit insurance

–1,089

–3,528

–1,181

69

–125

–834

–864

–3,610

–3,834

–2,241

–1,834

–902

–906

–543

–1,060

–4,535

–406

–65

56

354

124

–179

–169

–172

–168

–168

–168

–168

–39
–8,405

9 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
–12,057

–4,000

–1,998

–1,139

–1,554

–1,451

Other advancement of commerce:
Universal Service Fund .............
957
1,400
2,240
6,350
11,325
12,194
12,838
Payments to copyright owners
5
180
278
220
220
220
220
Spectrum auction subsidy .........
1
838
388 ................... ................... ................... ...................
Regulatory fees ...........................
–41
–38
–38
–38
–38
–38
–38
Patent and trademark fees ........
–111
–115
–119 ................... ................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................
–119
–119
–119
–119
Subtotal, Patent and trademark fees ..........................

–111

–115

Credit liquidating accounts .......
–85
–82
Other mandatory ........................
298
50
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other mandatory

–119

–119

–119

–119

–119

–259
–16

–180
–18

–90
33

–88
34

–85
36

–69

–69

–69

–69

–69

298

50

–85

–87

–36

–35

–33

Total, Other advancement of commerce ........

1,024

2,233

2,405

6,146

11,262

12,134

12,783

Total, Mandatory ........................

–13,793

–11,418

–4

2,568

7,196

4,025

4,869

Total, Commerce and housing
credit ..........................................

–10,646

–8,808

3,359

6,323

12,600

7,307

8,055

31.

263

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

400 Transportation:
Discretionary:
Ground transportation:
Highways ....................................
17,838
17,830
State infrastructure banks ........ ...................
22
Highway safety ...........................
348
400
Mass transit ................................
4,372
4,464
Railroads .....................................
1,012
917
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Railroads .............

1,012

917

Regulation ...................................

21

16

Total, Ground transportation .............................

23,591

23,649

Air transportation:
Airports and airways (FAA) ......
8,926
8,554
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

1999

2000

2001

2002

18,265
109
420
3,879
1,029

18,206
84
445
3,929
1,090

18,214
97
433
4,062
902

18,107
124
434
4,240
900

18,094
154
434
4,395
899

–60

–60

–60

–60

–60

969

1,030

842

840

839

1 ................... ................... ................... ...................

23,643

23,694

23,648

23,745

23,916

8,500

3,070

1,289

631

389

66

1,422

1,884

2,088

2,215

198

4,263

5,653

6,263

6,645

8,755

8,826

8,982

9,249

Subtotal, Airports and airways (FAA) .......................

8,926

8,554

8,764

Aeronautical research and technology .......................................
Payments to air carriers ............

1,187
22

1,348
27

1,285
1,326
1,391
1,419
1,466
10 ................... ................... ................... ...................

10,135

9,929

10,059

10,081

10,217

Water transportation:
Marine safety and transportation .......................................
Ocean shipping ...........................
Panama Canal Commission ......

2,734
297
–34

2,611
294
–26

2,747
192
–32

2,824
203
–1

2,838
184
39

2,855
2,863
131
133
19 ...................

Total, Water transportation .............................

2,997

2,879

2,907

3,026

3,061

3,005

2,996

228

225

228

228

228

1

1

1

1

1

5

6

5

5

5

Total, Air transportation

Other transportation:
Other discretionary programs ...
341
355
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

10,401

10,715

Subtotal, Other discretionary programs .............

341

355

234

232

234

234

234

Total, Discretionary ...................

37,064

36,812

36,843

37,033

37,160

37,385

37,861

264

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

Mandatory:
Ground transportation:
Highways ....................................
2,082
1,967
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Highways .............

2,082

1,967

1999

2000

2001

2002

1,834

1,586

1,386

1,227

1,115

15

56

35

–22

–82

1,849

1,642

1,421

1,205

1,033

Mass transit ................................
Offsetting receipts and liquidating accounts ............................

1 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
–24

–25

–35

–26

–30

–30

–30

Total, Ground transportation .............................

2,059

1,942

1,814

1,616

1,391

1,175

1,003

50
30

50
50

50
50

50
50

50
50

80

100

100

100

100

635

671

705

741

776

–102

29

22

25

25

20

–34

–29

–29

–29

Air transportation:
Airports and airways (FAA) ...... ................... ...................
Payments to air carriers ............ ................... ...................
Total, Air transportation

................... ...................

Water transportation:
Coast Guard retired pay ............
569
592
Other water transportation programs .......................................
–106
–53
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other water
transportation programs
Total, Water transportation .............................

–106

–53

–82

–5

–7

–4

–4

463

539

553

666

698

737

772

Other transportation:
Sale of Governor’s Island and
Union Station Air Rights
(Proposed PAYGO Legislation) .......................................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Other mandatory transportation
programs .................................
–21
–31
–31
–31
–32
–32

–540
–32

Total, Other transportation .............................

–21

–31

–31

–31

–32

–32

–572

Total, Mandatory ........................

2,501

2,450

2,416

2,351

2,157

1,980

1,303

Total, Transportation ................

39,565

39,262

39,259

39,384

39,317

39,365

39,164

1

23

35

31

30

30

30

4,545

4,837

4,641

4,845

4,633

4,438

4,216

450 Community and regional development:
Discretionary:
Community development:
Community development loan
guarantees ...............................
Community development block
grant ........................................

31.

265

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Community development financial institutions .......................
2
63
Other community development
programs .................................
291
379
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

66

96

130

157

209

329

301

258

251

251

2

36

80

59

17

Subtotal, Other community
development programs ....

291

379

331

337

338

310

268

Total, Community development ..........................

4,839

5,302

5,073

5,309

5,131

4,935

4,723

849

800

815

826

862

410
973

405
1,006

366
1,029

321
1,036

290
1,036

Area and regional development:
Rural development .....................
741
850
Economic Development Administration ...................................
415
466
Indian programs .........................
980
962
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Indian programs

7 ................... ................... ................... ...................

980

962

980

1,006

1,029

Appalachian Regional Commission ...........................................
Tennessee Valley Authority ......

236
107

197
109

188
107

183
70

145
17

Total, Area and regional
development .................

2,479

2,584

2,534

2,464

2,372

2,301

2,288

263
3,323

188
2,999

192
1,453

192
320

192
320

5

25

45

50

50

Disaster relief and insurance:
Small Business Administration
disaster loans ..........................
434
311
Disaster relief .............................
2,232
3,593
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

1,036

1,036

106
100
12 ...................

Subtotal, Disaster relief .....

2,232

3,593

3,328

3,024

1,498

370

370

Other disaster assistance programs .......................................

384

462

344

332

327

327

327

Total, Disaster relief and
insurance ......................

3,050

4,366

3,935

3,544

2,017

889

889

Total, Discretionary ...................

10,368

12,252

11,542

11,317

9,520

8,125

7,900

266

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Mandatory:
Community development:
Pennsylvania Avenue activities
and other programs ................
111
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ...................

Estimate
1997

186

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

85 ................... ................... ................... ...................

157 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

Subtotal, Pennsylvania Avenue activities and other
programs ..........................

111

343

Credit liquidating accounts .......

–90

–34

–43

–41

–38

–37

–35

Total, Community development ..........................

21

309

42

–41

–38

–37

–35

438

438

454

459

459

Area and regional development:
Indian programs .........................
351
500
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Indian programs

351

500

Rural development programs ....
68
428
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

85 ................... ................... ................... ...................

–7 ................... ................... ................... ...................
431

438

454

459

459

13

31

41

38

23

12

20 ...................

–15

–13

Subtotal, Rural development programs ................

68

428

25

51

41

23

10

Credit liquidating accounts .......
Offsetting receipts ......................

128
–359

–286
–258

64
–254

227
–254

207
–258

200
–264

46
–268

Total, Area and regional
development .................

188

384

266

462

444

418

247

Disaster relief and insurance:
National flood insurance fund ...
Credit liquidating accounts .......

310
–202

77
–270

–69
–346

–93
–245

–114
–166

–139
–2

–160
–2

Total, Disaster relief and
insurance ......................

108

–193

–415

–338

–280

–141

–162

Total, Mandatory ........................

317

500

–107

83

126

240

50

Total, Community and regional development ................

10,685

12,752

11,435

11,400

9,646

8,365

7,950

500 Education, training, employment, and social services:
Discretionary:
Elementary, secondary, and
vocational education:
Education reform ........................
School improvement programs

271
1,246

691
1,516

730
1,396

1,249
1,407

1,255
1,353

1,199
1,365

1,036
1,400

31.

267

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Education for the disadvantaged ........................................
Special education ........................
Impact aid ...................................
Vocational and adult education
Indian education programs .......
Bilingual and immigrant education .......................................
Other ...........................................
Total, Elementary, secondary, and vocational
education ......................

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

Federal family education loan
program ...................................
Other higher education programs .......................................
Total, Higher education

2002

7,235
3,426
901
1,589
610

7,476
3,753
701
1,487
601

8,169
4,270
688
1,554
630

8,318
4,289
689
1,602
626

8,481
4,404
710
1,645
628

8,702
4,519
727
1,688
630

185
6

225
13

276
11

341
7

361
7

372
7

381
7

14,864

16,206

16,431

18,315

18,500

18,811

19,090

9,283

8,887

9,009

9,231

150

742

781

809

8,165

9,433

9,629

9,790

10,040

881

901

923

946

968

16

107

137

144

148

6,862

7,599

Higher education account ..........
846
880
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Higher education
account .............................

2001

7,019
3,222
952
1,341
622

Higher education:
Student financial assistance .....
6,862
7,599
8,165
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Student financial
assistance .........................

2000

846

880

897

1,008

1,060

1,090

1,116

41

41

44

48

50

51

53

323

316

328

336

345

354

362

8,072

8,836

9,434

10,825

11,084

11,285

11,571

Research and general education aids:
Library of Congress ....................
Public broadcasting ....................
Smithsonian institution .............
Education research, statistics,
and improvement ....................
Other ...........................................

252
324
431

269
316
469

278
297
470

261
291
495

265
363
488

268
363
485

272
364
474

311
882

412
799

551
764

526
795

522
808

530
834

538
858

Total, Research and general education aids .......

2,200

2,265

2,360

2,368

2,446

2,480

2,506

Training and employment:
Training and employment services ...........................................
Older Americans employment ...

4,296
382

4,718
407

4,737
354

5,094
5,310
5,408
5,491
37 ................... ................... ...................

268

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

1999

2000

Federal-State employment service .............................................
1,241
1,201
1,226
1,222
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
19
38
Subtotal, Federal-State employment service ..............

1,241

1,201

Welfare to work jobs .................. ................... ...................
Other employment and training
81
78
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

2001

2002

1,228

1,205

1,206

–50

–50

–50

38

38

38

1,193

1,194

1,245

1,260

1,216

5
80

6
86

7
85

3 ...................
85
85

6

12

12

12

12

Subtotal, Other employment and training ...........

81

78

86

98

97

97

97

Total, Training and employment .......................

6,000

6,404

6,427

6,495

6,630

6,701

6,782

Other labor services:
Labor law, statistics, and other
administration ........................

925

1,004

1,053

1,052

1,054

1,054

1,053

Social services:
National service initiative .........
Children and families services
programs .................................
Aging services program .............
Other ...........................................

478

504

612

700

795

825

850

4,751
818
12

5,067
851
7

5,392
914
5

5,611
1,249
13

5,840
1,278
5

6,104
1,278
–3

6,397
1,278
–11

Total, Social services .......

6,059

6,429

6,923

7,573

7,918

8,204

8,514

Total, Discretionary ...................

38,120

41,144

42,628

46,628

47,632

48,535

49,516

7

7

7

7

7

–1

–7

–7

–7

–7

Mandatory:
Elementary, secondary, and
vocational education:
Vocational and adult education
7
9
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Vocational and
adult education ................

7

9

School construction (Proposed
PAYGO legislation) ................ ................... ...................
America Reads Challenge (Proposed PAYGO legislation) ...... ................... ...................
Total, Elementary, secondary, and vocational
education ......................

7

9

6 ................... ................... ................... ...................

1,250

1,250

1,250

1,250 ...................

31

212

284

331

380

1,287

1,462

1,534

1,581

380

31.

269

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Higher education:
Federal family education loan
program ...................................
3,007
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ...................
Subtotal, Federal family
education loan program

3,007

Estimate
1997

1998

Other higher education programs .......................................
Credit liquidating account
(Family education loan program) .......................................
Total, Higher education
Research and general education aids:
Mandatory programs .................

Social services:
Payments to States for foster
care and adoption assistance
Family support and preservation ...........................................
Social services block grant ........
Rehabilitation services ...............

2002

2,194

2,130

2,196

2,316

–340

–994

–418

–396

–408

–1,515

–18

1,357

1,776

1,734

1,788

801

1,126

1,353

1,342

1,242

1,262

–56

70

170

199

221

595

412

1,070

1,423

1,512

1,441

1,483

–98

–82

–86

–80

–80

–79

–78

615

6

–414

–541

–558

–595

–583

4,119

318

1,927

2,578

2,608

2,555

1,623

15

18

18

20

20

19

20

108

101

97

97

9

19

23

24

110

117

120

120

121

600

975

1,000

400

25

99

107

Welfare to work jobs (Proposed
PAYGO legislation) ................ ................... ...................
Payments to States for AFDC
work programs ........................
931
324
Total, Training and employment .......................

2001

2,351

Training and employment:
Trade adjustment assistance .....
99
107
110
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Trade adjustment
assistance .........................

2000

322

Federal direct loan program ......
595
412
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Federal direct
loan program ....................

1999

89

10 ................... ................... ...................

1,030

431

799

1,102

1,120

520

146

3,691

3,789

4,071

4,391

4,766

5,162

5,583

126
2,484
2,411

186
2,694
2,702

227
2,621
2,626

247
2,611
2,653

253
2,607
2,703

255
2,453
2,775

255
2,380
2,850

270

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Other social services ..................

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

–2 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

Total, Social services .......

8,710

9,371

9,545

9,902

10,329

10,645

11,068

Total, Mandatory ........................

13,881

10,147

13,576

15,064

15,611

15,320

13,237

Total, Education, training, employment, and social services ..............................................

52,001

51,291

56,204

61,692

63,243

63,855

62,753

2,084
2,027

1,880
2,117

2,064
2,091

2,140
2,122

2,134
2,136

2,120
2,147

2,105
2,159

5,722

5,305

5,348

5,452

5,441

5,412

5,384

9,833

9,302

9,503

9,714

9,711

9,679

9,648

10,212
291

12,146
288

12,786
228

13,076
144

13,169
132

13,205
122

13,252
120

306

247

284

295

283

278

274

10,809

12,681

13,298

13,515

13,584

13,605

13,646

591

591

591

591

591

–390

–390

–390

–390

–390

201

201

201

201

201

564

567

568

568

568

897

856

840

824

809

237

252

267

282

297

550 Health:
Discretionary:
Health care services:
Substance abuse and mental
health services ........................
Indian health ..............................
Other discretionary health care
services programs ...................
Total, Health care services ................................
Health research and training:
National Institutes of Health ....
Clinical training .........................
Other health research and
training ....................................
Total, Health research
and training .................

Consumer and occupational
health and safety:
Food safety and inspection ........
533
572
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Food safety and
inspection .........................

533

572

Occupational safety and health
489
534
Other consumer health programs .......................................
908
961
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other consumer
health programs ..............

908

961

1,134

1,108

1,107

1,106

1,106

Total, Consumer and occupational health and
safety .............................

1,930

2,067

1,899

1,876

1,876

1,875

1,875

Total, Discretionary ...................

22,572

24,050

24,700

25,105

25,171

25,159

25,169

31.

271

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Mandatory:
Health care services:
Medicaid grants ..........................
91,990
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ...................
Subtotal, Medicaid grants

91,990

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

98,503

104,456

111,203

119,580

129,105

139,171

39

1,417

412

–1,414

–3,884

–5,783

98,542

105,873

111,615

118,166

125,221

133,388

4,415

4,440

4,520

4,845

5,284

336

328

320

314

307

2,523

3,257

3,473

3,709

785

362

322

317

332

324

Federal employees’ and retired
employees’ health benefits .....
4,135
4,300
Coal miners retirees health benefits ..........................................
351
342
Health initiatives (Proposed
PAYGO legislation) ................ ................... ...................
Other mandatory health services activities ...........................
313
336
Total, Health care services ................................
Health research and safety:
Health research and training ....
Consumer and occupational
health and safety ....................

96,789

103,520

113,509

119,962

126,796

134,421

140,088

18

60

32

28

27

25

21

–1 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

Total, Health research
and safety .....................

17

60

32

28

27

25

21

Total, Mandatory ........................

96,806

103,580

113,541

119,990

126,823

134,446

140,109

Total, Health ................................

119,378

127,630

138,241

145,095

151,994

159,605

165,278

570 Medicare:
Discretionary:
Medicare:
Hospital insurance (HI) administrative expenses ...................
Supplementary medical insurance (SMI) administrative expenses ......................................

1,188

1,154

1,213

1,202

1,194

1,194

1,201

1,765

1,546

1,540

1,529

1,517

1,518

1,521

Total, Medicare ................

2,953

2,700

2,753

2,731

2,711

2,712

2,722

Total, Discretionary ...................

2,953

2,700

2,753

2,731

2,711

2,712

2,722

147,473

159,482

171,999

185,579

199,625

–19,410

–25,470

–33,770

–38,450

–44,320

128,063

134,012

138,229

147,129

155,305

Mandatory:
Medicare:
Hospital insurance (HI) .............
126,495
136,317
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Hospital insurance (HI) ..........................

126,495

136,317

272

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Supplementary medical insurance (SMI) ...............................
67,181
74,941
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Supplementary
medical insurance (SMI)

67,181

74,941

Medicare premiums and collections .........................................
–22,404
–19,702
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

1999

2000

2001

2002

82,475

91,145

100,047

109,702

120,621

14,889

14,578

13,059

13,288

14,047

97,364

105,723

113,106

122,990

134,668

–21,307

–22,416

–23,286

–24,192

–25,181

211

–498

–1,439

–2,658

–4,277

Subtotal, Medicare premiums and collections .....

–22,404

–19,702

–21,096

–22,914

–24,725

–26,850

–29,458

Total, Medicare ................

171,272

191,556

204,331

216,821

226,610

243,269

260,515

Total, Mandatory ........................

171,272

191,556

204,331

216,821

226,610

243,269

260,515

Total, Medicare ...........................

174,225

194,256

207,084

219,552

229,321

245,981

263,237

600 Income security:
Discretionary:
General retirement and disability insurance:
Railroad retirement ...................
Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation ...................................
Pension and Welfare Benefits
Administration and other ......

312

300

284

264

248

233

219

11

10

11

11

11

11

11

64

82

85

86

86

86

86

Total, General retirement
and disability insurance ...............................

387

392

380

361

345

330

316

Federal employee retirement
and disability:
Civilian retirement and disability program administrative
expenses ..................................
Armed forces retirement home

81
56

92
61

90
65

82
71

82
72

82
58

82
56

Total, Federal employee
retirement and disability ..................................

137

153

155

153

154

140

138

Unemployment compensation:
Unemployment programs administrative expenses .............

2,315

2,361

2,570

2,531

2,453

2,456

2,458

13

323

961

1,549

2,046

Housing assistance:
Public and Indian housing performance funds ....................... ................... ...................

31.

273

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Subsidized, public, homeless
and other HUD housing .........
26,094
28,338
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

29,041

29,271

28,862

27,935

27,235

–375

–814

–1,213

–838

–571

28,666

28,457

27,649

27,097

26,664

Subtotal, Subsidized, public, homeless and other
HUD housing ...................

26,094

Rural housing assistance ...........
Other housing assistance ..........

565
1

Total, Housing assistance

26,660

28,946

29,308

29,436

29,312

29,390

29,494

Food and nutrition assistance:
Special supplemental food program for women, infants, and
children (WIC) ........................
Other nutrition programs ..........

3,678
508

3,860
548

3,997
509

4,130
497

4,240
487

4,350
477

4,464
476

Total, Food and nutrition
assistance .....................

4,186

4,408

4,506

4,627

4,727

4,827

4,940

405

399

398

397

396

996

1,000

1,000

1,000

1,000

998

998

1,000

1,000

1,000

2,213

2,185

2,196

2,194

2,178

37

67

79

80

89

28,338

607
629
656
702
744
784
1 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

Other income assistance:
Refugee assistance .....................
361
429
Low income home energy assistance ..........................................
1,067
1,097
Child care and development
block grant ..............................
933
959
Supplemental security income
(SSI) administrative expenses
1,949
2,133
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Supplemental security income (SSI) administrative expenses .....

1,949

2,133

2,250

2,252

2,275

2,274

2,267

Total, Other income assistance .........................

4,310

4,618

4,649

4,649

4,673

4,671

4,663

Total, Discretionary ...................

37,995

40,878

41,568

41,757

41,664

41,814

42,009

4,245

4,246

4,375

4,546

4,485

31

46

46

47

47

Mandatory:
General retirement and disability insurance:
Railroad retirement ...................
4,365
4,235
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Railroad retirement ..................................

4,365

4,235

4,276

4,292

4,421

4,593

4,532

Special benefits for disabled
coal miners ..............................

1,216

1,181

1,116

1,072

1,026

980

934

274

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation ...................................
Special workers’ compensation
expenses ..................................
Total, General retirement
and disability insurance ...............................

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1999

2000

2001

2002

–862

–1,320

–1,296

–1,284

–1,053

–1,041

–1,066

128

143

144

150

159

166

174

4,847

4,239

4,240

4,230

4,553

4,698

4,574

43,922

45,969

47,993

50,039

52,293

–278

–285

–293

–301

–309

Federal employee retirement
and disability:
Federal civilian employee retirement and disability ...........
40,141
41,889
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Federal civilian
employee retirement and
disability ...........................

1998

40,141

41,889

43,644

45,684

47,700

49,738

51,984

28,831

30,105

31,251

32,389

33,477

34,512

35,537

Military retirement ....................
Federal employees workers’
compensation (FECA) .............
Federal employees life insurance fund .................................

61

118

134

154

220

192

264

–1,077

–1,051

–1,200

–1,134

–1,116

–1,105

–1,087

Total, Federal employee
retirement and disability ..................................

67,956

71,061

73,829

77,093

80,281

83,337

86,698

26,999

28,096

29,145

–200

–200

–200

25,734

26,799

27,896

28,945

226

242

244

246

17

24

25

26

Unemployment compensation:
Unemployment insurance programs .......................................
22,393
22,556
24,327
25,734
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Unemployment
insurance programs .........

22,393

22,556

24,327

Trade adjustment assistance .....
190
200
230
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Trade adjustment
assistance .........................

190

200

230

243

266

269

272

Total, Unemployment
compensation ................

22,583

22,756

24,557

25,977

27,065

28,165

29,217

Housing assistance:
Mandatory housing assistance
programs .................................

94

100

93

–4

–6

–6

–7

31.

275

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Food and nutrition assistance:
Food stamps (including Puerto
Rico) .........................................
25,422
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ...................
Subtotal, Food stamps (including Puerto Rico) ........

25,422

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

24,500

25,034

26,147

27,017

27,919

28,802

362

836

659

600

405

835

24,862

25,870

26,806

27,617

28,324

29,637

8,485

8,854

9,304

9,770

10,275

416

417

417

417

417

–10

–11

–11

–11

–11

State child nutrition programs
7,875
8,258
Funds for strengthening markets, income, and supply
(Sec.32) ....................................
450
467
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Funds for
strengthening markets,
income, and supply
(Sec.32) .............................

450

467

406

406

406

406

406

Total, Food and nutrition
assistance .....................

33,747

33,587

34,761

36,066

37,327

38,500

40,318

26,563

25,500

26,793

29,717

26,454

29,722

224

1,703

1,820

2,092

1,904

2,181

24,125

26,787

27,203

28,613

31,809

28,358

31,903

16,670

6,426

3,024

2,708

2,815

2,899

3,090

...................

–839

–1,032

–1,097

–1,106

–1,110

–1,208

...................
...................

12,388
1,592

16,682
1,922

17,500
2,088

17,266
2,227

17,232
2,212

16,997
2,442

19,159
...................
–1,187

21,163
41
–1,324

21,983
59
–1,390

22,864
54
–1,452

23,818
67
–1,626

24,634
68
–1,474

25,518
69
–1,648

Other income support:
Supplemental security income
(SSI) .........................................
24,125
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ...................
Subtotal, Supplemental security income (SSI) ..........
Family support payments ..........
Federal share of child support
collections ................................
Temporary assistance for needy
families and related programs
Child care entitlement to states
Earned income tax credit
(EITC) ......................................
Other assistance .........................
SSI recoveries and receipts .......
Total, Other income support ................................

58,767

66,234

68,451

71,278

75,270

72,819

77,163

Total, Mandatory ........................

187,994

197,977

205,931

214,640

224,490

227,513

237,963

Total, Income security ..............

225,989

238,855

247,499

256,397

266,154

269,327

279,972

276

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

650 Social security:
Discretionary:
Social security:
Old-age and survivors insurance (OASI)administrative
expenses ..................................
Disability insurance (DI) administrative expenses .............
Office of the Inspector General—Social Security Adm. ....

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

1,588

2,114

2,157

2,167

2,091

2,031

2,034

1,033

1,360

1,236

1,195

1,217

1,205

1,207

4

7

10

10

17

17

17

Total, Social security .......

2,625

3,481

3,403

3,372

3,325

3,253

3,258

Total, Discretionary ...................

2,625

3,481

3,403

3,372

3,325

3,253

3,258

375,844

392,349

Mandatory:
Social security:
Old-age and survivors insurance (OASI)(Off-budget) .........
303,864
317,376
330,517
344,515
359,469
Quinquennial OASI and DI adjustments .................................
–332 ................... ................... ................... ...................
Disability insurance (DI)(Offbudget) .....................................
43,517
46,846
50,418
54,107
58,266
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ................... ...................
–5
1
Subtotal, Disability insurance (DI)(Off-budget) ......
Intragovernmental transactions

43,517
2

46,846

50,418

54,102

58,267

–553 ...................
62,672

67,337

7

13

62,679

67,350

10 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

Total, Social security .......

347,051

364,232

380,935

398,617

417,736

437,970

459,699

Total, Mandatory ........................

347,051

364,232

380,935

398,617

417,736

437,970

459,699

Total, Social security .................

349,676

367,713

384,338

401,989

421,061

441,223

462,957

700 Veterans benefits and services:
Discretionary:
Veterans education, training,
and rehabilitation:
Loan fund program account ......

2

2

2

1

1

1

1

17,004

17,217

17,255

17,253

17,253

591

670

749

825

903

17,595

17,887

18,004

18,078

18,156

Hospital and medical care for
veterans:
Medical care and hospital services ...........................................
16,343
17,356
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Medical care and
hospital services ..............

16,343

17,356

31.

277

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

Transfer in of collections for
medical care (Proposed
PAYGO legislation) ................ ................... ...................
Construction of medical facilities ...........................................
696
547

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

–591

–670

–749

–825

–903

470

399

344

308

292

Total, Hospital and medical care for veterans ....

17,039

17,903

17,474

17,616

17,599

17,561

17,545

Veterans housing:
Housing program loan subsidies

118

139

160

156

151

149

150

Other veterans benefits and
services:
Other general operating expenses ......................................

1,006

1,027

1,007

1,018

1,020

1,013

1,014

Total, Discretionary ...................

18,165

19,071

18,643

18,791

18,771

18,724

18,710

16,436

16,566

17,899

15,439

16,816

298

773

1,162

1,524

2,005

–17

–38

–60

–76

–95

16,717

17,301

19,001

16,887

18,726

3,706

4,020

3,515

3,866

–516

–539

–566

–592

Mandatory:
Income security for veterans:
Compensation .............................
14,220
16,160
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Compensation .....

14,220

16,160

Pensions ......................................
2,834
3,140
3,177
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Pensions ..............

2,834

3,140

3,177

3,190

3,481

2,949

3,274

Burial benefits and miscellaneous assistance .........................
National service life insurance
trust fund ................................
All other insurance programs ...
Insurance program receipts .......

114

117

119

121

124

127

130

1,240
31
–238

1,323
58
–258

1,304
65
–218

1,319
63
–207

1,322
–15
–193

1,308
–11
–178

1,293
–9
–163

Total, Income security for
veterans ........................

18,201

20,540

21,164

21,787

23,720

21,082

23,251

1,213
27

1,342
80

1,409
33

1,462
21

1,469
16

1,512
10

1,529
9

–128

–345

–224

–234

–235

–240

–234

1,112

1,077

1,218

1,249

1,250

1,282

1,304

Veterans education, training,
and rehabilitation:
Readjustment benefits (GI Bill
and related programs) ............
Post-Vietnam era education ......
All-volunteer force educational
assistance trust fund ..............
Total, Veterans education, training, and rehabilitation ...................

278

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

Hospital and medical care for
veterans:
Fees, charges and other mandatory medical care ....................
–453
–416
Transfer out of collections for
medical care (Proposed
PAYGO legislation) ................ ................... ...................
Total, Hospital and medical care for veterans ....

–453

–416

Veterans housing:
Housing loan subsidies ..............
94
–581
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................
Subtotal, Housing loan subsidies .................................

94

–581

Housing loan liquidating account ........................................
–146
–75
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

1999

2000

2001

2002

–470

–311

–360

–408

–456

468

309

356

403

452

–2

–2

–4

–5

–4

192

396

386

377

374

–29

–234

–229

–228

–223

163

162

157

149

151

–126

–90

–67

–49

–32

–127 ................... ................... ................... ...................

Subtotal, Housing loan liquidating account ..............

–146

–75

–253

–90

–67

–49

–32

Total, Veterans housing

–52

–656

–90

72

90

100

119

Other veterans programs:
Other mandatory veterans programs .......................................

12

34

38

38

77

61

28

Total, Mandatory ........................

18,820

20,579

22,328

23,144

25,133

22,520

24,698

Total, Veterans benefits and
services ......................................

36,985

39,650

40,971

41,935

43,904

41,244

43,408

3,263

3,503

3,887

3,952

4,019

4,031

4,126

396

456

504

523

539

526

548

2,869

3,729

3,892

3,673

3,681

3,713

3,829

225

256

245

246

246

246

246

1,044

1,149

1,336

1,350

1,347

1,369

1,400

7,797

9,093

9,864

9,744

9,832

9,885

10,149

750 Administration of justice:
Discretionary:
Federal law enforcement activities:
Criminal investigations (DEA,
FBI, FinCEN, ICDE) ..............
Alcohol, tobacco, and firearms
investigations (ATF) ...............
Border enforcement activities
(Customs and INS) .................
Equal Employment Opportunity
Commission .............................
Other law enforcement activities ...........................................
Total, Federal law enforcement activities 1 ...

31.

279

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Federal litigative and judicial
activities:
Civil and criminal prosecution
and representation .................
Representation of indigents in
civil cases ................................
Federal judicial and other
litigative activities ..................

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

2,222

2,292

2,524

2,596

2,648

2,708

2,796

282

257

330

347

357

366

376

2,927

3,123

3,322

3,505

3,604

3,703

3,803

5,431

5,672

6,176

6,448

6,609

6,777

6,975

Correctional activities:
Discretionary programs .............

3,082

3,151

3,318

3,727

3,677

3,615

3,655

Criminal justice assistance:
Discretionary programs .............

1,274

2,101

4,304

5,478

5,915

5,369

4,777

Total, Discretionary ...................

17,584

20,017

23,662

25,397

26,033

25,646

25,556

390

379

352

402

399

399

399

1,108
–2,161

1,392
–2,261

1,476
–2,319

1,484
–2,390

1,536
–2,476

1,590
–2,542

1,646
–2,622

278

296

294

294

301

304

307

Total, Federal law enforcement activities 1 ...

–385

–194

–197

–210

–240

–249

–270

Federal litigative and judicial
activities:
Mandatory programs .................

246

623

479

445

452

460

471

Correctional activities:
Mandatory programs .................

–69

–47

–31

–26

–26

–26

–27

Criminal justice assistance:
Mandatory programs .................

172

385

315

330

214

219

226

Total, Mandatory ........................

–36

767

566

539

400

404

400

Total, Administration of justice ..............................................

17,548

20,784

24,228

25,936

26,433

26,050

25,956

800 General government:
Discretionary:
Legislative functions:
Legislative branch discretionary
programs .................................

1,873

1,938

2,056

2,083

2,098

2,111

2,122

Executive direction and management:
Drug control programs ...............

73

118

265

283

282

282

282

Total, Federal litigative
and judicial activities 1

Mandatory:
Federal law enforcement activities:
Assets forfeiture fund ................
Border enforcement activities
(Customs and INS) .................
Customs and INS fees ...............
Other mandatory law enforcement programs ........................

280

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Executive Office of the President ..........................................
Presidential transition and
former Presidents ...................

Estimate

1996
Actual

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

178

179

198

197

195

195

195

2

2

2

2

2

8

2

Total, Executive direction
and management .........

253

299

465

482

479

485

479

Central fiscal operations:
Tax administration ....................
Other fiscal operations ...............

7,183
488

7,133
531

7,316
653

7,758
682

7,790
687

7,349
685

7,307
699

Total, Central fiscal operations ............................

7,671

7,664

7,969

8,440

8,477

8,034

8,006

390
198

701
200

263
216

143
215

70 ................... ...................
213
213
213

281

197

174

176

149

136

136

Total, General property
and records management ..............................

869

1,098

653

534

432

349

349

Central personnel management:
Discretionary central personnel
management programs ...........

103

153

148

148

148

148

148

712

712

712

712

712

–180

–259

–113

–90

–197

719

532

453

599

622

515

11
114
2

10
102
2

10
102
1

10
102
1

10
102
1

10
102
1

General property and records
management:
Real property activities ..............
Records management .................
Other general and records management ...................................

General purpose fiscal assistance:
Payments and loans to the District of Columbia .....................
712
719
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Payments and
loans to the District of
Columbia ..........................

712

Payments to States and counties from Federal land management activities ...................
11
Payments in lieu of taxes ..........
113
Other ........................................... ...................
Total, General purpose
fiscal assistance ...........

836

846

646

566

712

735

628

Other general government:
Discretionary programs .............

158

177

164

167

163

160

161

Total, Discretionary ...................

11,763

12,175

12,101

12,420

12,509

12,022

11,893

31.

281

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

Mandatory:
Legislative functions:
Congressional members compensation and other ................
Executive direction and management:
Mandatory programs .................

1996
Actual

92

Estimate
1997

1998

94

1999

101

2000

94

2001

96

2002

96

95

–1 ................... ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................

Central fiscal operations:
Mandatory programs .................
–212
–121
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

–182

–184

–186

–188

–189

–15

–10

–5

–5

–5

Subtotal, Mandatory programs ................................

–212

–121

–197

–194

–191

–193

–194

General property and records
management:
Mandatory programs .................
Offsetting receipts ......................

–26
–23

17
–21

13
–21

12
–20

–3
–18

–3
–18

–5
–18

Total, General property
and records management ..............................

–49

–4

–8

–8

–21

–21

–23

General purpose fiscal assistance:
Payments and loans to the District of Columbia .....................

–12

–12

–12

–12

–12

–15 ...................

778

799

821

844

130

134

138

143

230

230

230

230

67

167

286

424

Payments to States and counties ...........................................
737
811
840
Payments to territories and
Puerto Rico ..............................
110
123
127
Tax revenues for Puerto Rico
(Treasury, BATF) ....................
221
230
230
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Tax revenues for
Puerto Rico (Treasury,
BATF) ...............................

221

230

230

297

397

516

654

Other general purpose fiscal assistance ....................................

89

92

94

96

98

100

102

Total, General purpose
fiscal assistance ...........

1,145

1,244

1,279

1,289

1,416

1,560

1,743

194
509

177
750

192
635

215
635

217
610

184
610

169
610

26

233

Other general government:
Territories ...................................
Treasury claims ..........................
Presidential election campaign
fund ..........................................

209

3 ...................

7 ...................

282

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Other mandatory programs .......

–64

–25

–46

–55

–72

–52

–66

Total, Other general government ........................

848

905

781

821

988

749

713

Deductions for offsetting receipts:
Offsetting receipts ......................

–1,694

–1,184

–1,184

–1,184

–1,184

–1,184

–1,184

Total, Mandatory ........................

129

934

772

818

1,104

1,007

1,150

Total, General government ......

11,892

13,109

12,873

13,238

13,613

13,029

13,043

365,344

370,406

369,987

369,816

367,643

763

2,063

4,300

7,087

9,149

366,107

372,469

374,287

376,903

376,792

–32,012

–32,757

–33,059

–33,493

–34,000

–40

–110

–190

–277

–369

–32,052

–32,867

–33,249

–33,770

–34,369

–11,800
–10,314

–12,000
–8,654

–12,300
–6,405

–12,500
–3,661

–12,700
–1,562

–302

–1,886

–4,004

–6,662

–8,584

–10,616

–10,540

–10,409

–10,323

–10,146

–8,876

–9,193

–9,427

–9,800

–10,175

–402

–16

–29

–42

–57

900 Net interest:
Mandatory:
Interest on the public debt:
Interest on the public debt ........
343,955
356,740
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Interest on the
public debt ........................

343,955

356,740

Interest received by on-budget
trust funds:
Civil service retirement and disability fund ..............................
–28,530
–30,727
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Civil service retirement and disability
fund ..................................

–28,530

–30,727

Military retirement ....................
–11,501
–11,600
Medicare ......................................
–11,777
–11,389
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Medicare ..............

–11,777

–11,389

Other on-budget trust funds .....
–9,061
–9,096
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other on-budget
trust funds .......................

–9,061

–9,096

–9,278

–9,209

–9,456

–9,842

–10,232

Total, Interest received
by on-budget trust
funds .............................

–60,869

–62,812

–63,746

–64,616

–65,414

–66,435

–67,447

Interest received by off-budget
trust funds:
Interest received by social security trust funds .......................

–36,507

–41,238

–45,199

–49,228

–53,181

–57,272

–61,554

31.

283

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Other interest:
Interest on loans to Federal Financing Bank ..........................
–6,458
–4,351
–3,958
–3,503
–3,121
–2,779
–2,425
Interest on refunds of tax collections .........................................
2,172
2,644
2,753
2,855
2,991
3,143
3,295
Payment to the Resolution
Funding Corporation ..............
2,328
2,328
2,328
2,328
2,328
2,328
2,328
Interest paid to loan guarantee
financing accounts ..................
2,350
2,438
2,452
2,491
2,541
2,601
2,674
Interest received from direct
loan financing accounts ..........
–3,031
–4,391
–5,754
–7,045
–8,336
–9,661
–10,976
Interest on deposits in tax and
loan accounts ...........................
–757
–736
–750
–750
–750
–750
–750
Interest received from Outer
Continental Shelf escrow account, Interior .........................
–1 ...................
–1,142 ................... ................... ................... ...................
All other interest ........................
–2,092
–3,083
–3,232
–3,158
–3,142
–3,115
–3,175
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ...................
–157 ................... ................... ................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, All other interest

–2,092

–3,240

–3,232

–3,158

–3,142

–3,115

–3,175

Total, Other interest .......

–5,489

–5,308

–7,303

–6,782

–7,489

–8,233

–9,029

Total, Mandatory ........................

241,090

247,382

249,859

251,843

248,203

244,963

238,762

–10,544

–10,566

–10,730

–10,850

–11,078

–6,103

–6,065

–6,280

–6,488

–6,733

–8,535

–8,746

–9,153

–9,640

–10,178

–621

–604

–588

–577

–567

950 Undistributed offsetting receipts:
Mandatory:
Employer share, employee retirement (on-budget):
Contributions to military retirement fund ................................
–11,174
–11,180
Postal Service contributions to
Civil Service Retirement and
Disability Fund .......................
–5,712
–5,916
Other contributions to civil and
foreign service retirement and
disability fund .........................
–7,991
–8,303
Proposed Legislation (nonPAYGO) ............................... ................... ...................
Subtotal, Other contributions to civil and foreign
service retirement and
disability fund ..................
Contributions to HI trust fund
Total, Employer share,
employee retirement
(on-budget) ....................

–7,991

–8,303

–9,156

–9,350

–9,741

–10,217

–10,745

–2,382

–2,470

–2,625

–2,777

–2,942

–3,072

–3,259

–27,259

–27,869

–28,428

–28,758

–29,693

–30,627

–31,815

284

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–2.

OUTLAYS BY FUNCTION, CATEGORY AND PROGRAM—
Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Employer share, employee retirement (off-budget):
Contributions to social security
trust funds ...............................

–6,278

–6,505

–7,028

–7,633

–8,356

–8,942

–9,781

Rents and royalties on the
Outer Continental Shelf:
OCS Receipts ..............................

–3,741

–4,152

–4,375

–4,036

–3,885

–4,050

–4,254

Sale of major assets:
Proceeds from Sale of U.S. Enrichment Corporation ............. ................... ...................
Privatization of Elk Hills ........... ................... ...................
Proceeds from sale of Power
Marketing Administrations ... ................... ...................
Total, Sale of major assets ................................ ................... ...................
Other undistributed offsetting
receipts:
Spectrum Auction .......................
–342
–7,961
Proposed Legislation
(PAYGO) .............................. ................... ...................

–1,800 ................... ................... ................... ...................
–2,415 ................... ................... ................... ...................
–85 ................... ................... ................... ...................

–4,300 ................... ................... ................... ...................

–9,359

–1,304

–264

–132 ...................

–2,100

–1,800

–3,800

–6,300

–22,100

Subtotal, Spectrum Auction

–342

–7,961

–11,459

–3,104

–4,064

–6,432

–22,100

Total, Mandatory ........................

–37,620

–46,487

–55,590

–43,531

–45,998

–50,051

–67,950

Total ......................................................

1,560,330

1,631,016

1,687,475

1,760,700

1,814,427

1,844,488

1,879,717

On-budget ........................................... (1,259,872) (1,316,014) (1,358,896) (1,422,832) (1,463,751) (1,479,969) (1,499,370)
Off-budget ..........................................
(300,458) (315,002) (328,579) (337,868) (350,676) (364,519) (380,347)
1 For 1999—2002, Federal law enforcement and Federal litigation and judicial totals do not include Violent Crime Reduction Trust Fund spending. That spending appears under the correctional activities and justice assistance subfunction
pending decisions on specific allocation.

31.

285

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–3.

DIRECT AND GUARANTEED LOANS BY FUNCTION
(in millions of dollars)

Function

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

NATIONAL DEFENSE:
DIRECT LOANS:
Loan disbursements ........................... .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
1,384
1,309
1,226
1,140
1,140
1,140
1,140
GUARANTEED LOANS:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

276
441

50
50

250
300

500
787

800
1,561

800
2,309

800
3,005

INTERNATIONAL AFFAIRS:
DIRECT LOANS:
Public Law 480:
Loan disbursements ........................... .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
9,767
9,438
8,879
8,528
8,227
7,920
7,611
Foreign Military Financing Loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
594
602
569
911
793
697
707
Outstandings ......................................
8,119
7,759
7,392
7,441
7,414
7,301
7,189
Economic assistance loans—liquidating
account:
Loan disbursements ...........................
3
4 .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
12,649
11,977
11,400
10,868
10,343
9,814
9,285
Overseas Private Investment Corporation:
Loan disbursements ...........................
30
63
60
60
60
60
60
Outstandings ......................................
125
161
203
236
272
302
322
Export-Import Bank:
Loan disbursements ...........................
1,045
1,373
1,235
1,218
1,308
1,255
1,255
Outstandings ......................................
7,887
7,770
7,870
8,232
8,809
9,382
10,058
Other, International Affairs:
Loan disbursements ...........................
2
108
36
2
1
1
1
Outstandings ......................................
436
480
462
413
363
313
263
Total, direct loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

1,674
38,983

2,150
37,585

1,900
36,206

2,191
35,718

2,162
35,428

2,013
35,032

2,023
34,728

GUARANTEED LOANS:
Foreign Military Financing Loans:
New guaranteed loans ....................... .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
6,129
5,694
5,305
4,921
4,544
4,183
3,828
Loan Guarantees to Israel:
New guaranteed loans .......................
1,751
2,000 .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
6,564
8,564
8,564
8,564
8,564
8,564
8,564
Overseas Private Investment Corporation:
New guaranteed loans .......................
855
1,520
1,905
2,400
2,700
2,400
2,400
Outstandings ......................................
1,551
2,942
4,272
5,632
6,802
7,481
7,881
Export-Import Bank:
New guaranteed loans .......................
5,667
8,997
10,102
10,693
11,036
11,302
11,600
Outstandings ......................................
17,785
17,999
17,792
17,281
16,528
15,339
14,004
Other, International Affairs:
New guaranteed loans .......................
145
175
52 .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
2,312
2,367
2,229
2,062
1,957
1,849
1,744
Total, guaranteed loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

8,418
34,341

12,692
37,566

12,059
38,162

13,093
38,460

13,736
38,395

13,702
37,416

14,000
36,021

286

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–3.

DIRECT AND GUARANTEED LOANS BY FUNCTION—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Function

ENERGY:
DIRECT LOANS:
Rural electrification and telecommunications:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................
Other, Energy:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................
Total, direct loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

975
33,965

2,419
34,730

1,975
35,504

1,607
35,782

2,520
36,032

1,661
36,484

1,510
36,710

61
160

108
207

118
254

124
299

143
353

153
409

172
469

1,036
34,125

2,527
34,937

2,093
35,758

1,731
36,081

2,663
36,385

1,814
36,893

1,682
37,179

GUARANTEED LOANS:
Rural electrification and telecommunications:
New guaranteed loans ....................... .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
691
670
646
646
646
646
646
NATURAL RESOURCES AND ENVIRONMENT:
DIRECT LOANS:
Natural Resources and Environment:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

34
294

45
321

38
342

37
362

37
381

39
403

40
426

AGRICULTURE:
DIRECT LOANS:
Agricultural credit insurance fund:
Loan disbursements ...........................
806
672
545
606
681
760
790
Outstandings ......................................
10,809
9,720
8,658
7,618
6,842
6,105
5,566
Commodity credit corporation fund:
Loan disbursements ...........................
5,137
6,174
7,922
7,844
7,500
6,797
6,256
Outstandings ......................................
1,672
1,436
1,665
1,638
1,546
1,480
1,437
P.L. 480 Direct credit financing account:
Loan disbursements ...........................
240
228
169
123
113
113
113
Outstandings ......................................
1,264
1,474
1,599
1,722
1,835
1,948
2,061
P.L. 480 Title I Food for Progress
Credits, financing account:
Loan disbursements ........................... .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
508
508
508
508
508
508
508
Debt reduction—financing account:
Loan disbursements ........................... .................. ..................
34 .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
66
66
100
100
100
100
100
Financial assistance corporation fund:
Loan disbursements ........................... .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
1,261
1,261
1,261
1,261
1,261
1,261
1,261
Total, direct loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

6,183
15,580

7,074
14,465

8,670
13,791

8,573
12,847

8,294
12,092

7,670
11,402

7,159
10,933

GUARANTEED LOANS:
Agricultural credit insurance fund:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

1,770
6,878

2,380
7,791

2,375
8,695

2,288
9,204

2,274
9,586

2,270
9,882

2,269
10,115

31.

287

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–3.

DIRECT AND GUARANTEED LOANS BY FUNCTION—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Function

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Commodity credit corporation export
guarantees:
New guaranteed loans .......................
3,312
5,500
5,700
5,700
5,700
5,700
5,700
Outstandings ......................................
5,414
8,058
10,086
11,169
11,379
11,496
11,545
Other, Agriculture:
New guaranteed loans ....................... .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
17
17
17
17
17
17
17
Total, guaranteed loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

5,082
12,309

COMMERCE AND HOUSING CREDIT:
DIRECT LOANS:
Rural Housing insurance fund:
Loan disbursements ...........................
1,156
Outstandings ......................................
29,985
FHA-Mutual mortgage and cooperative
housing insurance:
Loan disbursements ...........................
3
Outstandings ......................................
9
FHA-General and special risk insurance:
Loan disbursements ........................... ..................
Outstandings ......................................
97
Housing for the elderly or handicapped
fund liquidating account:
Loan disbursements ...........................
2
Outstandings ......................................
8,306
GNMA-Guarantees of mortgage-backed
securities:
Loan disbursements ...........................
128
Outstandings ......................................
321
SBA-Business Loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
164
Outstandings ......................................
1,832
Spectrum Auction Direct Loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
115
Outstandings ......................................
115
Other, Commerce and Housing Credit:
Loan disbursements ...........................
2
Outstandings ......................................
232
Total, direct loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................
GUARANTEED LOANS:
Rural Housing insurance fund:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
FHA-Mutual mortgage and cooperative
housing insurance:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
FHA-General and special risk insurance:
New guaranteed loans .......................

7,880
15,866

8,075
18,798

7,988
20,390

7,974
20,982

7,970
21,395

7,969
21,677

1,139
29,662

1,212
29,418

1,455
29,409

1,784
29,700

2,121
30,295

2,271
30,988

200
150

200 .................. .................. .................. ..................
260
260
260
260
260

40
125

120
216

20
186

20
136

20
108

20
81

189 .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
8,424
8,352
8,281
8,211
8,141
8,072

144
327

116
329

99
334

86
341

78
350

75
360

129
1,486

103
898

82
327

13
296

13
267

14
241

6,980
6,973

3,220 .................. .................. .................. ..................
9,732
9,732
9,732
9,732
9,732

3
201

2
107

26
129

25
148

26
165

25
179

1,570
40,897

8,824
47,348

4,973
49,312

1,682
48,658

1,928
48,824

2,258
49,318

2,405
49,913

1,496
3,535

2,319
5,712

2,944
8,427

3,018
11,107

2,831
13,484

2,612
15,519

2,488
17,301

59,221
363,994

65,440
390,979

60,718
414,967

61,710
445,562

62,687
472,134

63,694
497,512

64,712
520,340

12,220

14,652

15,005

14,887

14,940

14,940

14,940

288

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–3.

DIRECT AND GUARANTEED LOANS BY FUNCTION—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Function

Outstandings ......................................
GNMA, Guarantees of mortgagebacked securities:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
SBA-Business Guaranteed Loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
Other, Commerce and Housing Credit:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
Total, guaranteed loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
TRANSPORTATION:
DIRECT LOANS:
Transportation infrastructure credit direct loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................
Direct loan financing account:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................
Other, Transportation:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

91,176

98,323

106,811

113,886

120,272

126,442

132,668

101,540
497,433

79,560
533,333

75,799
563,667

74,582
556,837

75,357
577,255

77,233
568,817

79,128
560,073

6,774
31,013

6,956
33,793

7,144
36,869

7,337
40,203

7,535
43,766

7,739
47,535

7,948
51,497

26
269

32
267

3 .................. .................. .................. ..................
240
222
206
191
177

181,277
168,959
161,613
161,534
163,350
166,218
169,216
987,420 1,062,407 1,130,981 1,167,817 1,227,117 1,256,016 1,282,056

.................. ..................
.................. ..................

425
425

..................
..................

140
140

140
280

120 .................. .................. ..................
400
400
400
400

47
314

76
311

26
285

33
272

12
240

28
225

28
210

Total, direct loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

47
314

216
451

591
990

791
1,735

863
2,554

879
3,390

879
4,226

GUARANTEED LOANS:
Maritime guaranteed loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

826
2,154

1,065
3,354

477
3,499

477
3,646

477
3,784

477
3,913

477
4,014

35
4,183

3 .................. .................. .................. ..................
3,994
3,810
3,635
3,467
3,308

759
2,362

706
3,052

656
3,686

695
4,354

761
5,080

648
5,685

161
501

180
671

177
835

206
1,024

196
1,199

183
1,357

45
42

120
120

150
273

150
384

150
482

150
564

874
8,807

1,041
8,751

746
5,127

878
1,561

902
1,607

936
1,658

COMMUNITY AND REGIONAL DEVELOPMENT:
DIRECT LOANS:
Rural development insurance fund:
Loan disbursements ...........................
12
Outstandings ......................................
4,348
Rural water and waste disposal loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
650
Outstandings ......................................
1,615
Rural community facility loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
118
Outstandings ......................................
348
Distance learning and medical link
loans:
Loan disbursements ........................... ..................
Outstandings ...................................... ..................
SBA, Disaster Loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
946
Outstandings ......................................
8,903

638
1,063

851
1,914

851
2,765

851
3,616

31.

289

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–3.

DIRECT AND GUARANTEED LOANS BY FUNCTION—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Function

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Other, Community and Regional Development:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

237
2,525

439
2,726

410
2,937

179
1,214

189
1,302

201
1,402

226
1,526

Total, direct loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

1,963
17,739

2,313
18,621

2,460
19,525

1,908
14,945

2,118
12,260

2,210
13,237

2,143
14,098

GUARANTEED LOANS:
Rural development insurance fund:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
Rural community facility loan guarantees:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
Rural business and industry guaranteed loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
Community development loan guarantees:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
Other, Community and Regional Development:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

1
499

18 .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
425
344
280
228
186
152

45
94

54
143

77
212

129
330

153
465

184
624

208
798

339
723

543
1,185

609
1,661

621
2,097

616
2,481

610
2,817

454
2,960

404
993

765
1,628

1,160
2,620

1,210
3,650

1,207
4,632

1,255
5,612

1,250
6,542

50
256

74
262

95
323

95
378

114
445

110
496

110
538

839
2,565

1,454
3,643

1,941
5,160

2,055
6,735

2,090
8,251

2,159
9,735

2,022
10,990

9,100
11,565

11,978
23,153

14,533
36,829

17,635
52,879

20,156
70,430

21,730
88,240

23,076
105,781

20
866

6
847

3
827

1
806

6
794

9,120
12,431

11,984
24,000

14,536
37,656

17,636
53,685

20,162
71,224

21,736
89,021

23,076
106,545

GUARANTEED LOANS:
Federal family education loan program:
New guaranteed loans .......................
19,816
Outstandings ......................................
101,874
Historically Black college and university loan guarantees:
New guaranteed loans ....................... ..................

20,948
107,800

21,241
111,301

20,533
113,630

20,520
113,242

21,518
112,815

22,872
112,273

10

15

15

20

Total, guaranteed loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................
EDUCATION, TRAINING, EMPLOYMENT, AND SOCIAL SERVICES:
DIRECT LOANS:
Federal direct student loan program:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................
Other, Education, Training, Employment and Social Services:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................
Total, direct loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

6 ..................
781
764

20 ..................

290

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–3.

DIRECT AND GUARANTEED LOANS BY FUNCTION—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Function

1996
Actual

Outstandings ...................................... ..................
Total, guaranteed loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

19,816
101,874

HEALTH:
DIRECT LOANS:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

25
834

GUARANTEED LOANS:
Health Professions Graduate Student
Loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
210
Outstandings ......................................
2,915
Other, Health:
New guaranteed loans ....................... ..................
Outstandings ......................................
198
Total, guaranteed loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

210
3,113

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

10

25

40

59

78

77

20,958
107,810

21,256
111,326

20,548
113,670

20,540
113,301

21,538
112,893

22,872
112,350

20 .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
823
796
770
746
723
704

140
2,952

85 .................. .................. .................. ..................
2,940
2,833
2,711
2,580
2,438

134
281

20
260

6 .................. .................. ..................
224
190
158
154

274
3,233

105
3,200

6 .................. .................. ..................
3,057
2,901
2,738
2,592

INCOME SECURITY:
DIRECT LOANS:
Low-rent public housing—loans and
other expenses:
Loan disbursements ........................... .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
1,627
1,562
1,497
1,432
1,367
1,302
1,237
Other, Income Security:
Loan disbursements ...........................
93
95
73
8 .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
676
769
839
844
841
838
835
Total, direct loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

93
2,303

95
2,331

73
2,336

8 .................. .................. ..................
2,276
2,208
2,140
2,072

GUARANTEED LOANS:
Low-rent public housing—loans and
other expenses:
New guaranteed loans ....................... .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
Outstandings ......................................
3,861
3,507
3,227
2,947
2,667
2,387
2,107
Indian housing:
New guaranteed loans .......................
5
5
17
34
40
40
37
Outstandings ......................................
6
11
28
62
102
142
179
Total, guaranteed loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

5
3,867

5
3,518

17
3,255

34
3,009

40
2,769

40
2,529

37
2,286

VETERANS BENEFITS AND SERVICES:
DIRECT LOANS:
Veterans housing benefit program
fund:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

1,434
1,172

1,918
1,811

2,172
2,227

2,229
2,599

2,271
2,961

2,285
3,295

2,267
3,600

31.

291

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–3.

DIRECT AND GUARANTEED LOANS BY FUNCTION—Continued
(in millions of dollars)

Function

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Other, Veterans Benefits:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

8
16

15
28

17
43

20
60

2
58

2
57

2
56

Total, direct loans:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

1,442
1,188

1,933
1,839

2,189
2,270

2,249
2,659

2,273
3,019

2,287
3,352

2,269
3,656

GUARANTEED LOANS:
Veterans housing benefit program
fund:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

28,676
154,762

30,230
156,703

28,948
159,047

25,458
156,185

25,032
153,594

24,566
151,136

24,059
148,711

GENERAL GOVERNMENT:
DIRECT LOANS:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

379
462

FEDERAL GOVERNMENT TOTALS:
DIRECT LOANS:
Loan disbursements ...........................
Outstandings ......................................

23,566
166,534

GUARANTEED LOANS (Gross):
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

461 .................. .................. .................. .................. ..................
531
57
44
31
15
13

37,642
184,561

37,523
200,265

36,806
210,920

40,500
226,292

40,906
246,066

41,676
265,633

245,425
243,567
234,741
231,693
234,039
237,470
241,452
1,303,537 1,394,820 1,474,374 1,514,402 1,573,301 1,600,726 1,624,348

Less, secondary guaranteed loans: 1
GNMA guarantees of FmHA/VA/FHA
pools:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

–101,540
–497,433

–79,560
–533,333

–75,799
–563,667

–74,582
–556,837

Total, primary guaranteed loans:
New guaranteed loans .......................
Outstandings ......................................

143,885
806,104

164,007
861,487

158,942
910,707

157,111
957,565

–75,357
–577,255

–77,233
–568,817

–79,128
–560,073

158,682
160,237
162,324
996,046 1,031,909 1,064,275

1 Loans guaranteed by FHA, VA, or FmHA are included above. GNMA places a secondary guarantee on these loans, so
they are deducted here to avoid double counting in the totals.

292

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–4.

TAX EXPENDITURES BY FUNCTION
(In millions of dollars)
Total Revenue Loss

Function and provision
1996

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

National defense:
Current law tax expenditures:
Exclusion of benefits and allowances to armed forces personnel ....................................................................................

2,060

2,080

2,095

2,120

2,140

2,160

2,180

Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................

2,060

2,080

2,095

2,120

2,140

2,160

2,180

1,520
1,500
1,400

1,680
1,600
1,500

1,865
1,700
1,600

2,065
1,800
1,700

2,290
1,900
1,800

2,545
2,000
1,900

2,825
2,100
2,000

2,100

2,200

2,400

2,600

2,800

3,000

3,200

6,520

6,980

7,565

8,165

8,790

9,445 10,125

..............
10
............................

90
–19

100
–34

110
–39

............................
............................

–403
–488

–594
–880

International affairs:
Current law tax expenditures:
Exclusion of income earned abroad by United States citizens ........................................................................................
Exclusion of income of foreign sales corporations .................
Inventory property sales source rules exception ...................
Deferral of income from controlled foreign corporations
(normal tax method) ............................................................
Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................
Proposals affecting tax expenditures:
Tax benefits for foreign sales corporations ............................
Expand subpart F provisions regarding certain income ......
Reduce allocations to foreign source income under sales
source rules by 50 percent ...................................................
Replace sales source rule with activity-based rule ...............

Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ..............
General science, space, and technology:
Current law tax expenditures:
Expensing of research and experimentation expenditures
(normal tax method) ............................................................
Credit for increasing research activities ................................

10

120
–44

130
–48

–625
–670
–715
–930 –1,080 –1,140

–820 –1,408 –1,484 –1,674 –1,773

40
805

195
685

430
1,045

580
250

685
105

740
40

765
5

Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................
845
Proposals affecting tax expenditures:.
Extend R&E credit .................................................................. ..............

880

1,475

830

790

780

770

430

787

540

234

111

41

Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ..............

430

787

540

234

111

41

–210
1,125
570

–130
1,145
600

–40
1,170
485

20
1,190
565

100
1,205
535

75
1,225
505

80
1,255
485

50
15

50
15

55
15

55
20

60
20

60
20

65
20

315
80
30
10

315
85
35
10

315
90
40
10

315
100
40
10

310
105
40
10

310
105
45
10

310
110
45
10

65

65

75

80

85

90

95

150

65

15

30

35

45

45

2,200

2,255

2,230

2,425

2,505

2,490

2,520

Energy:
Current law tax expenditures:
Expensing of exploration and development costs, fuels .......
Excess of percentage over cost depletion, fuels .....................
Alternative fuel production credit ..........................................
Exception from passive loss limitation for working interests in oil and gas properties ..............................................
Capital gains treatment of royalties on coal .........................
Exclusion of interest on State and local IDBs for energy facilities ....................................................................................
Enhanced oil recovery credit ...................................................
New technology credit .............................................................
Alcohol fuel credit 1 ..................................................................
Tax credit and deduction for clean-fuel burning vehicles
and properties .......................................................................
Exclusion from income of conservation subsidies provided
by public utilities .................................................................
Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................

31.

293

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–4.

TAX EXPENDITURES BY FUNCTION—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Total Revenue Loss

Function and provision
1996

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Proposals affecting tax expenditures:
Eliminate extension of synthetic fules credit from biomass
or coal .................................................................................... ..............

–14

–64

–96

–99

–101

–102

Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ..............

–14

–64

–96

–99

–101

–102

Natural resources and environment:
Current law tax expenditures:
Expensing of exploration and development costs, nonfuel
minerals ................................................................................
35
35
35
35
35
35
35
Excess of percentage over cost depletion, nonfuel minerals
285
295
300
305
315
320
325
Capital gains treatment of iron ore ........................................ ..................................................................................................
Special rules for mining reclamation reserves ......................
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
Exclusion of interest on State and local IDBs for pollution
control and sewage and waste disposal facilities ..............
700
690
675
655
640
600
545
Capital gains treatment of certain timber income ................
15
15
15
20
20
20
20
Expensing of multiperiod timber growing costs ....................
395
415
440
460
485
505
525
Investment credit and seven-year amortization for reforestation expenditures ................................................................
45
50
50
50
50
50
50
Tax incentives for preservation of historic structures ..........
125
120
115
115
110
105
105
Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................
1,650
Proposals affecting tax expenditures:
Repeal percentage depletion for non-fuel minerals mined
from certain lands ................................................................ ..............

1,670

1,680

1,690

1,705

1,685

1,655

–8

–89

–92

–94

–96

–97

Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ..............

–8

–89

–92

–94

–96

–97

65
80
10
165

65
80
10
170

65
80
10
175

70
85
10
180

70
85
10
185

70
85
10
190

70
85
10
195

Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................
320
Proposals affecting tax expenditures:
Phase-out preferential tax deferral for certain large farm
corporations required to use accrual accounting ............... ..............

325

330

345

350

355

360

–28

–136

–121

–124

–124

–124

Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ..............

–28

–136

–121

–124

–124

–124

1,765

1,755

1,735

1,715

1,690

1,665

1,640

755

760

755

760

765

760

750

Agriculture:
Current law tax expenditures
Expensing of certain capital outlays ......................................
Expensing of certain multiperiod production costs ...............
Treatment of loans forgiven solvent farmers as if insolvent
Capital gains treatment of certain income ............................

Commerce and housing:
Current law tax expenditures:
Housing:
Exclusion of interest on owner-occupied mortgage subsidy bonds ..........................................................................
Exclusion of interest on State and local debt for rental
housing ..............................................................................
Deductibility of mortgage interest on owner-occupied
homes .................................................................................
Deductibility of State and local property tax on owner-occupied homes .....................................................................
Deferral of income from post 1987 installment sales ........
Deferral of capital gains on home sales .............................
Exclusion of capital gains on home sales for persons age
55 and over ........................................................................
Exception from passive loss rules for $25,000 of rental
loss .....................................................................................

47,525 49,820 52,115 54,440 56,830 59,345 62,060
15,900 16,670 17,435 18,215 19,015 19,855 20,765
955
975
995 1,015 1,035 1,055 1,075
14,410 14,845 15,290 15,745 16,220 16,705 17,205
5,225

5,230

5,095

5,515

5,295

5,810

5,495

3,950

3,700

3,470

3,260

3,065

2,885

2,715

294

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–4.

TAX EXPENDITURES BY FUNCTION—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Total Revenue Loss

Function and provision
1996

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Accelerated depreciation on rental housing (normal tax
method) ..............................................................................
1,190 1,350 1,555 1,955 2,335 2,240 2,310
Credit for low-income housing investments .......................
2,600 2,840 3,270 3,500 3,595 3,445 3,325
Financial institutions and insurance:
Exemption of credit union income ...................................
660
700
745
790
835
885
940
Excess bad debt reserves of financial institutions .........
90
70
40
15
5............................
Deferral on income on life insurance and annuity contracts .............................................................................. 10,525 11,210 11,940 12,715 13,540 14,420 15,360
Special alternative tax on small property and casualty
insurance companies .....................................................
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
Tax exemption of certain insurance companies .............
240
245
255
260
280
295
310
Small life insurance company deduction ........................
110
115
120
130
135
140
145
Commerce:
Cancellation of indebtedness ...............................................
70
40
15..............
–10
–5
–5
Permanent exceptions from imputed interest rules ..........
150
155
155
160
160
160
165
Capital gains (other than agriculture, timber, iron ore,
and coal) (normal tax method) ........................................
7,990 8,230 8,480 8,730 8,995 9,265 9,540
Capital gains exclusion of small corporation stock ........... ............................
5
20
40
70
95
Step-up basis of capital gains at death .............................. 29,530 30,715 31,945 33,225 34,555 35,940 37,375
Carryover basis of capital gains on gifts ............................
140
150
160
170
180
190
200
Ordinary income treatment of loss from small business
corporation stock sale .......................................................
35
35
35
35
40
40
40
Accelerated depreciation of buildings other than rental
housing (normal tax method) ...........................................
6,800 5,800 4,660 3,420 2,385 1,640 1,085
Accelerated depreciation of machinery and equipment
(normal tax method) ......................................................... 25,430 27,280 29,285 32,500 35,730 38,325 40,125
Expensing of certain small investments (normal tax
method) ..............................................................................
1,440 1,065
900
890
850
700
560
Amortization of start-up costs (normal tax method) .........
195
200
205
210
215
220
225
Graduated corporation income tax rate (normal tax
method) ..............................................................................
4,435 4,695 4,940 5,125 5,455 5,720 5,925
Exclusion of interest on small issue IDBs .........................
275
265
260
255
250
250
240
Treatment of Alaska Native Corporations .........................
20
15
10
5
5
5..............
Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................
Proposals affecting tax expenditures:
Capital gains exclusion on sale of principal residence .........
Further restrict like-kind exchanges involving foreign
property .................................................................................
Require recognition of gain on certain stocks, indebtedness
and partnership interests ....................................................

182,415 188,935 195,875 204,780 213,495 222,030 229,670
..............

71

288

301

284

268

249

..............

–2

–7

–12

–17

–23

–29

............................

–38

–61

–65

–71

–76

69

243

228

202

174

144

Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ..............
Transportation:
Current law tax expenditures:
Deferral of tax on shipping companies ..................................
Exclusion of reimbursed employee parking expenses ...........
Exclusion for employer-provided transit passes ....................

20
1,250
50

20
1,285
60

20
1,315
70

20
1,350
85

20
1,385
100

20
1,425
115

20
1,470
130

Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................

1,320

1,365

1,405

1,455

1,505

1,560

1,620

Community and regional development:
Current law tax expenditures:
Investment credit for rehabilitation of structures (other
than historic) ........................................................................
Exclusion of interest on IDBs for airports, docks, and
sports and convention facilities ...........................................
Exemption of certain mutuals’ and cooperatives’ income .....

80

80

70

70

70

65

65

1,980
60

1,975
60

1,970
60

1,915
65

1,865
65

1,810
65

1,760
70

31.

295

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–4.

TAX EXPENDITURES BY FUNCTION—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Total Revenue Loss

Function and provision
1996
Empowerment zones ................................................................

530

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

585

640

670

700

700

530

Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................
2,650 2,700
Proposals affecting tax expenditures:
Tax incentives for distressed areas ........................................ ..............
40
Tax credit for investment in community development institutions and venture capital funds ....................................... ............................
District of Columbia tax incentive ......................................... ............................

2,740

2,720

2,700

2,640

2,425

424

500

502

469

410

2
24

5
46

7
56

9
66

11
68

450

551

565

544

489

Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ..............

40

Education, training, employment, and social services:
Current law tax expenditures:
Education:
Exclusion of scholarship and fellowship income (normal
tax method) .......................................................................
835
845
850
860
870
875
885
Exclusion of interest on State and local student loan
bonds ..................................................................................
305
290
280
265
260
250
250
Exclusion of interest on State and local debt for private
nonprofit educational facilities ........................................
955
930
895
860
830
800
775
Exclusion of interest on savings bonds transferred to
educational institutions ....................................................
5
10
10
15
15
15
20
Parental personal exemption for students age 19 or over
820
845
885
930
985 1,045 1,090
Deductibility of charitable contributions (education) ........
1,865 1,960 2,060 2,165 2,270 2,385 2,500
Exclusion of employer provided educational assistance ...
20
575
20........................................................
Training, employment, and social services:
Work opportunity tax credit ................................................ ..............
120
150
85
30
10..............
Exclusion of employer provided child care .........................
775
830
890
955 1,025 1,100 1,180
Adoption assistance .............................................................. ..............
10
200
320
355
370
365
Exclusion of employee meals and lodging (other than
military) .............................................................................
570
600
630
665
700
735
775
Credit for child and dependent care expenses ...................
2,580 2,705 2,840 2,985 3,130 3,290 3,455
Credit for disabled access expenditures .............................
80
85
85
85
90
90
90
Expensing of costs of removing certain architectural barriers to the handicapped ..................................................
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
Deductibility of charitable contributions, other than education and health .............................................................. 16,045 16,845 17,680 18,560 19,480 20,445 21,455
Exclusion of certain foster care payments .........................
30
35
35
35
40
40
45
Exclusion of parsonage allowances .....................................
295
315
335
360
380
410
435
Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................
Proposals affecting tax expenditures:
Incentive for education and training ......................................
Extension of income exclusion for employer-provided educational assistance ...............................................................
Extend work opportunity tax credit .......................................
Targeted welfare-to-work tax credit .......................................
Equitable tolling ......................................................................
Extend deduction provided for contribuitions of appreciated
stock to private foundations ................................................

25,200 27,020 27,865 29,165 30,480 31,880 33,340
..............

84

4,044

6,199

7,848

..............
82
645
670
758
............................
128
157
93
............................
68
137
163
......................................................................
............................

Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ..............

166

34
4,919

8,632

9,386

247..............
31
10
122
61
6
49

38..........................................
7,201

8,862

9,038

9,506

Health:
Current law tax expenditures:
Exclusion of employer contributions for medical insurance
premiums and medical care ................................................ 64,450 70,460 75,750 81,285 86,900 92,815 98,995
Medical savings accounts ........................................................ ..............
10
100
190
195
195
200
Deductibility of medical expenses ..........................................
3,675 4,060 4,535 4,895 5,270 5,670 6,100

296

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table 31–4.

TAX EXPENDITURES BY FUNCTION—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Total Revenue Loss

Function and provision
1996
Exclusion of interest on State and local debt for private
nonprofit health facilities ....................................................
Deductibility of charitable contributions (health) .................
Tax credit for orphan drug research ......................................
Special Blue Cross/Blue Shield deduction .............................

2,135
2,360
5
120

1997

1998

2,080
2,480
20
135

1999

2000

2001

2002

2,005 1,930 1,855 1,790 1,745
2,600 2,735 2,870 3,005 3,155
10........................................................
95
150
165
200
250

Total, current law tax expenditures .......................................... 72,745 79,245 85,095 91,185 97,255 103,675 110,445
Proposals affecting tax expenditures:
Extend orphan drug credit ...................................................... ..............
8
19
12
3
3
1
Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ..............
Income security:
Current law tax expenditures:
Exclusion of railroad retirement system benefits .................
Exclusion of workmen’s compensation benefits .....................
Exclusion of public assistance benefits (normal tax method)
Exclusion of special benefits for disabled coal miners ..........
Exclusion of military disability pensions ...............................
Net exclusion of pension contributions and earnings:
Employer plans .....................................................................
Individual Retirement Accounts .........................................
Keogh plans ..........................................................................
Exclusion of employer provided death benefits .....................
Exclusion of other employee benefits:
Premiums on group term life insurance .............................
Premiums on accident and disability insurance ................
Income of trusts to finance supplementary unemployment
benefits ..................................................................................
Special ESOP rules ..................................................................
Additional deduction for the blind .........................................
Additional deduction for the elderly .......................................
Tax credit for the elderly and disabled ..................................
Deductibility of casualty losses ...............................................
Earned income credit 2 ............................................................

440
4,695
500
90
130

8

19

12

3

3

1

440
4,970
515
90
130

450
5,305
550
85
130

450
5,550
575
80
130

455
5,855
600
75
130

455
6,220
625
75
130

465
6,660
655
70
130

55,410 55,810 56,245 56,665 57,085 57,510 57,940
8,025 8,345 8,600 8,880 9,125 9,340 9,520
3,030 3,200 3,325 3,500 3,680 3,875 4,080
35
35
35
40
40
45
45
2,495
155

2,615
165

2,745
175

2,880
185

3,020
195

3,170
205

3,325
215

20
905
25
1,470
45
460
5,097

20
735
25
1,485
50
485
5,653

20
720
25
1,495
50
510
5,814

20
740
30
1,500
50
535
6,112

20
760
30
1,510
50
560
6,319

20
790
30
1,515
50
590
6,621

20
820
30
1,515
50
620
6,859

Total, current law tax expenditures .......................................... 83,027 84,768 86,279 87,922 89,509 91,266 93,019
Proposals affecting tax expenditures:
Expand individual retirement accounts ................................. ............................ 1,454
477
753 1,157 1,674
Tax credit for dependent children .......................................... ..............
718 9,889 6,806 8,552 10,387 10,369
Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ..............

718 11,343

7,283

9,305 11,544 12,043

Social Security:
Current law tax expenditures:
Exclusion of social security benefits:
OASI benefits for retired workers ......................................
Disability insurance benefits ...............................................
Benefits for dependents and survivors ...............................

17,005 17,810 18,495 19,290 20,190 20,875 21,495
2,090 2,375 2,615 2,820 3,045 3,290 3,545
3,795 3,985 4,175 4,355 4,530 4,710 4,895

Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................

22,890 24,170 25,285 26,465 27,765 28,875 29,935

Veterans benefits and services:
Current law tax expenditures:
Exclusion of veterans disability compensation ......................
Exclusion of veterans pensions ...............................................
Exclusion of GI bill benefits ....................................................
Exclusion of interest on State and local debt for veterans
housing ..................................................................................

2,615
70
50

2,770
70
60

2,930
70
70

3,100
70
80

3,280
75
90

3,470
80
95

3,675
85
100

40

40

35

35

35

35

35

31.

297

DETAILED FUNCTIONAL TABLES

Table 31–4.

TAX EXPENDITURES BY FUNCTION—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Total Revenue Loss

Function and provision
1996
Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................
General government:
Current law tax expenditures:
Exclusion of interest on public purpose State and local
debt ........................................................................................
Deductibility of nonbusiness State and local taxes other
than on owner-occupied homes ...........................................
Tax credit for corporations receiving income from doing
business in U.S. possessions ...............................................

2,775

1997
2,940

1998
3,105

1999
3,285

2000
3,480

2001
3,680

2002
3,895

15,720 15,800 15,735 15,595 15,445 15,300 15,170
28,265 29,630 30,995 32,375 33,800 35,290 36,910
2,760

2,700

2,770

2,800

2,885

2,970

3,060

Total, current law tax expenditures .......................................... 46,745 48,130 49,500 50,770 52,130 53,560 55,140
Proposals affecting tax expenditures:
Extend pro-rata disallowance of tax-exempt interest expense to all corporations ...................................................... ............................
–16
–31
–45
–56
–65
Extend possessions wage credit .............................................. ............................
27
68
91
109
122
Total, proposals affecting tax expenditures .............................. ............................
Interest:
Current law tax expenditures:
Deferral of interest on savings bonds ....................................

1,300

Total, current law tax expenditures ..........................................

1,300

11

37

46

53

57

1,290

1,285

1,270

1,215

1,170

1,155

1,290

1,285

1,270

1,215

1,170

1,155

Notes:
Revenue loss estimates for new proposals are not directly comparable to estimates for current law tax expenditures, because the current law estimates do not reflect behavioral effects.
Total revenue loss estimates by function are calculated here as the simple totals for the provisions listed for each function. Because of interactions across provisions, these estimates are only rough approximations of the total revenue loss for
the functions.
Negative numbers for proposals affecting tax expenditures indicate the expected increase in receipts; postive numbers
indicate the expected decrease in receipts.
1 In addition, the partial exemption from the excise tax for alcohol fuels results in a reduction in excise tax receipts as
follows: 1996, $670 million; 1997, $670 million; 1998, $700 million; 1999, $740 million; 2000, $770 million; 2001, $800 million; and 2002, $840 million.
2 The figures in the table indicate the effect of the earned income tax credit on receipts. The effect on outlays is as follows: 1996, $19,159 million; 1997, $21,163 million; 1998, $21,983 million; 1999, $22,864 million; 2000, $23,818 million;
2001, $24,634 million; and 2002, $25,518 million.

VII.

SUMMARY TABLES

299

Budget Aggregates

301

BUDGET AGGREGATES
Table S–1. OUTLAYS, RECEIPTS, AND DEFICIT SUMMARY
(In billions of dollars)
1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Outlays:
Discretionary:
National defense ...............................................
International .....................................................
Domestic ............................................................

266.0
18.3
250.1

268.0
19.6
262.5

260.1
19.3
268.0

262.1
19.9
275.5

267.7
19.1
277.1

268.6
18.9
273.5

273.9
19.0
274.3

Subtotal, discretionary .................................

534.4

550.0

547.5

557.5

563.9

561.0

567.2

Mandatory:
Programmatic:
Social security ...............................................
Medicare and Medicaid ................................
Means-tested entitlements (except Medicaid) ..............................................................
Deposit insurance .........................................
Other ..............................................................

347.1
263.3

364.2
290.1

380.9
310.2

398.6
328.4

417.7
344.8

438.0
368.5

459.7
393.9

95.3
–8.4
125.2

103.8
–12.1
134.0

107.4
–4.0
151.2

111.6
–2.0
158.2

117.1
–1.1
169.8

115.3
–1.6
168.3

121.9
–1.5
167.7

Subtotal, programmatic ............................

822.5

880.1

945.7

994.9

1,048.3

1,088.5

1,141.7

Undistributed offsetting receipts ....................

–37.6

–46.5

–55.6

–43.5

–46.0

–50.1

–68.0

Subtotal, mandatory .....................................

784.9

833.6

890.2

951.3

1,002.3

1,038.5

1,073.8

Net interest ..........................................................

241.1

247.4

249.9

251.8

248.2

245.0

238.8

Subtotal, mandatory and net interest ............

1,026.0

1,081.0

1,140.0

1,203.2

1,250.5

1,283.5

1,312.5

Total outlays ..........................................................

1,560.3

1,631.0

1,687.5

1,760.7

1,814.4

1,844.5

1,879.7

Receipts ..................................................................

1,453.1

1,505.4

1,566.8

1,643.3

1,727.3

1,808.3

1,896.7

Deficit/Surplus ......................................................

–107.3

–125.6

–120.6

–117.4

–87.1

–36.1

17.0

Memorandum:
Discretionary Budget Authority:
National Defense ..............................................
International .....................................................
Domestic ............................................................

265.0
18.1
219.3

263.1
18.1
224.6

266.0
23.0
241.5

269.8
20.1
245.5

275.5
19.1
247.9

282.0
18.8
248.6

289.8
18.8
252.0

Total ..................................................................

502.5

505.8

530.5

535.4

542.5

549.4

560.6

303

304

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table S–2.
1996
Actual

ON- AND OFF-BUDGET TOTALS (1996–2007)
Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

2003

2004

2005

2006

2007

In billions of dollars
Outlays ...................... 1,560.3 1,631.0 1,687.5 1,760.7 1,814.4 1,844.5 1,879.7 1,986.3 2,063.8 2,147.9 2,229.0 2,319.9
Receipts ..................... 1,453.1 1,505.4 1,566.8 1,643.3 1,727.3 1,808.3 1,896.7 1,986.4 2,081.3 2,189.4 2,291.8 2,402.1
Deficit/Surplus:
Unified ...................
On-Budget ..............
Off-Budget ..............

–107.3 –125.6 –120.6 –117.4 –87.1 –36.1
–174.3 –199.5 –197.0 –204.7 –183.3 –139.2
67.0
73.9
76.4
87.3
96.2 103.1

17.0
0.1
17.6
–92.5 –115.5 –104.4
109.5 115.6 122.0

41.5
–93.6
135.1

62.8
–76.7
139.4

82.2
–65.1
147.4

As percentages of GDP
Outlays ......................
Receipts .....................

20.8
19.4

20.8
19.2

20.5
19.1

20.4
19.1

20.1
19.1

19.4
19.0

18.9
19.0

19.0
19.0

18.8
18.9

18.6
19.0

18.4
18.9

18.3
18.9

Deficit/Surplus:
Unified ...................
On-Budget ..............
Off-Budget ..............

–1.4
–2.3
0.9

–1.6
–2.5
0.9

–1.5
–2.4
0.9

–1.4
–2.4
1.0

–1.0
–2.0
1.1

–0.4
–1.5
1.1

0.2
–0.9
1.1

*
–1.1
1.1

0.2
–1.0
1.1

0.4
–0.8
1.2

0.5
–0.6
1.2

0.6
–0.5
1.2

* 0.05 percent or less.

305

BUDGET AGGREGATES

Table S–3.

SUMMARY OF RECEIPTS, OUTLAYS, AND SURPLUSES OR
DEFICITS (–): 1789–2002
(In millions of dollars)
Total

Year
Receipts
1789–1849 .....
1850–1900 .....
1901 ...............
1902 ...............
1903 ...............
1904 ...............
1905 ...............
1906 ...............
1907 ...............
1908 ...............
1909 ...............
1910 ...............
1911 ...............
1912 ...............
1913 ...............
1914 ...............
1915 ...............
1916 ...............
1917 ...............
1918 ...............
1919 ...............
1920 ...............
1921 ...............
1922 ...............
1923 ...............
1924 ...............
1925 ...............
1926 ...............
1927 ...............
1928 ...............
1929 ...............
1930 ...............
1931 ...............
1932 ...............
1933 ...............
1934 ...............
1935 ...............
1936 ...............
1937 ...............
1938 ...............
1939 ...............
1940 ...............
1941 ...............
1942 ...............
1943 ...............
1944 ...............
1945 ...............
1946 ...............
1947 ...............
1948 ...............
1949 ...............
1950 ...............
1951 ...............
1952 ...............
1953 ...............
1954 ...............
1955 ...............
1956 ...............
1957 ...............
1958 ...............
1959 ...............
1960 ...............
1961 ...............

1,160
14,462
588
562
562
541
544
595
666
602
604
676
702
693
714
725
683
761
1,101
3,645
5,130
6,649
5,571
4,026
3,853
3,871
3,641
3,795
4,013
3,900
3,862
4,058
3,116
1,924
1,997
2,955
3,609
3,923
5,387
6,751
6,295
6,548
8,712
14,634
24,001
43,747
45,159
39,296
38,514
41,560
39,415
39,443
51,616
66,167
69,608
69,701
65,451
74,587
79,990
79,636
79,249
92,492
94,388

Outlays
1,090
15,453
525
485
517
584
567
570
579
659
694
694
691
690
715
726
746
713
1,954
12,677
18,493
6,358
5,062
3,289
3,140
2,908
2,924
2,930
2,857
2,961
3,127
3,320
3,577
4,659
4,598
6,541
6,412
8,228
7,580
6,840
9,141
9,468
13,653
35,137
78,555
91,304
92,712
55,232
34,496
29,764
38,835
42,562
45,514
67,686
76,101
70,855
68,444
70,640
76,578
82,405
92,098
92,191
97,723

On-Budget
Surplus or
Deficit (–)

Receipts

70
–991
63
77
45
–43
–23
25
87
–57
–89
–18
11
3
–*
–*
–63
48
–853
–9,032
–13,363
291
509
736
713
963
717
865
1,155
939
734
738
–462
–2,735
–2,602
–3,586
–2,803
–4,304
–2,193
–89
–2,846
–2,920
–4,941
–20,503
–54,554
–47,557
–47,553
–15,936
4,018
11,796
580
–3,119
6,102
–1,519
–6,493
–1,154
–2,993
3,947
3,412
–2,769
–12,849
301
–3,335

1,160
14,462
588
562
562
541
544
595
666
602
604
676
702
693
714
725
683
761
1,101
3,645
5,130
6,649
5,571
4,026
3,853
3,871
3,641
3,795
4,013
3,900
3,862
4,058
3,116
1,924
1,997
2,955
3,609
3,923
5,122
6,364
5,792
5,998
8,024
13,738
22,871
42,455
43,849
38,057
37,055
39,944
37,724
37,336
48,496
62,573
65,511
65,112
60,370
68,162
73,201
71,587
70,953
81,851
82,279

Outlays
1,090
15,453
525
485
517
584
567
570
579
659
694
694
691
690
715
726
746
713
1,954
12,677
18,493
6,358
5,062
3,289
3,140
2,908
2,924
2,930
2,857
2,961
3,127
3,320
3,577
4,659
4,598
6,541
6,412
8,228
7,582
6,850
9,154
9,482
13,618
35,071
78,466
91,190
92,569
55,022
34,193
29,396
38,408
42,038
44,237
65,956
73,771
67,943
64,461
65,668
70,562
74,902
83,102
81,341
86,046

Off-Budget
Surplus or
Deficit (–)

Receipts

Outlays

Surplus or
Deficit (–)

70
–991
63
77
45
–43
–23
25
87
–57
–89
–18
11
3
–*
–*
–63
48
–853
–9,032
–13,363
291
509
736
713
963
717
865
1,155
939
734
738
–462
–2,735
–2,602
–3,586
–2,803
–4,304
–2,460
–486
–3,362
–3,484
–5,594
–21,333
–55,595
–48,735
–48,720
–16,964
2,861
10,548
–684
–4,702
4,259
–3,383
–8,259
–2,831
–4,091
2,494
2,639
–3,315
–12,149
510
–3,766

................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
265
387
503
550
688
896
1,130
1,292
1,310
1,238
1,459
1,616
1,690
2,106
3,120
3,594
4,097
4,589
5,081
6,425
6,789
8,049
8,296
10,641
12,109

................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
–2
–10
–13
–14
35
66
89
114
143
210
303
368
427
524
1,277
1,730
2,330
2,912
3,983
4,972
6,016
7,503
8,996
10,850
11,677

..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
..................
267
397
516
564
653
830
1,041
1,178
1,167
1,028
1,157
1,248
1,263
1,583
1,843
1,864
1,766
1,677
1,098
1,452
773
546
–700
–209
431

306

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table S–3.

SUMMARY OF RECEIPTS, OUTLAYS, AND SURPLUSES OR
DEFICITS (–): 1789–2002—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Total

Year

1962 ...............
1963 ...............
1964 ...............
1965 ...............
1966 ...............
1967 ...............
1968 ...............
1969 ...............
1970 ...............
1971 ...............
1972 ...............
1973 ...............
1974 ...............
1975 ...............
1976 ...............
TQ ..................
1977 ...............
1978 ...............
1979 ...............
1980 ...............
1981 ...............
1982 ...............
1983 ...............
1984 ...............
1985 ...............
1986 ...............
1987 ...............
1988 ...............
1989 ...............
1990 ...............
1991 ...............
1992 ...............
1993 ...............
1994 ...............
1995 ...............
1996 ...............
1997 est. ........
1998 est. ........
1999 est. ........
2000 est. ........
2001 est. ........
2002 est. ........

Receipts

Outlays

99,676
106,560
112,613
116,817
130,835
148,822
152,973
186,882
192,807
187,139
207,309
230,799
263,224
279,090
298,060
81,232
355,559
399,561
463,302
517,112
599,272
617,766
600,562
666,499
734,165
769,260
854,396
909,303
991,190
1,031,969
1,055,041
1,091,279
1,154,401
1,258,627
1,351,830
1,453,062
1,505,425
1,566,842
1,643,320
1,727,304
1,808,347
1,896,686

106,821
111,316
118,528
118,228
134,532
157,464
178,134
183,640
195,649
210,172
230,681
245,707
269,359
332,332
371,792
95,975
409,218
458,746
504,032
590,947
678,249
745,755
808,380
851,888
946,499
990,505
1,004,164
1,064,489
1,143,671
1,253,163
1,324,400
1,381,681
1,409,414
1,461,731
1,515,729
1,560,330
1,631,016
1,687,475
1,760,700
1,814,427
1,844,488
1,879,717

* $500 thousand or less.

On-Budget
Surplus or
Deficit (–)

Receipts

Outlays

–7,146
–4,756
–5,915
–1,411
–3,698
–8,643
–25,161
3,242
–2,842
–23,033
–23,373
–14,908
–6,135
–53,242
–73,732
–14,744
–53,659
–59,186
–40,729
–73,835
–78,976
–127,989
–207,818
–185,388
–212,334
–221,245
–149,769
–155,187
–152,481
–221,194
–269,359
–290,402
–255,013
–203,104
–163,899
–107,268
–125,591
–120,633
–117,380
–87,123
–36,141
16,969

87,405
92,385
96,248
100,094
111,749
124,420
128,056
157,928
159,348
151,294
167,402
184,715
209,299
216,633
231,671
63,216
278,741
314,169
365,309
403,903
469,097
474,299
453,242
500,424
547,994
569,031
640,994
667,812
727,525
750,314
761,157
788,853
842,467
923,601
1,000,751
1,085,570
1,116,522
1,161,898
1,218,124
1,280,408
1,340,730
1,406,821

93,286
96,352
102,794
101,699
114,817
137,040
155,798
158,436
168,042
177,346
193,824
200,118
217,270
271,892
302,183
76,555
328,502
369,089
404,054
476,618
543,053
594,351
661,272
686,074
769,692
807,007
810,332
861,798
932,760
1,028,098
1,082,713
1,129,343
1,142,827
1,182,359
1,227,065
1,259,872
1,316,014
1,358,896
1,422,832
1,463,751
1,479,969
1,499,370

Off-Budget
Surplus or
Deficit (–)

Receipts

–5,881
–3,966
–6,546
–1,605
–3,068
–12,620
–27,742
–507
–8,694
–26,052
–26,423
–15,403
–7,971
–55,260
–70,512
–13,339
–49,760
–54,920
–38,745
–72,715
–73,956
–120,052
–208,030
–185,650
–221,698
–237,976
–169,339
–193,986
–205,235
–277,784
–321,557
–340,489
–300,360
–258,758
–226,314
–174,302
–199,492
–196,998
–204,708
–183,343
–139,239
–92,549

12,271
14,175
16,366
16,723
19,085
24,401
24,917
28,953
33,459
35,845
39,907
46,084
53,925
62,458
66,389
18,016
76,817
85,391
97,994
113,209
130,176
143,467
147,320
166,075
186,171
200,228
213,402
241,491
263,666
281,656
293,885
302,426
311,934
335,026
351,079
367,492
388,903
404,944
425,196
446,896
467,617
489,865

Outlays
13,535
14,964
15,734
16,529
19,715
20,424
22,336
25,204
27,607
32,826
36,857
45,589
52,089
60,440
69,609
19,421
80,716
89,657
99,978
114,329
135,196
151,404
147,108
165,813
176,807
183,498
193,832
202,691
210,911
225,065
241,687
252,339
266,587
279,372
288,664
300,458
315,002
328,579
337,868
350,676
364,519
380,347

Surplus or
Deficit (–)
–1,265
–789
632
194
–630
3,978
2,581
3,749
5,852
3,019
3,050
495
1,836
2,018
–3,220
–1,405
–3,899
–4,266
–1,984
–1,120
–5,020
–7,937
212
262
9,363
16,731
19,570
38,800
52,754
56,590
52,198
50,087
45,347
55,654
62,415
67,034
73,901
76,365
87,328
96,220
103,098
109,518

1998 Budget Proposals

307

1998 BUDGET PROPOSALS
Table S–4.

SUMMARY OF BUDGET PROPOSALS
(In billions of dollars)
Estimate

Total
1998–
2002

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Current services deficit .....................................................
Programmatic changes:
Revenues:
Tax relief .....................................................................
Eliminate unwarranted benefits and other .............

127.7

119.5

140.1

127.6

108.5

100.8

1.4
–3.0

17.9
–10.9

16.2
–14.9

19.6
–15.9

21.9
–16.4

22.8
–17.9

98.4
–76.0

Total, revenues .......................................................

–1.6

7.0

1.4

3.7

5.5

4.9

22.4

Discretionary Programs:
Defense ........................................................................
Nondefense .................................................................

–0.7
*

–5.3
–0.6

–14.6
–3.3

–14.4
–8.3

–21.9
–18.8

–23.2
–27.0

–79.5
–58.0

–0.7

–5.9

–17.8

–22.7

–40.7

–50.2

–137.4

.............

–4.3

–11.4

–22.2

–27.8

–34.6

–100.2

*
.............

1.2
0.2

2.0
–1.6

2.6
–4.1

3.4
–7.3

3.9
–9.7

13.2
–22.4

*
.............
0.2

1.4
–2.1
5.1

0.4
–1.8
7.2

–1.4
–3.8
8.0

–3.9
–6.3
5.4

–5.8
–22.1
–1.4

–9.3
–36.1
24.3

Total, discretionary programs ...............................
Mandatory Programs:
Medicare .....................................................................
Medicaid:
New initiatives ........................................................
Savings proposals ...................................................
Net savings, Medicaid ........................................
Spectrum auction receipts .........................................
Other mandatory programs .......................................
Total, mandatory programs ...................................

0.3

0.1

–5.6

–19.4

–32.6

–63.8

–121.2

Total, programmatic changes ...........................................
Debt service ....................................................................

–2.0
–0.1

1.2
–0.1

–22.0
–0.7

–38.4
–2.1

–67.8
–4.5

–109.2
–8.5

–236.3
–15.9

Total, proposals .................................................................
Resulting deficit/surplus (–) .............................................

–2.1
125.6

1.1
120.6

–22.7
117.4

–40.5
87.1

–72.3
36.1

–117.7
–17.0

–252.1

* $50 million or less.

309

310

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table S–5.

CURRENT SERVICES AND PROPOSED DISCRETIONARY
SPENDING LEVELS
(In billions of dollars)
Estimate

Current Services Baseline:
Defense Discretionary ..............................................................
Non-Defense Discretionary .....................................................

Total current services ..........................................................
Proposed Levels:
Defense Discretionary ..............................................................
Non-Defense Discretionary .....................................................

Total discretionary proposals 1 ............................................
Discretionary savings from current services baseline:
Defense Discretionary ..............................................................
Non-Defense Discretionary .....................................................

Total savings .........................................................................

1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Total,
1998–
2002

BA
OL
BA
OL

265.8
268.7
242.9
282.0

273.6
265.4
257.8
288.0

281.8
276.7
269.2
298.7

290.2
282.2
279.2
304.4

298.9
290.5
288.9
311.3

307.8
297.1
298.8
320.3

1,452.3
1,411.9
1,393.8
1,522.6

BA
OL

508.8
550.7

531.4
553.4

551.0
575.4

569.4
586.6

587.7
601.8

606.6
617.4

2,846.1
2,934.5

BA
OL
BA
OL

263.1
268.0
242.7
282.1

266.0
260.1
264.5
287.3

269.8
262.1
265.6
295.4

275.5
267.7
267.0
296.2

282.0
268.6
267.4
292.5

289.8
273.9
270.8
293.3

1,383.1
1,332.4
1,335.3
1,464.7

BA
OL

505.8
550.1

530.5
547.5

535.4
557.5

542.5
563.9

549.4
561.0

560.7
567.2

2,718.4
2,797.1

BA
OL
BA
OL

–2.8
–0.7
–0.2
0.0

–7.6
–5.3
6.7
–0.6

–11.9
–14.6
–3.7
–3.3

–14.7
–14.4
–12.1
–8.3

–16.9
–21.9
–21.4
–18.8

–18.1
–23.2
–28.0
–27.0

–69.2
–79.5
–58.5
–58.0

BA
OL

–3.0
–0.7

–0.9
–5.9

–15.6
–17.8

–26.8
–22.7

–38.3
–40.7

–46.0
–50.2

–127.7
–137.4

1 The budget proposes a five-year budget resolution by function, from 1998 through 2002, consistent with the level of discretionary spending assumed in the budget, which achieves balance in 2002.

311

1998 BUDGET PROPOSALS

Table S–6.

MANDATORY BUDGET PROPOSALS BY PROGRAM
(In millions of dollars)
Estimate
1997

Preserve Medicare .............................................................
Strengthen Medicaid:
Savings proposals ...........................................................
New initiatives:
Children’s health initiatives ..........................................
Welfare reform proposals ..............................................
Effects of other mandatory proposals ...........................

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Total
1998–2002

............ –4,310 –11,390 –22,150 –27,820 –34,550 –100,220
............

205

–1,597

–4,059

–7,313

–9,666

–22,430

............
39
............

344
619
249

587
793
629

934
975
736

1,362
1,194
873

1,530
1,315
1,038

4,757
4,896
3,525

Subtotal, new initiatives ..............................................

39

1,212

2,009

2,645

3,429

3,883

13,178

Net savings, Medicaid .......................................................
Spectrum:
Broaden and extend non-broadcast auctions ...................
Auction analog broadcast ..................................................
Auction 888 phone numbers .............................................
Auction a portion of the broadcast channels 60–69 ........

39

1,417

412

–1,414

–3,884

–5,783

–9,252

............ –1,400 –1,800 –3,800 –4,500 –5,600
............ ............ .............. .............. .............. –14,800
............
–700 .............. .............. .............. ..............
............ ............ .............. .............. –1,800 –1,700

–17,100
–14,800
–700
–3,500

............ –2,100

–36,100

Subtotal, Spectrum ............................................................
Other mandatory:
Agriculture:
Amend Welfare Reform Food Stamps provisions ........
Shift fund for Rural America from 2000 to 1998 to
correct a drafting error ..............................................
Enhance the farm income ‘‘safety net’’ .........................
Use certain Forest Service fees to protect forest
ecosystems ...................................................................
Have beneficiaries of marketing orders pay administrative costs .................................................................
Subtotal, Agriculture .........................................................
Commerce:
Extend surcharge on patent fees ..................................
Defense:
Sell from National Defense Stockpile ...........................
Education:
Student loans:
Reduce payments to lenders, restructure guaranty
agencies and recover Federal reserves, reduce
Federal administrative funding, and reduce borrower fees ................................................................
Improve third grade literacy .....................................
Invest in school construction .....................................
Repeal the mandatory appropriation under the
Smith-Hughes Act of 1918 .....................................

362

836

............
............

25
–21

–1,800

–3,800

659

600

–6,300 –22,100

405

835

3,335

40 ..............
–30
–25
–2
–2 .............. ..............

10
–25

............ ............ .............. .............. .............. .............. ................
............

–10

–11

–11

–11

–11

–54

362

830

686

587

364

799

3,266

............ ............

–119

–119

–119

–119

–476

............ ............ .............. .............. ..............

–200

–200

–209 –1,294
331
380
1,250 ..............

–3,127
1,238
5,000

–340 –1,050
............
31
............ 1,250
–1

–226
284
1,250

–7

–7

–7

–7

–29

Subtotal, Education ...........................................................
–340
230
1,107
1,301
1,365
Energy:
Lease excess Strategic petroleum reserve storage
space ............................................................................ ............ ............
–14
–37
–67
Sell Weeks Island Strategic petroleum reserve oil ...... ............ ............ .............. .............. ..............
Sell or lease naval petroleum and oil shale reserves
............ ............
–10
2
2

–921

3,082

–83
–1,145
2

–201
–1,145
–4

–1,226

–1,350

Subtotal, Energy ................................................................
Health and Human Services:
Set annual targets to increase permanent adoptions
and establish a financial bonus to states for increasing adoptions 1 ....................................................
Permit States to spend HCFA initial survey and certification fee (offset under revenue) ..........................
Establish health insurance for the families of workers in-between jobs .....................................................
Establish purchasing cooperative grants .....................

............

–348
212
1,250

............ ............

–24

–35

–65

............ ............ .............. .............. .............. .............. ................
............

10

10

10

............
............

1,738
25

2,472
25

2,688
25

10

10

50

2,924 ..............
25
25

9,822
125

312

Table S–6.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

MANDATORY BUDGET PROPOSALS BY PROGRAM—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Estimate
1997

Expand health coverage for children ............................ ............
Subtotal, Health and Human Services ............................
Housing and Urban Development:
Replace FHA single family loan limits with conforming limit .......................................................................
Reform FHA single family assignment ........................
Retain receipts by proposing to lower administrative
expenses for FHA single family assignment (nonpaygo) ..........................................................................
Undertake FHA portfolio reengineering:
Paygo ...........................................................................
Non-paygo ...................................................................
Subtotal, Housing and Urban Development ....................
Interior:
Extend and index hardrock mining holding fees on
public lands .................................................................
Establish hardrock mining royalties on public domain lands (5 percent on net smelter return) ..........
Charge sugar assessment for Everglades restoration
Impose Hetch Hetchy Dam (CA) rental payments ......
Extend National Park Service fee demonstration authority through 2002; make all new receipts available to parks 2 .............................................................
Subtotal, Interior ...............................................................
Labor:
Increase Federal Unemployment Trust Fund ceilings
(net of administrative distribution to the States) ....
Extend the NAFTA Transitional Adjustment Assistance program ..............................................................
Move 1 million welfare recipients into jobs by 2000 ...
Reduce unemployment compensation payments from
increased attention to integrity activities in State
unemployment insurance operations (non-paygo) ...
Improve management of Workers’ Compensation benefits (non-paygo) .........................................................
Subtotal, Labor ..................................................................
State:
Delay foreign service retirement COLA .......................
Transportation:
Extend vessel tonnage fees ...........................................
Convert Boat Safety State Grant program to mandatory ...............................................................................
Transform St. Lawrence Seaway Development Corporation into a Performance Based Organization ....
Decrease Federal-aid highways minimum allocation
Sell Governor’s Island ....................................................
Sell Union Station air rights .........................................

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Total
1998–2002

750

750

750

750

750

3,750

............

2,523

3,257

3,473

3,709

785

13,747

............
............

–206
–164

–226
–220

–222
–182

–220
–177

–224
–171

–1,098
–914

............

–33

–46

–60

–74

–89

–302

............
............

–665 .............. .............. .............. ..............
523
899
864
–888 –1,069

–665
329

............

–545

407

400

–1,359

–1,553

–2,650

............

–1

–32

–33

–34

–35

–135

–42
–63
–35
–35
–4 .............. .............. ..............
–1
–1
–1
–1

–175
–22
–5

............ ............
............
–18
............
–1

............ ............ .............. .............. .............. .............. ................
............

–20

–79

–97

–70

–71

–337

............ ............ ..............

–200

–200

–200

–600

............ ............
............
600

26
975

43
1,000

48
400

50
25

167
3,000

............

–118

–158

–160

–162

–165

–763

............

4

–20

–41

–49

–44

–150

............

486

823

642

37

–334

1,654

............

–4

–4

–4

–4

–4

–20

............ ............

–62

–62

–62

–62

–248

27

35

35

35

147

............
11
12
13
13
............
15
56
35
–22
............ ............ .............. .............. ..............
............ ............ .............. .............. ..............

13
–82
–500
–40

62
2
–500
–40

............

15

Subtotal, Transportation ................................................... ............
41
Treasury:
Charge vendors for the cost of making payments by
paper check ................................................................. ............
–15
Provide funding for job training assistance for Puerto
Rico .............................................................................. ............ ............
Subtotal, Treasury ............................................................. ............
Veterans:
Move medical care existing collections to discretionary ......................................................................... ............

33

21

–36

–636

–577

–10

–5

–5

–5

–40

67

167

286

424

944

–15

57

162

281

419

904

468

309

356

403

452

1,988

313

1998 BUDGET PROPOSALS

Table S–6.

MANDATORY BUDGET PROPOSALS BY PROGRAM—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Estimate
1997

Compensation and Pensions:
Extend rounding down for compensation COLA .....
Extend income verification of pension beneficiaries
Limit pension benefits to Medicaid-eligible beneficiaries in nursing homes 3 ....................................
Housing:
Enable VA to use Federal salary and tax refund
offset to collect on deficiency balances for defaulted loans guaranteed prior to 1990 .................
Extend three provisions that maintain higher loan
fees and reduce resale losses on foreclosed properties ........................................................................
Increase fees for non-veterans in the home loan
program to match FHA ..........................................
Permanently extend loan asset sale enhancement
authority ..................................................................

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Total
1998–2002

............
–17
............ ............

–38
–10

–60
–23

–76
–36

–95
–51

–286
–120

............ ............

–506

–516

–530

–541

–2,093

–127 .............. .............. .............. ..............

–127

............

............ ............

–204

–198

–197

–192

–791

............

–25

–26

–26

–26

–27

–130

............

–4

–4

–5

–5

–4

–22

Subtotal, Veterans ............................................................. ............
District of Columbia:
Assume liabilities of the DC pension system ............... ............
Receive reimbursement from DC pension system assets ............................................................................... ............

295

–479

–472

–467

–458

–1,581

422

425

451

479

506

2,283

–422

–425

–451

–479

–506

–2,283

Subtotal, District of Columbia ..........................................
Environmental Protection Agency:
Provide funding for Superfund orphan shares ............
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation:
Collect state bank exam fees (net of premium reduction) ..............................................................................
Federal Trade Commission:
Increase Hart-Scott Rodino merger filing fees ............
Japan-United State Friendship Commission:
Privatize the Japan/United State Friendship Commission ........................................................................
Office of Personnel Management:
Delay civilian retirement COLA ...................................
Increase agency contributions to CSRS (non-paygo) ...

............ ............ .............. .............. .............. .............. ................
............

142

162

184

............

–79

–82

161 .............. .............. ................

............

–70

–70

–70

............

192

–70

200

880

–70

–350

37 .............. .............. .............. ..............

37

............
............

–274
–621

–281
–604

–289
–588

–297
–577

–305
–567

–1,446
–2,957

Subtotal, Office of Personnel Management ..................... ............
Postal Service:
Repeal Workers’ Compensation Reimbursement to
the United States Postal Service:
Paygo ........................................................................... ............
Non-paygo ................................................................... ............

–895

–885

–877

–874

–872

–4,403

–33
–32
–30
–29
8 .............. .............. ..............

–159
43

–25

–32

–30

–29

–116

Subtotal, Postal Service ....................................................
Railroad Retirement Board:
Conform railroad retirement Social Security equivalent benefits with Social Security .............................
Social Security Administration:
Amend welfare reform provisions to exempt disabled
immigrants from Supplemental Security Income
restrictions and extend eligibility for refugees and
asylees .........................................................................
Test employment strategy for the disabled:
Paygo ...........................................................................
Non-paygo ...................................................................
Subtotal, test employment strategy for the disabled
Subtotal, Social Security Administration ........................

–35
35

............ ............

............

31

46

46

47

47

217

224

1,707

1,824

2,096

1,907

2,184

9,718

............
–4
............ ............

–4
–5

–4
1

–3
7

–3
13

–18
16

............

–4

–9

–3

4

10

–2

224

1,703

1,815

2,093

1,911

2,194

9,716

314

Table S–6.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

MANDATORY BUDGET PROPOSALS BY PROGRAM—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Estimate
1997

1998

1999

Undistributed Offsetting Receipts:
Effects of lower pay raise impact on agency payments
to the civilian service retirement trust fund (nonpaygo) .......................................................................... ............
436
Other proposals:
Other paygo proposals ................................................... ............
1
Other non-paygo proposals (largely effects of pay
raise) ............................................................................ ............ ............
Subtotal, other mandatory outlay proposals ..............
246
Total, mandatory outlay proposals ...............................
285
Non-paygo ........................................................................... ............
Paygo:.
Mandatory ......................................................................
285
Paygo funding of discretionary spending that requires adjusting the discretionary caps (see below) ............
Total, paygo proposals .......................................................
Paygo funding of discretionary spending funded by
governmental receipts that requires adjusting
the discretionary caps:
HHS:.
Increase spending from Food and Drug Administration user fees ...............................................................
Labor:
Increase spending from alien labor certification fee ...
State:
Increase spending from State immigration, passport
and other fees .............................................................
Transportation:
Increase spending from aviation fees ...........................
National Transportation and Safety Board:
Increase spending from user fees .................................

2000

2001

Total
1998–2002

2002

602

630

664

701

3,033

1

1

1

1

5

–10

–35

–48

–63

–156

5,127
134
226

7,219
7,960
5,429 –1,410
24,325
–5,559 –19,404 –32,575 –63,843 –121,247
666
611 –1,127 –1,283
–907

–92

–6,225 –20,015 –31,448 –62,560 –120,340

971

5,137

6,564

7,195

7,592

27,459

–1,088 –13,451 –24,253 –54,968

–92,881

285

879

............

237

252

267

282

297

1,335

............

25

50

50

50

50

225

............

506

566

589

595

595

2,851

............

198

4,263

5,653

6,263

6,645

23,022

............

5

6

5

5

5

26

Total, paygo funding of discretionary spending funded by
governmental receipts that requires adjusting the discretionary caps ................................................................... ............

971

5,137

6,564

7,195

7,592

27,459

MEMORANDUM
Welfare Reform proposals included above:
Medicaid .............................................................................
Agriculture: Food Stamps .................................................
Social Security Administration: Supplementary Security Income ......................................................................

39
362

619
836

793
659

975
600

1,194
405

1,315
835

4,896
3,335

224

1,707

1,824

2,096

1,907

2,184

9,718

Total, Welfare Reform proposals ......................................

625

3,162

3,276

3,671

3,506

4,334

17,949

Note: All savings are paygo, unless otherwise stated.
1 The budget includes a proposal to pay incentive payments to States that increase adoptions from the foster care system. The budget
assumes incentive payments of up to $108 million over 1999–2002 for these payments. It is anticipated that reduced foster care payments
would offset the outlays from any incentives paid.
2 Also affects Bureau of Land Management, Fish and Wildlife Services, and Forest Service. Current proposal would make available all
new receipts to the collections agency (no net savings).
3 Net Government savings is $300 million less annually because of offsetting costs to the Medicaid program.

315

1998 BUDGET PROPOSALS

Table S–7.

EFFECT OF PROPOSALS ON RECEIPTS
(In millions of dollars)
Estimate
1997

Provide tax relief and extend expiring provisions:
Middle Class Bill of Rights:
Provide tax credit for dependent children .......................
–718
Expand Individual Retirement Accounts (IRAs) ............. ..............
Provide tax incentive for education and training ............
–84
Subtotal, Middle Class Bill of Rights ...........................
Provide targeted welfare-to-work tax credit ....................
Provide capital gains exclusion on sale of principal residence ................................................................................
Establish DC tax incentive program ................................
Provide estate tax relief for small business .....................
Provide tax incentives for distressed areas .....................
Provide tax credit for investment in community development financial institutions (CDFI) ...........................
Toll statute of limitations for incapacitated taxpayers ...
Allow Foreign Sales Corporation (FSC) benefits for
computer software licenses ............................................
Extend exclusion for employer-provided educational assistance ............................................................................
Extend R&E tax credit ......................................................
Extend orphan drug tax credit .........................................
Extend work opportunity tax credit .................................
Extend deduction for contributions of appreciated stock
Extend and modify Puerto Rico economic-activity tax
credit ................................................................................
Subtotal, Provide tax relief and extend expiring
provisions ..................................................................
Eliminate unwarranted benefits and adopt other revenue measures:
Deny interest deduction on certain debt instruments ........
Defer original issue discount deduction on convertible
debt .....................................................................................
Limit dividends-received deduction (DRD):
Reduce DRD to 50 percent ................................................
Eliminate DRD for certain stock ......................................
Modify holding period for DRD .........................................
Interaction ..........................................................................
Extend pro-rata disallowance of tax-exempt interest to all
corporations. .......................................................................
Require average-cost basis for stocks, securities, etc. ........
Require recognition of gain on certain stocks, indebtedness and partnership interests .........................................
Change the treatment of gains and losses on extinguishment ....................................................................................
Require reasonable payment assumptions for interest accruals on certain debt instruments ..................................
Require gain recognition for certain extraordinary dividends ...................................................................................
Repeal percentage depletion for non-fuel minerals mined
on Federal and formerly Federal lands ............................
Modify loss carryback and carryforward rules ....................
Treat certain preferred stock as ‘‘boot’’ ................................
Repeal tax free conversions of large C corporations to S
corporations ........................................................................

2001

Total
1998–
2002

1998

1999

2000

2002

–9,889
–1,454
–4,044

–6,806
–477
–6,199

–8,552 –10,387 –10,369 –46,003
–753 –1,157 –1,674 –5,515
–7,848 –8,632 –9,386 –36,109

–802 –15,387 –13,482 –17,153 –20,176 –21,429 –87,627
..............

–68

–137

–163

–122

–61

–551

–71
..............
..............
–40

–288
–24
–1
–424

–301
–46
–164
–500

–284
–56
–166
–502

–268
–66
–174
–469

–249
–68
–182
–410

–1,390
–260
–687
–2,305

..............
–2
–5
–7
.............. .............. .............. ..............

–9
–6

–11
–49

–34
–55

–120

–130

–550

–670
–758
–247 ..............
–540
–234
–111
–41
–12
–3
–3
–1
–157
–93
–31
–10
–38 .............. .............. ..............

–2,320
–1,713
–38
–419
–72

–10

–90

–82
–430
–8
..............
..............

–645
–787
–19
–128
–34

..............

–27

–100

–68

–110

–91

–109

–122

–417

–1,443 –17,924 –16,220 –19,620 –21,911 –22,763 –98,438

15

52

103

158

213

271

797

..............

12

21

32

43

52

160

..............
..............
..............
..............

255
13
36
–8

339
23
26
–8

354
36
27
–8

370
49
28
–9

387
63
29
–9

1,705
184
146
–42

..............
..............

16
638

31
601

45
594

56
589

65
589

213
3,011

..............

38

61

65

71

76

311

..............

6

6

6

7

7

32

..............

79

234

288

289

207

1,097

401

586

6

11

17

23

643

8
5
25

89
144
145

92
617
163

94
798
172

96
690
180

97
629
144

468
2,878
804

..............

1

12

26

35

45

119

316

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table S–7.

EFFECT OF PROPOSALS ON RECEIPTS—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Estimate
1997

Require gain recognition in certain distributions of controlled corporation stock ....................................................
Reform treatment of certain stock transfers .......................
Expand subpart F provisions regarding certain income ....
Modify taxation of captive ‘‘insurance’’ companies .............
Modify foreign tax credit carryback and carryforward
rules ....................................................................................
Replace sales source rules with activity-based rules ..........
Modify rules relating to foreign oil and gas extraction income ....................................................................................
Phase out preferential tax deferral for certain large farm
corporations required to use accrual accounting .............
Initiate Inventory reform:
Repeal lower of cost or market method ............................
Repeal components of cost method ...................................
Expand requirement that involuntarily converted property be replaced with property acquired from an unrelated party ..........................................................................
Place further restrictions on like-kind exchanges involving personal property .........................................................
Require registration of certain corporate tax shelters .......
Require reporting of payments to corporations rendering
service to Federal agencies ...............................................
Increase penalties for failure to file correct information
returns ................................................................................
Tighten substantial understatement penalty for large corporations .............................................................................
Repeal exemption for withholding on gambling winnings
from bingo and keno in excess of $5,000 .........................
Require tax reporting for payments to attorneys ...............
Extend oil spill excise tax 1 ...................................................
Impose excise taxes on kerosene as diesel fuel 1 .................
Limit extension of tax credit for producing fuel from a
nonconventional source .....................................................
Extend and modify FUTA provisions:
Extend FUTA surtax 1 .......................................................
Accelerate deposit of unemployment insurance taxes ....
Subtotal, Eliminate unwarranted benefits ..........
Other provisions that affect receipts:
Extend corporate environmental tax 2 .................................
Extend Superfund excise taxes 1 ..........................................
Extend LUST excise taxes 1 ..................................................
Extend aviation excise taxes/new user fee 1, 3 .....................
Extend GSP and modify other trade provisions 1 ...............
Assess fees for examination of FDIC-insured banks and
bank holding companies (receipt effect) 1 .........................
Modify method of reimbursing Federal Reserve Banks
(receipt effect) .....................................................................
Establish IRS continuous levy ..............................................
Assess fees for NTSB aviation accident investigation activities 1 ...............................................................................
Establish alien labor certification fee 1 ................................
Exempt Federal vaccine purchases from the payment of
vaccine excise taxes 1 .........................................................
Extend and increase FDA user fees 1 ...................................
Initiate HCFA Medicare survey and certification fee 1 ......

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Total
1998–
2002

10
31
..............
..............

62
114
19
26

67
127
34
18

71
137
39
13

73
146
44
7

76
155
48
4

349
679
184
68

..............
..............

50
891

263
1,474

340
1,555

293
1,750

275
1,855

1,221
7,525

..............

4

59

97

104

107

371

28

136

121

124

124

124

629

20
39

213
130

351
178

372
187

378
196

179
204

1,493
895

..............

2

4

5

8

10

29

2
..............

7
1

12
3

17
2

23
2

29
2

88
10

..............

1

7

21

45

77

151

..............

3

16

21

24

26

90

..............

24

40

41

35

29

169

1
17
.............. ..............
26
222
4
35

4
3
224
33

1
3
228
31

1
2
230
30

1
2
231
30

24
10
1,135
159

96

99

101

102

462

.............. ..............
862
1,218
1,295
.............. .............. .............. .............. ..............

1,333
1,320

4,708
1,320

14

64

629

4,123

6,323

7,320

7,635

8,894

34,295

..............
110
16
2,291
..............

1,095
661
120
5,017
–665

732
675
126
6,678
–509

767
687
128
6,647
–648

785
697
131
6,824
–732

803
708
134
7,007
–771

4,182
3,428
639
32,173
–3,325

..............

72

75

78

82

86

393

..............
..............

122
402

125
398

129
364

132
269

136
212

644
1,645

..............
..............

5
19

5
37

5
37

5
37

5
37

25
167

–72 .............. .............. .............. ..............
178
189
200
211
223
7
7
7
7
7

–72
1,001
35

..............
..............
..............

317

1998 BUDGET PROPOSALS

Table S–7.

EFFECT OF PROPOSALS ON RECEIPTS—Continued
(In millions of dollars)
Estimate
1997

1998

Increase employee contributions to CSRS and FERS ........ .............. ..............
Adjust Federal pay raise (receipt effect) .............................. ..............
–164

1999

2000

2001

2002

Total
1998–
2002

214
–216

423
–213

571
–212

621
–212

1,829
–1,017

Subtotal, Other provisions ...........................................

2,417

6,797

8,536

8,611

8,807

8,996

41,747

Subtotal, Eliminate unwarranted benefits and
other provisions that affect receipts .....................

3,046

10,920

14,859

15,931

16,442

17,890

76,042

Total effect of proposals 1 .............................................

1,603

–7,004

–1,361

–3,689

–5,469

–4,873 –22,396

(Paygo proposals) 1 .....................................................
1,603
(Non-Paygo proposals) 1 ............................................ ..............

–6,890
–114

–1,270
–91

–3,605
–84

–5,389
–80

–4,797 –21,951
–76
–445

1 Net

of income offsets.
of deductibility for income tax purposes.
3 The aviation excise taxes are proposed to be reinstated effective April 1, 1997. In addition, the Administration proposes
that aviation excise taxes be repealed effective October 1, 1998 and replaced with cost-based user fees.
2 Net

318

Table S–8.

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

SUMMARY OF SUPPLEMENTAL AND RESCISSION PROPOSALS
(In millions of dollars)
Budget Authority
1997

1998

1999

Outlays
1997

1998

1999

Supplemental Increases in Discretionary Programs:
Department of Agriculture ........................................
106 .......... ..........
91
9 ............
Department of Defense ..............................................
2,098 .......... .......... 1,572
404
71
Department of Housing and Urban Development ...
30 .......... .......... ............
3
21
Department of Labor ................................................. .............. .......... ..........
–45
30 ............
Department of State .................................................. .............. ..........
921 ............ ............
921
Department of Transportation .................................. .............. .......... ..........
47
168
52
Other Independent Agencies .....................................
20 .......... ..........
18
2 ............
Subtotal, Supplemental Increases in Discretionary Programs ................................................
Decreases in Discretionary Programs:
Department of Agriculture ........................................
Department of Defense ..............................................
Corps of Engineers—Civil .........................................
Department of Housing and Urban Development ...
Subtotal, Decreases in Discretionary Programs ......................................................................

2,254 ..........
–50
–4,872
–50
–280

..........
..........
..........
..........

921

1,683

616

1,065

2000

2001

2002

..........
..........
6
15
..........
15
..........

..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
9
..........

..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
8
..........

36

9

8

..........
–28
–18
–3 .......... .......... ..........
.......... –2,314 –1,333
–825 .......... .......... ..........
..........
–30
–20 ............ .......... .......... ..........
..........
–16
–33
–47
–40
–37
–33

–5,252 .......... .......... –2,388 –1,404

–875

–40

–37

–33

Supplemental Increases in Mandatory Programs:
Department of Transportation ..................................
Department of Veterans Affairs ...............................

4 .......... ..........
753 .......... ..........

4 ............ ............ .......... .......... ..........
753 ............ ............ .......... .......... ..........

Subtotal, Supplemental Increases in Mandatory Programs ......................................................

757 .......... ..........

757 ............ ............ .......... .......... ..........

Total, All Proposals ............................................

–2,241 ..........

921

52

–788

190

–4

–28

–25

319

1998 BUDGET PROPOSALS

Table S–9.

DISCRETIONARY PROPOSALS BY APPROPRIATIONS
SUBCOMMITTEE
(In millions of dollars)

Appropriations Subcommittee

1996 Enacted
BA

Outlays

1997 Estimate
BA

Outlays

1998 Proposed
BA

Outlays

Change:
1997 to 1998
BA

Outlays

General Purpose Discretionary
Agriculture and Rural Development ...........
Commerce, Justice, State, and the Judiciary ..............................................................
National Security ..........................................
District of Columbia .....................................
Energy and Water Development .................
Foreign Operations .......................................
Interior and Related Agencies .....................
Labor, HHS, and Education .........................
Legislative .....................................................
Military Construction ...................................
Transportation and Related Agengies .........
Treasury, Postal Service and General Government ......................................................
Veterans Affairs, HUD, and Independent
Agencies .....................................................
Subtotal, General Purpose Discretionary

13,776

13,672

13,644

14,480

13,839

13,889

195

–591

23,876
242,556
712
19,624
12,331
12,808
67,183
2,121
11,150
12,573

23,962
243,254
712
21,603
12,600
13,294
67,895
2,161
10,511
35,916

25,191
238,967
719
19,919
12,244
12,751
74,346
2,169
9,984
12,735

25,232
242,835
719
21,275
13,194
13,628
73,114
2,247
10,920
35,505

26,362
243,290
770
23,000
16,846
13,107
79,602
2,386
8,383
12,416

26,455
238,581
532
19,677
13,165
13,520
75,641
2,373
9,521
35,729

1,171
4,323
51
3,081
4,602
356
5,256
217
1,601
–319

1,223
–4,254
–187
–1,598
–29
–108
2,527
126
–1,399
224

11,444

11,594

12,054

12,213

13,057

12,520

1,003

307

68,211

75,939

64,280

80,457

71,921

80,575

7,641

118

498,366

533,114

499,004

545,820

524,980

542,178

25,976

–3,642

3,956
53

1,175
26

4,525
61

2,508
47

5,238
144

4,705
76

713
83

2,197
29

77

55

84

81

118

102

34

21

4,086

1,256

4,670

2,636

5,500

4,883

830

2,247

502,452 534,370 503,674 548,456 530,479 547,061

26,805

–1,395

Violent Crime Reduction Trust Fund
(VCRTF)
Commerce, Justice, State, and the Judiciary ..............................................................
Labor, HHS, and Education .........................
Treasury, Postal Service, and General Government ......................................................
Subtotal, VCRTF .......................................
Total, Discretionary ..........................
Memorandum:
Amounts
Excluded
From Budget Resolution Allocations
And Not Included Above
National Security .......................................... .............. ..............
Transportation and Related Agencies ......... .............. ..............

2,078
20

1,567 ..............
18 ..............

399 .............. ..............
2 .............. ..............

Total, Supplemental Requests for
Emergency Funding .......................... .............. ..............

2,098

1,585 ..............

401 .............. ..............

Summaries by Agency

321

SUMMARIES BY AGENCY
Table S–10.

DISCRETIONARY BUDGET AUTHORITY BY AGENCY
(In billions of dollars)

Agency

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Legislative Branch ...........................................................
The Judiciary ...................................................................
Executive Office Of the President ..................................
Funds Appropriated to the President ............................
Agriculture .......................................................................
Commerce .........................................................................
Defense—Military ............................................................
Defense—Civil ..................................................................
Education ..........................................................................
Energy ..............................................................................
Health and Human Services ...........................................
Housing and Urban Development ..................................
Interior .............................................................................
Justice ...............................................................................
Labor .................................................................................
State ..................................................................................
Transportation .................................................................
Treasury ...........................................................................
Veterans Affairs ...............................................................
Environmental Protection Agency ..................................
General Services Administration ...................................
National Aeronautics and Space Administration ..........
Office of Personnel Management ....................................
Small Business Administration ......................................
Social Security Administration .......................................
Other Independent Agencies ...........................................

2.2
2.8
0.2
10.8
15.3
3.7
253.6
3.4
21.4
16.4
33.2
21.7
7.1
14.6
9.4
4.7
12.7
10.4
18.3
6.5
0.2
13.9
0.2
0.8
5.0
14.0

2.2
3.0
0.2
10.8
15.3
3.8
250.9
3.5
26.2
16.5
34.1
19.3
6.9
16.3
10.2
4.8
12.8
10.6
18.9
6.8
0.6
13.7
0.2
0.9
5.6
11.7

2.4
3.4
0.2
15.6
15.1
4.2
251.6
3.8
29.1
19.2
36.3
24.8
7.4
17.1
10.8
5.1
12.5
11.8
18.7
7.6
0.2
13.5
0.2
0.7
5.6
13.6

2.4
3.5
0.2
11.9
15.2
4.9
257.2
3.4
29.8
17.6
36.6
28.4
7.4
17.8
10.6
5.8
13.7
11.8
18.7
7.7
0.1
13.4
0.2
0.7
5.5
10.8

2.5
3.6
0.2
11.8
15.4
6.1
263.5
3.4
30.5
16.7
36.8
30.3
7.6
16.8
10.6
4.9
13.9
11.4
18.7
7.1
0.1
13.2
0.2
0.7
5.5
10.9

2.5
3.7
0.2
11.4
15.5
4.0
270.3
3.4
31.1
16.3
37.1
31.7
7.5
17.0
10.7
5.0
14.1
11.6
18.7
7.2
0.1
13.2
0.2
0.7
5.5
10.7

2.5
3.8
0.2
11.3
15.8
4.0
278.4
3.4
31.5
15.8
37.4
33.0
7.5
17.5
10.9
5.0
14.3
11.8
18.7
7.3
0.1
13.2
0.2
0.7
5.5
10.7

Total .................................................................................

502.5

505.8

530.5

535.4

542.5

549.4

560.6

323

324

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table S–11.

DISCRETIONARY OUTLAYS BY AGENCY
(In billions of dollars)

Agency

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Legislative Branch ...........................................................
The Judiciary ...................................................................
Executive Office Of the President ..................................
Funds Appropriated to the President ............................
Agriculture .......................................................................
Commerce .........................................................................
Defense—Military ............................................................
Defense—Civil ..................................................................
Education ..........................................................................
Energy ..............................................................................
Health and Human Services ...........................................
Housing and Urban Development ..................................
Interior .............................................................................
Justice ...............................................................................
Labor .................................................................................
State ..................................................................................
Transportation .................................................................
Treasury ...........................................................................
Veterans Affairs ...............................................................
Environmental Protection Agency ..................................
General Services Administration ...................................
National Aeronautics and Space Administration ..........
Office of Personnel Management ....................................
Small Business Administration ......................................
Social Security Administration .......................................
Other Independent Agencies ...........................................

2.2
2.9
0.2
11.4
15.1
3.8
253.7
3.8
23.2
18.4
32.3
31.4
7.0
11.5
9.6
4.5
36.3
10.2
18.1
6.3
0.7
13.9
0.1
0.9
4.6
12.2

2.3
3.1
0.2
11.8
16.2
3.9
255.2
3.7
25.3
17.7
34.0
33.4
7.5
13.5
10.1
5.1
35.9
10.5
19.0
6.5
0.9
13.7
0.2
0.8
5.6
13.9

2.4
3.3
0.2
11.9
15.2
4.2
248.4
3.5
26.3
16.8
35.4
34.0
7.3
16.6
10.5
5.1
36.0
11.1
18.6
6.7
0.4
13.6
0.2
0.8
5.7
13.4

2.4
3.5
0.2
11.7
15.2
4.7
250.1
3.4
29.5
17.0
36.3
34.3
7.5
18.0
10.5
5.8
36.1
11.8
18.7
7.1
0.3
13.5
0.2
0.7
5.6
13.2

2.5
3.6
0.2
11.8
15.2
6.4
255.9
3.4
30.0
16.8
36.7
33.9
7.6
18.4
10.5
4.9
36.1
11.9
18.7
7.3
0.2
13.2
0.2
0.7
5.6
12.0

2.5
3.6
0.2
11.6
15.4
4.1
256.9
3.4
30.5
16.4
36.9
33.7
7.6
17.9
10.6
5.0
36.4
11.5
18.7
7.4
0.1
13.2
0.2
0.7
5.5
10.9

2.5
3.7
0.2
11.6
15.6
4.0
262.3
3.4
31.1
16.2
37.2
33.5
7.5
17.6
10.7
5.0
36.8
11.7
18.7
7.3
0.1
13.2
0.2
0.7
5.5
10.8

Total .................................................................................

534.4

550.0

547.5

557.5

563.9

561.0

567.2

325

SUMMARIES BY AGENCY

Table S–12.

BUDGET AUTHORITY BY AGENCY
(In billions of dollars)

Agency

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Legislative Branch ........................................
The Judiciary .................................................
Executive Office Of the President ................
Funds Appropriated to the President ..........
Agriculture .....................................................
Commerce ......................................................
Defense—Military .........................................
Defense—Civil ...............................................
Education .......................................................
Energy ............................................................
Health and Human Services ........................
Housing and Urban Development ...............
Interior ...........................................................
Justice ............................................................
Labor ..............................................................
State ...............................................................
Transportation ...............................................
Treasury .........................................................
Veterans Affairs ............................................
Environmental Protection Agency ...............
General Services Administration .................
National Aeronautics and Space Administration .........................................................
Office of Personnel Management .................
Small Business Administration ...................
Social Security Administration ....................
On-Budget ..................................................
Off-Budget ..................................................
Other Independent Agencies ........................
On-Budget ..................................................
Off-Budget ..................................................
Undistributed Offsetting Receipts ...............
On-Budget ..................................................
Off-Budget ..................................................

2.5
3.2
0.2
10.2
58.7
3.6
254.4
32.4
29.1
14.1
318.5
21.1
7.2
15.2
33.4
5.1
35.7
365.8
38.7
6.3
0.2

2.5
3.4
0.2
10.6
60.6
3.7
250.0
33.8
29.4
14.2
357.3
19.4
7.1
17.4
34.4
5.2
43.0
382.6
39.4
6.6
0.7

2.8
3.8
0.2
14.9
60.3
4.2
250.7
35.2
39.5
17.0
370.0
23.0
7.3
17.8
37.5
5.5
43.3
392.9
41.1
7.7
0.2

2.8
3.9
0.2
10.5
60.3
4.8
256.3
35.9
36.4
15.5
396.3
28.7
7.3
18.4
39.0
6.3
42.1
399.6
41.6
7.8
0.1

2.8
4.0
0.2
10.6
62.3
6.1
262.8
37.0
37.0
14.6
414.3
30.6
7.4
17.4
40.3
5.5
42.2
401.4
42.1
7.2
0.1

2.8
4.1
0.2
10.8
62.7
4.0
269.6
38.0
37.7
14.0
439.2
31.1
7.3
17.7
40.3
5.6
42.5
404.4
42.6
7.2
0.1

2.9
4.2
0.2
11.0
65.6
3.9
277.5
39.0
37.4
11.4
463.1
31.8
7.3
18.2
41.5
5.6
42.2
404.9
43.1
7.3
0.1

13.9
43.8
1.1
377.3
(31.0)
(346.3)
24.3
(20.9)
(3.4)
–135.0
(–92.2)
(–42.8)

13.7
44.8
0.9
395.7
(35.3)
(360.3)
27.0
(19.0)
(8.0)
–150.5
(–102.8)
(–47.7)

13.5
47.8
0.7
412.7
(34.5)
(378.2)
25.8
(20.9)
(5.0)
–165.7
(–113.4)
(–52.2)

13.4
50.1
0.7
433.2
(37.7)
(395.5)
23.5
(22.1)
(1.4)
–157.4
(–100.5)
(–56.9)

13.2
52.3
0.7
455.8
(41.7)
(414.2)
28.4
(27.2)
(1.2)
–164.6
(–103.1)
(–61.5)

13.2
54.7
0.7
472.8
(38.4)
(434.4)
30.4
(28.0)
(2.4)
–173.8
(–107.5)
(–66.2)

13.2
57.3
0.7
497.9
(42.9)
(455.0)
31.9
(28.6)
(3.3)
–197.0
(–125.6)
(–71.3)

Total ..............................................................
On-Budget ..................................................
Off-Budget ..................................................

1,581.1
(1,274.1)
(307.0)

1,652.9
(1,332.3)
(320.6)

1,709.5
(1,378.6)
(330.9)

1,777.4
(1,437.3)
(340.1)

1,831.7
(1,477.9)
(353.8)

1,880.0
(1,509.4)
(370.6)

1,922.3
(1,535.3)
(387.0)

326

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table S–13.

OUTLAYS BY AGENCY

(In billions of dollars)
Agency

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Legislative Branch ........................................
The Judiciary .................................................
Executive Office Of the President ................
Funds Appropriated to the President ..........
Agriculture .....................................................
Commerce ......................................................
Defense—Military .........................................
Defense—Civil ...............................................
Education .......................................................
Energy ............................................................
Health and Human Services ........................
Housing and Urban Development ...............
Interior ...........................................................
Justice ............................................................
Labor ..............................................................
State ...............................................................
Transportation ...............................................
Treasury .........................................................
Veterans Affairs ............................................
Environmental Protection Agency ...............
General Services Administration .................
National Aeronautics and Space Administration .........................................................
Office of Personnel Management .................
Small Business Administration ...................
Social Security Administration ....................
On-Budget ..................................................
Off-Budget ..................................................
Other Independent Agencies ........................
On-Budget ..................................................
Off-Budget ..................................................
Undistributed Offsetting Receipts ...............
On-Budget ..................................................
Off-Budget ..................................................

2.3
3.1
0.2
9.7
54.3
3.7
253.3
32.5
29.7
16.2
319.8
25.5
6.7
12.0
32.5
5.0
38.8
364.6
36.9
6.0
0.7

2.5
3.6
0.2
9.7
57.0
3.8
254.3
33.9
28.3
15.4
351.1
29.9
7.4
14.5
32.9
5.5
38.4
380.6
39.6
6.3
1.2

2.8
3.7
0.2
10.2
58.8
4.1
247.5
34.8
32.1
14.6
376.1
32.3
7.1
17.4
35.6
5.5
38.5
390.4
40.9
6.7
0.5

2.7
3.8
0.2
10.4
58.0
4.6
249.3
35.8
36.2
14.9
396.9
32.9
7.3
18.7
37.5
6.3
38.5
397.8
41.9
7.1
0.3

2.7
3.9
0.2
10.6
59.7
6.2
255.2
36.9
36.8
14.6
414.1
32.4
7.3
19.1
39.0
5.5
38.4
400.2
43.8
7.4
0.2

2.8
4.1
0.2
10.5
59.7
4.0
256.2
38.0
37.4
14.1
438.6
30.2
7.4
18.5
39.6
5.5
38.4
402.5
41.1
7.4
0.1

2.8
4.2
0.2
10.6
61.6
3.9
261.4
39.0
35.9
11.8
461.9
29.6
7.2
18.2
40.4
5.6
38.2
402.8
43.3
7.3
0.1

13.9
42.9
0.9
375.2
(31.4)
(343.9)
8.9
(9.5)
(–0.6)
–135.0
(–92.2)
(–42.8)

13.7
44.8
0.5
395.9
(35.2)
(360.8)
10.4
(8.5)
(2.0)
–150.5
(–102.8)
(–47.7)

13.6
46.5
0.1
413.0
(36.3)
(376.7)
20.2
(16.1)
(4.1)
–165.7
(–113.4)
(–52.2)

13.5
48.6
0.2
432.0
(38.1)
(393.9)
22.5
(21.7)
(0.9)
–157.4
(–100.5)
(–56.9)

13.2
50.7
0.5
454.0
(41.7)
(412.4)
26.2
(26.3)
(–0.2)
–164.6
(–103.1)
(–61.5)

13.2
53.0
0.6
470.9
(38.4)
(432.5)
24.1
(25.8)
(–1.8)
–173.8
(–107.5)
(–66.2)

13.2
55.7
0.6
495.9
(42.9)
(453.0)
25.1
(26.4)
(–1.3)
–197.0
(–125.6)
(–71.3)

Total ..............................................................
On-Budget ..................................................
Off-Budget ..................................................

1,560.3
(1,259.9)
(300.5)

1,631.0
(1,316.0)
(315.0)

1,687.5
(1,358.9)
(328.6)

1,760.7
(1,422.8)
(337.9)

1,814.4
(1,463.8)
(350.7)

1,844.5
(1,480.0)
(364.5)

1,879.7
(1,499.4)
(380.3)

Other Summary Tables

327

OTHER SUMMARY TABLES
Table S–14.

RECEIPTS BY SOURCE—SUMMARY
(In millions of dollars)

Source

1996
Actual

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Individual income taxes ..............
Corporation income taxes ...........
Social insurance taxes and contributions ..................................
(On-budget) ...............................
(Off-budget) ...............................
Excise taxes ..................................
Estate and gift taxes ...................
Customs duties ............................
Miscellaneous receipts .................

656,417
171,824

672,683
176,199

691,199
189,662

721,554
199,555

755,558
212,046

795,223
220,521

839,850
227,844

509,414
(141,922)
(367,492)
54,014
17,189
18,670
25,534

535,766
(146,863)
(388,903)
57,247
17,588
17,328
28,614

557,783
(152,839)
(404,944)
61,239
18,817
18,307
29,835

585,229
(160,033)
(425,196)
64,496
19,969
18,469
34,048

614,395
(167,499)
(446,896)
64,934
21,390
19,617
39,364

642,161
(174,544)
(467,617)
66,194
22,926
20,523
40,799

673,075
(183,210)
(489,865)
67,363
24,573
21,988
41,993

Total receipts .........................
On-budget ..............................
Off-budget ..............................

1,453,062
(1,085,570)
(367,492)

1,505,425
(1,116,522)
(388,903)

1,566,842
(1,161,898)
(404,944)

1,643,320
(1,218,124)
(425,196)

1,727,304
(1,280,408)
(446,896)

1,808,347
(1,340,730)
(467,617)

1,896,686
(1,406,821)
(489,865)

329

330

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table S–15.

FEDERAL EMPLOYMENT IN THE EXECUTIVE BRANCH

(Civilian employment as measured by Full-Time Equivalents, in thousands)
Actual
Agency

Cabinet agencies:
Agriculture 1 .............................................
Commerce .................................................
Defense-military functions ......................
Education .................................................
Energy ......................................................
Health and Human Services 1 .................
Social Security Administration ...............
Housing and Urban Development ..........
Interior .....................................................
Justice .......................................................
Labor .........................................................
State ..........................................................
Transportation .........................................
Treasury ...................................................
Veterans Affairs 1 .....................................
Other agencies (excluding Postal Service):
Agency for International Development 1
Corps of Engineers ..................................
Environmental Protection Agency ..........
EEOC ........................................................
FEMA .......................................................
FDIC/RTC .................................................
General Services Administration ...........
NASA ........................................................
National Archives and Records Admin. .
National Labor Relations Board .............
National Science Foundation ..................
Nuclear Regulatory Commission ............
Office of Personnel Management ............
Panama Canal Commission ....................
Peace Corps ..............................................
Railroad Retirement Board .....................
Securities and Exchange Commission ...
Small Business Administration ..............
Smithsonian Institution ..........................
Tennessee Valley Authority ....................
United States Information Agency .........
All other small agencies ..........................

1993
Base

1993

1994

Estimate

1995

1996

1997

115.6
36.7
931.3
5.0
20.6
65.0
65.4
13.6
79.3
99.4
18.3
26.0
70.3
166.1
232.4

114.4
36.1
931.8
4.9
20.3
66.1
64.8
13.3
78.1
95.4
18.0
25.6
69.1
161.1
234.2

109.8
36.0
868.3
4.8
19.8
62.9
64.5
13.1
76.3
95.3
17.5
25.2
66.4
157.3
233.1

103.8
35.3
821.7
4.8
19.7
59.3
64.6
12.1
72.0
97.9
16.8
23.9
63.2
157.5
228.5

100.7
33.8
778.9
4.7
19.1
57.2
64.0
11.4
66.7
103.8
16.0
22.9
62.4
151.1
221.9

101.7
34.9
760.0
4.6
18.2
57.6
65.6
11.4
70.6
113.3
16.6
23.2
64.0
148.3
215.5

4.4
29.2
18.6
2.9
2.7
21.6
20.6
25.7
2.8
2.1
1.3
3.4
6.2
8.7
1.3
1.9
2.7
4.0
5.9
19.1
8.7
16.1

4.1
28.4
17.9
2.8
4.0
21.9
20.2
24.9
2.6
2.1
1.2
3.4
5.9
8.5
1.2
1.8
2.7
5.6
5.5
17.3
8.3
15.4

3.9
27.9
17.6
2.8
4.9
20.0
19.5
23.9
2.6
2.1
1.2
3.3
5.3
8.5
1.2
1.7
2.7
6.3
5.4
18.6
8.1
15.0

3.6
27.7
17.5
2.8
4.6
15.7
17.0
22.4
2.5
2.0
1.2
3.2
4.2
8.8
1.2
1.6
2.7
5.7
5.3
16.6
7.7
15.1

3.4
27.1
17.2
2.7
4.7
11.8
15.7
21.1
2.5
1.9
1.3
3.1
3.4
9.0
1.1
1.5
2.8
4.8
5.1
16.0
7.0
14.1

3.1
27.1
18.0
2.7
5.0
9.4
14.9
20.7
2.5
2.0
1.3
3.1
3.4
10.2
1.2
1.4
2.8
4.6
5.3
15.7
7.0
14.8

Change: 1993 base
to 1998

1998

FTE’s

Percent

99.9
–15.8 –13.6%
38.3
+1.6 +4.3%
733.2 –198.1 –21.3%
4.6
–0.5 –9.3%
17.2
–3.4 –16.5%
57.6
–7.3 –11.3%
65.4 .............. ..............
11.0
–2.7 –19.6%
71.4
–7.9 –10.0%
121.8
+22.4 +22.5%
17.1
–1.2 –6.5%
23.2
–2.8 –10.8%
64.8
–5.5 –7.8%
148.1
–18.0 –10.8%
210.6
–21.8 –9.4%
3.0
26.4
18.3
2.7
4.7
7.8
14.4
19.8
2.5
2.0
1.2
3.0
3.3
10.3
1.1
1.3
2.8
4.6
5.3
15.6
6.9
14.5

–1.4
–2.8
–0.3
–0.2
+1.9
–13.8
–6.2
–6.0
–0.2
–0.1
–0.1
–0.4
–3.0
+1.6
–0.1
–0.5
+0.1
+0.6
–0.6
–3.6
–1.8
–1.6

–31.9%
–9.7%
–1.6%
–6.2%
+70.5%
–64.0%
–30.2%
–23.3%
–8.6%
–6.0%
–8.2%
–12.1%
–47.6%
+18.5%
–9.4%
–29.0%
+2.1%
+15.2%
–10.4%
–18.8%
–20.9%
–9.9%

Total, Executive Branch civilian employment ................................................. 2,155.2 2,138.8 2,052.7 1,970.2 1,891.7 1,881.3 1,855.6 –299.6 –13.9%
Reduction from 1993 base ....................... ..............
–16.4 –102.5 –185.0 –263.5 –273.9 –299.6 .............. ..............
Subtotal, Defense ........................................
931.3
931.8
868.3
821.7
778.9
760.0
733.2 –198.1 –21.3%
Subtotal, non-defense .................................. 1,223.9 1,207.1 1,184.4 1,148.4 1,112.8 1,121.2 1,122.4 –101.5 –8.3%
Status of Federal civilian employment relative to the FWRA: 2
Total, Executive Branch employment ....
Less: FTEs exempt from FWRA .............
Total, Executive Branch subject to
FWRA Ceiling .......................................
FWRA ceiling ...........................................
Executive Branch employment relative
to FWRA ceiling ...................................

.............. .............. 2,052.7 1,970.2 1,891.7 1,881.3 1,855.6 .............. ..............
.............. ..............
5.7
5.7
7.6
7.9
5.6 .............. ..............
.............. .............. 2,047.0 1,964.4 1,884.1 1,873.3 1,850.0 .............. ..............
.............. .............. 2,084.6 2,043.3 2,003.3 1,963.3 1,922.3 .............. ..............
.............. ..............

–37.6

–78.9

–119.2

–90.0

–72.3 .............. ..............

1 The Departments of Agriculture, Health and Human Services, Veterans Affairs, and the Agency for International Development have
components that are exempt from FTE controls. In 1998, Agriculture has 2,098 exemptions; HHS has 268 exemptions; Veterans Affairs
has 3,200 exemptions and AID has 27 exemptions.
2 FTE limitations are set for the Executive Branch in the Federal Workforce Restructuring Act of 1994 (P.L. 103–226) from 1994–99.

331

OTHER SUMMARY TABLES

Table S–16.

FEDERAL GOVERNMENT FINANCING AND DEBT 1
(In billions of dollars)
1996
Actual

Financing:
Surplus or deficit (–) ........................................................
(On-budget) ...................................................................
(Off-budget) ...................................................................
Means of financing other than borrowing from the
public:
Changes in: 2
Treasury operating cash balance ............................
Checks outstanding, etc. 3 ........................................
Deposit fund balances ..............................................
Seigniorage on coins ....................................................
Less: Net financing disbursements:
Direct loan financing accounts ................................
Guaranteed loan financing accounts .......................

–107.3
–174.3
67.0

–6.3
–3.9
–1.0
0.6

Estimate
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

–125.6
–199.5
73.9

–120.6
–197.0
76.4

–117.4
–204.7
87.3

–87.1
–183.3
96.2

–36.1
–139.2
103.1

2002

17.0
–92.5
109.5

4.2 .............. .............. .............. .............. ..............
–*
–1.4 .............. .............. .............. ..............
0.7
–2.6 .............. .............. .............. ..............
0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6

–13.0
1.3

–22.6
–0.2

–21.9
0.4

–21.9
0.6

–23.8
0.7

–24.4
0.9

–24.0
1.2

Total, means of financing other than borrowing
from the public ..........................................................

–22.3

–17.2

–24.9

–20.7

–22.4

–22.8

–22.1

Total, requirement for borrowing from the public ........
Change in debt held by the public .................................

–129.6
129.6

–142.8
142.8

–145.6
145.6

–138.1
138.1

–109.6
109.6

–59.0
59.0

–5.2
5.2

Debt Outstanding, End of Year:
Gross Federal debt:
Debt issued by Treasury ..............................................
Debt issued by other agencies .....................................

5,146.9
35.1

5,420.4
33.3

5,706.3
29.9

5,983.1
29.5

6,243.0
29.0

6,456.6
28.7

6,624.3
28.2

5,181.9

5,453.7

5,736.2

6,012.6

6,272.0

6,485.2

6,652.5

Total, gross Federal debt .............................................
Held by:
Government accounts ..................................................
The public .....................................................................
Federal Reserve Banks ............................................
Other .........................................................................

1,449.0 1,577.9 1,714.8 1,853.2 2,003.0 2,157.2 2,319.4
3,733.0 3,875.8 4,021.4 4,159.4 4,269.0 4,328.0 4,333.1
390.9 .............. .............. .............. .............. .............. ..............
3,342.0 .............. .............. .............. .............. .............. ..............

Debt Subject to Statutory Limitation, End of Year:
Debt issued by Treasury .................................................
Less: Treasury debt not subject to limitation 4 .............
Agency debt subject to limitation ...................................
Adjustment for discount and premium 5 ........................

5,146.9
–15.5
0.1
5.8

5,420.4
–15.5
0.1
5.8

5,706.3
–15.5
0.1
5.8

5,983.1
–15.5
0.1
5.8

6,243.0
–15.5
0.1
5.8

6,456.6
–15.5
0.1
5.8

6,624.3
–15.5
0.1
5.8

Total, debt subject to statutory limitation 6 ..................

5,137.2

5,410.7

5,696.6

5,973.4

6,233.3

6,446.9

6,614.7

* $50 million or less.
1 Treasury securities held by the public and zero-coupon bonds held by Government accounts are almost entirely measured at sales price plus amortized discount or less amortized premium. Agency debt is almost entirely measured at face
value. Treasury securities in the Government account series are measured at face value less unrealized discount (if any).
2 A decrease in the Treasury operating cash balance (which is an asset) would be a means of financing the deficit and
therefore has a positive sign. An increase in checks outstanding or deposit fund balances (which are liabilities) would also
be a means of financing the deficit and therefore also have a positive sign.
3 Besides checks outstanding, includes accrued interest payable on Treasury debt, miscellaneous liability accounts,
allocations of special drawing rights, and, as an offset, cash and monetary assets other than the Treasury operating cash
balance, miscellaneous asset accounts, and profit on sale of gold.
4 Consists primarily of Federal Financing Bank debt.
5 Consists of unamortized discount (less premium) on public issues of Treasury notes and bonds (other than zero-coupon
bonds) and unrealized discount on Government account series securities.
6 The statutory debt limit is $5,500 billion.

332

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1998

Table S–17.

COMPARISON OF ECONOMIC ASSUMPTIONS
(Calendar years)
Projections
1997

1998

1999

2000

2001

2002

Real GDP (chain-weighted): 1
1997 Mid-Session Review ......................
CBO January 2 .......................................
1998 Budget ...........................................

2.3
2.1
2.0

2.3
2.1
2.0

2.3
2.2
2.3

2.3
2.2
2.3

2.3
2.1
2.3

2.3
2.1
2.3

Chain-weighted GDP Price Index: 1
1997 Mid-Session Review ......................
CBO January 2 .......................................
1998 Budget ...........................................

2.7
2.4
2.5

2.7
2.6
2.6

2.7
2.6
2.6

2.7
2.6
2.6

2.7
2.6
2.6

2.7
2.6
2.6

Consumer Price Index (all-urban): 1
1997 Mid-Session Review ......................
CBO January 2 .......................................
1998 Budget ...........................................

2.8
2.9
2.6

2.8
3.0
2.7

2.8
3.0
2.7

2.8
3.0
2.7

2.8
3.0
2.7

2.8
3.0
2.7

Unemployment rate: 3
1997 Mid-Session Review ......................
CBO January 2 .......................................
1998 Budget ...........................................

5.7
5.3
5.3

5.7
5.6
5.5

5.7
5.8
5.5

5.7
5.9
5.5

5.7
6.0
5.5

5.7
6.0
5.5

Interest rates: 3
91-day Treasury bills:
1997 Mid-Session Review ..................
CBO January 2 ....................................
1998 Budget ........................................

4.5
5.0
5.0

4.3
5.0
4.7

4.2
4.6
4.4

4.0
4.2
4.2

4.0
3.9
4.0

4.0
3.9
4.0

10-year Treasury notes:
1997 Mid-Session Review ..................
CBO January 2 ....................................
1998 Budget ........................................

5.6
6.2
6.1

5.2
6.1
5.9

5.0
5.8
5.5

5.0
5.5
5.3

5.0
5.5
5.1

5.0
5.5
5.1

1 Percent

change, fourth quarter over fourth quarter.
projections assuming balanced budget policy.
3 Annual averages, percent.
2 Economic

VIII.

LIST OF CHARTS AND
TABLES

333

LIST OF CHARTS AND TABLES
LIST OF CHARTS
Page

I. The Budget Message of the President
The Federal Government Dollar Fiscal Year 1998 Estimates .............................
III. Putting the Building Blocks in Place
III–1. Saving Rates .............................................................................................................
III–2. Real Interest Rates ..................................................................................................
III–3. Net Private Domestic Investment ..........................................................................
III–4. Budget Deficits .........................................................................................................
III–5. Job Creation .............................................................................................................
III–6. Underlying Rates of Inflation
CPI: All Items Less Food and Energy ................................................................
III–7. Poverty Rates ...........................................................................................................
III–8. Long-Run Deficit Projections ..................................................................................
IV. Improving Performance in a Balanced Budget World
IV–1. Executive Branch Civilian Employment, 1965–1996 ............................................
IV–2. Civilian FTE Changes on a Percent Basis, 1993–1996
Cabinet Departments and Selected Independent Agencies ..............................
V. Creating Opportunity, Demanding Responsibility, and Strengthening Community
Investing In Education and Training:
2–1. Investment in Education Department Programs, Hope Scholarships And Tax
Deductions Will Increase 56 Percent Between 1996 And 2002 ........................
2–2. 36 Thousand New Head Start Opportunities for Children in 1998 over 1997;
One Million by 2002 .............................................................................................
2–3. The Federal Government Will Provide Nearly $60 Billion in Student Aid in
2002, More than Double the 1993 Level .............................................................
Protecting the Environment:
3–1. Major Progress in Superfund Cleanups .................................................................
3–2. USDA Wetlands Conservation ................................................................................
3–3. Recreational Visits to Select Federal Lands ..........................................................
Enforcing the Law:
5–1. Anti-Crime Budget History .....................................................................................
5–2. Immigration and Naturalization Service Border Patrol and Land Border Inspection Staffing ...................................................................................................
Restoring the American Community:
6–1. Concentration of Poverty in Urban Areas Reached a 30-Year High in 1990 ......
6–2. Housing Voucher Recipients Are Less Likely to Live in High Poverty Neighborhoods Than Are Residents of Public Housing ...............................................
Implementing Welfare Reform:
7–1. Welfare Rolls Declined as the Economy Improved and as States Experimented
with Welfare Innovations .....................................................................................

2
23
23
24
26
27
27
28
30
38
39

60
61
63
72
74
75
86
92
96
100

106
335

336

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1997

LIST OF CHARTS—Continued
Page

7–2.

1993 Expansion of the EITC Helps 15 Million Lower-Income Working Families ..........................................................................................................................

VI. Investing in the Common Good: The Major Functions of the Federal Government
Natural Resources and Environment:
16–1. Air Quality Trends in Urban Areas ........................................................................
16–2. Population Served by Secondary Treatment or Better .........................................
Agriculture:
17–1. Production Flexibility Contract Payments Exceed Projected Deficiency Payments .....................................................................................................................
Social Security:
25–1. Composition of Social Security Recipients .............................................................
25–2. Beneficiary Population with Family Income Above and Below the Poverty
Line ........................................................................................................................
25–3. Portion of Beneficiaries that Rely Heavily on Social Security .............................
Veterans Benefits and Services:
26–1. Estimated Veteran Population ................................................................................
Administration of Justice:
27–1. Administration of Justice Expenditures .................................................................
27–2. Federal Justice Expenditures .................................................................................
Net Interest:
29–1. Net Interest ..............................................................................................................

108

156
157

160
194
195
196
200
204
205
212

LIST OF TABLES
Page

I. The Budget Message of the President
I–1. Receipts, Outlays, and Surplus or Deficit ..............................................................

2

III. Putting the Building Blocks in Place
III–1. Economic Assumptions ............................................................................................

31

IV. Improving Performance in a Balanced Budget World
IV–1. Strategies to Improve Performance and Reduce Costs .........................................
IV–2. Proposed Performance-Based Organizations .........................................................
IV–3. Program Performance Benefits from Major Information Technology Investments .....................................................................................................................

45

V. Creating Opportunity, Demanding Responsibility, and Strengthening Community
Investing in Education and Training:
2–1. The Budget Increases Resources for Major Education and Training Programs
by $15 Billion, or 56 Percent over 1993 .............................................................

59

37
37

337

LIST OF CHARTS AND TABLES

LIST OF TABLES—Continued
Page

Protecting the Environment:
3–1. Environmental/Natural Resource Investments and Other High-Priority Programs .....................................................................................................................
Promoting Research:
4–1. Research and Development Investments ...............................................................
4–2. Selected Science and Technology Highlights .........................................................
Enforcing the Law:
5–1. Violent Crime Reduction Trust Fund Spending by Function ..............................
5–2. Drug Control Funding .............................................................................................
5–3. Immigration and Naturalization Service Funding by Program ...........................
Restoring the American Community:
6–1. Government-Wide Native American Program Funding .......................................
Promoting Tax Fairness:
8–1. The President’s Tax Plan ........................................................................................
Supporting America’s Global Leadership:
9–1. International Discretionary Programs ...................................................................
Supporting the World’s Strongest Military Force:
10–1. Military Force Trends ..............................................................................................
VI. Investing in the Common Good: The Major Functions of the Federal Government
Overview:
11–1. Federal Resources by Function ...............................................................................
National Defense:
12–1. Federal Resources in Support of National Defense ..............................................
International Affairs:
13–1. Federal Resources in Support of International Affairs ........................................
General Science, Space, and Technology:
14–1. Federal Resources in Support of General Science, Space,and Technology .........
Energy:
15–1. Federal Resources in Support of Energy ...............................................................
Natural Resources and Environment:
16–1. Federal Resources in Support of Natural Resources and Environment .............
Agriculture:
17–1. Federal Resources in Support of Agriculture ........................................................
Commerce and Housing Credit:
18–1. Federal Resources in Support of Commerce and Housing Credit .......................
18–2. Selected Federal Commerce and Housing Credit Programs Portfolio Characteristics ..................................................................................................................
Transportation:
19–1. Federal Resources in Support of Transportation ..................................................
Community and Regional Development:
20–1. Federal Resources in Support of Community and Regional Development .........

71
78
79
87
89
91
101
112
117
124

132
137
141
145
149
153
159
163
164
169
173

338

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1997

LIST OF TABLES—Continued
Page

Education, Training, Employment, and Social Services:
21–1. Federal Resources in Support of Education, Training, Employment, and Social
Services .................................................................................................................
Health:
22–1. Federal Resources in Support of Health ................................................................
Medicare:
23–1. Federal Resources in Support of Medicare ............................................................
Income Security:
24–1. Federal Resources in Support of Income Security ................................................
Social Security:
25–1. Federal Resources in Support of Social Security ..................................................
Veterans Benefits and Services:
26–1. Federal Resources in Support of Veterans Benefits and Services .......................
Administration of Justice:
27–1. Federal Resources in Support of Administration of Justice .................................
General Government:
28–1. Federal Resources in Support of General Government ........................................
Net Interest:
29–1. Net Interest ..............................................................................................................
Undistributed Offsetting Receipts:
30–1. Undistributed Offsetting Receipts ..........................................................................
Detailed Functional Tables:
31–1. Budget Authority by Function, Category and Program .......................................
31–2. Outlays by Function, Category and Program ........................................................
31–3. Direct and Guaranteed Loans by Function ...........................................................
31–4. Tax Expenditures by Function ...............................................................................
VII. Summary Tables
Budget Aggregates:
S–1. Outlays, Receipts, and Deficit Summary ...............................................................
S–2. On- and Off-Budget Totals (1996–2007) ................................................................
S–3. Summary of Receipts, Outlays, and Surpluses or Deficits (–): 1789–2002 .........
1998 Budget Proposals:
S–4. Summary of Budget Proposals ...............................................................................
S–5. Current Services and Proposed Discretionary Spending Levels ..........................
S–6. Mandatory Budget Proposals by Program .............................................................
S–7. Effect of Proposals on Receipts ...............................................................................
S–8. Summary of Supplemental and Rescission Proposals ..........................................
S–9. Discretionary Proposals by Appropriations Subcommittee ..................................
Summaries by Agency:
S–10. Discretionary Budget Authority by Agency ...........................................................
S–11. Discretionary Outlays by Agency ...........................................................................
S–12. Budget Authority by Agency ...................................................................................
S–13. Outlays by Agency ...................................................................................................

177
181
185
189
193
199
203
207
211
215
217
251
285
292

303
304
305
309
310
311
315
318
319
323
324
325
326

339

LIST OF CHARTS AND TABLES

LIST OF TABLES—Continued
Page

Other Summary Tables:
S–14. Receipts by Source—Summary ...............................................................................
S–15. Federal Employment in the Executive Branch .....................................................
S–16. Federal Government Financing and Debt .............................................................
S–17. Comparison of Economic Assumptions ..................................................................

329
330
331
332

IX. OMB CONTRIBUTORS TO
THE 1998 BUDGET

341

OMB CONTRIBUTORS TO THE 1998 BUDGET
The following personnel contributed to the preparation of this publication. Hundreds, perhaps
thousands, of others throughout the Government also deserve credit for their valuable contributions.
A
Rein Abel
Andrew Abrams
David S. Adams
Gordon Adams
Marsha D. Adams
Gordon P. Agress
Steven D. Aitken
Susan Alesi
Richard M. Allen
Lois E. Altoft
Barry B. Anderson
Robert B. Anderson
Kenneth S. Apfel
Donald R. Arbuckle
John B. Arthur
Jeffrey H. Ashford
Renee Austin

B
Paul W. Baker
Jonathan C. Ball
Sharon A. Barkeloo
Robert E. Barker
Christina Barnes
Pamela S. Barr
Mary C. Barth
Richard B. Bavier
Jean D. Baxter
Bruce D. Beard
Richard B. Belzer
Gary L. Bennethum
Deborah L. Benoit
Maya A. Bernstein
James A. Bessin
Pamela L. Beverly
Sarah Bianchi
Keith B. Bickel
Jeff Blaylock
Jill M. Blickstein
Mathew C. Blum
James Boden
Debra J. Bond
Constance J. Bowers
Yvonne T. Bowlding
Jacqueline Boykin

Donald P. Bradford
James Bradford, Jr.
Betty I. Bradshaw
Nancy Brandel
Denise M. Bray
Jonathan D. Breul
Anna M. Briatico
Edward A. Brigham
Allan E. Brown
James A. Brown
Thomas M. Brown
Paul Bugg
Ann M. Burget
John D. Burnim

C
Philip T. Calbos
Susan M. Carr
Michael Casella
Lester D. Cash
Mary I. Cassell
Winifred Y. Chang
Edward H. Chase
Antonio E. Chavez
Anita Chellaraj
Daniel J. Chenok
David C. Childs
Margaret B. Davis
Christian
James P. Christopoulos
Mary M. Chuckerel
Zach Church
Kevin P. Cichetti
Robert L. Civiak
Edward H. Clarke
Barry T. Clendenin
Jerry L. Coffey
Ron Cogswell
Arthur Cohen
Carol Thompson-Cole
Debra M. Collins
Teresa L. Collins
Nani A. Coloretti
Sheila Conley
Melissa Y. Cook
Jacqueline A. Corsetty
Daniel W. Costello

Elizabeth Cowan
Michael F. Crowley
James C. Crutchfield
Rebecca Culberson
William P. Curtis
Margaret Cvrkel

D
Josie R. Dade
Rosemarie W. Dale
Philip R. Dame
Robert G. Damus
J. Michael Daniel
Caroline B. Davis
Jozelyn Davis
Peter O. Davis
Lorraine Day
Stacy L. Dean
Michael Deich
Arline P. Dell
Carol R. Dennis
G. Edward DeSeve
Cheree D. Desimone
Eugene J. Devine
Barbara Diering
Elizabeth M. DiGennaro
Michael J. Discenza, Jr.
Robert J. Donnelly
Kate Donovan
Michele M. Donovan
William Dorotinsky
Robert S. Dotson
Sherron R. Duncan
Philip A. DuSault
Nancy J. Duykers
Marguerite D. Dyson

E
Jacqueline A. Easley
Eugene M. Ebner
Mabel E. Echols
Teresa F. Ellison
Richard P. Emery Jr.
Noah Engelberg
Michelle A. Enger
Robert Epplin

Adrienne C. Erbach
Frank Esposito
Jim R. Esquea
Margaret Evans
Suzann K. Evinger
Rowe Ewell
Quincy Ewing III
Allison H. Eydt

F
Timothy R. Fain
Chris Fairhall
Lisa B. Fairhall
Robert S. Fairweather
Jeffrey A. Farkas
Evan T. Farley
William R. Feezle
Jack D. Fellows
Patricia A. Ferrell
John W. Fielding
Desiree Filippone
Joseph Firschein
Elyse H. Fitter
Michael Fitzpatrick
Darlene B. Fleming
Dana L. Flower-Lake
Keith J. Fontenot
Janet R. Forsgren
Gillian Foster
Wanda J. Foster
Arthur G. Fraas
William P. Frazier
Stephen M. Frerichs

G
Lisa A. Gaisford
Dina L. Gallo
Bonnie E. Galvin
Evett F. Gardner
Marc Garufi
Sandra Gault
Darcel D. Gayle
Darlene O. Gaymon
Michael D. Gerich
M. Jill Gibbons
Brian Gillis

343

344

THE BUDGET FOR FISCAL YEAR 1997

T.J. Glauthier
Kenneth G. Glozer
Michael L. Goad
Robert Goldberg
Jeffrey D. Goldstein
Janet L. Graves
Arecia A. Grayton
Maryanne B. Green
Pamela B. Green
Richard E. Green
Jack A. Gribben
Walter S. Groszyk Jr.
K. Lisa Grove

H
Julie L. Haas
Lawrence J. Haas
Lauren Haber
Harvey D. Hagman
William A. Halter
Dianne M. Ham
Patricia S. Haney
Michelle L. Hanson
Dionne M. Hardy
Rebecca J. Hardy
Brenda F. Harper
Nashingda Hart
Melinda D. Haskins
David J. Haun
Thomas Hawkins
Nicole Haynes
Daniel D. Heath
Renee P. Helm
Gregory G. Henry
Linda K. Hicklin
Nicolette Highsmith
Jefferson B. Hill
Timothy B. Hill
Troy S. Hillier
Janet L. Himler
Adam Hoffberg
Jean W. Holcombe
Christine P. Holmes
Katie Hong
Edith D. Hopkins
Sarah G. Horrigan
Kathy M. Hudgins
Paul W. Huelskamp
Alexander T. Hunt
Lawrence W. Hush
Toni S. Hustead
Virginia A. Huth

I
Chin-Chin Ip
Janet Irwin
Steven J. Isakowitz

J
Norwood J. Jackson Jr.
Laurence R. Jacobson
Lisa E. Jacobson
E. Irene James
Carline M. Jelsma
Carol D. Jenkins
Carol S. Johnson
Darrell A. Johnson
Kim I. Johnson
Heather A. Johnston
Lisa M. Jones
Marilyn E. Jones
Ronald E. Jones
James F. Jordan
James J. Jukes
Robert Justus

K
Barbara F. Kahlow
Phyllis E. Kaiser-Dark
John Kamensky
Stephen Kane
Stuart Kasdin
David E. Katague
Sally Katzen
Stanley Kaufman
Stephanie I. Kaufman
Ward Kay
James B. Kazel
Alex S. Keenan
John W. Kelly
Kenneth S. Kelly
Tamara Kelly
Steven Kelman
Ann H. Kendrall
Robert O. Kerr
Farooq A. Khan
Charles E. Kieffer
Robert W. Kilpatrick
Nancy Kirkendall
Carole Kitti
Andrew W. Kleine
Louisa Koch
Richard H. Kodl
Raymond P. Kogut
Alicia K. Kolaian
Charles S. Konigsberg
John A. Koskinen
Lisa Kountoupes
Deborah F. Kramer
Lori A. Krauss
Richard A. Kuzmack
Bradley W. Kyser

L
Susan Laabs
Joseph F. Lackey Jr.
Leonard L. Lainhart
James A. Laity
Sarah A. Laskin
Edwin Lau
Corey Lee
Alexandra Lehr
Cameron M. Leuthy
Jacob J. Lew
Thomas S. Lewis
Richard A. Lichtenberger
Henry E. Lilienthal
Susanne D. Lind
David Lippold
Jenise Littlejohn
Neil R. Lobron
Patrick G. Locke
Richard C. Loeb
Bruce D. Long
Jonna M. Long
Lewis P. Long
Janet Looney
Randall W. Lutter
Randolph M. Lyon

M
Joslyn Mack
Eric L. Macris
Stephen Madison
Kimberly Maluski
Dalton L. Mann
Judith F. Mann
Cynthia Marable
Karen A. Maris
Bernard H. Martin
James Mathews
Larry R. Matlack
Shelly McAllister
Alexander J. McClelland
Bruce W. McConnell
Douglas D. McCormick
Yvonne A. McCoy
Michael J. McDermott
Katrina A. McDonald
Matthew McKearn
William N. McLeod
William J. McQuaid
Barbara Menard
Mark Menchik
William C. Menth
Katherine L. Meredith
Richard A. Mertens
Steven M. Mertens
Linda L. Mesaros
Harry G. Meyers

Edward S. Michlovich
James D. Mietus
Maria F. Mikitka
Mark E. Miller
Nancy-Ann E. Min
Joseph J. Minarik
Janet W. Minkler
Ginger Moench
Fran Monblatt
Diane R. Montgomery
John B. Moore
Harry E. Moran
John F. Morrall, III
Adele C. Morris
David H. Morrison
Delphine C. Motley
Jane T. Moy
James C. Murr
Margaret A. Murray
Suzanne M. Murrin
Leslie S. Mustain
Anne W. Mutti
David L. Muzio

N
Robert L. Nabors
Kim C. Nakahara
Robert J. Nassif
Suneeth Nayak
Kimberly A. Newman
Sheila D. Newman
Kevin F. Neyland
James A. Nix
Desiree C. Noble
S. Aromie Noe
Christine L. Nolin
Jaha Norman
Memphis A. Norman
Douglas A. Norwood

O
Marcia D. Occomy
Lewis W. Oleinick
Marvis G. Olfus
Jason Orlando

P
William D. Palmer
Anna K. Pannell
Darrell Park
Jacqueline Parrish
Jacqueline M. Peay
Robert J. Pellicci
Alison C. Perkins
Kathleen Peroff
Ronald K. Peterson
John R. Pfeiffer

345

OMB CONTRIBUTORS TO THE 1997 BUDGET

Carolyn R. Phelps
Janet S. Piller
Joseph G. Pipan
Catherine Poynton

Q
Scott Quehl

R
John S. Radzikowski
Franklin D. Raines
Terrill W. Ramsey
Edward M. Rea
Francis S. Redburn
McGavock D. Reed
Thomas M. Reilly
Gary Reisner
Rosalyn J. Rettman
Alan B. Rhinesmith
Alison Rhyner
John M. Richardson
Sarah B. Richardson
Michelle S. Richman
Nancy S. Ridenour
Robert B. Rideout
Donna M. Rivelli
Justine F. Rodriguez
Lara L. Roholt
Patricia Romani
Annette E. Rooney
Timothy A. Rosado
Lynn C. Ross
Elizabeth L. Rossman
David Rostker
John Roy
Martha A. Rubenstein
Doris L. Rutledge
Christine Ryan

S
Cynthia R. Salavantis
LaVonne D. Sampson
Mark S. Sandy
Bruce K. Sasser
Ruth D. Saunders
Lori R. Schack
Victoria A. Schaefer
Glenn R. Schlarman
Andrew M. Schoenbach

Steven L. Schooner
Ingrid M. Schroeder
John T. Schuhart
Rudolph J. Schuhbauer
Kenneth L. Schwartz
Mark J. Schwartz
Nancy E. Schwartz
Ardy D. Scott
W. Larry Scott
Robyn L. Seaton
Jasmeet K. Seehra
Albert Seferian
Frank J. Seidl III
Jane Selkirk
Neil K. Shapiro
Deborah L. Shaw
Alice S. Sheck
Vanna J. Shields
Allen Shimada
Robert M. Shireman
Alice E. Shuffield
S. Peter Shultz
Mary Jo Siclari
Laura Oliven Silberfarb
Ronald L. Silberman
Angela C. Simmons
Linda Simmons
Pamula L. Simms
Jack A. Smalligan
Bryan R. Smith
Cynthia Smith
Patricia A. Smith
Julie J. Song
Julie J. Sonier
John Sotelo
Shaun D. Spencer
Edward C. Springer
Kathryn B. Stack
Thomas P. Stack
Norman H. Starler
Randolph J. Steer
Douglas L. Steiger
Albert F. Stidman
Carla B. Stone
Shannon Stuart
Justin Sullivan
Kelley A. Sullivan
E. S. Swain
Carolyn Swinney

T
Sahar Taman
Daniel M. Tangherlini
Vernetta Tanner
Carmen Tarbell
Nathan S. Tash
Wendy A. Taylor
Richard P. Theroux
Beverly B. Thierwechter
John E. Thompson
Courtney B. Timberlake
Naomi M. Tinklepaugh
Paul Tisdale
David E. Tornquist
Hai M. Tran
Moon T. Tran
Stella Tsai
Robert J. Tuccillo
Donald L. Tuck
Aurelia Tucker
Anne Tumlinson
Kathleen M. Turco
Richard J. Turman
Katherine M. Tyer

V
Cynthia A. Vallina
Pamela B. VanWie
Areletha L. Venson
Harry Vernon
Sandra L. Via
Phebe N. Vickers
Allan Villabroza

Gary Waxman
Rebecca A. Wayne
Mark A. Weatherly
Bessie M. Weaver
Tawana F. Webb
Maryann Weber
Stephen A. Weigler
Jeffrey A. Weinberg
Peter N. Weiss
Dianne M. Wells
Philip R. Wenger
Michael G. Wenk
Ophelia D. West
Lisa F. Western
Leticia Whitaker
Arnette C. White
Barry White
Kim S. White
William G. White
Ora L. Whitman
William F. Wiggins
Roxanne V. Willard
Debra Williams
Linda Williams
Jonathan D. Winer
Doris J. Wingard
Ariel Winter
Joseph M. Wire
Wayne A. Wittig
Christopher D. Wolz
Daren K. Wong
Latasha Woodall
David J. Worzala
Anthony B. Wu

Y
W
Victoria A. Wachino
Jennifer C. Wagner
Joyce M. Wakefield
Martha A. Wallace
Stanley R. Wallace
Katherine K. Wallman
Maureen H. Walsh
Alecia Ward
Sharon A. Warner
Theodore Wartell
Barbara E. Washington
Mark A. Wasserman
Victoria Wassmer
Iratha H. Waters

Louise D. Young
Julia E. Yuille

Z
David M. Zavada
Wendy B. Zenker
Richard Zeoli
Gail S. Zimmerman
Leonard B. Zuza

Need Additional Copies ???
Copies of the Budget and related Office of Management and Budget documents may be purchased
at any of the GPO bookstores listed below. (Paper copies only.)
GPO BOOKSTORES
ALABAMA

DISTRICT OF COLUMBIA

MARYLAND

NEW YORK

O’Neill Building
2021 Third Ave., North
Birmingham, Alabama 35203
(205) 731–1056
FAX (205) 731–3444

U.S. Government Printing Office
710 North Capitol Street, NW
Washington, DC 20401
(202) 512–0132
FAX (202) 512–1355

Retail Sales Outlet
8660 Cherry Lane
Laurel, Maryland 20707
(301) 953–7974
FAX (301) 498–8995

Federal Building, Room 2–120
26 Federal Plaza
New York, New York 10278
(212) 264–3825/2922
FAX (212) 264–9318

CALIFORNIA

1510 H Street, NW
Washington, DC 20005
(202) 653–5075
FAX (202) 376–5055

MASSACHUSETTS

OHIO

Thomas P. O’Neill Fed. Bldg.
10 Causeway Street, Rm. 169
Boston, Massachusetts 02222
(619) 720–4180
FAX (617) 720–5753

Room 1653, Federal Building
1240 East 9th Street
Cleveland, Ohio 44199
(216) 522–4922
FAX (216) 522–4714

MICHIGAN

Room 207, Federal Building
200 North High Street
Columbus, Ohio 43215
(614) 469–6956
FAX (614) 469–5374

Room 118, Federal Building
1000 Liberty Avenue
Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania 15222
(412) 644–2721
FAX (412) 644–4547

TEXAS
ARCO Plaza, C-Level
505 South Flower Street
Los Angeles, California 90071
(213) 239–9844
FAX (213) 239–9848

FLORIDA
100 W. Bay Street
Suite 100
Jacksonville, Florida 32202
(904) 353–0569
FAX (904) 353–1280

Marathon Plaza, Room 141-S
3C3 Second Street
San Francisco, California 94107
(415) 512–2770
FAX (415) 512–2776

GEORGIA
First Union Plaza
999 Peachtree Street, NE
Suite 120
Atlanta, Georgia 30309
(404) 347–1900
FAX (404) 347–1897

COLORADO
Room 117, Federal Building
1961 Stout Street
Denver, Colorado 80294
(303) 844–3964
FAX (303) 844–4000

Suite 160, Federal Building
477 Michigan Avenue
Detroit, Michigan 48226
(313) 226–7816
FAX (313) 226–4698

120 Bannister Mall
5600 E. Bannister Road
Kansas City, Missouri 64137
(816) 767–8225
FAX (816) 767–8233

ILLINOIS

Norwest Banks Building
201 West 8th Street
Pueblo, Colorado 81003
(719) 544–3142
FAX (719) 544–6719

1305 SW. First Avenue
Portland, Oregon 97201
(503) 221–6127
FAX (503) 225–0563

Room 194, Federal Building
915 Second Avenue
Seattle, Washington 98174
(206) 553–4270
FAX (206) 553–6717

PENNSYLVANIA

WISCONSIN

Robert Morris Building
100 North 17th Street
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 19103
(215) 636–1900
FAX (215) 636–1903

One Congress Center, Suite 124
401 South State Street
Chicago, Illinois 60605
(312) 353–5133
FAX (313) 353–1590

Texas Crude Building
801 Travis Street
Houston, Texas 77002
(713) 228–1187
FAX (713) 228–1186

WASHINGTON

OREGON
MISSOURI

Room 1C50, Federal Building
1100 Commerce Street
Dallas, Texas 75242
(214) 767–0076
FAX (214) 767–3239

The Reuss Federal Plaza
310 West Wisconsin Avenue
Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53203
(414) 297–1304
FAX (414) 297–1300

There is a 25% discount on all orders for 100 or more copies of a single title mailed to a
single address. No discount is allowed if such orders are mailed to multiple addresses.

Superintendent of Documents Publications Order Form
Order Processing Code: *8002
All prices include regular domestic postage and handling and are good through October 1997. After this date, please call the
Order and Information Desk at (202) 512–1800 to verify prices. To fax your orders and inquiries—(202) 512–2250.
Qty.

Stock Number

Title

041–001–00478–5 Budget of the United States Government, Fiscal Year 1998
041–001–00479–3 Budget of the United States Government, Fiscal Year 1998—Appendix
041–001–00480–7 Analytical Perspectives, Fiscal Year 1998
041–001–00481–5 Historical Tables, Fiscal Year 1998
041–001–00482–3 A Citizen’s Guide to the Federal Budget, Fiscal Year 1998
041–001–00483–1 The Budget System and Concepts, Fiscal Year 1998
041–001–00484–0 The Budget on CD-ROM, Fiscal Year 1998
(International customers—please add an additional 25%.)

Please Print or Type

Price
Each
$21.00
61.00
40.00
22.00
3.75
3.50
16.00
Total for Publications

Please choose method of payment:

(Company or personal name)

Check payable to the Superintendent of Documents

(Additional address/attention line)

GPO Deposit Account

(Street address)

Total
Price

–

VISA or MasterCard Account

(City, State, ZIP Code)
Thank you for your order!
(Daytime phone—including area code)
Mail To: Superintendent of Documents
Mail To: Government Printing Office,
Mail To: Washington, DC 20402–9325

(Credit card expiration date)
(Signature)